DWARF-5: call sites
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2061 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2067 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068 set a different device for your program.
2069 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071 @cindex pipes
2072 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075 wrong program.
2076 @end table
2077
2078 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2081 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087 your current breakpoints.
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex start
2091 @item start
2092 @cindex run to main procedure
2093 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098 procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102 the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104 @cindex elaboration phase
2105 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2107 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2111 will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2116 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2120 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2121 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2122 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2123 elaboration code before running your program.
2124
2125 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2126 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2127 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2128 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2129 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2130 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2131 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2132 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2133 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2134 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2135 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2136 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2137
2138 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2139 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2140 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2141 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2142
2143 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2144 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2145 environment:
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2149 (@value{GDBP}) run
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2153 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2154
2155 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2156 @item set startup-with-shell
2157 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2158 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2159 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2160 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2161 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2162 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2163 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2164 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2165 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2166 startup failures such as:
2167
2168 @smallexample
2169 (@value{GDBP}) run
2170 Starting program: ./a.out
2171 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2172 @end smallexample
2173
2174 @noindent
2175 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2176 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2177 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2178 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2179 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2180 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2181
2182 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2183 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2184 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2185 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2186 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2187 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2188
2189 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2190 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2191 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2192 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2193 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2194 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2195
2196 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2197 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2198 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2199
2200 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2201 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2202
2203 @smallexample
2204 (@value{GDBP}) run
2205 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2209 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2210
2211 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2212 @code{target native} command. For example,
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2216 (@value{GDBP}) run
2217 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2218 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2219 (@value{GDBP}) run
2220 Starting program: ./a.out
2221 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2222 @end smallexample
2223
2224 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2225 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2226 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2227 disconnect.
2228
2229 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2230 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2231 proc}, @code{info os}.
2232
2233 @kindex set disable-randomization
2234 @item set disable-randomization
2235 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2236 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2237 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2238 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2239 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2240
2241 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2242 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2246 @end smallexample
2247
2248 @item set disable-randomization off
2249 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2250 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2251 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2252 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2253 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2254 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2255
2256 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2257 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2258 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2259 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2260 a code at its expected addresses.
2261
2262 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2263 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2264 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2265 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2266 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2267 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2268 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2269 a randomly chosen address.
2270
2271 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2272 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2273 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2274 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2275 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2276
2277 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2278 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2279
2280 @item show disable-randomization
2281 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2282 the virtual address space of the started program.
2283
2284 @end table
2285
2286 @node Arguments
2287 @section Your Program's Arguments
2288
2289 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2290 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2291 @code{run} command.
2292 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2293 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2294 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2295 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2296 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2297
2298 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2299 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2300 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2301 the program, not by the shell.
2302
2303 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2304 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2305
2306 @table @code
2307 @kindex set args
2308 @item set args
2309 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2310 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2311 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2312 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2313 it again without arguments.
2314
2315 @kindex show args
2316 @item show args
2317 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2318 @end table
2319
2320 @node Environment
2321 @section Your Program's Environment
2322
2323 @cindex environment (of your program)
2324 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2325 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2326 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2327 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2328 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2329 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2330 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2331
2332 @table @code
2333 @kindex path
2334 @item path @var{directory}
2335 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2336 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2337 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2338 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2339 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2340 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2341 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2342
2343 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2344 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2345 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2346 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2347 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2348 @var{directory} to the search path.
2349 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2350 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2351
2352 @kindex show paths
2353 @item show paths
2354 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2355 environment variable).
2356
2357 @kindex show environment
2358 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2359 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2360 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2361 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2362 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2363
2364 @kindex set environment
2365 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2366 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2367 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2368 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2369 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2370 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2371 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2372 null value.
2373 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2374 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2375
2376 For example, this command:
2377
2378 @smallexample
2379 set env USER = foo
2380 @end smallexample
2381
2382 @noindent
2383 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2384 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2385 are not actually required.)
2386
2387 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2388 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2389 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2390 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2391 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2392
2393 @kindex unset environment
2394 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2395 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2396 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2397 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2398 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2399 @end table
2400
2401 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2402 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2403 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2404 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2405 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2406 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2407 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2408 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2409 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2410 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2411
2412 @node Working Directory
2413 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2414
2415 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2416 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2417 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2418 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2419 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2420 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2421
2422 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2423 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2424 Specify Files}.
2425
2426 @table @code
2427 @kindex cd
2428 @cindex change working directory
2429 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2430 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2431 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2432
2433 @kindex pwd
2434 @item pwd
2435 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2436 @end table
2437
2438 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2439 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2440 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2441 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2442 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2443 current working directory of the debuggee.
2444
2445 @node Input/Output
2446 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2447
2448 @cindex redirection
2449 @cindex i/o
2450 @cindex terminal
2451 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2452 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2453 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2454 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2455 running your program.
2456
2457 @table @code
2458 @kindex info terminal
2459 @item info terminal
2460 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2461 program is using.
2462 @end table
2463
2464 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2465 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2466
2467 @smallexample
2468 run > outfile
2469 @end smallexample
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2473
2474 @kindex tty
2475 @cindex controlling terminal
2476 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2477 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2478 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2479 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2480 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2481
2482 @smallexample
2483 tty /dev/ttyb
2484 @end smallexample
2485
2486 @noindent
2487 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2488 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2489 that as their controlling terminal.
2490
2491 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2492 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2493 terminal.
2494
2495 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2496 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2497 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2498 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2499
2500 @cindex inferior tty
2501 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2502 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2503 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2504 program.
2505
2506 @table @code
2507 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2508 @kindex set inferior-tty
2509 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2510 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2511 @value{GDBN}.
2512
2513 @item show inferior-tty
2514 @kindex show inferior-tty
2515 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 @node Attach
2519 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2520 @kindex attach
2521 @cindex attach
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @item attach @var{process-id}
2525 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2526 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2527 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2528 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2529 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2530
2531 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2536 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2537 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2538 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2539
2540 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2541 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2542 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2543 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2544 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2545 Specify Files}.
2546
2547 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2548 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2549 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2550 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2551 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2552 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2553 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2554
2555 @table @code
2556 @kindex detach
2557 @item detach
2558 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2559 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2560 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2561 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2562 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2563 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2564 executing the command.
2565 @end table
2566
2567 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2568 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2569 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2570 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2571 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2572 Messages}).
2573
2574 @node Kill Process
2575 @section Killing the Child Process
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @kindex kill
2579 @item kill
2580 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2581 @end table
2582
2583 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2584 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2585 is running.
2586
2587 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2588 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2589 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2590 outside the debugger.
2591
2592 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2593 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2594 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2595 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2596 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2597 breakpoint settings).
2598
2599 @node Inferiors and Programs
2600 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2601
2602 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2603 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2604 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2605 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2606 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2607 from multiple executables.
2608
2609 @cindex inferior
2610 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2611 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2612 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2613 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2614 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2615 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2616 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2617 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2618 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2619 threads running in it.
2620
2621 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2622 inferiors}}:
2623
2624 @table @code
2625 @kindex info inferiors
2626 @item info inferiors
2627 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2628
2629 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2630
2631 @enumerate
2632 @item
2633 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2634
2635 @item
2636 the target system's inferior identifier
2637
2638 @item
2639 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2640
2641 @end enumerate
2642
2643 @noindent
2644 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2645 indicates the current inferior.
2646
2647 For example,
2648 @end table
2649 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2650
2651 @smallexample
2652 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2653 Num Description Executable
2654 2 process 2307 hello
2655 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2656 @end smallexample
2657
2658 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2659
2660 @table @code
2661 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2662 @item inferior @var{infno}
2663 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2664 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2665 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2666 @end table
2667
2668 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2669 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2670 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2671 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2672 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2673 information on convenience variables.
2674
2675 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2676 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2677 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2678 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2679 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2680 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2681
2682 @table @code
2683 @kindex add-inferior
2684 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2685 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2686 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2687 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2688 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2689 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2690
2691 @kindex clone-inferior
2692 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2693 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2694 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2695 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2696 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2697
2698 @smallexample
2699 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2700 Num Description Executable
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2703 Added inferior 2.
2704 1 inferiors added.
2705 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2706 Num Description Executable
2707 2 <null> helloworld
2708 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2712
2713 @kindex remove-inferiors
2714 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2716 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2717 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2718
2719 @end table
2720
2721 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2722 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2723 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2724 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2725
2726 @table @code
2727 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2730 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2731 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2732 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733
2734 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2735 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2736 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2737 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2738 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2739 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2740 @end table
2741
2742 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2743 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2744 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2745 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2746
2747
2748 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2749 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2750
2751 @table @code
2752 @kindex set print inferior-events
2753 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2754 @item set print inferior-events
2755 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2756 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2757 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2758 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2759 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2760 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2761
2762 @kindex show print inferior-events
2763 @item show print inferior-events
2764 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2765 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2766 @end table
2767
2768 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2769 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2770 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2771
2772
2773 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2774 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2775 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2776 info program-spaces}} command.
2777
2778 @table @code
2779 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2780 @item maint info program-spaces
2781 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2782 @value{GDBN}.
2783
2784 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2785
2786 @enumerate
2787 @item
2788 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2789
2790 @item
2791 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2792 the @code{file} command.
2793
2794 @end enumerate
2795
2796 @noindent
2797 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2798 indicates the current program space.
2799
2800 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2801 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2802 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2803
2804 @smallexample
2805 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2806 Id Executable
2807 * 1 hello
2808 2 goodbye
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2813 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2814 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2815 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2816 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2817
2818 @smallexample
2819 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2820 Id Executable
2821 * 1 vfork-test
2822 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2826 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2827 @end table
2828
2829 @node Threads
2830 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2831
2832 @cindex threads of execution
2833 @cindex multiple threads
2834 @cindex switching threads
2835 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2836 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2837 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2838 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2839 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2840 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2841 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2842
2843 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2844 programs:
2845
2846 @itemize @bullet
2847 @item automatic notification of new threads
2848 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2849 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2850 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2851 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2852 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2853 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2854 messages on thread start and exit.
2855 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2856 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2857 isn't compatible with the program.
2858 @end itemize
2859
2860 @cindex focus of debugging
2861 @cindex current thread
2862 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2863 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2864 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2865 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2866 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2867
2868 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2869 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2870 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2871 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2872 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2873 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2874 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2875 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2876 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2877 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2881 @end smallexample
2882
2883 @noindent
2884 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2885 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2886 further qualifier.
2887
2888 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2889 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2890 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2891 @c program?
2892 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2893 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2894 @c threads ab initio?
2895
2896 @anchor{thread numbers}
2897 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2898 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2899 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2900 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2901 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2902 between threads of different inferiors.
2903
2904 @cindex qualified thread ID
2905 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2906 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2907 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2908 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2909 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2910 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2911 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2912 inferior.
2913
2914 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2915 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2916 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2917 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2918
2919 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2920 @cindex thread ID lists
2921 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2922 argument. A list element can be:
2923
2924 @enumerate
2925 @item
2926 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2927 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2928 @samp{1}.
2929
2930 @item
2931 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2932 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2933 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2934
2935 @item
2936 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2937 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2938 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2939 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2940 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2941
2942 @end enumerate
2943
2944 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2945 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2946 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2947 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2948 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2949 7.1}.
2950
2951
2952 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2953 @cindex global thread number
2954 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2955 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2956 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2957 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2958 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2959 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2960
2961 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2962 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2963 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2964
2965 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2966 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2967 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2968 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2969 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2970 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2971 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2972 general information on convenience variables.
2973
2974 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2975 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2976 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2977
2978 @smallexample
2979 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2980 @end smallexample
2981
2982 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2983
2984 @smallexample
2985 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2986 @end smallexample
2987
2988 @table @code
2989 @kindex info threads
2990 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2991
2992 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2993 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2994 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2995 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2996
2997 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2998
2999 @enumerate
3000 @item
3001 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3002
3003 @item
3004 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3005 option was specified
3006
3007 @item
3008 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3009
3010 @item
3011 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3012 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3013 program itself.
3014
3015 @item
3016 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3017 @end enumerate
3018
3019 @noindent
3020 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3021 indicates the current thread.
3022
3023 For example,
3024 @end table
3025 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3026
3027 @smallexample
3028 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3029 Id Target Id Frame
3030 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3031 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3032 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3033 at threadtest.c:68
3034 @end smallexample
3035
3036 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3037 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3038 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3039
3040 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3041 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3042
3043 @smallexample
3044 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3045 Id GId Target Id Frame
3046 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3047 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3048 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3049 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3050 @end smallexample
3051
3052 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3053 Solaris-specific command:
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @item maint info sol-threads
3057 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3058 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3059 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3060 @end table
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3064 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3065 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3066 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3067 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3068 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3069
3070 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3071 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3075 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3076 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3077 8 printf ("hello\n");
3078 @end smallexample
3079
3080 @noindent
3081 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3082 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3083 threads.
3084
3085 @kindex thread apply
3086 @cindex apply command to several threads
3087 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3088 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3089 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3090 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3091 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3092 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3093 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3094 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3095
3096
3097 @kindex thread name
3098 @cindex name a thread
3099 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3100 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3101 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3102 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3103
3104 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3105 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3106 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3107 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3108 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3109
3110 @kindex thread find
3111 @cindex search for a thread
3112 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3113 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3114 matches the supplied regular expression.
3115
3116 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3117 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3118 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3119 is the LWP id.
3120
3121 @smallexample
3122 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3123 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3124 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3125 Id Target Id Frame
3126 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @kindex set print thread-events
3130 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3131 @item set print thread-events
3132 @itemx set print thread-events on
3133 @itemx set print thread-events off
3134 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3135 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3136 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3137 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3138 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3139
3140 @kindex show print thread-events
3141 @item show print thread-events
3142 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3143 have started and exited.
3144 @end table
3145
3146 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3147 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3148 programs with multiple threads.
3149
3150 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3151 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3152
3153 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3154 @table @code
3155 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3156 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3157 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3158 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3159 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3160 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3161 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3162 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3163 macro.
3164
3165 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3166 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3167 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3169 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3170 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3171
3172 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3173 refers to the default system directories that are
3174 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3175 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3176 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3177
3178 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3179 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3180 was loaded in the inferior process.
3181
3182 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3183 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3184 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3185 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3186 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3187 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3188 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3189
3190 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3191 only on some platforms.
3192
3193 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3194 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3195 Display current libthread_db search path.
3196
3197 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3198 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3199 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3200 @item set debug libthread-db
3201 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3202 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3203 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3204 @end table
3205
3206 @node Forks
3207 @section Debugging Forks
3208
3209 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3210 @cindex multiple processes
3211 @cindex processes, multiple
3212 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3213 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3214 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3215 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3216 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3217 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3218 will cause it to terminate.
3219
3220 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3221 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3222 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3223 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3224 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3225 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3226 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3227 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3228 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3229 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3230
3231 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3232 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3233 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3234 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3235
3236 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3237 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3238 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3239
3240 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3241 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3242
3243 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3244 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3248 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3249 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3250 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3251 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3252
3253 @table @code
3254 @item parent
3255 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3256 unimpeded. This is the default.
3257
3258 @item child
3259 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3260 unimpeded.
3261
3262 @end table
3263
3264 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3265 @item show follow-fork-mode
3266 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3267 @end table
3268
3269 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3270 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3271 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3272
3273 @table @code
3274 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3275 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3276 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3277 retain debugger control over them both.
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @item on
3281 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3282 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3283 independently. This is the default.
3284
3285 @item off
3286 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3287 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3288 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3289 is held suspended.
3290
3291 @end table
3292
3293 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3294 @item show detach-on-fork
3295 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3296 @end table
3297
3298 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3299 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3300 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3301 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3302 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3303 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3304
3305 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3306 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3307 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3308 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3309 and Programs}.
3310
3311 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3312 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3313 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3314 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3315 the child process's @code{main}.
3316
3317 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3318 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3319
3320 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3321 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3322 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3323 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3324 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3325 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3326 command.
3327
3328 @table @code
3329 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3330 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3331
3332 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3333 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3334
3335 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3336
3337 @table @code
3338 @item new
3339 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3340 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3341 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3342 original inferior.
3343
3344 For example:
3345
3346 @smallexample
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 (gdb) info inferior
3349 Id Description Executable
3350 * 1 <null> prog1
3351 (@value{GDBP}) run
3352 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3353 Program exited normally.
3354 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3355 Id Description Executable
3356 1 <null> prog1
3357 * 2 <null> prog2
3358 @end smallexample
3359
3360 @item same
3361 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3362 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3363 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3364 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3365 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3366
3367 For example:
3368
3369 @smallexample
3370 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3371 Id Description Executable
3372 * 1 <null> prog1
3373 (@value{GDBP}) run
3374 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3375 Program exited normally.
3376 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3377 Id Description Executable
3378 * 1 <null> prog2
3379 @end smallexample
3380
3381 @end table
3382 @end table
3383
3384 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3385 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3386
3387 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3388 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3389 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3390
3391 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3392 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3393
3394 @cindex checkpoint
3395 @cindex restart
3396 @cindex bookmark
3397 @cindex snapshot of a process
3398 @cindex rewind program state
3399
3400 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3401 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3402 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3403 later.
3404
3405 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3406 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3407 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3408 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3409 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3410
3411 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3412 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3413 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3414 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3415 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3416 start again from there.
3417
3418 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3419 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3420
3421 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3422
3423 @table @code
3424 @kindex checkpoint
3425 @item checkpoint
3426 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3427 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3428 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3429
3430 @kindex info checkpoints
3431 @item info checkpoints
3432 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3433 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3434 listed:
3435
3436 @table @code
3437 @item Checkpoint ID
3438 @item Process ID
3439 @item Code Address
3440 @item Source line, or label
3441 @end table
3442
3443 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3444 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3445 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3446 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3447 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3448 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3449 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3450
3451 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3452 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3453 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3454 the debugger.
3455
3456 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3457 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3458 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3459
3460 @end table
3461
3462 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3463 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3464 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3465 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3466 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3467 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3468 previously read data can be read again.
3469
3470 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3471 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3472 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3473 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3474 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3475 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3476
3477 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3478 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3479 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3480 different execution path this time.
3481
3482 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3483 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3484 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3485 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3486 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3487 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3488 potentially pose a problem.
3489
3490 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3491
3492 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3493 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3494 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3495 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3496 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3497 next.
3498
3499 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3500 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3501 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3502 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3503 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3504
3505 @node Stopping
3506 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3507
3508 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3509 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3510 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3511
3512 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3513 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3514 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3515 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3516 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3517 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3518 explicitly request this information at any time.
3519
3520 @table @code
3521 @kindex info program
3522 @item info program
3523 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3524 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3525 @end table
3526
3527 @menu
3528 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3529 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3530 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3531 Skipping over functions and files
3532 * Signals:: Signals
3533 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3534 @end menu
3535
3536 @node Breakpoints
3537 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3538
3539 @cindex breakpoints
3540 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3541 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3542 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3543 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3544 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3545 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3546 program.
3547
3548 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3549 the executable is run.
3550
3551 @cindex watchpoints
3552 @cindex data breakpoints
3553 @cindex memory tracing
3554 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3555 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3556 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3557 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3558 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3559 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3560 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3561 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3562 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3563 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3564 same commands.
3565
3566 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3567 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3568 Automatic Display}.
3569
3570 @cindex catchpoints
3571 @cindex breakpoint on events
3572 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3573 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3574 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3575 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3576 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3577 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3578 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3579
3580 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3581 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3582 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3583 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3584 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3585 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3586 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3587 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3588 enable it again.
3589
3590 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3591 @cindex breakpoint lists
3592 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3593 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3594 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3595 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3596 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3597 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3598 are operated on.
3599
3600 @menu
3601 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3602 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3603 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3604 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3605 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3606 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3607 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3608 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3609 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3610 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3611 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3612 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3613 @end menu
3614
3615 @node Set Breaks
3616 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3617
3618 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3619 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3620 @c
3621 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3622
3623 @kindex break
3624 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3625 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3626 @cindex latest breakpoint
3627 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3628 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3629 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3630 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3631 convenience variables.
3632
3633 @table @code
3634 @item break @var{location}
3635 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3636 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3637 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3638 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3639 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3640
3641 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3642 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3643 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3644 that situation.
3645
3646 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3647 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3648 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3649
3650 @item break
3651 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3652 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3653 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3654 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3655 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3656 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3657 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3658 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3659 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3660 inside loops.
3661
3662 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3663 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3664 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3665 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3666 existed when your program stopped.
3667
3668 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3669 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3670 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3671 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3672 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3673 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3674 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3675
3676 @kindex tbreak
3677 @item tbreak @var{args}
3678 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3679 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3680 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3681 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3682
3683 @kindex hbreak
3684 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3685 @item hbreak @var{args}
3686 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3687 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3688 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3689 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3690 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3691 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3692 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3693 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3694 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3695 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3696 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3697 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3698 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3699 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3700 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3701 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3702 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3703 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3704
3705 @kindex thbreak
3706 @item thbreak @var{args}
3707 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3708 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3709 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3710 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3711 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3712 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3713 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3714 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3715
3716 @kindex rbreak
3717 @cindex regular expression
3718 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3719 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3720 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3721 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3722 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3723 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3724 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3725 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3726 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3727
3728 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3729 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3730 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3731 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3732 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3733 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3734
3735 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3736 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3737 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3738 classes.
3739
3740 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3741 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3742 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3746 @end smallexample
3747
3748 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3749 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3750 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3751 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3752 every function in a given file:
3753
3754 @smallexample
3755 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3756 @end smallexample
3757
3758 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3759 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3760
3761 @kindex info breakpoints
3762 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3763 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3764 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3765 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3766 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3767 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3768 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3769
3770 @table @emph
3771 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3772 @item Type
3773 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3774 @item Disposition
3775 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3776 @item Enabled or Disabled
3777 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3778 that are not enabled.
3779 @item Address
3780 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3781 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3782 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3783 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3784 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3785 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3786 @item What
3787 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3788 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3789 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3790 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @noindent
3794 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3795 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3796 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3797 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3798 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3799 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3800
3801 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3802 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3803 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3804 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3805
3806 @noindent
3807 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3808 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3809 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3810 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3811 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3812
3813 @noindent
3814 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3815 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3816 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3817 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3818 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3819 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3820
3821 @noindent
3822 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3823 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3824
3825 @end table
3826
3827 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3828 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3829 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3830 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3831
3832 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3833 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3834 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3835 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3836
3837 @itemize @bullet
3838 @item
3839 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3840
3841 @item
3842 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3843 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3844
3845 @item
3846 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3847 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3848
3849 @item
3850 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3851 several places where that function is inlined.
3852 @end itemize
3853
3854 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3855 the relevant locations.
3856
3857 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3858 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3859 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3860 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3861 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3862 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3863 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3864
3865 For example:
3866
3867 @smallexample
3868 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3869 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3870 stop only if i==1
3871 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3872 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3873 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3874 @end smallexample
3875
3876 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3877 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3878 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3879 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3880 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3881 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3882 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3883 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3884 that belong to that breakpoint.
3885
3886 @cindex pending breakpoints
3887 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3888 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3889 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3890 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3891 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3892 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3893 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3894 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3895 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3896 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3897 is not yet resolved.
3898
3899 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3900 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3901 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3902 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3903 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3904 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3905
3906 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3907 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3908 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3909 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3910
3911 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3912 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3913 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3914
3915 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3916 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3917 address specification to an address:
3918
3919 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3920 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3921 @table @code
3922 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3923 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3924 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3925
3926 @item set breakpoint pending on
3927 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3928 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3929
3930 @item set breakpoint pending off
3931 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3932 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3933 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3934
3935 @item show breakpoint pending
3936 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3937 @end table
3938
3939 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3940 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3941 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3942
3943 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3944 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3945 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3946 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3947 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3948 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3949 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3950 breakpoints.
3951
3952 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3953
3954 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3955 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3956 @table @code
3957 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3958 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3959 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3960 breakpoint must be used.
3961
3962 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3963 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3964 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3965 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3966 @end table
3967
3968 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3969 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3970 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3971 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3972 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3973 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3974 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3975 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3976 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3977
3978 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3979 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3980 @table @code
3981 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3982 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3983 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3984 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3985
3986 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3987 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3988 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3989 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3990 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3991 @end table
3992
3993 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3994 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3995 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3996
3997 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3998 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3999
4000 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4001
4002 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4003 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4006 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4007 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4008 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4009 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4010
4011 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4012 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4013 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4014 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4015 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4016 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4017 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4018 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4019 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4020 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4021 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4022 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4023 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4024
4025 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4026 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4027 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4028 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4029 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4030 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4031 @end table
4032
4033
4034 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4035 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4036 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4037 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4038 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4039 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4040 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4041 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4042
4043
4044 @node Set Watchpoints
4045 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4046
4047 @cindex setting watchpoints
4048 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4049 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4050 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4051 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4052 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4053
4054 @itemize @bullet
4055 @item
4056 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4057
4058 @item
4059 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4060 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4061 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4062
4063 @item
4064 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4065 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4066 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4067 @end itemize
4068
4069 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4070 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4071 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4072 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4073 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4074 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4075 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4076 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4077 the expression changes.
4078
4079 @cindex software watchpoints
4080 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4081 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4082 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4083 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4084 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4085 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4086 culprit.)
4087
4088 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4089 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4090 slow down the running of your program.
4091
4092 @table @code
4093 @kindex watch
4094 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4095 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4096 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4097 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4098 to watch the value of a single variable:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4102 @end smallexample
4103
4104 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4105 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4106 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4107 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4108 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4109 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4110
4111 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4112 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4113 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4114 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4115 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4116 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4117 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4118 error.
4119
4120 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4121 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4122 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4123 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4124 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4125 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4126 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4127 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4128 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4129 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4130 Examples:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4134 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4135 @end smallexample
4136
4137 @kindex rwatch
4138 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4139 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4140 by the program.
4141
4142 @kindex awatch
4143 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4144 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4145 or written into by the program.
4146
4147 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4148 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4149 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4150 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4151 @end table
4152
4153 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4154 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4155 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4156 a never-changing value:
4157
4158 @smallexample
4159 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4160 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4161 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4162 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4163 @end smallexample
4164
4165 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4166 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4167 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4168 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4169 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4170 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4171
4172 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4173 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4174 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4175 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4176 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4177 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4178 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4179 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4180
4181 @table @code
4182 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4183 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4184 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4185
4186 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4187 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4188 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4189 @end table
4190
4191 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4192 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4193 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4194
4195 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4196
4197 @smallexample
4198 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4199 @end smallexample
4200
4201 @noindent
4202 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4203
4204 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4205 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4206 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4207 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4208 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4209 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4210 will print a message like this:
4211
4212 @smallexample
4213 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4214 @end smallexample
4215
4216 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4217 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4218 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4219 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4220 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4221 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4222 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4223 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4224
4225 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4226 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4227 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4228 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4229 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4230 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4231
4232 @smallexample
4233 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4234 @end smallexample
4235
4236 @noindent
4237 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4238
4239 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4240 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4241 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4242 expression with separately allocated resources.
4243
4244 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4245 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4246 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4247
4248 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4249 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4250 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4251 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4252 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4253 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4254 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4255 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4256 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4257
4258 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4259 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4260 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4261 watched expression from every thread.
4262
4263 @quotation
4264 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4265 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4266 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4267 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4268 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4269 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4270 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4271 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4272 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4273 @end quotation
4274
4275 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4276
4277 @node Set Catchpoints
4278 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4279 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4280 @cindex exception handlers
4281 @cindex event handling
4282
4283 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4284 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4285 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @kindex catch
4289 @item catch @var{event}
4290 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4294 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4295 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4296 @kindex catch throw
4297 @kindex catch rethrow
4298 @kindex catch catch
4299 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4300 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4301
4302 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4303 regular expression will be caught.
4304
4305 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4306 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4307 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4308 exception being thrown.
4309
4310 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4311 @value{GDBN}:
4312
4313 @itemize @bullet
4314 @item
4315 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4316 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4317 supported.
4318
4319 @item
4320 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4321 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4322 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4323 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4324 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4325 built.
4326
4327 @item
4328 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4329 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4330
4331 @item
4332 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4333 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4334 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4335 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4336
4337 @item
4338 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4339 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4340 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4341 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4342 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4343 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4344 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4345 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4346 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4347
4348 @item
4349 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4350
4351 @item
4352 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4353 @end itemize
4354
4355 @item exception
4356 @kindex catch exception
4357 @cindex Ada exception catching
4358 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4359 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4360 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4361 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4362 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4363
4364 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4365 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4366 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4367 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4368 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4369 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4370 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4371 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4372
4373 @item exception unhandled
4374 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4375 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4376
4377 @item assert
4378 @kindex catch assert
4379 A failed Ada assertion.
4380
4381 @item exec
4382 @kindex catch exec
4383 @cindex break on fork/exec
4384 A call to @code{exec}.
4385
4386 @item syscall
4387 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4388 @kindex catch syscall
4389 @cindex break on a system call.
4390 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4391 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4392 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4393 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4394 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4395 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4396 will be caught.
4397
4398 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4399 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4400 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4401 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4402
4403 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4404 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4405 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4406 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4407
4408 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4409 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4410 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4411 available choices.
4412
4413 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4414 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4415 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4416 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4417 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4418 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4419 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4420 behind the OS upgrades).
4421
4422 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4423 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4424 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4425 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4426 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4427 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4428 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4429 syscall groups available on your environment.
4430
4431 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4432 arguments to it:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4451
4452 @smallexample
4453 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4454 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4455 (@value{GDBP}) r
4456 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4457
4458 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4459 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4460 (@value{GDBP}) c
4461 Continuing.
4462
4463 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4464 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4465 (@value{GDBP})
4466 @end smallexample
4467
4468 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4469 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4470 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4471
4472 @smallexample
4473 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4474 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4475 (@value{GDBP}) r
4476 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4477
4478 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4479 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4480 (@value{GDBP}) c
4481 Continuing.
4482
4483 Program exited normally.
4484 (@value{GDBP})
4485 @end smallexample
4486
4487 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4488
4489 @smallexample
4490 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4491 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4492 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4493 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4494 (@value{GDBP}) r
4495 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4496
4497 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4498 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4499
4500 (@value{GDBP}) c
4501 Continuing.
4502 @end smallexample
4503
4504 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4505 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4506 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4507 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4508
4509 @smallexample
4510 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4511 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4512 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4513 (@value{GDBP})
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4517 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4518 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4519 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4520 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4521 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4522
4523 @smallexample
4524 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4525 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4526 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4527 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4528 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4529 (@value{GDBP})
4530 @end smallexample
4531
4532 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4533
4534 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4535 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4536
4537 @smallexample
4538 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4539 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4540 @end smallexample
4541
4542 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4543
4544 @item fork
4545 @kindex catch fork
4546 A call to @code{fork}.
4547
4548 @item vfork
4549 @kindex catch vfork
4550 A call to @code{vfork}.
4551
4552 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4553 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4554 @kindex catch load
4555 @kindex catch unload
4556 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4557 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4558 matches one of the affected libraries.
4559
4560 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4561 @kindex catch signal
4562 The delivery of a signal.
4563
4564 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4565 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4566 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4567
4568 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4569 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4570 signal names.
4571
4572 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4573 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4577 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4578 catchpoint.
4579
4580 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4581 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4582 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4583 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4584 commands.
4585
4586 @end table
4587
4588 @item tcatch @var{event}
4589 @kindex tcatch
4590 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4591 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4592
4593 @end table
4594
4595 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4596
4597
4598 @node Delete Breaks
4599 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4600
4601 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4602 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4603 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4604 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4605 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4606 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4607
4608 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4609 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4610 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4611 their breakpoint numbers.
4612
4613 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4614 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4615 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4616
4617 @table @code
4618 @kindex clear
4619 @item clear
4620 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4621 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4622 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4623 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4624
4625 @item clear @var{location}
4626 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4627 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4628 most useful ones are listed below:
4629
4630 @table @code
4631 @item clear @var{function}
4632 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4633 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4634
4635 @item clear @var{linenum}
4636 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4637 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4638 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 @cindex delete breakpoints
4642 @kindex delete
4643 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4644 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4645 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4646 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4647 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4648 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4649 @end table
4650
4651 @node Disabling
4652 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4653
4654 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4655 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4656 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4657 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4658 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4659
4660 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4661 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4662 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4663 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4664 do not know which numbers to use.
4665
4666 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4667 affects all of its locations.
4668
4669 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4670 different states of enablement:
4671
4672 @itemize @bullet
4673 @item
4674 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4675 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4676 @item
4677 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4678 @item
4679 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4680 disabled.
4681 @item
4682 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4683 N times, then becomes disabled.
4684 @item
4685 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4686 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4687 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4688 @end itemize
4689
4690 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4691 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4692
4693 @table @code
4694 @kindex disable
4695 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4696 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4697 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4698 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4699 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4700 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4701 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4702
4703 @kindex enable
4704 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4705 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4706 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4707
4708 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4709 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4710 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4711
4712 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4713 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4714 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4715 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4716 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4717 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4718 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4719
4720 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4721 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4722 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4723 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4724 @end table
4725
4726 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4727 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4728 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4729 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4730 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4731 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4732 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4733 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4734 Stepping}.)
4735
4736 @node Conditions
4737 @subsection Break Conditions
4738 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4739 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4740
4741 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4742 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4743 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4744 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4745 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4746 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4747 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4748 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4749
4750 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4751 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4752 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4753 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4754 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4755
4756 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4757 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4758 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4759 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4760 one.
4761
4762 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4763 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4764 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4765 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4766 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4767 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4768 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4769 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4770 conditions for the
4771 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4772 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4773
4774 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4775 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4776 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4777 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4778 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4779 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4780
4781 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4782 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4783 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4784 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4785 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4786
4787 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4788 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4789 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4790 with the @code{condition} command.
4791
4792 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4793 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4794 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4795 catchpoint.
4796
4797 @table @code
4798 @kindex condition
4799 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4800 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4801 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4802 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4803 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4804 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4805 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4806 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4807 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4808 prints an error message:
4809
4810 @smallexample
4811 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4812 @end smallexample
4813
4814 @noindent
4815 @value{GDBN} does
4816 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4817 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4818 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4819
4820 @item condition @var{bnum}
4821 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4822 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4823 @end table
4824
4825 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4826 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4827 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4828 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4829 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4830 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4831 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4832 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4833 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4834 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4835 your program reaches it.
4836
4837 @table @code
4838 @kindex ignore
4839 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4840 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4841 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4842 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4843 takes no action.
4844
4845 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4846 a count of zero.
4847
4848 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4849 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4850 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4851 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4852
4853 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4854 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4855 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4856
4857 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4858 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4859 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4860 Variables}.
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4864
4865
4866 @node Break Commands
4867 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4868
4869 @cindex breakpoint commands
4870 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4871 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4872 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4873 enable other breakpoints.
4874
4875 @table @code
4876 @kindex commands
4877 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4878 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4879 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4880 @itemx end
4881 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4882 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4883 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4884
4885 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4886 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4887
4888 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4889 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4890 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4891 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4892 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4893 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4894 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4895 Expressions}).
4896 @end table
4897
4898 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4899 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4900
4901 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4902 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4903 that resumes execution.
4904
4905 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4906 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4907 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4908 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4909 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4910
4911 @kindex silent
4912 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4913 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4914 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4915 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4916 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4917 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4918
4919 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4920 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4921 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4922
4923 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4924 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4925
4926 @smallexample
4927 break foo if x>0
4928 commands
4929 silent
4930 printf "x is %d\n",x
4931 cont
4932 end
4933 @end smallexample
4934
4935 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4936 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4937 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4938 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4939 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4940 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4941 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4942
4943 @smallexample
4944 break 403
4945 commands
4946 silent
4947 set x = y + 4
4948 cont
4949 end
4950 @end smallexample
4951
4952 @node Dynamic Printf
4953 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4954
4955 @cindex dynamic printf
4956 @cindex dprintf
4957 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4958 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4959 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4960 having to recompile it.
4961
4962 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4963 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4964 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4965 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4966 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4967 redirects to files and so forth.
4968
4969 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4970 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4971 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4972 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4973 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4974 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4975 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4976
4977 @table @code
4978 @kindex dprintf
4979 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4980 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4981 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4982 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4983
4984 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4985 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4986 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4987 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4988 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4989 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4990
4991 @table @code
4992 @item gdb
4993 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4994 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4995
4996 @item call
4997 @kindex dprintf-style call
4998 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4999 @code{printf}).
5000
5001 @item agent
5002 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5003 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5004 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5005 support running commands on the target.
5006 @end table
5007
5008 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5009 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5010 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5011 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5012 command.
5013
5014 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5015 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5016 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5017 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5018 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5019 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5020
5021 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5022 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5023 you could do the following:
5024
5025 @example
5026 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5027 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5028 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5029 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5030 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5031 (gdb) info break
5032 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5033 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5034 continue
5035 (gdb)
5036 @end example
5037
5038 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5039 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5040 the variable settings.
5041
5042 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5043 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5044 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5045 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5046 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5047 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5048
5049 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5050 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5051 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5052
5053 @end table
5054
5055 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5056 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5057 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5058 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5059 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5060 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5061
5062 @node Save Breakpoints
5063 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5064
5065 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5066 breakpoints}} command.
5067
5068 @table @code
5069 @kindex save breakpoints
5070 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5071 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5072 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5073 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5074 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5075 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5076 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5077 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5078 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5079 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5080 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5081 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5082 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5083 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5084 that can no longer be recreated.
5085 @end table
5086
5087 @node Static Probe Points
5088 @subsection Static Probe Points
5089
5090 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5091 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5092 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5093 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5094 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5095
5096 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5097 ELF-compatible systems:
5098
5099 @itemize @bullet
5100
5101 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5102 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5103 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5104 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5105 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5106 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5107 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5108 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5109
5110 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5111 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5112 C@t{++} languages.
5113 @end itemize
5114
5115 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5116 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5117 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5118 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5119 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5120 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5121 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5122 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5123 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5124
5125 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5126 probes}, with optional arguments:
5127
5128 @table @code
5129 @kindex info probes
5130 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5131 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5132 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5133 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5134
5135 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5136 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5137 probes from all providers are listed.
5138
5139 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5140 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5141 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5142
5143 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5144 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5145 given, all object files are considered.
5146
5147 @item info probes all
5148 List the available static probes, from all types.
5149 @end table
5150
5151 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5152 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5153 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5154 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5155 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5156
5157 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5158 commands, with optional arguments:
5159
5160 @table @code
5161 @kindex enable probes
5162 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5163 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5164 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5165 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5166
5167 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5168 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5169 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5170
5171 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5172 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5173 given, all object files are considered.
5174
5175 @kindex disable probes
5176 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5177 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5178 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5179 @end table
5180
5181 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5182 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5183 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5184 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5185 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5186 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5187 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5188 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5189 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5190 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5191 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5192 at the current probe point.
5193
5194 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5195 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5196 an error message.
5197
5198
5199 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5200 @node Error in Breakpoints
5201 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5202
5203 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5204 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5205
5206 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5207 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5208 @smallexample
5209 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5210 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5211 @end smallexample
5212
5213 @noindent
5214 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5215 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5216 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5217
5218 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5219 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5220
5221 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5222 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5223 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5224
5225 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5226 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5227 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5228 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5229
5230 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5231 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5232 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5233 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5234 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5235 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5236 first in the bundle.
5237
5238 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5239 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5240 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5241 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5242 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5243 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5244 is hit.
5245
5246 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5247 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5251 @end smallexample
5252
5253 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5254 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5255 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5256 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5257 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5258 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5259 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5260 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5261
5262 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5263 adjusted breakpoints:
5264
5265 @smallexample
5266 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5267 to 0x00010410.
5268 @end smallexample
5269
5270 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5271 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5272 frequently than expected.
5273
5274 @node Continuing and Stepping
5275 @section Continuing and Stepping
5276
5277 @cindex stepping
5278 @cindex continuing
5279 @cindex resuming execution
5280 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5281 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5282 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5283 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5284 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5285 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5286 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5287 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5288 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5289 handlers}).)
5290
5291 @table @code
5292 @kindex continue
5293 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5294 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5295 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5296 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5297 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5298 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5299 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5300 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5301 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5302 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5303
5304 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5305 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5306 @code{continue} is ignored.
5307
5308 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5309 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5310 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5311 @code{continue}.
5312 @end table
5313
5314 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5315 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5316 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5317 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5318
5319 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5320 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5321 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5322 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5323 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5324 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5325
5326 @table @code
5327 @kindex step
5328 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5329 @item step
5330 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5331 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5332 abbreviated @code{s}.
5333
5334 @quotation
5335 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5336 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5337 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5338 @c distinction here.
5339 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5340 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5341 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5342 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5343 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5344 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5345 below.
5346 @end quotation
5347
5348 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5349 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5350 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5351 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5352 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5353 called within the line.
5354
5355 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5356 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5357 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5358 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5359 was any debugging information about the routine.
5360
5361 @item step @var{count}
5362 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5363 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5364 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5365
5366 @kindex next
5367 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5368 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5369 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5370 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5371 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5372 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5373 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5374 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5375
5376 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5377
5378
5379 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5380 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5381 @c
5382 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5383 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5384 @c function are executed without stopping.
5385
5386 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5387 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5388 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5389
5390 @kindex set step-mode
5391 @item set step-mode
5392 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5393 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5394 @itemx set step-mode on
5395 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5396 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5397 information rather than stepping over it.
5398
5399 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5400 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5401 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5402
5403 @item set step-mode off
5404 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5405 debug information. This is the default.
5406
5407 @item show step-mode
5408 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5409 source line debug information.
5410
5411 @kindex finish
5412 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5413 @item finish
5414 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5415 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5416 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5417
5418 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5419 ,Returning from a Function}).
5420
5421 @kindex until
5422 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5423 @cindex run until specified location
5424 @item until
5425 @itemx u
5426 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5427 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5428 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5429 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5430 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5431 than the address of the jump.
5432
5433 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5434 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5435 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5436 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5437 through the next iteration.
5438
5439 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5440 stack frame.
5441
5442 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5443 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5444 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5445 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5446 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5447
5448 @smallexample
5449 (@value{GDBP}) f
5450 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5451 206 expand_input();
5452 (@value{GDBP}) until
5453 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5454 @end smallexample
5455
5456 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5457 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5458 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5459 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5460 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5461 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5462 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5463
5464 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5465 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5466 argument.
5467
5468 @item until @var{location}
5469 @itemx u @var{location}
5470 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5471 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5472 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5473 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5474 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5475 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5476 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5477 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5478 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5479 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5480 invocations have returned.
5481
5482 @smallexample
5483 94 int factorial (int value)
5484 95 @{
5485 96 if (value > 1) @{
5486 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5487 98 @}
5488 99 return (value);
5489 100 @}
5490 @end smallexample
5491
5492
5493 @kindex advance @var{location}
5494 @item advance @var{location}
5495 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5496 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5497 @ref{Specify Location}.
5498 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5499 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5500 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5501 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5502
5503
5504 @kindex stepi
5505 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5506 @item stepi
5507 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5508 @itemx si
5509 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5510
5511 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5512 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5513 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5514 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5515
5516 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5517
5518 @need 750
5519 @kindex nexti
5520 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5521 @item nexti
5522 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5523 @itemx ni
5524 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5525 proceed until the function returns.
5526
5527 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5528
5529 @end table
5530
5531 @anchor{range stepping}
5532 @cindex range stepping
5533 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5534 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5535 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5536 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5537 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5538 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5539 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5540 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5541 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5542 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5543 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5544 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5545 if necessary:
5546
5547 @table @code
5548 @kindex set range-stepping
5549 @kindex show range-stepping
5550 @item set range-stepping
5551 @itemx show range-stepping
5552 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5553
5554 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5555 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5556 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5557 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5558 default is @code{on}.
5559
5560 @end table
5561
5562 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5563 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5564 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5565
5566 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5567 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5568 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5569 a particular file when stepping.
5570
5571 For example, consider the following C function:
5572
5573 @smallexample
5574 101 int func()
5575 102 @{
5576 103 foo(boring());
5577 104 bar(boring());
5578 105 @}
5579 @end smallexample
5580
5581 @noindent
5582 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5583 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5584 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5585 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5586
5587 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5588 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5589 is called from many places.
5590
5591 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5592 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5593 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5594 @code{foo}.
5595
5596 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5597 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5598 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5599
5600 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5601 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5602 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5603 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5604 the underlying system.
5605 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5606 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5607
5608 @table @code
5609 @kindex skip
5610 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5611 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5612 that specify what to skip.
5613 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5614
5615 @table @code
5616 @item -file @var{file}
5617 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5618 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5619
5620 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5621 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5622 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5623 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5624 over when stepping.
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5628 @end smallexample
5629
5630 @item -function @var{linespec}
5631 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5632 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5633 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5634 @xref{Specify Location}.
5635
5636 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5637 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5638 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5639 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5640
5641 This form is useful for complex function names.
5642 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5643 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5644 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5645 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5646 regular expression makes this easier.
5647
5648 @smallexample
5649 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5653 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5654
5655 @smallexample
5656 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5657 @end smallexample
5658 @end table
5659
5660 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5661 will be skipped.
5662
5663 @kindex skip function
5664 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5665 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5666 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5667 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5668
5669 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5670 will be skipped.
5671
5672 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5673 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5674
5675 @kindex skip file
5676 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5677 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5678 will be skipped over when stepping.
5679
5680 @smallexample
5681 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5682 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5683 @end smallexample
5684
5685 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5686 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5687 @end table
5688
5689 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5690 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5691
5692 @table @code
5693 @kindex info skip
5694 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5695 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5696 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5697 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5698
5699 @table @emph
5700 @item Identifier
5701 A number identifying this skip.
5702 @item Enabled or Disabled
5703 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5704 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5705 @item Glob
5706 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5707 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5708 @item File
5709 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5710 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5711 @item RE
5712 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5713 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5714 @item Function
5715 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5716 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5717 @end table
5718
5719 @kindex skip delete
5720 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5721 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5722 skips.
5723
5724 @kindex skip enable
5725 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5726 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5727 skips.
5728
5729 @kindex skip disable
5730 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5731 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5732 skips.
5733
5734 @end table
5735
5736 @node Signals
5737 @section Signals
5738 @cindex signals
5739
5740 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5741 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5742 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5743 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5744 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5745 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5746 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5747 requested an alarm).
5748
5749 @cindex fatal signals
5750 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5751 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5752 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5753 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5754 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5755 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5756
5757 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5758 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5759 signal.
5760
5761 @cindex handling signals
5762 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5763 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5764 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5765 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5766 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5767
5768 @table @code
5769 @kindex info signals
5770 @kindex info handle
5771 @item info signals
5772 @itemx info handle
5773 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5774 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5775 the defined types of signals.
5776
5777 @item info signals @var{sig}
5778 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5779
5780 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5781
5782 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5783 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5784 for details about this command.
5785
5786 @kindex handle
5787 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5788 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5789 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5790 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5791 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5792 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5793 say what change to make.
5794 @end table
5795
5796 @c @group
5797 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5798 Their full names are:
5799
5800 @table @code
5801 @item nostop
5802 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5803 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5804
5805 @item stop
5806 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5807 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5808
5809 @item print
5810 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5811
5812 @item noprint
5813 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5814 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5815
5816 @item pass
5817 @itemx noignore
5818 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5819 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5820 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5821
5822 @item nopass
5823 @itemx ignore
5824 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5825 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5826 @end table
5827 @c @end group
5828
5829 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5830 program until you
5831 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5832 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5833 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5834 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5835 program sees that signal when you continue.
5836
5837 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5838 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5839 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5840 erroneous signals.
5841
5842 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5843 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5844 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5845 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5846 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5847 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5848 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5849 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5850 Program a Signal}.
5851
5852 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5853 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5854
5855 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5856 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5857 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5858 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5859 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5860 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5861 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5862 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5863 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5864 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5865 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5866 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5867 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5868
5869 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5870
5871 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5872 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5873 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5874 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5875
5876 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5877 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5878 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5879 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5880
5881 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5882 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5883
5884 @smallexample
5885 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5886 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5887 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5888 (@value{GDBP}) c
5889 Continuing.
5890
5891 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5892 main () sigusr1.c:28
5893 28 p = 0;
5894 (@value{GDBP}) si
5895 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5896 9 @{
5897 @end smallexample
5898
5899 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5900 program to receive the signal first:
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 (@value{GDBP}) n
5904 28 p = 0;
5905 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5906 (@value{GDBP}) si
5907 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5908 9 @{
5909 (@value{GDBP})
5910 @end smallexample
5911
5912 @cindex extra signal information
5913 @anchor{extra signal information}
5914
5915 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5916 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5917 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5918 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5919 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5920 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5921 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5922 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5923 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5924 system header.
5925
5926 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5927 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5928
5929 @smallexample
5930 @group
5931 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5932 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5933 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5934 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5935 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5936 type = struct @{
5937 int si_signo;
5938 int si_errno;
5939 int si_code;
5940 union @{
5941 int _pad[28];
5942 struct @{...@} _kill;
5943 struct @{...@} _timer;
5944 struct @{...@} _rt;
5945 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5946 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5947 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5948 @} _sifields;
5949 @}
5950 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5951 type = struct @{
5952 void *si_addr;
5953 @}
5954 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5955 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5956 @end group
5957 @end smallexample
5958
5959 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5960
5961 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5962 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5963 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5964 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5965 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5966 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5967 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5968 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5969 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5970 information is displayed.
5971
5972 The usual output of a segfault is:
5973 @smallexample
5974 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5975 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5976 68 value = *(p + len);
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 While a bound violation is presented as:
5980 @smallexample
5981 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5982 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5983 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5984 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5985 68 value = *(p + len);
5986 @end smallexample
5987
5988 @node Thread Stops
5989 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5990
5991 @cindex stopped threads
5992 @cindex threads, stopped
5993
5994 @cindex continuing threads
5995 @cindex threads, continuing
5996
5997 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5998 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5999 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6000 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6001 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6002 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6003 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6004 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6005 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6006
6007 @menu
6008 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6009 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6010 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6011 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6012 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6013 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6014 @end menu
6015
6016 @node All-Stop Mode
6017 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6018
6019 @cindex all-stop mode
6020
6021 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6022 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6023 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6024 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6025 underfoot.
6026
6027 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6028 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6029 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6030
6031 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6032 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6033 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6034 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6035 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6036 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6037 stops.
6038
6039 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6040 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6041 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6042 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6043
6044 @cindex automatic thread selection
6045 @cindex switching threads automatically
6046 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6047 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6048 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6049 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6050 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6051 thread.
6052
6053 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6054 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6058 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6059 @cindex lock scheduler
6060 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6061 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6062 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6063 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6064 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6065 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6066 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6067 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6068 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6069 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6070 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6071 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6072 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6073 @code{on} in replay mode.
6074
6075 @item show scheduler-locking
6076 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6077 @end table
6078
6079 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6080 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6081 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6082 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6083 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6084 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6085 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6086 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6087 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6088 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6089 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6090 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6091 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6092 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6093
6094 @table @code
6095 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6096 @item set schedule-multiple
6097 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6098 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6099 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6100 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6101 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6102 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6103
6104 @item show schedule-multiple
6105 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6106 multiple processes.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @node Non-Stop Mode
6110 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6111
6112 @cindex non-stop mode
6113
6114 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6115 @c with more details.
6116
6117 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6118 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6119 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6120 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6121 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6122 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6123
6124 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6125 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6126 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6127 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6128 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6129 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6130 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6131 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6132 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6133 independently and simultaneously.
6134
6135 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6136 or attach to your program:
6137
6138 @smallexample
6139 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6140 set pagination off
6141
6142 # Finally, turn it on!
6143 set non-stop on
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6147
6148 @table @code
6149 @kindex set non-stop
6150 @item set non-stop on
6151 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6152 @item set non-stop off
6153 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6154 @kindex show non-stop
6155 @item show non-stop
6156 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6157 @end table
6158
6159 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6160 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6161 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6162 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6163 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6164 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6165 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6166 default.
6167
6168 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6169 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6170 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6171
6172 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6173 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6174 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6175 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6176 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6177
6178 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6179 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6180 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6181 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6182 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6183
6184 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6185
6186 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6187 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6188 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6189 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6190 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6191 previously current thread.
6192
6193 @node Background Execution
6194 @subsection Background Execution
6195
6196 @cindex foreground execution
6197 @cindex background execution
6198 @cindex asynchronous execution
6199 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6200
6201 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6202 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6203 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6204 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6205 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6206 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6207
6208 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6209 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6210
6211 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6212 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6213 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6214 are:
6215
6216 @table @code
6217 @kindex run&
6218 @item run
6219 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6220
6221 @item attach
6222 @kindex attach&
6223 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6224
6225 @item step
6226 @kindex step&
6227 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6228
6229 @item stepi
6230 @kindex stepi&
6231 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6232
6233 @item next
6234 @kindex next&
6235 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6236
6237 @item nexti
6238 @kindex nexti&
6239 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6240
6241 @item continue
6242 @kindex continue&
6243 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6244
6245 @item finish
6246 @kindex finish&
6247 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6248
6249 @item until
6250 @kindex until&
6251 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6252
6253 @end table
6254
6255 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6256 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6257 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6258 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6259 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6260 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6261
6262 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6263 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6264
6265 @table @code
6266 @kindex interrupt
6267 @item interrupt
6268 @itemx interrupt -a
6269
6270 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6271 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6272 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6273 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6274 @end table
6275
6276 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6277 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6278
6279 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6280 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6281 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6282
6283 @table @code
6284 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6285 @cindex thread breakpoints
6286 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6287 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6288 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6289 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6290 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6291 specify some source line.
6292
6293 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6294 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6295 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6296 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6297 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6298
6299 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6300 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6301 program.
6302
6303 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6304 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6305 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6306
6307 @smallexample
6308 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6309 @end smallexample
6310
6311 @end table
6312
6313 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6314 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6315 thread list. For example:
6316
6317 @smallexample
6318 (@value{GDBP}) c
6319 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6323 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6324 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6325 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6326 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6327 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6328 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6329 command.
6330
6331 @node Interrupted System Calls
6332 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6333
6334 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6335 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6336 @cindex premature return from system calls
6337 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6338 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6339 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6340 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6341 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6342 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6343 stop execution.
6344
6345 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6346 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6347 style anyways.
6348
6349 For example, do not write code like this:
6350
6351 @smallexample
6352 sleep (10);
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6356 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6357
6358 Instead, write this:
6359
6360 @smallexample
6361 int unslept = 10;
6362 while (unslept > 0)
6363 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6367 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6368 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6369 @value{GDBN}.
6370
6371 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6372 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6373 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6374 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6375
6376 @node Observer Mode
6377 @subsection Observer Mode
6378
6379 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6380 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6381 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6382 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6383 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6384
6385 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6386 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6387 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6388 mode.
6389
6390 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6391 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6392 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6393 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6394 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6395
6396 @table @code
6397
6398 @kindex observer
6399 @item set observer on
6400 @itemx set observer off
6401 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6402 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6403 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6404 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6405
6406 @item show observer
6407 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6408
6409 @kindex may-write-registers
6410 @item set may-write-registers on
6411 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6412 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6413 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6414 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6415
6416 @item show may-write-registers
6417 Show the current permission to write registers.
6418
6419 @kindex may-write-memory
6420 @item set may-write-memory on
6421 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6422 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6423 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6424 defaults to @code{on}.
6425
6426 @item show may-write-memory
6427 Show the current permission to write memory.
6428
6429 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6430 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6431 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6432 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6433 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6434 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6435
6436 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6437 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6438
6439 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6440 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6441 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6442 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6443 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6444 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6445 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6448 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6449
6450 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6451 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6452 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6454 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6455 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6456 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6457
6458 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6459 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6460
6461 @kindex may-interrupt
6462 @item set may-interrupt on
6463 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6464 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6465 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6466 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6467 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6468
6469 @item show may-interrupt
6470 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6471
6472 @end table
6473
6474 @node Reverse Execution
6475 @chapter Running programs backward
6476 @cindex reverse execution
6477 @cindex running programs backward
6478
6479 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6480 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6481 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6482 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6483
6484 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6485 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6486 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6487 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6488 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6489 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6490
6491 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6492 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6493 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6494 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6495 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6496 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6497 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6498 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6499 prior values@footnote{
6500 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6501 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6502 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6503
6504 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6505 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6506 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6507 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6508 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6509 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6510 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6511 }.
6512
6513 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6514 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6515
6516 @table @code
6517 @kindex reverse-continue
6518 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6519 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6520 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6521 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6522 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6523 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6524 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6525
6526 @kindex reverse-step
6527 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6528 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6530 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6531
6532 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6533 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6534 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6535 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6536 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6537 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6538
6539 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6540 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6541
6542 @kindex reverse-stepi
6543 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6544 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6546 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6547 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6548 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6549 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6550
6551 @kindex reverse-next
6552 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6553 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6554 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6555 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6556 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6557 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6558 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6559 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6560 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6561 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6562
6563 @kindex reverse-nexti
6564 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6565 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6566 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6567 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6568 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6569 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6570 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6571 frame) is reached.
6572
6573 @kindex reverse-finish
6574 @item reverse-finish
6575 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6576 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6577 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6578 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6579
6580 @kindex set exec-direction
6581 @item set exec-direction
6582 Set the direction of target execution.
6583 @item set exec-direction reverse
6584 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6585 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6586 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6587 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6588 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6589 @item set exec-direction forward
6590 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6591 This is the default.
6592 @end table
6593
6594
6595 @node Process Record and Replay
6596 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6597 @cindex process record and replay
6598 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6599
6600 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6601 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6602 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6603
6604 @cindex replay mode
6605 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6606 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6607 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6608 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6609 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6610 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6611 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6612 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6613 execution log.
6614
6615 @cindex record mode
6616 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6617 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6618 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6619 for future replay.
6620
6621 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6622 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6623 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6624 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6625 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6626 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6627
6628 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6629 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6630 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6631 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6632
6633 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6634 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6635
6636 @table @code
6637 @kindex target record
6638 @kindex target record-full
6639 @kindex target record-btrace
6640 @kindex record
6641 @kindex record full
6642 @kindex record btrace
6643 @kindex record btrace bts
6644 @kindex record btrace pt
6645 @kindex record bts
6646 @kindex record pt
6647 @kindex rec
6648 @kindex rec full
6649 @kindex rec btrace
6650 @kindex rec btrace bts
6651 @kindex rec btrace pt
6652 @kindex rec bts
6653 @kindex rec pt
6654 @item record @var{method}
6655 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6656 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6657 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6658 recording methods are available:
6659
6660 @table @code
6661 @item full
6662 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6663 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6664 execution.
6665
6666 @item btrace @var{format}
6667 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6668 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6669 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6670 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6671 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6672 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6673 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6674
6675 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6676 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6677 formats are available:
6678
6679 @table @code
6680 @item bts
6681 @cindex branch trace store
6682 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6683 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6684 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6685
6686 @item pt
6687 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6688 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6689 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6690 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6691
6692 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6693 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6694 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6695
6696 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6697 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6698 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6699 buffer-size with care.
6700 @end table
6701
6702 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6703 @end table
6704
6705 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6706 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6707 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6708 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6709
6710 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6711 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6712 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6713 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6714 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6715
6716 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6717 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6718 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6719 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6720 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6721 does not support these two modes.
6722
6723 @kindex record stop
6724 @kindex rec s
6725 @item record stop
6726 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6727 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6728 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6729
6730 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6731 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6732 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6733 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6734 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6735
6736 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6737 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6738 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6739 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6740 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6741
6742 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6743 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6744
6745 @kindex record goto
6746 @item record goto
6747 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6748 ways to specify the location to go to:
6749
6750 @table @code
6751 @item record goto begin
6752 @itemx record goto start
6753 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6754
6755 @item record goto end
6756 Go to the end of the execution log.
6757
6758 @item record goto @var{n}
6759 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6760 @end table
6761
6762 @kindex record save
6763 @item record save @var{filename}
6764 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6765 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6766 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6767
6768 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6769
6770 @kindex record restore
6771 @item record restore @var{filename}
6772 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6773 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6774
6775 @kindex set record full
6776 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6777 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6778 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6779 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6780
6781 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6782 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6783 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6784 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6785 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6786 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6787 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6788 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6789
6790 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6791 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6792 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6793
6794 @kindex show record full
6795 @item show record full insn-number-max
6796 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6797 recording method.
6798
6799 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6800 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6801 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6802 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6803 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6804 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6805 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6806 oldest one to be deleted.
6807
6808 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6809 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6810
6811 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6812 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6813
6814 @item set record full memory-query
6815 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6816 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6817 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6818 case.
6819
6820 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6821 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6822 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6823 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6824 results.
6825
6826 @item show record full memory-query
6827 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6828
6829 @kindex set record btrace
6830 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6831 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6832 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6833 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6834 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6835 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6836 You can use the following command for that:
6837
6838 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6839 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6840 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6841 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6842 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6843 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6844 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6845 position.
6846
6847 @kindex show record btrace
6848 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6849 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6850
6851 @kindex set record btrace bts
6852 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6853 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6854 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6855 format. Default is 64KB.
6856
6857 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6858 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6859 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6860 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6861 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6862 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6863 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6864
6865 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6866 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6867
6868 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6869 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6870
6871 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6872 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6873 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6874
6875 @kindex set record btrace pt
6876 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6877 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6878 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6879 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6880
6881 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6882 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6883 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6884 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6885 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6886 actual buffer size for each thread.
6887
6888 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6889 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6890
6891 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6892 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6893
6894 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6895 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6896 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6897
6898 @kindex info record
6899 @item info record
6900 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6901 method:
6902
6903 @table @code
6904 @item full
6905 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6906 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6907
6908 @itemize @bullet
6909 @item
6910 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6911 @item
6912 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6913 @item
6914 Highest recorded instruction number.
6915 @item
6916 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6917 @item
6918 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6919 @item
6920 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6921 @end itemize
6922
6923 @item btrace
6924 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6925
6926 @itemize @bullet
6927 @item
6928 Recording format.
6929 @item
6930 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6931 @item
6932 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6933 instructions.
6934 @item
6935 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6936 @end itemize
6937
6938 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6939 @itemize @bullet
6940 @item
6941 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6942 @end itemize
6943
6944 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6945 @itemize @bullet
6946 @item
6947 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6948 @end itemize
6949 @end table
6950
6951 @kindex record delete
6952 @kindex rec del
6953 @item record delete
6954 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6955 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6956 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6957 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6958
6959 @kindex record instruction-history
6960 @kindex rec instruction-history
6961 @item record instruction-history
6962 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6963 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6964 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6965 are printed in execution order.
6966
6967 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6968 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6969 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6970
6971 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6972 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6973 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6974 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6975 @code{/p} modifier.
6976
6977 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6978 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6979 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6980
6981 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6982 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6983
6984 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6985 disassemble:
6986
6987 @table @code
6988 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6989 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6990 @var{insn}.
6991
6992 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6993 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6994 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6995 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6996 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6997 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6998
6999 @item record instruction-history
7000 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7001
7002 @item record instruction-history -
7003 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7004
7005 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7006 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7007 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7008 number @var{end} is included.
7009 @end table
7010
7011 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7012
7013 @kindex set record
7014 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7015 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7016 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7017 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7018 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7019
7020 @kindex show record
7021 @item show record instruction-history-size
7022 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7023 instruction-history} command.
7024
7025 @kindex record function-call-history
7026 @kindex rec function-call-history
7027 @item record function-call-history
7028 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7029 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7030 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7031 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7032 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7033 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7034 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7035 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7036 given together.
7037
7038 @smallexample
7039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7040 1 void foo (void)
7041 2 @{
7042 3 @}
7043 4
7044 5 void bar (void)
7045 6 @{
7046 7 ...
7047 8 foo ();
7048 9 ...
7049 10 @}
7050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7051 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7052 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7053 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7054 @end smallexample
7055
7056 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7057 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7058 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7059 to print:
7060
7061 @table @code
7062 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7063 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7064
7065 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7066 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7067 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7068 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7069 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7070
7071 @item record function-call-history
7072 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7073
7074 @item record function-call-history -
7075 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7076
7077 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7078 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7079 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7080 @end table
7081
7082 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7083
7084 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7085 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7086 Define how many lines to print in the
7087 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7088 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7089
7090 @item show record function-call-history-size
7091 Show how many lines to print in the
7092 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7093 @end table
7094
7095
7096 @node Stack
7097 @chapter Examining the Stack
7098
7099 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7100 stopped and how it got there.
7101
7102 @cindex call stack
7103 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7104 is generated.
7105 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7106 the arguments of the call,
7107 and the local variables of the function being called.
7108 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7109 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7110 stack}.
7111
7112 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7113 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7114
7115 @cindex selected frame
7116 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7117 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7118 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7119 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7120 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7121 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7122
7123 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7124 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7125 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7126
7127 @menu
7128 * Frames:: Stack frames
7129 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7130 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7131 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7132 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7133
7134 @end menu
7135
7136 @node Frames
7137 @section Stack Frames
7138
7139 @cindex frame, definition
7140 @cindex stack frame
7141 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7142 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7143 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7144 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7145 which the function is executing.
7146
7147 @cindex initial frame
7148 @cindex outermost frame
7149 @cindex innermost frame
7150 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7151 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7152 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7153 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7154 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7155 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7156 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7157 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7158
7159 @cindex frame pointer
7160 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7161 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7162 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7163 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7164 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7165 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7166
7167 @cindex frame number
7168 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7169 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7170 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7171 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7172 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7173
7174 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7175 @c underflow problems.
7176 @cindex frameless execution
7177 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7178 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7179 @smallexample
7180 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7181 @end smallexample
7182 generates functions without a frame.)
7183 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7184 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7185 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7186 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7187 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7188 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7189 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7190
7191 @node Backtrace
7192 @section Backtraces
7193
7194 @cindex traceback
7195 @cindex call stack traces
7196 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7197 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7198 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7199 stack.
7200
7201 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7202 @table @code
7203 @kindex backtrace
7204 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7205 @item backtrace
7206 @itemx bt
7207 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7208 frames in the stack.
7209
7210 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7211 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7212
7213 @item backtrace @var{n}
7214 @itemx bt @var{n}
7215 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7216
7217 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7218 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7219 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7220
7221 @item backtrace full
7222 @itemx bt full
7223 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7224 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7225 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7226 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7227
7228 @item backtrace no-filters
7229 @itemx bt no-filters
7230 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7231 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7232 @itemx bt no-filters full
7233 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7234 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7235 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7236 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7237 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7238 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7239 support.
7240 @end table
7241
7242 @kindex where
7243 @kindex info stack
7244 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7245 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7246
7247 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7248 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7249 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7250 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7251 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7252 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7253 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7254 multi-threaded program.
7255
7256 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7257 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7258 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7259 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7260 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7261 line number.
7262
7263 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7264 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7265
7266 @smallexample
7267 @group
7268 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7269 at builtin.c:993
7270 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7271 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7272 at macro.c:71
7273 (More stack frames follow...)
7274 @end group
7275 @end smallexample
7276
7277 @noindent
7278 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7279 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7280 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7284 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7285 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7286 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7287 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7288
7289 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7290 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7291 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7292 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7293 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7294 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7295 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7296 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7297 such a backtrace might look like:
7298
7299 @smallexample
7300 @group
7301 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7302 at builtin.c:993
7303 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7304 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7305 at macro.c:71
7306 (More stack frames follow...)
7307 @end group
7308 @end smallexample
7309
7310 @noindent
7311 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7312 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7313
7314 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7315 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7316 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7317
7318 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7319 @cindex program entry point
7320 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7321 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7322 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7323 @code{main}@footnote{
7324 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7325 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7326 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7327 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7328 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7329 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7330
7331 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7332 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7333
7334 @table @code
7335 @item set backtrace past-main
7336 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7337 @kindex set backtrace
7338 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7339
7340 @item set backtrace past-main off
7341 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7342 default.
7343
7344 @item show backtrace past-main
7345 @kindex show backtrace
7346 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7347
7348 @item set backtrace past-entry
7349 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7350 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7351 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7352 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7353
7354 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7355 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7356 application. This is the default.
7357
7358 @item show backtrace past-entry
7359 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7360
7361 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7362 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7363 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7364 @cindex backtrace limit
7365 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7366 or zero means unlimited levels.
7367
7368 @item show backtrace limit
7369 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7370 @end table
7371
7372 You can control how file names are displayed.
7373
7374 @table @code
7375 @item set filename-display
7376 @itemx set filename-display relative
7377 @cindex filename-display
7378 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7379
7380 @item set filename-display basename
7381 Display only basename of a filename.
7382
7383 @item set filename-display absolute
7384 Display an absolute filename.
7385
7386 @item show filename-display
7387 Show the current way to display filenames.
7388 @end table
7389
7390 @node Selection
7391 @section Selecting a Frame
7392
7393 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7394 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7395 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7396 of the stack frame just selected.
7397
7398 @table @code
7399 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7400 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7401 @item frame @var{n}
7402 @itemx f @var{n}
7403 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7404 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7405 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7406 @code{main}.
7407
7408 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7409 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7410 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7411 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7412 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7413 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7414 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7415 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7416
7417 @kindex up
7418 @item up @var{n}
7419 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7420 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7421 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7422
7423 @kindex down
7424 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7425 @item down @var{n}
7426 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7427 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7428 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7429 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7430 @end table
7431
7432 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7433 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7434 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7435 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7436
7437 @need 1000
7438 For example:
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 (@value{GDBP}) up
7443 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7444 at env.c:10
7445 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7450 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7451 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7452 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7453 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7454 for details.
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @kindex select-frame
7458 @item select-frame
7459 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7460 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7461 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7462 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7463
7464 @kindex down-silently
7465 @kindex up-silently
7466 @item up-silently @var{n}
7467 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7468 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7469 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7470 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7471 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7472 distracting.
7473 @end table
7474
7475 @node Frame Info
7476 @section Information About a Frame
7477
7478 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7479 stack frame.
7480
7481 @table @code
7482 @item frame
7483 @itemx f
7484 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7485 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7486 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7487 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7488 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7489
7490 @kindex info frame
7491 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7492 @item info frame
7493 @itemx info f
7494 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7495 including:
7496
7497 @itemize @bullet
7498 @item
7499 the address of the frame
7500 @item
7501 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7502 @item
7503 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7504 @item
7505 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7506 @item
7507 the address of the frame's arguments
7508 @item
7509 the address of the frame's local variables
7510 @item
7511 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7512 @item
7513 which registers were saved in the frame
7514 @end itemize
7515
7516 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7517 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7518 the usual conventions.
7519
7520 @item info frame @var{addr}
7521 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7522 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7523 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7524 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7525 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7526 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7527
7528 @kindex info args
7529 @item info args
7530 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7531
7532 @item info locals
7533 @kindex info locals
7534 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7535 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7536 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7537
7538 @end table
7539
7540 @node Frame Filter Management
7541 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7542 @cindex managing frame filters
7543
7544 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7545 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7546
7547 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7548 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7549
7550 @table @code
7551 @kindex info frame-filter
7552 @item info frame-filter
7553 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7554 their name, priority and enabled status.
7555
7556 @kindex disable frame-filter
7557 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7558 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7559 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7560 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7561 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7562 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7563 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7564 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7565 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7566 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7567 may be enabled again later.
7568
7569 @kindex enable frame-filter
7570 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7571 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7572 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7573 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7574 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7575 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7576 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7577 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7578 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7579
7580 Example:
7581
7582 @smallexample
7583 (gdb) info frame-filter
7584
7585 global frame-filters:
7586 Priority Enabled Name
7587 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7588 100 Yes Reverse
7589
7590 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7591 Priority Enabled Name
7592 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7593
7594 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7595 Priority Enabled Name
7596 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7597
7598 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7599 (gdb) info frame-filter
7600
7601 global frame-filters:
7602 Priority Enabled Name
7603 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7604 100 Yes Reverse
7605
7606 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7607 Priority Enabled Name
7608 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7609
7610 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7611 Priority Enabled Name
7612 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7613
7614 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7615 (gdb) info frame-filter
7616
7617 global frame-filters:
7618 Priority Enabled Name
7619 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7620 100 Yes Reverse
7621
7622 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7625
7626 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7627 Priority Enabled Name
7628 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7629 @end smallexample
7630
7631 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7632 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7633 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7634 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7635 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7636 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7637 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7638
7639 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7640 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7641 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7642 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7643 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7644 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7645 dictionary resides.
7646
7647 Example:
7648
7649 @smallexample
7650 (gdb) info frame-filter
7651
7652 global frame-filters:
7653 Priority Enabled Name
7654 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7655 100 Yes Reverse
7656
7657 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7658 Priority Enabled Name
7659 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7660
7661 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7662 Priority Enabled Name
7663 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7664
7665 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7666 (gdb) info frame-filter
7667
7668 global frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7671 50 Yes Reverse
7672
7673 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7674 Priority Enabled Name
7675 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7676
7677 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7678 Priority Enabled Name
7679 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7680 @end smallexample
7681 @end table
7682
7683 @node Source
7684 @chapter Examining Source Files
7685
7686 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7687 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7688 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7689 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7690 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7691 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7692 source files by explicit command.
7693
7694 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7695 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7696 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7697
7698 @menu
7699 * List:: Printing source lines
7700 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7701 * Edit:: Editing source files
7702 * Search:: Searching source files
7703 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7704 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7705 @end menu
7706
7707 @node List
7708 @section Printing Source Lines
7709
7710 @kindex list
7711 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7712 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7713 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7714 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7715 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7716
7717 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7718
7719 @table @code
7720 @item list @var{linenum}
7721 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7722 current source file.
7723
7724 @item list @var{function}
7725 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7726 @var{function}.
7727
7728 @item list
7729 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7730 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7731 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7732 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7733 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7734
7735 @item list -
7736 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7737 @end table
7738
7739 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7740 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7741 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7742
7743 @table @code
7744 @kindex set listsize
7745 @item set listsize @var{count}
7746 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7747 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7748 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7749 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7750
7751 @kindex show listsize
7752 @item show listsize
7753 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7757 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7758 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7759 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7760 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7761
7762 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7763 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7764 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7765 to specify some source line.
7766
7767 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7768
7769 @table @code
7770 @item list @var{location}
7771 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7772
7773 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7774 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7775 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7776 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7777 the same source file as the first location.
7778
7779 @item list ,@var{last}
7780 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7781
7782 @item list @var{first},
7783 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7784
7785 @item list +
7786 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7787
7788 @item list -
7789 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7790
7791 @item list
7792 As described in the preceding table.
7793 @end table
7794
7795 @node Specify Location
7796 @section Specifying a Location
7797 @cindex specifying location
7798 @cindex location
7799 @cindex source location
7800
7801 @menu
7802 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7803 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7804 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7805 @end menu
7806
7807 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7808 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7809 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7810 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7811 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7812
7813 @node Linespec Locations
7814 @subsection Linespec Locations
7815 @cindex linespec locations
7816
7817 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7818 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7819 specifying a linespec:
7820
7821 @table @code
7822 @item @var{linenum}
7823 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7824
7825 @item -@var{offset}
7826 @itemx +@var{offset}
7827 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7828 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7829 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7830 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7831 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7832 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7833 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7834 linespec.
7835
7836 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7837 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7838 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7839 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7840 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7841 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7842 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7843
7844 @item @var{function}
7845 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7846 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7847
7848 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7849 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7850
7851 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7852 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7853 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7854 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7855 functions in different source files.
7856
7857 @item @var{label}
7858 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7859 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7860 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7861 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7862
7863 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7864 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7865 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7866 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7867 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7868 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7869
7870 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7871 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7872 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7873 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7874 each one of those probes.
7875 @end table
7876
7877 @node Explicit Locations
7878 @subsection Explicit Locations
7879 @cindex explicit locations
7880
7881 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7882 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7883
7884 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7885 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7886 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7887 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7888 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7889
7890 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7891 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7892 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7893 the symbol table to know.
7894
7895 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7896 following table:
7897
7898 @table @code
7899 @item -source @var{filename}
7900 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7901 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7902 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7903 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7904 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7905
7906 @item -function @var{function}
7907 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7908 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7909 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7910 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7911
7912 @item -label @var{label}
7913 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7914 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7915 selected stack frame.
7916
7917 @item -line @var{number}
7918 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7919 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7920 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7921 relative to the current line.
7922 @end table
7923
7924 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7925 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7926
7927 @node Address Locations
7928 @subsection Address Locations
7929 @cindex address locations
7930
7931 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7932 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7933
7934 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7935 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7936 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7937 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7938 source files.
7939
7940 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7941 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7942 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7943 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7944 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7945 of @var{address}:
7946
7947 @table @code
7948 @item @var{expression}
7949 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7950
7951 @item @var{funcaddr}
7952 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7953 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7954 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7955 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7956 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7957 (although the Pascal form also works).
7958
7959 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7960 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7961
7962 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7963 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7964 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7965 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7966 functions with identical names in different source files.
7967 @end table
7968
7969 @node Edit
7970 @section Editing Source Files
7971 @cindex editing source files
7972
7973 @kindex edit
7974 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7975 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7976 The editing program of your choice
7977 is invoked with the current line set to
7978 the active line in the program.
7979 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7980 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7981
7982 @table @code
7983 @item edit @var{location}
7984 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7985 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7986 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7987 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7988 command most commonly used:
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @item edit @var{number}
7992 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7993
7994 @item edit @var{function}
7995 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7996 @end table
7997
7998 @end table
7999
8000 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8001 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8002 @footnote{
8003 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8004 following command-line syntax:
8005 @smallexample
8006 ex +@var{number} file
8007 @end smallexample
8008 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8009 the file where to start editing.}.
8010 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8011 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8012 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8013 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8014 @smallexample
8015 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8016 export EDITOR
8017 gdb @dots{}
8018 @end smallexample
8019 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8020 @smallexample
8021 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8022 gdb @dots{}
8023 @end smallexample
8024
8025 @node Search
8026 @section Searching Source Files
8027 @cindex searching source files
8028
8029 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8030 regular expression.
8031
8032 @table @code
8033 @kindex search
8034 @kindex forward-search
8035 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8036 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8037 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8038 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8039 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8040 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8041 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8042 @code{fo}.
8043
8044 @kindex reverse-search
8045 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8046 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8047 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8048 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8049 this command as @code{rev}.
8050 @end table
8051
8052 @node Source Path
8053 @section Specifying Source Directories
8054
8055 @cindex source path
8056 @cindex directories for source files
8057 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8058 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8059 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8060 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8061 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8062 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8063 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8064
8065 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8066 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8067 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8068 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8069 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8070 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8071 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8072 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8073 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8074 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8075 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8076
8077 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8078 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8079 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8080 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8081 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8082 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8083
8084 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8085 source files.
8086
8087 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8088 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8089 each line is in the file.
8090
8091 @kindex directory
8092 @kindex dir
8093 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8094 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8095 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8096
8097 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8098 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8099
8100 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8101 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8102 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8103 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8104 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8105 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8106 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8107 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8108 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8109 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8110 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8111 name to look up the sources.
8112
8113 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8114 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8115 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8116 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8117 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8118 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8119 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8120 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8121
8122 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8123 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8124 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8125 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8126 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8127 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8128 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8129
8130 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8131 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8132 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8133 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8134 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8135 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8136 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8137 command.
8138
8139 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8140 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8141 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8142 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8143 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8144 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8145 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8146
8147 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8148 @cindex default source path substitution
8149 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8150 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8151 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8152 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8153 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8154 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8155 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8156 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8157 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8158 together.
8159
8160 @table @code
8161 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8162 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8163 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8164 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8165 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8166 part of absolute file names) or
8167 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8168 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8169
8170 @kindex cdir
8171 @kindex cwd
8172 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8173 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8174 @cindex compilation directory
8175 @cindex current directory
8176 @cindex working directory
8177 @cindex directory, current
8178 @cindex directory, compilation
8179 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8180 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8181 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8182 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8183 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8184 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8185
8186 @item directory
8187 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8188
8189 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8190 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8191
8192 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8193 @kindex set directories
8194 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8195 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8196
8197 @item show directories
8198 @kindex show directories
8199 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8200
8201 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8202 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8203 @kindex set substitute-path
8204 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8205 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8206 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8207
8208 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8209 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8210
8211 @smallexample
8212 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @noindent
8216 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8217 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8218 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8219
8220 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8221 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8222 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8223 the substitution.
8224
8225 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8226
8227 @smallexample
8228 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8229 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8230 @end smallexample
8231
8232 @noindent
8233 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8234 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8235 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8236 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8237
8238
8239 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8240 @kindex unset substitute-path
8241 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8242 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8243 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8244
8245 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8246
8247 @item show substitute-path [path]
8248 @kindex show substitute-path
8249 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8250 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8251
8252 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8253 rules.
8254
8255 @end table
8256
8257 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8258 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8259 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8260
8261 @enumerate
8262 @item
8263 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8264
8265 @item
8266 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8267 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8268 directories in one command.
8269 @end enumerate
8270
8271 @node Machine Code
8272 @section Source and Machine Code
8273 @cindex source line and its code address
8274
8275 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8276 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8277 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8278 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8279 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8280 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8281 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8282 well as hex.
8283
8284 @table @code
8285 @kindex info line
8286 @item info line @var{location}
8287 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8288 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8289 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8290 @end table
8291
8292 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8293 the object code for the first line of function
8294 @code{m4_changequote}:
8295
8296 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8297 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8298 @smallexample
8299 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8300 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8301 @end smallexample
8302
8303 @noindent
8304 @cindex code address and its source line
8305 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8306 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8307 @smallexample
8308 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8309 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8310 @end smallexample
8311
8312 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8313 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8314 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8315 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8316 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8317 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8318 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8319 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8320 Variables}).
8321
8322 @table @code
8323 @kindex disassemble
8324 @cindex assembly instructions
8325 @cindex instructions, assembly
8326 @cindex machine instructions
8327 @cindex listing machine instructions
8328 @item disassemble
8329 @itemx disassemble /m
8330 @itemx disassemble /s
8331 @itemx disassemble /r
8332 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8333 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8334 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8335 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8336 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8337 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8338 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8339 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8340 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8341 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8345 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8346 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8347 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8348 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8349 @end table
8350
8351 @noindent
8352 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8353 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8354
8355 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8356 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8357
8358 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8359 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8360 @end table
8361
8362 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8363 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8364
8365 @smallexample
8366 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8367 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8368 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8369 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8370 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8371 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8372 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8373 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8374 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8375 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8376 End of assembler dump.
8377 @end smallexample
8378
8379 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8380 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8381 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8382
8383 @smallexample
8384 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8385 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8386 5 @{
8387 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8388 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8389 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8390 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8391 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8392
8393 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8394 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8395 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8396
8397 7 return 0;
8398 8 @}
8399 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8400 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8401 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8402
8403 End of assembler dump.
8404 @end smallexample
8405
8406 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8407 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8408 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8409 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8410 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8411 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8412 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8413 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8414 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8415
8416 @file{foo.h}:
8417
8418 @smallexample
8419 int
8420 foo (int a)
8421 @{
8422 if (a < 0)
8423 return a * 2;
8424 if (a == 0)
8425 return 1;
8426 return a + 10;
8427 @}
8428 @end smallexample
8429
8430 @file{foo.c}:
8431
8432 @smallexample
8433 #include "foo.h"
8434 volatile int x, y;
8435 int
8436 main ()
8437 @{
8438 x = foo (y);
8439 return 0;
8440 @}
8441 @end smallexample
8442
8443 @smallexample
8444 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8445 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8446 5 @{
8447
8448 6 x = foo (y);
8449 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8450 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8451
8452 7 return 0;
8453 8 @}
8454 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8455 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8456 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8457 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8458
8459 End of assembler dump.
8460 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8461 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8462 foo.c:
8463 5 @{
8464 6 x = foo (y);
8465 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8466
8467 foo.h:
8468 4 if (a < 0)
8469 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8470 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8471
8472 6 if (a == 0)
8473 7 return 1;
8474 8 return a + 10;
8475 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8476 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8477 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8478 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8479
8480 foo.c:
8481 6 x = foo (y);
8482 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8483
8484 7 return 0;
8485 8 @}
8486 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8487 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8488
8489 foo.h:
8490 5 return a * 2;
8491 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8492 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8493 End of assembler dump.
8494 @end smallexample
8495
8496 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8500 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8501 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8502 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8503 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8504 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8505 End of assembler dump.
8506 @end smallexample
8507
8508 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8509 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8510 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8511 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8512
8513 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8514 mnemonics or other syntax.
8515
8516 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8517 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8518 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8519 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8520 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8521
8522 @table @code
8523 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8524 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8525 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8526 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8527 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8528 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8529
8530 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8531 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8532 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8533 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8534
8535 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8536 @item show disassembly-flavor
8537 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8538 @end table
8539
8540 @table @code
8541 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8542 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8543 @item set disassemble-next-line
8544 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8545 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8546 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8547 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8548 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8549 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8550 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8551 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8552 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8553 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8554 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8555 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8556 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8557 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8558 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8559 instruction.
8560 @end table
8561
8562
8563 @node Data
8564 @chapter Examining Data
8565
8566 @cindex printing data
8567 @cindex examining data
8568 @kindex print
8569 @kindex inspect
8570 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8571 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8572 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8573 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8574 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8575 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8576
8577 @table @code
8578 @item print @var{expr}
8579 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8580 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8581 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8582 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8583 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8584 Formats}.
8585
8586 @item print
8587 @itemx print /@var{f}
8588 @cindex reprint the last value
8589 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8590 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8591 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8592 @end table
8593
8594 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8595 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8596 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8597
8598 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8599 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8600 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8601 Table}.
8602
8603 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8604 @kindex explore
8605 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8606 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8607 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8608 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8609 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8610 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8611 embedded in the higher level data types.
8612
8613 @table @code
8614 @item explore @var{arg}
8615 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8616 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8617 @end table
8618
8619 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8620 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8621 C program as
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 struct SimpleStruct
8625 @{
8626 int i;
8627 double d;
8628 @};
8629
8630 struct ComplexStruct
8631 @{
8632 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8633 int arr[10];
8634 @};
8635 @end smallexample
8636
8637 @noindent
8638 followed by variable declarations as
8639
8640 @smallexample
8641 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8642 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8643 @end smallexample
8644
8645 @noindent
8646 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8647 @code{explore} command as follows.
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 (gdb) explore cs
8651 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8652 the following fields:
8653
8654 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8655 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8656
8657 Enter the field number of choice:
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @noindent
8661 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8662 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8663 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8664 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8665 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8666 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8667 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8668 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8669
8670 @smallexample
8671 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8672 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8673 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8674 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8675
8676 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8677 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8678
8679 Press enter to return to parent value:
8680 @end smallexample
8681
8682 @noindent
8683 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8684 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8685 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8686 to explore.
8687
8688 @smallexample
8689 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8690 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8691
8692 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8693
8694 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8695
8696 Press enter to return to parent value:
8697 @end smallexample
8698
8699 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8700 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8701 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8702 level data structure).
8703
8704 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8705 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8706 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8707 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8708 same example as above, your can explore the type
8709 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8710 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8711
8712 @smallexample
8713 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 @noindent
8717 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8718 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8719 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8720 example.
8721
8722 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8723 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8724 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8725 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8726 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8727
8728 @table @code
8729 @item explore value @var{expr}
8730 @cindex explore value
8731 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8732 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8733 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8734 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8735 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8736
8737 @item explore type @var{arg}
8738 @cindex explore type
8739 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8740 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8741 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8742 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8743 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8744 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8745 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8746 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8747 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8748 @end table
8749
8750 @menu
8751 * Expressions:: Expressions
8752 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8753 * Variables:: Program variables
8754 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8755 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8756 * Memory:: Examining memory
8757 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8758 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8759 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8760 * Value History:: Value history
8761 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8762 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8763 * Registers:: Registers
8764 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8765 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8766 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8767 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8768 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8769 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8770 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8771 character set than GDB does
8772 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8773 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8774 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8775 @end menu
8776
8777 @node Expressions
8778 @section Expressions
8779
8780 @cindex expressions
8781 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8782 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8783 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8784 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8785 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8786 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8787 @ref{Compilation}.
8788
8789 @cindex arrays in expressions
8790 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8791 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8792 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8793 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8794 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8795 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8796
8797 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8798 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8799 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8800 languages.
8801
8802 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8803 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8804
8805 @cindex casts, in expressions
8806 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8807 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8808 at that address in memory.
8809 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8810
8811 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8812 to programming languages:
8813
8814 @table @code
8815 @item @@
8816 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8817 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8818
8819 @item ::
8820 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8821 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8822
8823 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8824 @cindex type casting memory
8825 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8826 @cindex casts, to view memory
8827 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8828 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8829 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8830 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8831 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8832 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8833 @end table
8834
8835 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8836 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8837 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8838
8839 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8840 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8841 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8842 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8843 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8844 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8845 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8846
8847 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8848 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8849 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8850 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8851 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8852 as well.
8853
8854 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8855 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8856 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8857 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8858 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8859 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8860 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8861 choices.
8862
8863 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8864 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8865 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8866
8867 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8868 @smallexample
8869 @group
8870 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8871 [0] cancel
8872 [1] all
8873 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8874 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8875 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8876 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8877 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8878 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8879 > 2 4 6
8880 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8881 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8882 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8883 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8884 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8885 breakpoints.
8886 (@value{GDBP})
8887 @end group
8888 @end smallexample
8889
8890 @table @code
8891 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8892 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8893 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8894
8895 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8896 is ambiguous.
8897
8898 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8899 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8900 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8901 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8902 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8903 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8904 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8905 in the use of the menu.
8906
8907 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8908 when an ambiguity is detected.
8909
8910 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8911 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8912
8913 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8914 @item show multiple-symbols
8915 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8916 @end table
8917
8918 @node Variables
8919 @section Program Variables
8920
8921 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8922 in your program.
8923
8924 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8925 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8926
8927 @itemize @bullet
8928 @item
8929 global (or file-static)
8930 @end itemize
8931
8932 @noindent or
8933
8934 @itemize @bullet
8935 @item
8936 visible according to the scope rules of the
8937 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8938 @end itemize
8939
8940 @noindent This means that in the function
8941
8942 @smallexample
8943 foo (a)
8944 int a;
8945 @{
8946 bar (a);
8947 @{
8948 int b = test ();
8949 bar (b);
8950 @}
8951 @}
8952 @end smallexample
8953
8954 @noindent
8955 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8956 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8957 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8958 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8959
8960 @cindex variable name conflict
8961 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8962 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8963 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8964 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8965 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8966 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8967 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8968
8969 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8970 @ifnotinfo
8971 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8972 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8973 @end ifnotinfo
8974 @smallexample
8975 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8976 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8977 @end smallexample
8978
8979 @noindent
8980 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8981 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8982 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8983 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8984
8985 @smallexample
8986 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8987 @end smallexample
8988
8989 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8990 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8991 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8992 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8993 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8994
8995 @smallexample
8996 void
8997 foo (int a)
8998 @{
8999 if (a < 10)
9000 bar (a);
9001 else
9002 process (a); /* Stop here */
9003 @}
9004
9005 int
9006 bar (int a)
9007 @{
9008 foo (a + 5);
9009 @}
9010 @end smallexample
9011
9012 @noindent
9013 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9014 here is what you might see
9015 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9016
9017 @smallexample
9018 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9019 $1 = 10
9020 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9021 $2 = 5
9022 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9023 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9024 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9025 $3 = 5
9026 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9027 $4 = 0
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9031 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9032 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9033 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9034 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9035
9036 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9037 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9038 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9039 @code{some_global}.
9040
9041 @smallexample
9042 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9043 $1 = 23
9044 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9045 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9046 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9047 $2 = 27
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 @cindex wrong values
9051 @cindex variable values, wrong
9052 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9053 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9054 @quotation
9055 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9056 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9057 scope, and just before exit.
9058 @end quotation
9059 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9060 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9061 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9062 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9063 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9064 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9065 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9066 variable definitions may be gone.
9067
9068 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9069 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9070 when compiling.
9071
9072 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9073 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9074 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9075 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9076 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9077 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9078 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9082 @end smallexample
9083
9084 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9085 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9086 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9087 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9088 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9089
9090 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9091 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9092 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9093 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9094
9095 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9096 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9097 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9098 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9099 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9100
9101 @smallexample
9102 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9103 29 i++;
9104 (gdb) next
9105 30 e (i);
9106 (gdb) print i
9107 $1 = 31
9108 (gdb) print i@@entry
9109 $2 = 30
9110 @end smallexample
9111
9112 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9113 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9114 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9115 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9116 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9117 For program code
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 char var0[] = "A";
9121 signed char var1[] = "A";
9122 @end smallexample
9123
9124 You get during debugging
9125 @smallexample
9126 (gdb) print var0
9127 $1 = "A"
9128 (gdb) print var1
9129 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9130 @end smallexample
9131
9132 @node Arrays
9133 @section Artificial Arrays
9134
9135 @cindex artificial array
9136 @cindex arrays
9137 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9138 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9139 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9140 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9141 program.
9142
9143 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9144 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9145 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9146 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9147 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9148 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9149 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9150 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9151 example. If a program says
9152
9153 @smallexample
9154 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 @noindent
9158 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 p *array@@len
9162 @end smallexample
9163
9164 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9165 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9166 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9167 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9168 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9169
9170 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9171 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9172 The value need not be in memory:
9173 @smallexample
9174 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9175 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9176 @end smallexample
9177
9178 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9179 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9180 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9181 @smallexample
9182 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9183 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9184 @end smallexample
9185
9186 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9187 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9188 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9189 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9190 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9191 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9192 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9193 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9194 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9195 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9196
9197 @smallexample
9198 set $i = 0
9199 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9200 @key{RET}
9201 @key{RET}
9202 @dots{}
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 @node Output Formats
9206 @section Output Formats
9207
9208 @cindex formatted output
9209 @cindex output formats
9210 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9211 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9212 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9213 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9214 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9215
9216 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9217 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9218 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9219 letters supported are:
9220
9221 @table @code
9222 @item x
9223 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9224 hexadecimal.
9225
9226 @item d
9227 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9228
9229 @item u
9230 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9231
9232 @item o
9233 Print as integer in octal.
9234
9235 @item t
9236 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9237 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9238 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9239 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9240
9241 @item a
9242 @cindex unknown address, locating
9243 @cindex locate address
9244 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9245 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9246 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9247
9248 @smallexample
9249 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9250 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9251 @end smallexample
9252
9253 @noindent
9254 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9255 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9256
9257 @item c
9258 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9259 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9260 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9261 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9262
9263 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9264 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9265 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9266 data.
9267
9268 @item f
9269 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9270 using typical floating point syntax.
9271
9272 @item s
9273 @cindex printing strings
9274 @cindex printing byte arrays
9275 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9276 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9277 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9278 natural types.
9279
9280 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9281 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9282 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9283 array.
9284
9285 @item z
9286 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9287 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9288 to the size of the integer type.
9289
9290 @item r
9291 @cindex raw printing
9292 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9293 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9294 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9295 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9296 pretty-printer which might exist.
9297 @end table
9298
9299 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9300
9301 @smallexample
9302 p/x $pc
9303 @end smallexample
9304
9305 @noindent
9306 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9307 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9308
9309 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9310 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9311 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9312
9313 @node Memory
9314 @section Examining Memory
9315
9316 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9317 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9318
9319 @cindex examining memory
9320 @table @code
9321 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9322 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9323 @itemx x @var{addr}
9324 @itemx x
9325 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9326 @end table
9327
9328 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9329 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9330 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9331 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9332 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9333
9334 @table @r
9335 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9336 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9337 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9338 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9339 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9340 @c 4.1.2.
9341
9342 @item @var{f}, the display format
9343 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9344 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9345 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9346 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9347 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9348
9349 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9350 The unit size is any of
9351
9352 @table @code
9353 @item b
9354 Bytes.
9355 @item h
9356 Halfwords (two bytes).
9357 @item w
9358 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9359 @item g
9360 Giant words (eight bytes).
9361 @end table
9362
9363 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9364 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9365 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9366 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9367 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9368 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9369 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9370 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9371 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9372 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9373 be altered.
9374
9375 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9376 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9377 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9378 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9379 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9380 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9381 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9382 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9383 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9384 a value from memory).
9385 @end table
9386
9387 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9388 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9389 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9390 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9391 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9392
9393 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9394 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9395 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9396
9397 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9398 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9399 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9400 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9401 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9402
9403 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9404 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9405 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9406 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9407 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9408 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9409 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9410 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9411 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9412
9413 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9414 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9415 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9416 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9417 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9418 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9419
9420 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9421 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9422 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9423 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9424 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9425 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9426 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9427
9428 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9429 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9430
9431 @smallexample
9432 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9433 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9434 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9435 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9436 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9437 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9438 @end smallexample
9439
9440 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9441 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9442 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9443 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9444 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9445 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9446 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9447 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9448 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9449
9450 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9451 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9452 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9453
9454 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9455 @cindex addressable memory unit
9456 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9457 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9458 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9459 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9460 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9461 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9462 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9463 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9464 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9465
9466 @cindex remote memory comparison
9467 @cindex target memory comparison
9468 @cindex verify remote memory image
9469 @cindex verify target memory image
9470 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9471 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9472 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9473 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9474 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9475 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9476
9477 @table @code
9478 @kindex compare-sections
9479 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9480 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9481 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9482 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9483 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9484 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9485
9486 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9487 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9488 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9489 @end table
9490
9491 @node Auto Display
9492 @section Automatic Display
9493 @cindex automatic display
9494 @cindex display of expressions
9495
9496 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9497 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9498 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9499 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9500 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9501 The automatic display looks like this:
9502
9503 @smallexample
9504 2: foo = 38
9505 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9506 @end smallexample
9507
9508 @noindent
9509 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9510 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9511 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9512 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9513 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9514 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9515
9516 @table @code
9517 @kindex display
9518 @item display @var{expr}
9519 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9520 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9521
9522 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9523
9524 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9525 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9526 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9527 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9528 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9529
9530 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9531 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9532 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9533 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9534 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9535 @end table
9536
9537 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9538 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9539 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9540
9541 @table @code
9542 @kindex delete display
9543 @kindex undisplay
9544 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9545 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9546 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9547 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9548 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9549 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9550 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9551
9552 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9553 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9554
9555 @kindex disable display
9556 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9557 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9558 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9559 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9560 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9561 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9562 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9563 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9564
9565 @kindex enable display
9566 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9567 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9568 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9569 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9570 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9571 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9572 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9573
9574 @item display
9575 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9576 done when your program stops.
9577
9578 @kindex info display
9579 @item info display
9580 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9581 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9582 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9583 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9584 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9585 @end table
9586
9587 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9588 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9589 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9590 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9591 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9592 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9593 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9594 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9595 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9596 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9597 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9598
9599 @node Print Settings
9600 @section Print Settings
9601
9602 @cindex format options
9603 @cindex print settings
9604 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9605 and symbols are printed.
9606
9607 @noindent
9608 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9609
9610 @table @code
9611 @kindex set print
9612 @item set print address
9613 @itemx set print address on
9614 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9615 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9616 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9617 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9618 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9619 @code{set print address on}:
9620
9621 @smallexample
9622 @group
9623 (@value{GDBP}) f
9624 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9625 at input.c:530
9626 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9627 @end group
9628 @end smallexample
9629
9630 @item set print address off
9631 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9632 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9633
9634 @smallexample
9635 @group
9636 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9637 (@value{GDBP}) f
9638 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9639 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9640 @end group
9641 @end smallexample
9642
9643 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9644 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9645 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9646 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9647
9648 @kindex show print
9649 @item show print address
9650 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9651 @end table
9652
9653 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9654 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9655 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9656 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9657 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9658 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9659 it prints a symbolic address:
9660
9661 @table @code
9662 @item set print symbol-filename on
9663 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9664 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9665 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9666 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9667
9668 @item set print symbol-filename off
9669 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9670 default.
9671
9672 @item show print symbol-filename
9673 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9674 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9675 @end table
9676
9677 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9678 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9679 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9680
9681 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9682 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9683
9684 @table @code
9685 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9686 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9687 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9688 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9689 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9690 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9691 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9692 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9693
9694 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9695 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9696 symbolic address.
9697 @end table
9698
9699 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9700 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9701 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9702 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9703 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9704 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9705 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9706 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9707
9708 @smallexample
9709 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9710 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9711 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9712 @end smallexample
9713
9714 @quotation
9715 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9716 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9717 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9718 @end quotation
9719
9720 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9721 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9722
9723 @table @code
9724 @item set print symbol on
9725 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9726 one exists.
9727
9728 @item set print symbol off
9729 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9730 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9731 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9732
9733 @item show print symbol
9734 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9735 address.
9736 @end table
9737
9738 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9739
9740 @table @code
9741 @item set print array
9742 @itemx set print array on
9743 @cindex pretty print arrays
9744 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9745 but uses more space. The default is off.
9746
9747 @item set print array off
9748 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9749
9750 @item show print array
9751 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9752 arrays.
9753
9754 @cindex print array indexes
9755 @item set print array-indexes
9756 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9757 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9758 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9759 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9760
9761 @item set print array-indexes off
9762 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9763
9764 @item show print array-indexes
9765 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9766 arrays.
9767
9768 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9769 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9770 @cindex number of array elements to print
9771 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9772 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9773 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9774 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9775 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9776 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9777 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9778 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9779
9780 @item show print elements
9781 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9782 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9783
9784 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9785 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9786 @cindex printing frame argument values
9787 @cindex print all frame argument values
9788 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9789 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9790 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9791 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9792 values are:
9793
9794 @table @code
9795 @item all
9796 The values of all arguments are printed.
9797
9798 @item scalars
9799 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9800 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9801 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9802 only scalar arguments are shown:
9803
9804 @smallexample
9805 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9806 at frame-args.c:23
9807 @end smallexample
9808
9809 @item none
9810 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9811 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9812
9813 @smallexample
9814 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9815 at frame-args.c:23
9816 @end smallexample
9817 @end table
9818
9819 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9820 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9821 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9822 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9823 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9824 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9825 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9826 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9827 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9828 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9829
9830 @item show print frame-arguments
9831 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9832
9833 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9834 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9835
9836 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9837 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9838 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9839 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9840 This is the default.
9841
9842 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9843 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9844
9845 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9846 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9847 @kindex set print entry-values
9848 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9849 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9850 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9851 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9852 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9853
9854 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9855 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9856 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9857 @code{no} setting.
9858
9859 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9860 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9861 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9862 this information.
9863
9864 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9865
9866 @table @code
9867 @item no
9868 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9869 point.
9870 @smallexample
9871 #0 equal (val=5)
9872 #0 different (val=6)
9873 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9874 #0 born (val=10)
9875 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9876 @end smallexample
9877
9878 @item only
9879 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9880 values are never printed.
9881 @smallexample
9882 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9883 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9884 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9885 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9886 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9887 @end smallexample
9888
9889 @item preferred
9890 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9891 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9892 value for such parameter.
9893 @smallexample
9894 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9895 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9896 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9897 #0 born (val=10)
9898 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9899 @end smallexample
9900
9901 @item if-needed
9902 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9903 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9904 parameter.
9905 @smallexample
9906 #0 equal (val=5)
9907 #0 different (val=6)
9908 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9909 #0 born (val=10)
9910 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9911 @end smallexample
9912
9913 @item both
9914 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9915 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9916 optimizations.
9917 @smallexample
9918 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9919 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9920 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9921 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9922 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9923 @end smallexample
9924
9925 @item compact
9926 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9927 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9928 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9929 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9930 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9931 @smallexample
9932 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9933 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9934 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9935 #0 born (val=10)
9936 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9937 @end smallexample
9938
9939 @item default
9940 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9941 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9942 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9943 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9944 @smallexample
9945 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9946 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9947 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9948 #0 born (val=10)
9949 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9950 @end smallexample
9951 @end table
9952
9953 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9954 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9955
9956 @item show print entry-values
9957 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9958 entry.
9959
9960 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9961 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9962 @cindex repeated array elements
9963 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9964 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9965 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9966 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9967 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9968 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9969 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9970 is 10.
9971
9972 @item show print repeats
9973 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9974 elements.
9975
9976 @item set print null-stop
9977 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9978 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9979 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9980 contain only short strings.
9981 The default is off.
9982
9983 @item show print null-stop
9984 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9985 @sc{null} character.
9986
9987 @item set print pretty on
9988 @cindex print structures in indented form
9989 @cindex indentation in structure display
9990 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9991 per line, like this:
9992
9993 @smallexample
9994 @group
9995 $1 = @{
9996 next = 0x0,
9997 flags = @{
9998 sweet = 1,
9999 sour = 1
10000 @},
10001 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10002 @}
10003 @end group
10004 @end smallexample
10005
10006 @item set print pretty off
10007 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10008
10009 @smallexample
10010 @group
10011 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10012 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10013 @end group
10014 @end smallexample
10015
10016 @noindent
10017 This is the default format.
10018
10019 @item show print pretty
10020 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10021
10022 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10023 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10024 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10025 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10026 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10027 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10028 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10029 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10030
10031 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10032 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10033 international character sets, and is the default.
10034
10035 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10036 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10037
10038 @item set print union on
10039 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10040 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10041 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10042
10043 @item set print union off
10044 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10045 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10046 instead.
10047
10048 @item show print union
10049 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10050 structures and other unions.
10051
10052 For example, given the declarations
10053
10054 @smallexample
10055 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10056 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10057 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10058 Bug_forms;
10059
10060 struct thing @{
10061 Species it;
10062 union @{
10063 Tree_forms tree;
10064 Bug_forms bug;
10065 @} form;
10066 @};
10067
10068 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10069 @end smallexample
10070
10071 @noindent
10072 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10073
10074 @smallexample
10075 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10076 @end smallexample
10077
10078 @noindent
10079 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10080
10081 @smallexample
10082 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10083 @end smallexample
10084
10085 @noindent
10086 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10087 and in Pascal.
10088 @end table
10089
10090 @need 1000
10091 @noindent
10092 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10093
10094 @table @code
10095 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10096 @item set print demangle
10097 @itemx set print demangle on
10098 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10099 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10100 linkage. The default is on.
10101
10102 @item show print demangle
10103 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10104
10105 @item set print asm-demangle
10106 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10107 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10108 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10109 The default is off.
10110
10111 @item show print asm-demangle
10112 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10113 or demangled form.
10114
10115 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10116 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10117 @kindex set demangle-style
10118 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10119 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10120 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10121
10122 @table @code
10123 @item auto
10124 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10125 This is the default.
10126
10127 @item gnu
10128 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10129
10130 @item hp
10131 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10132
10133 @item lucid
10134 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10135
10136 @item arm
10137 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10138 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10139 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10140 require further enhancement to permit that.
10141
10142 @end table
10143 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10144
10145 @item show demangle-style
10146 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10147
10148 @item set print object
10149 @itemx set print object on
10150 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10151 @cindex display derived types
10152 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10153 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10154 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10155 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10156 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10157 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10158 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10159
10160 @item set print object off
10161 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10162 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10163
10164 @item show print object
10165 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10166
10167 @item set print static-members
10168 @itemx set print static-members on
10169 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10170 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10171
10172 @item set print static-members off
10173 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10174
10175 @item show print static-members
10176 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10177
10178 @item set print pascal_static-members
10179 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10180 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10181 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10182 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10183
10184 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10185 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10186
10187 @item show print pascal_static-members
10188 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10189
10190 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10191 @item set print vtbl
10192 @itemx set print vtbl on
10193 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10194 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10195 @cindex VTBL display
10196 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10197 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10198 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10199
10200 @item set print vtbl off
10201 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10202
10203 @item show print vtbl
10204 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10205 @end table
10206
10207 @node Pretty Printing
10208 @section Pretty Printing
10209
10210 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10211 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10212 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10213
10214 @menu
10215 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10216 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10217 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10218 @end menu
10219
10220 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10221 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10222
10223 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10224 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10225 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10226
10227 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10228 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10229 pretty-printers with their names.
10230 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10231 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10232 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10233 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10234
10235 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10236 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10237 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10238 do anything special.
10239
10240 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10241
10242 @itemize @bullet
10243 @item
10244 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10245 all inferiors.
10246
10247 @item
10248 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10249 when debugging that program.
10250 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10251
10252 @item
10253 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10254 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10255 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10256 @end itemize
10257
10258 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10259 pretty-printers are selected,
10260
10261 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10262 for new types.
10263
10264 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10265 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10266
10267 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10271 $1 = @{
10272 static npos = 4294967295,
10273 _M_dataplus = @{
10274 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10275 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10276 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10277 @},
10278 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10279 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10280 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10281 @}
10282 @}
10283 @end smallexample
10284
10285 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10286
10287 @smallexample
10288 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10289 $2 = "abcd"
10290 @end smallexample
10291
10292 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10293 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10294 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10295
10296 @table @code
10297 @kindex info pretty-printer
10298 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10299 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10300 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10301
10302 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10303 whose pretty-printers to list.
10304 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10305 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10306 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10307 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10308 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10309
10310 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10311 to list.
10312
10313 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10314 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10315 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10316 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10317
10318 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10319 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10320 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10321 @end table
10322
10323 Example:
10324
10325 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10326 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10327 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10328 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10332 library1.so:
10333 foo
10334 library2.so:
10335 bar
10336 bar1
10337 bar2
10338 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10339 library2.so:
10340 bar
10341 bar1
10342 bar2
10343 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10344 1 printer disabled
10345 2 of 3 printers enabled
10346 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10347 library1.so:
10348 foo [disabled]
10349 library2.so:
10350 bar
10351 bar1
10352 bar2
10353 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10354 1 printer disabled
10355 1 of 3 printers enabled
10356 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10357 library1.so:
10358 foo [disabled]
10359 library2.so:
10360 bar
10361 bar1 [disabled]
10362 bar2
10363 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10364 1 printer disabled
10365 0 of 3 printers enabled
10366 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10367 library1.so:
10368 foo [disabled]
10369 library2.so:
10370 bar [disabled]
10371 bar1 [disabled]
10372 bar2
10373 @end smallexample
10374
10375 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10376 as can each individual subprinter.
10377
10378 @node Value History
10379 @section Value History
10380
10381 @cindex value history
10382 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10383 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10384 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10385 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10386 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10387 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10388 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10389 symbol table.
10390
10391 @cindex @code{$}
10392 @cindex @code{$$}
10393 @cindex history number
10394 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10395 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10396 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10397 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10398 history number.
10399
10400 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10401 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10402 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10403 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10404 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10405 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10406 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10407
10408 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10409 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10410
10411 @smallexample
10412 p *$
10413 @end smallexample
10414
10415 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10416 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10417
10418 @smallexample
10419 p *$.next
10420 @end smallexample
10421
10422 @noindent
10423 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10424 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10425
10426 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10427 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10428
10429 @smallexample
10430 print x
10431 set x=5
10432 @end smallexample
10433
10434 @noindent
10435 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10436 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10437
10438 @table @code
10439 @kindex show values
10440 @item show values
10441 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10442 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10443 values} does not change the history.
10444
10445 @item show values @var{n}
10446 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10447
10448 @item show values +
10449 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10450 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10451 @end table
10452
10453 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10454 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10455
10456 @node Convenience Vars
10457 @section Convenience Variables
10458
10459 @cindex convenience variables
10460 @cindex user-defined variables
10461 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10462 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10463 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10464 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10465 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10466
10467 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10468 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10469 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10470 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10471 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10472
10473 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10474 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10475 For example:
10476
10477 @smallexample
10478 set $foo = *object_ptr
10479 @end smallexample
10480
10481 @noindent
10482 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10483 @code{object_ptr}.
10484
10485 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10486 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10487 value with another assignment at any time.
10488
10489 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10490 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10491 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10492 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10493
10494 @table @code
10495 @kindex show convenience
10496 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10497 @item show convenience
10498 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10499 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10500 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10501
10502 @kindex init-if-undefined
10503 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10504 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10505 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10506 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10507 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10508 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10509 override default values used in a command script.
10510
10511 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10512 any side-effects do not occur.
10513 @end table
10514
10515 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10516 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10517 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10518
10519 @smallexample
10520 set $i = 0
10521 print bar[$i++]->contents
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 @noindent
10525 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10526
10527 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10528 values likely to be useful.
10529
10530 @table @code
10531 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10532 @item $_
10533 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10534 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10535 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10536 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10537 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10538 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10539 to the type of @code{$__}.
10540
10541 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10542 @item $__
10543 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10544 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10545 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10546
10547 @item $_exitcode
10548 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10549 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10550 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10551 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10552
10553 @item $_exitsignal
10554 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10555 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10556 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10557 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10558
10559 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10560 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10561 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10562 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10563 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10564
10565 @smallexample
10566 #include <signal.h>
10567
10568 int
10569 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10570 @{
10571 raise (SIGALRM);
10572 return 0;
10573 @}
10574 @end smallexample
10575
10576 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10577 or signalled would be:
10578
10579 @smallexample
10580 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10581 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10582 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10583 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10584 >echo The program has exited\n
10585 >else
10586 >echo The program has signalled\n
10587 >end
10588 >end
10589 (@value{GDBP}) run
10590 Starting program:
10591
10592 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10593 The program no longer exists.
10594 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10595 The program has signalled
10596 @end smallexample
10597
10598 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10599 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10600 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10601 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10602
10603 @smallexample
10604 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10605 The program has exited
10606 @end smallexample
10607
10608 @item $_exception
10609 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10610 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10611
10612 @item $_probe_argc
10613 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10614 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10615
10616 @item $_sdata
10617 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10618 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10619 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10620 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10621 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10622
10623 @item $_siginfo
10624 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10625 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10626 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10627 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10628 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10629
10630 @item $_tlb
10631 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10632 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10633 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10634 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10635 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10636 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10637
10638 @item $_inferior
10639 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10640 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10641
10642 @item $_thread
10643 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10644
10645 @item $_gthread
10646 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10647
10648 @end table
10649
10650 @node Convenience Funs
10651 @section Convenience Functions
10652
10653 @cindex convenience functions
10654 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10655 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10656 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10657 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10658 @value{GDBN}.
10659
10660 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10661 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10662
10663 @table @code
10664
10665 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10666 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10667 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10668 returns zero.
10669
10670 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10671 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10672 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10673 it is @code{void}:
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10677 $1 = void
10678 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10679 $2 = 1
10680 (@value{GDBP}) run
10681 Starting program: ./a.out
10682 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10683 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10684 $3 = 0
10685 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10686 $4 = 0
10687 @end smallexample
10688
10689 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10690 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10691 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10692 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10693 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10694 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10695 anymore.
10696
10697 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10698 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10699
10700 @smallexample
10701 void
10702 foo (void)
10703 @{
10704 @}
10705 @end smallexample
10706
10707 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10708
10709 @smallexample
10710 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10711 $1 = void
10712 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10713 $2 = 1
10714 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10715 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10716 $3 = void
10717 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10718 $4 = 1
10719 @end smallexample
10720
10721 @end table
10722
10723 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10724 @code{Python} support.
10725
10726 @table @code
10727
10728 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10729 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10730 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10731 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10732 Otherwise it returns zero.
10733
10734 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10735 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10736 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10737 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10738 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10739 regular expression support.
10740
10741 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10742 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10743 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10744 Otherwise it returns zero.
10745
10746 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10747 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10748 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10749
10750 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10751 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10752 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10753 Otherwise it returns zero.
10754
10755 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10756 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10757 The default is 1.
10758
10759 Example:
10760
10761 @smallexample
10762 (gdb) backtrace
10763 #0 bottom_func ()
10764 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10765 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10766 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10767 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10768 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10769 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10770 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10771 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10772 $1 = 1
10773 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10774 $1 = 1
10775 @end smallexample
10776
10777 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10778 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10779 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10780 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10781
10782 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10783 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10784 The default is 1.
10785
10786 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10787 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10788 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10789 Otherwise it returns zero.
10790
10791 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10792 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10793 The default is 1.
10794
10795 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10796 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10797 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10798 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10799
10800 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10801 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10802 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10803 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10804
10805 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10806 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10807 The default is 1.
10808
10809 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10810 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10811 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10812 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10813
10814 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10815 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10816 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10817
10818 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10819 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10820 an enumerated type:
10821
10822 @smallexample
10823 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10824 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10825 @end smallexample
10826
10827 @end table
10828
10829 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10830 convenience functions.
10831
10832 @table @code
10833 @item help function
10834 @kindex help function
10835 @cindex show all convenience functions
10836 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10837 @end table
10838
10839 @node Registers
10840 @section Registers
10841
10842 @cindex registers
10843 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10844 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10845 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10846 your machine.
10847
10848 @table @code
10849 @kindex info registers
10850 @item info registers
10851 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10852 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10853
10854 @kindex info all-registers
10855 @cindex floating point registers
10856 @item info all-registers
10857 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10858 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10859
10860 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10861 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10862 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10863 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10864 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10865 @end table
10866
10867 @anchor{standard registers}
10868 @cindex stack pointer register
10869 @cindex program counter register
10870 @cindex process status register
10871 @cindex frame pointer register
10872 @cindex standard registers
10873 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10874 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10875 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10876 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10877 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10878 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10879 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10880 you could print the program counter in hex with
10881
10882 @smallexample
10883 p/x $pc
10884 @end smallexample
10885
10886 @noindent
10887 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10888
10889 @smallexample
10890 x/i $pc
10891 @end smallexample
10892
10893 @noindent
10894 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10895 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10896 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10897 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10898 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10899 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10900 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10901
10902 @smallexample
10903 set $sp += 4
10904 @end smallexample
10905
10906 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10907 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10908 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10909 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10910 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10911 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10912 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10913
10914 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10915 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10916 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10917 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10918 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10919 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10920 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10921
10922 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10923 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10924 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10925 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10926 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10927 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10928 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10929 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10930 prints the data in both formats.
10931
10932 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10933 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10934 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10935 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10936 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10937 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10938 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10939
10940 @smallexample
10941 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10942 $1 = @{
10943 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10944 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10945 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10946 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10947 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10948 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10949 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10950 @}
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 @noindent
10954 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10955 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10956 value to a @code{struct} member:
10957
10958 @smallexample
10959 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10960 @end smallexample
10961
10962 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10963 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10964 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10965 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10966 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10967 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10968
10969 @cindex caller-saved registers
10970 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10971 @cindex volatile registers
10972 @cindex <not saved> values
10973 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10974 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10975 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10976 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10977 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10978 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10979 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10980 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10981 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10982 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10983 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10984 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10985 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10986 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10987 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10988 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10989 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10990 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10991 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10992 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10993 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10994 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10995 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10996
10997 @node Floating Point Hardware
10998 @section Floating Point Hardware
10999 @cindex floating point
11000
11001 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11002 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11003
11004 @table @code
11005 @kindex info float
11006 @item info float
11007 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11008 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11009 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11010 the ARM and x86 machines.
11011 @end table
11012
11013 @node Vector Unit
11014 @section Vector Unit
11015 @cindex vector unit
11016
11017 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11018 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11019
11020 @table @code
11021 @kindex info vector
11022 @item info vector
11023 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11024 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11025 @end table
11026
11027 @node OS Information
11028 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11029 @cindex OS information
11030
11031 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11032 you debug your program.
11033
11034 @cindex auxiliary vector
11035 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11036 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11037 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11038 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11039 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11040 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11041 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11042 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11043 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11044 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11045 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11046 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11047
11048 @table @code
11049 @kindex info auxv
11050 @item info auxv
11051 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11052 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11053 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11054 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11055 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11056 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11057 an unrecognized tag.
11058 @end table
11059
11060 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11061 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11062 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11063 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11064 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11065 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11066 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11067
11068 @table @code
11069 @kindex info os
11070 @item info os @var{infotype}
11071
11072 Display OS information of the requested type.
11073
11074 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11075
11076 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11077 @table @code
11078 @kindex info os cpus
11079 @item cpus
11080 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11081 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11082 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11083 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11084 kernel initialization.
11085
11086 @kindex info os files
11087 @item files
11088 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11089 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11090 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11091 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11092
11093 @kindex info os modules
11094 @item modules
11095 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11096 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11097 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11098 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11099 in memory.
11100
11101 @kindex info os msg
11102 @item msg
11103 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11104 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11105 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11106 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11107 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11108 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11109 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11110 the message queue was last changed.
11111
11112 @kindex info os processes
11113 @item processes
11114 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11115 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11116 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11117 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11118 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11119 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11120
11121 @kindex info os procgroups
11122 @item procgroups
11123 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11124 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11125 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11126 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11127 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11128 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11129 and the process group leader is listed first.
11130
11131 @kindex info os semaphores
11132 @item semaphores
11133 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11134 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11135 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11136 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11137 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11138
11139 @kindex info os shm
11140 @item shm
11141 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11142 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11143 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11144 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11145 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11146 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11147 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11148
11149 @kindex info os sockets
11150 @item sockets
11151 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11152 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11153 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11154 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11155 connection.
11156
11157 @kindex info os threads
11158 @item threads
11159 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11160 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11161 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11162 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11163 process is not listed.
11164 @end table
11165
11166 @item info os
11167 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11168 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11169 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11170 types, this command will report an error.
11171 @end table
11172
11173 @node Memory Region Attributes
11174 @section Memory Region Attributes
11175 @cindex memory region attributes
11176
11177 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11178 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11179 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11180 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11181 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11182 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11183 user can override the fetched regions.
11184
11185 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11186 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11187 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11188 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11189 all memory.
11190
11191 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11192 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11193
11194 @table @code
11195 @kindex mem
11196 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11197 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11198 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11199 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11200 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11201 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11202
11203 @item mem auto
11204 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11205 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11206
11207 @kindex delete mem
11208 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11209 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11210 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11211
11212 @kindex disable mem
11213 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11214 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11215 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11216 It may be enabled again later.
11217
11218 @kindex enable mem
11219 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11220 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11221
11222 @kindex info mem
11223 @item info mem
11224 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11225 for each region:
11226
11227 @table @emph
11228 @item Memory Region Number
11229 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11230 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11231 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11232
11233 @item Lo Address
11234 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11235
11236 @item Hi Address
11237 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11238
11239 @item Attributes
11240 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11241 @end table
11242 @end table
11243
11244
11245 @subsection Attributes
11246
11247 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11248 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11249 write accesses to a memory region.
11250
11251 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11252 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11253 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11254
11255 @table @code
11256 @item ro
11257 Memory is read only.
11258 @item wo
11259 Memory is write only.
11260 @item rw
11261 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11262 @end table
11263
11264 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11265 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11266 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11267 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11268 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11269
11270 @table @code
11271 @item 8
11272 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11273 @item 16
11274 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11275 @item 32
11276 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11277 @item 64
11278 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11279 @end table
11280
11281 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11282 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11283 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11284 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11285 @c
11286 @c @table @code
11287 @c @item hwbreak
11288 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11289 @c @item swbreak (default)
11290 @c @end table
11291
11292 @subsubsection Data Cache
11293 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11294 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11295 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11296 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11297 registers.
11298
11299 @table @code
11300 @item cache
11301 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11302 @item nocache
11303 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11304 @end table
11305
11306 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11307 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11308 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11309 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11310 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11311
11312 @table @code
11313 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11314 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11315 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11316 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11317 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11318 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11319 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11320 The default value is @code{on}.
11321 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11322 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11323 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11324 @end table
11325
11326
11327 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11328 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11329 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11330 @c
11331 @c @table @code
11332 @c @item verify
11333 @c @item noverify (default)
11334 @c @end table
11335
11336 @node Dump/Restore Files
11337 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11338 @cindex dump/restore files
11339 @cindex append data to a file
11340 @cindex dump data to a file
11341 @cindex restore data from a file
11342
11343 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11344 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11345 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11346 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11347 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11348 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11349 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11350
11351 @table @code
11352
11353 @kindex dump
11354 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11355 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11356 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11357 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11358
11359 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11360 @table @code
11361 @item binary
11362 Raw binary form.
11363 @item ihex
11364 Intel hex format.
11365 @item srec
11366 Motorola S-record format.
11367 @item tekhex
11368 Tektronix Hex format.
11369 @item verilog
11370 Verilog Hex format.
11371 @end table
11372
11373 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11374 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11375 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11376 form.
11377
11378 @kindex append
11379 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11380 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11381 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11382 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11383 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11384
11385 @kindex restore
11386 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11387 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11388 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11389 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11390 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11391
11392 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11393 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11394 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11395 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11396 from that location.
11397
11398 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11399 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11400 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11401 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11402
11403 @end table
11404
11405 @node Core File Generation
11406 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11407 @cindex dump core from inferior
11408
11409 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11410 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11411 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11412 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11413 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11414 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11415 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11416
11417 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11418 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11419 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11420
11421 @table @code
11422 @kindex gcore
11423 @kindex generate-core-file
11424 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11425 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11426 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11427 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11428 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11429 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11430
11431 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11432 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11433
11434 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11435 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11436 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11437
11438 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11439 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11440 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11441 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11442 Enable or disable the use of the file
11443 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11444 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11445 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11446 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11447
11448 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11449 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11450 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11451 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11452 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11453 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11454 about the bits that can be set in the
11455 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11456 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11457
11458 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11459 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11460 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11461 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11462 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11463 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11464 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11465 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11466 @end table
11467
11468 @node Character Sets
11469 @section Character Sets
11470 @cindex character sets
11471 @cindex charset
11472 @cindex translating between character sets
11473 @cindex host character set
11474 @cindex target character set
11475
11476 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11477 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11478 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11479 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11480 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11481 @dfn{target character set}.
11482
11483 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11484 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11485 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11486 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11487 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11488 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11489 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11490 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11491 character and string literals in expressions.
11492
11493 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11494 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11495 target-charset} command, described below.
11496
11497 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11498 support:
11499
11500 @table @code
11501 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11502 @kindex set target-charset
11503 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11504 list of supported target character sets, type
11505 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11506
11507 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11508 @kindex set host-charset
11509 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11510
11511 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11512 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11513 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11514 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11515 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11516
11517 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11518 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11519 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11520
11521 @item set charset @var{charset}
11522 @kindex set charset
11523 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11524 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11525 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11526 for both host and target.
11527
11528 @item show charset
11529 @kindex show charset
11530 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11531
11532 @item show host-charset
11533 @kindex show host-charset
11534 Show the name of the current host character set.
11535
11536 @item show target-charset
11537 @kindex show target-charset
11538 Show the name of the current target character set.
11539
11540 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11541 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11542 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11543 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11544 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11545 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11546
11547 @item show target-wide-charset
11548 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11549 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11550 @end table
11551
11552 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11553 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11554 @file{charset-test.c}:
11555
11556 @smallexample
11557 #include <stdio.h>
11558
11559 char ascii_hello[]
11560 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11561 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11562 char ibm1047_hello[]
11563 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11564 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11565
11566 main ()
11567 @{
11568 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11569 @}
11570 @end smallexample
11571
11572 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11573 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11574 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11575
11576 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11577
11578 @smallexample
11579 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11580 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11581 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11582 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11583 @dots{}
11584 (@value{GDBP})
11585 @end smallexample
11586
11587 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11588 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11589 strings:
11590
11591 @smallexample
11592 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11593 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11594 (@value{GDBP})
11595 @end smallexample
11596
11597 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11598 initial character set:
11599 @smallexample
11600 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11601 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11602 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11603 (@value{GDBP})
11604 @end smallexample
11605
11606 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11607 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11608 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11609 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11610 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11611
11612 @smallexample
11613 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11614 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11615 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11616 $2 = 72 'H'
11617 (@value{GDBP})
11618 @end smallexample
11619
11620 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11621 literals you use in expressions:
11622
11623 @smallexample
11624 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11625 $3 = 43 '+'
11626 (@value{GDBP})
11627 @end smallexample
11628
11629 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11630 character.
11631
11632 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11633 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11634 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11635
11636 @smallexample
11637 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11638 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11639 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11640 $5 = 200 '\310'
11641 (@value{GDBP})
11642 @end smallexample
11643
11644 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11645 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11646
11647 @smallexample
11648 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11649 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11650 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11651 @end smallexample
11652
11653 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11654 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11655 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11656 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11657 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11658
11659 @smallexample
11660 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11661 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11662 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11663 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11664 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11665 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11666 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11667 $7 = 72 '\110'
11668 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11669 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11670 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11671 $9 = 200 'H'
11672 (@value{GDBP})
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11676 string literals you use in expressions:
11677
11678 @smallexample
11679 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11680 $10 = 78 '+'
11681 (@value{GDBP})
11682 @end smallexample
11683
11684 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11685 character.
11686
11687 @node Caching Target Data
11688 @section Caching Data of Targets
11689 @cindex caching data of targets
11690
11691 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11692 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11693 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11694 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11695 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11696 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11697 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11698 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11699 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11700 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11701 is executing.
11702 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11703 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11704 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11705 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11706 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11707 in the code segment.
11708 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11709 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11710
11711 @table @code
11712 @kindex set remotecache
11713 @item set remotecache on
11714 @itemx set remotecache off
11715 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11716 with old scripts.
11717
11718 @kindex show remotecache
11719 @item show remotecache
11720 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11721
11722 @kindex set stack-cache
11723 @item set stack-cache on
11724 @itemx set stack-cache off
11725 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11726 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11727
11728 @kindex show stack-cache
11729 @item show stack-cache
11730 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11731
11732 @kindex set code-cache
11733 @item set code-cache on
11734 @itemx set code-cache off
11735 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11736 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11737 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11738
11739 @kindex show code-cache
11740 @item show code-cache
11741 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11742 accesses.
11743
11744 @kindex info dcache
11745 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11746 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11747 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11748 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11749 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11750 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11751
11752 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11753 printed in hex.
11754
11755 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11756 @cindex dcache size
11757 @kindex set dcache size
11758 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11759
11760 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11761 @cindex dcache line-size
11762 @kindex set dcache line-size
11763 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11764 Must be a power of 2.
11765
11766 @item show dcache size
11767 @kindex show dcache size
11768 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11769
11770 @item show dcache line-size
11771 @kindex show dcache line-size
11772 Show default size of dcache lines.
11773
11774 @end table
11775
11776 @node Searching Memory
11777 @section Search Memory
11778 @cindex searching memory
11779
11780 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11781 @code{find} command.
11782
11783 @table @code
11784 @kindex find
11785 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11786 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11787 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11788 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11789 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11790 @end table
11791
11792 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11793 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11794
11795 @table @r
11796 @item @var{s}, search query size
11797 The size of each search query value.
11798
11799 @table @code
11800 @item b
11801 bytes
11802 @item h
11803 halfwords (two bytes)
11804 @item w
11805 words (four bytes)
11806 @item g
11807 giant words (eight bytes)
11808 @end table
11809
11810 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11811 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11812 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11813
11814 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11815 value's type in the current language.
11816 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11817 pattern as a mixture of types.
11818 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11819 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11820 which is typically four bytes.
11821
11822 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11823 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11824 @end table
11825
11826 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11827 (@code{"}).
11828 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11829 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11830
11831 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11832 number of matches found.
11833
11834 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11835 @samp{$_}.
11836 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11837
11838 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11839
11840 @smallexample
11841 void
11842 hello ()
11843 @{
11844 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11845 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11846 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11847 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11848 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11849 @}
11850 @end smallexample
11851
11852 @noindent
11853 you get during debugging:
11854
11855 @smallexample
11856 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11857 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11858 1 pattern found
11859 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11860 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11861 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11862 2 patterns found
11863 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11864 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11865 1 pattern found
11866 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11867 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11868 1 pattern found
11869 (gdb) print $numfound
11870 $1 = 1
11871 (gdb) print $_
11872 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11873 @end smallexample
11874
11875 @node Value Sizes
11876 @section Value Sizes
11877
11878 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11879 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11880 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11881 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11882 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11883
11884 @table @code
11885 @kindex set max-value-size
11886 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11887 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11888 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11889 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11890 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11891
11892 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11893 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11894
11895 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11896 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11897 currently 16 bytes.
11898
11899 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11900 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11901 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11902 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11903 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11904 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11905 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11906 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11907
11908 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11909
11910 @kindex show max-value-size
11911 @item show max-value-size
11912 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11913 allocate for the contents of a value.
11914 @end table
11915
11916 @node Optimized Code
11917 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11918 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11919 @cindex debugging optimized code
11920
11921 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11922 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11923 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11924 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11925 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11926 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11927 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11928
11929 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11930 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11931 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11932 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11933
11934 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11935 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11936 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11937 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11938 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11939 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11940
11941 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11942 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11943 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11944 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11945 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11946
11947 @menu
11948 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11949 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11950 @end menu
11951
11952 @node Inline Functions
11953 @section Inline Functions
11954 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11955
11956 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11957 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11958 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11959 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11960 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11961 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11962 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11963 @code{info frame} command.
11964
11965 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11966 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11967 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11968 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11969 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11970 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11971 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11972 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11973 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11974 local variables in the caller.
11975
11976 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11977 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11978 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11979 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11980 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11981 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11982 instructions are executed.
11983
11984 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11985 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11986 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11987 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11988
11989 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11990 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11991
11992 @itemize @bullet
11993 @item
11994 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11995 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11996 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11997 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11998 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11999 or inside the inlined function instead.
12000
12001 @item
12002 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12003 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12004 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12005 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12006
12007 @end itemize
12008
12009 @node Tail Call Frames
12010 @section Tail Call Frames
12011 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12012
12013 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12014 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12015 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12016 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12017 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12018
12019 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12020 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12021 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12022 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12023 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12024 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12025 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12026
12027 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12028 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12029 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12030 this information.
12031
12032 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12033 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12034
12035 @smallexample
12036 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12037 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12038 (gdb) info frame
12039 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12040 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12041 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12042 source language c++.
12043 Arglist at unknown address.
12044 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12045 @end smallexample
12046
12047 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12048 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12049 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12050 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12051 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12052 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12053
12054 @table @code
12055 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12056 @item set debug entry-values
12057 @kindex set debug entry-values
12058 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12059 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12060 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12061 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12062 result.
12063
12064 @item show debug entry-values
12065 @kindex show debug entry-values
12066 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12067 values at function entry and tail calls.
12068 @end table
12069
12070 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12071 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12072 reference by variable @code{x}):
12073
12074 @smallexample
12075 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12076 void (*x) (void) = c;
12077 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12078 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12079 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12080
12081 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12082 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12083 a () at t.c:3
12084 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12085 (gdb) bt
12086 #0 a () at t.c:3
12087 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12088 @end smallexample
12089
12090 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12091
12092 @smallexample
12093 int i;
12094 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12095 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12096 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12097 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12098 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12099 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12100 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12101 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12102
12103 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12104 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12105 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12106 (gdb) bt
12107 #0 f () at t.c:2
12108 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12109 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12110 @end smallexample
12111
12112 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12113 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12114
12115 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12116 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12117 @set ARROW @click{}
12118 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12119 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12120 @end ifset
12121 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12122 @set ARROW ->
12123 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12124 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12125 @end ifclear
12126
12127 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12128 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12129 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12130
12131 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12132 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12133 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12134 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12135 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12136 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12137
12138 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12139 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12140 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12141 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12142 omitted.
12143
12144 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12145 entry may fail:
12146
12147 @smallexample
12148 int v;
12149 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12150 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12151 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12152 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12153 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12154 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12155
12156 (gdb) bt
12157 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12158 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12159 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12160 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12161 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12162 @end smallexample
12163
12164 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12165 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12166 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12167 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12168 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12169
12170 @node Macros
12171 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12172
12173 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12174 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12175 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12176 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12177 where it was defined.
12178
12179 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12180 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12181 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12182 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12183
12184 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12185 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12186 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12187 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12188 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12189 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12190 see @ref{List}.
12191
12192 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12193 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12194 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12195
12196 @table @code
12197
12198 @kindex macro expand
12199 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12200 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12201 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12202 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12203 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12204 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12205 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12206 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12207 it can be any string of tokens.
12208
12209 @kindex macro exp1
12210 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12211 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12212 @cindex expand macro once
12213 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12214 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12215 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12216 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12217 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12218 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12219 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12220 can be any string of tokens.
12221
12222 @kindex info macro
12223 @cindex macro definition, showing
12224 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12225 @cindex macros, from debug info
12226 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12227 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12228 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12229 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12230 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12231 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12232
12233 @kindex info macros
12234 @item info macros @var{location}
12235 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12236 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12237 command-line where those definitions were established.
12238
12239 @kindex macro define
12240 @cindex user-defined macros
12241 @cindex defining macros interactively
12242 @cindex macros, user-defined
12243 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12244 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12245 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12246 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12247 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12248 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12249 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12250 @var{arglist}.
12251
12252 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12253 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12254 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12255 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12256 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12257
12258 @kindex macro undef
12259 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12260 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12261 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12262 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12263 in the program being debugged.
12264
12265 @kindex macro list
12266 @item macro list
12267 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12268 @end table
12269
12270 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12271 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12272 show our source files:
12273
12274 @smallexample
12275 $ cat sample.c
12276 #include <stdio.h>
12277 #include "sample.h"
12278
12279 #define M 42
12280 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12281
12282 main ()
12283 @{
12284 #define N 28
12285 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12286 #undef N
12287 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12288 #define N 1729
12289 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12290 @}
12291 $ cat sample.h
12292 #define Q <
12293 $
12294 @end smallexample
12295
12296 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12297 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12298 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12299 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12300 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12301 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12302 information.
12303
12304 @smallexample
12305 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12306 $
12307 @end smallexample
12308
12309 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12310
12311 @smallexample
12312 $ gdb -nw sample
12313 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12314 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12315 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12316 (@value{GDBP})
12317 @end smallexample
12318
12319 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12320 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12321 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12322
12323 @smallexample
12324 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12325 3
12326 4 #define M 42
12327 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12328 6
12329 7 main ()
12330 8 @{
12331 9 #define N 28
12332 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12333 11 #undef N
12334 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12335 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12336 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12337 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12338 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12339 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12340 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12341 #define Q <
12342 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12343 expands to: (42 + 1)
12344 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12345 expands to: once (M + 1)
12346 (@value{GDBP})
12347 @end smallexample
12348
12349 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12350 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12351 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12352 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12353
12354 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12355 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12356
12357 @smallexample
12358 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12359 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12360 (@value{GDBP}) run
12361 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12362
12363 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12364 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12365 (@value{GDBP})
12366 @end smallexample
12367
12368 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12369
12370 @smallexample
12371 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12372 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12373 #define N 28
12374 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12375 expands to: 28 < 42
12376 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12377 $1 = 1
12378 (@value{GDBP})
12379 @end smallexample
12380
12381 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12382 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12383 thereof) in force at each point:
12384
12385 @smallexample
12386 (@value{GDBP}) next
12387 Hello, world!
12388 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12389 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12390 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12391 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12392 (@value{GDBP}) next
12393 We're so creative.
12394 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12395 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12396 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12397 #define N 1729
12398 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12399 expands to: 1729 < 42
12400 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12401 $2 = 0
12402 (@value{GDBP})
12403 @end smallexample
12404
12405 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12406 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12407 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12408 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12409
12410 @smallexample
12411 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12412 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12413 -D__STDC__=1
12414 (@value{GDBP})
12415 @end smallexample
12416
12417
12418 @node Tracepoints
12419 @chapter Tracepoints
12420 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12421 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12422
12423 @cindex tracepoints
12424 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12425 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12426 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12427 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12428 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12429 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12430 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12431
12432 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12433 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12434 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12435 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12436 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12437 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12438 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12439 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12440 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12441 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12442 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12443
12444 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12445 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12446 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12447 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12448 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12449 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12450 Packets}.
12451
12452 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12453 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12454 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12455
12456 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12457
12458 @menu
12459 * Set Tracepoints::
12460 * Analyze Collected Data::
12461 * Tracepoint Variables::
12462 * Trace Files::
12463 @end menu
12464
12465 @node Set Tracepoints
12466 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12467
12468 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12469 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12470 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12471 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12472 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12473 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12474 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12475
12476 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12477 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12478 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12479 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12480 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12481 tracepoint was hit.
12482
12483 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12484 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12485 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12486 either.
12487
12488 @cindex fast tracepoints
12489 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12490 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12491 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12492
12493 @cindex static tracepoints
12494 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12495 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12496 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12497 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12498 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12499 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12500 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12501 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12502 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12503 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12504 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12505 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12506 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12507 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12508 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12509 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12510 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12511 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12512 static tracepoint marker.
12513
12514 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12515 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12516
12517 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12518 conditions and actions.
12519
12520 @menu
12521 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12522 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12523 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12524 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12525 * Trace State Variables::
12526 * Tracepoint Actions::
12527 * Listing Tracepoints::
12528 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12529 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12530 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12531 @end menu
12532
12533 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12534 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12535
12536 @table @code
12537 @cindex set tracepoint
12538 @kindex trace
12539 @item trace @var{location}
12540 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12541 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12542 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12543 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12544 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12545 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12546 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12547 in tracing}).
12548 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12549 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12550 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12551 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12552 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12553 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12554 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12555 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12556 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12557 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12558 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12559 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12560
12561 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12562
12563 @smallexample
12564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12565
12566 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12567
12568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12569
12570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12571
12572 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12573 @end smallexample
12574
12575 @noindent
12576 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12577
12578 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12579 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12580 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12581 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12582 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12583 information on tracepoint conditions.
12584
12585 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12586 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12587 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12588 @kindex ftrace
12589 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12590 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12591 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12592 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12593 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12594 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12595 message.
12596
12597 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12598 @code{trace}.
12599
12600 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12601 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12602 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12603 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12604 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12605 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12606 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12607 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12608
12609 @example
12610 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12611 @end example
12612
12613 @noindent
12614 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12615 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12616
12617 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12618 @cindex set static tracepoint
12619 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12620 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12621 @kindex strace
12622 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12623 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12624 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12625 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12626 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12627
12628 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12629 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12630 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12631 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12632 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12633 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12634 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12635 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12636 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12637 tracing engine:
12638
12639 @smallexample
12640 main ()
12641 @{
12642 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12643 @}
12644 @end smallexample
12645
12646 @noindent
12647 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12648 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12649
12650 @smallexample
12651 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12652 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12653 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12654 Data: "str %s"
12655 [etc...]
12656 @end smallexample
12657
12658 @noindent
12659 so you may probe the marker above with:
12660
12661 @smallexample
12662 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12663 @end smallexample
12664
12665 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12666 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12667 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12668 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12669 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12670 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12671 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12672 the @samp{Data:} field.
12673
12674 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12675 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12676 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12677
12678 @vindex $tpnum
12679 @cindex last tracepoint number
12680 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12681 @cindex tracepoint number
12682 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12683 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12684
12685 @kindex delete tracepoint
12686 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12687 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12688 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12689 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12690 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12691
12692 Examples:
12693
12694 @smallexample
12695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12696
12697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12698 @end smallexample
12699
12700 @noindent
12701 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12702 @end table
12703
12704 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12705 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12706
12707 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12708
12709 @table @code
12710 @kindex disable tracepoint
12711 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12712 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12713 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12714 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12715 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12716 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12717 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12718 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12719 next trace experiment.
12720
12721 @kindex enable tracepoint
12722 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12723 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12724 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12725 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12726 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12727 next time a trace experiment is run.
12728 @end table
12729
12730 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12731 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12732
12733 @table @code
12734 @kindex passcount
12735 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12736 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12737 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12738 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12739 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12740 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12741 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12742 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12743 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12744 user.
12745
12746 Examples:
12747
12748 @smallexample
12749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12750 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12751
12752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12760 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12761 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12762 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12763 @end smallexample
12764 @end table
12765
12766 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12767 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12768 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12769 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12770
12771 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12772 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12773 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12774 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12775 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12776 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12777 is true.
12778
12779 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12780 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12781 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12782 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12783 just as with breakpoints.
12784
12785 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12786 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12787 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12788 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12789 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12790 accesses, and so forth.
12791
12792 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12793 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12794 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12795 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12796 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12797 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12798 search through.
12799
12800 @smallexample
12801 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12802 @end smallexample
12803
12804 @node Trace State Variables
12805 @subsection Trace State Variables
12806 @cindex trace state variables
12807
12808 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12809 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12810 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12811 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12812 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12813 integers.
12814
12815 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12816 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12817 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12818 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12819
12820 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12821 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12822 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12823 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12824 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12825 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12826 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12827 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12828 variable with the same name.
12829
12830 @table @code
12831
12832 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12833 @kindex tvariable
12834 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12835 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12836 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12837 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12838 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12839 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12840 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12841 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12842 value. The default initial value is 0.
12843
12844 @item info tvariables
12845 @kindex info tvariables
12846 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12847 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12848 currently running.
12849
12850 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12851 @kindex delete tvariable
12852 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12853 are specified.
12854
12855 @end table
12856
12857 @node Tracepoint Actions
12858 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12859
12860 @table @code
12861 @kindex actions
12862 @cindex tracepoint actions
12863 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12864 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12865 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12866 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12867 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12868 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12869 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12870 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12871 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12872 @code{while-stepping}.
12873
12874 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12875 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12876 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12877
12878 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12879 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12880 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12881
12882 @smallexample
12883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12884
12885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12886
12887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12888 @end smallexample
12889
12890 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12891 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12892 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12893 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12894 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12895 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12896 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12897 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12898
12899 @smallexample
12900 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12901 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12902 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12903 > collect bar,baz
12904 > collect $regs
12905 > while-stepping 12
12906 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12907 > end
12908 end
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12912 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12913 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12914 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12915 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12916 special arguments are supported:
12917
12918 @table @code
12919 @item $regs
12920 Collect all registers.
12921
12922 @item $args
12923 Collect all function arguments.
12924
12925 @item $locals
12926 Collect all local variables.
12927
12928 @item $_ret
12929 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12930 of a backtrace.
12931
12932 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12933 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12934 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12935 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12936 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12937 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12938
12939 @item $_probe_argc
12940 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12941 tracepoint is located.
12942 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12943
12944 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12945 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12946 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12947 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12948
12949 @item $_sdata
12950 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12951 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12952 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12953 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12954 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12955 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12956 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12957 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12958 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12959
12960 @smallexample
12961 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12962 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12963 @end smallexample
12964
12965 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12966 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12967 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12968 @value{GDBN}.
12969 @end table
12970
12971 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12972 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12973 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12974
12975 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12976 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12977 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12978 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12979 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12980 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12981 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12982 @samp{mystr}.
12983
12984 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12985 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12986
12987 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12988 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12989 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12990 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12991 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12992 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12993 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12994 action were used.
12995
12996 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12997 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12998 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12999 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13000 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13001 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13002
13003 @smallexample
13004 > while-stepping 12
13005 > collect $regs, myglobal
13006 > end
13007 >
13008 @end smallexample
13009
13010 @noindent
13011 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13012 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13013 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13014 @code{stepping}.
13015
13016 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13017 @kindex set default-collect
13018 @cindex default collection action
13019 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13020 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13021 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13022 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13023 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13024 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13025
13026 @item show default-collect
13027 @kindex show default-collect
13028 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13029 tracepoint hit.
13030
13031 @end table
13032
13033 @node Listing Tracepoints
13034 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13035
13036 @table @code
13037 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13038 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13039 @cindex information about tracepoints
13040 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13041 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13042 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13043 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13044 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13045 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13046
13047 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13048 tracing:
13049
13050 @itemize @bullet
13051 @item
13052 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13053
13054 @item
13055 the state about installed on target of each location
13056 @end itemize
13057
13058 @smallexample
13059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13060 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13061 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13062 while-stepping 20
13063 collect globfoo, $regs
13064 end
13065 collect globfoo2
13066 end
13067 pass count 1200
13068 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13069 collect $eip
13070 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13071 installed on target
13072 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13073 installed on target
13074 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13075 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13076 not installed on target
13077 (@value{GDBP})
13078 @end smallexample
13079
13080 @noindent
13081 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13082 @end table
13083
13084 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13085 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13086
13087 @table @code
13088 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13089 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13090 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13091 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13092 program.
13093
13094 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13095
13096 @table @emph
13097 @item Count
13098 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13099 stable identifier.
13100 @item ID
13101 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13102 @item Enabled or Disabled
13103 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13104 that are not enabled.
13105 @item Address
13106 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13107 @item What
13108 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13109 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13110 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13111 will be left blank.
13112 @end table
13113
13114 @noindent
13115 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13116
13117 @table @emph
13118 @item Data
13119 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13120 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13121 marker call.
13122 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13123 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13124 @end table
13125
13126 @smallexample
13127 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13128 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13129 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13130 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13131 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13132 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13133 Data: str %s
13134 (@value{GDBP})
13135 @end smallexample
13136 @end table
13137
13138 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13139 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13140
13141 @table @code
13142 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13143 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13144 @cindex collected data discarded
13145 @item tstart
13146 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13147 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13148 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13149 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13150 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13151 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13152 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13153 information, and so forth.
13154
13155 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13156 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13157 @item tstop
13158 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13159 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13160 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13161 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13162 needs to be stopped quickly.
13163
13164 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13165 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13166 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13167
13168 @kindex tstatus
13169 @cindex status of trace data collection
13170 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13171 @item tstatus
13172 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13173 collection.
13174 @end table
13175
13176 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13177
13178 @smallexample
13179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13181 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13182 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13183 > while-stepping 11
13184 > collect $regs
13185 > end
13186 > end
13187 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13188 [time passes @dots{}]
13189 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13190 @end smallexample
13191
13192 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13193 @cindex disconnected tracing
13194 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13195 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13196 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13197 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13198 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13199 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13200 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13201 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13202
13203 @table @code
13204 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13205 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13206 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13207 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13208 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13209 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13210 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13211 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13212
13213 @item show disconnected-tracing
13214 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13215 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13216
13217 @end table
13218
13219 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13220 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13221 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13222 it will continue after reconnection.
13223
13224 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13225 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13226 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13227 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13228 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13229 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13230 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13231 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13232 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13233 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13234
13235 @cindex circular trace buffer
13236 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13237 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13238 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13239 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13240 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13241 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13242 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13243 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13244 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13245 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13246 the next run.
13247
13248 @table @code
13249 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13250 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13251 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13252 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13253 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13254 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13255 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13256
13257 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13258 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13259 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13260 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13261 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13262 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13263
13264 @end table
13265
13266 @table @code
13267 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13268 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13269 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13270 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13271 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13272 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13273 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13274 likes. This is also the default.
13275
13276 @item show trace-buffer-size
13277 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13278 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13279 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13280 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13281 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13282 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13283 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13284 @end table
13285
13286 @table @code
13287 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13288 @kindex set trace-user
13289
13290 @item show trace-user
13291 @kindex show trace-user
13292
13293 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13294 @kindex set trace-notes
13295 Set the trace run's notes.
13296
13297 @item show trace-notes
13298 @kindex show trace-notes
13299 Show the trace run's notes.
13300
13301 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13302 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13303 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13304 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13305 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13306
13307 @item show trace-stop-notes
13308 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13309 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13310
13311 @end table
13312
13313 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13314 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13315
13316 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13317 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13318 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13319 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13320 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13321 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13322 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13323 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13324 mentioned here.
13325
13326 @itemize @bullet
13327
13328 @item
13329 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13330 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13331 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13332 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13333 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13334 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13335 cannot be collected either.
13336
13337 @item
13338 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13339 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13340 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13341 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13342 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13343 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13344 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13345 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13346 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13347 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13348
13349 @item
13350 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13351 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13352 in a misleading way.
13353
13354 @item
13355 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13356 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13357 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13358 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13359 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13360 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13361 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13362 by @code{ptr}.
13363
13364 @item
13365 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13366 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13367 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13368 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13369 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13370 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13371 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13372 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13373 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13374 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13375 invalid address.
13376
13377 @item
13378 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13379 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13380 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13381 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13382 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13383 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13384 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13385 it to zero.
13386
13387 @end itemize
13388
13389 @node Analyze Collected Data
13390 @section Using the Collected Data
13391
13392 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13393 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13394 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13395 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13396 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13397 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13398 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13399 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13400 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13401 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13402 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13403 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13404 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13405 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13406 the buffer will fail.
13407
13408 @menu
13409 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13410 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13411 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13412 @end menu
13413
13414 @node tfind
13415 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13416
13417 @kindex tfind
13418 @cindex select trace snapshot
13419 @cindex find trace snapshot
13420 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13421 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13422 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13423 snapshot is selected.
13424
13425 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13426
13427 @table @code
13428 @item tfind start
13429 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13430 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13431
13432 @item tfind none
13433 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13434
13435 @item tfind end
13436 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13437
13438 @item tfind
13439 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13440 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13441
13442 @item tfind -
13443 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13444 retracing earlier steps.
13445
13446 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13447 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13448 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13449 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13450 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13451
13452 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13453 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13454 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13455 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13456 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13457
13458 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13459 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13460 addresses (exclusive).
13461
13462 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13463 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13464 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13465
13466 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13467 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13468 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13469 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13470 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13471 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13472 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13473 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13474 @end table
13475
13476 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13477 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13478 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13479 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13480 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13481 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13482 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13483 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13484 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13485 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13486 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13487 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13488 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13489 tracepoint as the current one.
13490
13491 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13492 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13493 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13494 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13495 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13496
13497 @smallexample
13498 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13499 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13500 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13501 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13502 > tfind
13503 > end
13504
13505 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13506 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13507 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13508 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13509 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13510 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13511 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13512 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13513 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13514 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13515 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13516 @end smallexample
13517
13518 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13519 the buffer:
13520
13521 @smallexample
13522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13523 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13524 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13525 > tfind line
13526 > end
13527
13528 Frame 0, X = 1
13529 Frame 7, X = 2
13530 Frame 13, X = 255
13531 @end smallexample
13532
13533 @node tdump
13534 @subsection @code{tdump}
13535 @kindex tdump
13536 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13537 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13538
13539 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13540 the current trace snapshot.
13541
13542 @smallexample
13543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13545 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13546 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13547 > end
13548
13549 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13550
13551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13552 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13553 at gdb_test.c:444
13554 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13555
13556 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13557 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13558 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13559 d1 0x18 24
13560 d2 0x80 128
13561 d3 0x33 51
13562 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13563 d5 0x22 34
13564 d6 0xe0 224
13565 d7 0x380035 3670069
13566 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13567 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13568 a2 0x100 256
13569 a3 0x322000 3284992
13570 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13571 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13572 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13573 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13574 ps 0x0 0
13575 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13576 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13577 fpstatus 0x0 0
13578 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13579 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13580 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13581 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13582 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13583 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13584 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13585 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13586 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13587
13588 (@value{GDBP})
13589 @end smallexample
13590
13591 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13592 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13593 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13594 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13595
13596 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13597 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13598 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13599 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13600 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13601 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13602 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13603 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13604 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13605 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13606
13607 @node save tracepoints
13608 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13609 @kindex save tracepoints
13610 @kindex save-tracepoints
13611 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13612
13613 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13614 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13615 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13616 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13617 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13618 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13619
13620 @node Tracepoint Variables
13621 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13622 @cindex tracepoint variables
13623 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13624
13625 @table @code
13626 @vindex $trace_frame
13627 @item (int) $trace_frame
13628 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13629 snapshot is selected.
13630
13631 @vindex $tracepoint
13632 @item (int) $tracepoint
13633 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13634
13635 @vindex $trace_line
13636 @item (int) $trace_line
13637 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13638
13639 @vindex $trace_file
13640 @item (char []) $trace_file
13641 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13642
13643 @vindex $trace_func
13644 @item (char []) $trace_func
13645 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13646 @end table
13647
13648 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13649 use @code{output} instead.
13650
13651 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13652 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13653 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13654 which are managed by the target.
13655
13656 @smallexample
13657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13658
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13660 > output $trace_file
13661 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13662 > tfind
13663 > end
13664 @end smallexample
13665
13666 @node Trace Files
13667 @section Using Trace Files
13668 @cindex trace files
13669
13670 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13671 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13672 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13673 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13674 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13675
13676 @table @code
13677
13678 @kindex tsave
13679 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13680 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13681 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13682 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13683 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13684 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13685 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13686 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13687 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13688 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13689 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13690 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13691 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13692 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13693 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13694
13695 @kindex target tfile
13696 @kindex tfile
13697 @kindex target ctf
13698 @kindex ctf
13699 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13700 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13701 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13702 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13703 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13704 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13705 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13706 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13707 the host.
13708
13709 @smallexample
13710 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13711 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13712 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13713 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13714 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13715 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13716 i = 0
13717 a = 0
13718 b = 1 '\001'
13719 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13720 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13721 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13722 $1 = 1
13723 @end smallexample
13724
13725 @end table
13726
13727 @node Overlays
13728 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13729 @cindex overlays
13730
13731 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13732 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13733 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13734 use overlays.
13735
13736 @menu
13737 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13738 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13739 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13740 mapped by asking the inferior.
13741 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13742 @end menu
13743
13744 @node How Overlays Work
13745 @section How Overlays Work
13746 @cindex mapped overlays
13747 @cindex unmapped overlays
13748 @cindex load address, overlay's
13749 @cindex mapped address
13750 @cindex overlay area
13751
13752 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13753 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13754 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13755 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13756 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13757
13758 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13759 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13760 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13761 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13762 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13763 largest overlay as well.
13764
13765 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13766 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13767 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13768 there.
13769
13770 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13771 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13772 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13773
13774 @smallexample
13775 @group
13776 Data Instruction Larger
13777 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13778 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13779 | | | | | |
13780 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13781 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13782 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13783 | and heap | | | | | |
13784 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13785 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13786 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13787 | | | | | |
13788 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13789 address | | | | | |
13790 | overlay | <-' | | |
13791 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13792 | | <---. | | load address
13793 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13794 | | | |
13795 +-----------+ | |
13796 +-----------+
13797 | |
13798 +-----------+
13799
13800 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13801 @end group
13802 @end smallexample
13803
13804 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13805 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13806 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13807 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13808 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13809 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13810 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13811 program and the overlay area.
13812
13813 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13814 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13815 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13816 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13817 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13818 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13819 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13820
13821 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13822 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13823 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13824
13825 @itemize @bullet
13826
13827 @item
13828 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13829 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13830 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13831 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13832
13833 @item
13834 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13835 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13836 your program's performance.
13837
13838 @item
13839 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13840 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13841 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13842 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13843 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13844 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13845 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13846
13847 @item
13848 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13849 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13850 instruction and data spaces.
13851
13852 @end itemize
13853
13854 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13855 improved in many ways:
13856
13857 @itemize @bullet
13858
13859 @item
13860 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13861 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13862 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13863 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13864 area in the usual way.
13865
13866 @item
13867 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13868 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13869
13870 @item
13871 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13872 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13873 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13874 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13875 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13876 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13877 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13878
13879 @end itemize
13880
13881
13882 @node Overlay Commands
13883 @section Overlay Commands
13884
13885 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13886 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13887 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13888 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13889 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13890 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13891
13892 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13893 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13894
13895 @table @code
13896 @item overlay off
13897 @kindex overlay
13898 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13899 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13900 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13901 overlay support is disabled.
13902
13903 @item overlay manual
13904 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13905 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13906 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13907 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13908 commands described below.
13909
13910 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13911 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13912 @cindex map an overlay
13913 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13914 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13915 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13916 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13917 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13918 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13919
13920 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13921 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13922 @cindex unmap an overlay
13923 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13924 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13925 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13926 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13927
13928 @item overlay auto
13929 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13930 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13931 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13932 Overlay Debugging}.
13933
13934 @item overlay load-target
13935 @itemx overlay load
13936 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13937 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13938 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13939 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13940 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13941 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13942
13943 @item overlay list-overlays
13944 @itemx overlay list
13945 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13946 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13947 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13948
13949 @end table
13950
13951 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13952 of the function the address falls in:
13953
13954 @smallexample
13955 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13956 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13957 @end smallexample
13958 @noindent
13959 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13960 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13961 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13962 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13963
13964 @smallexample
13965 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13966 No sections are mapped.
13967 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13968 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13969 @end smallexample
13970 @noindent
13971 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13972 name normally:
13973
13974 @smallexample
13975 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13976 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13977 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13978 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13979 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13980 @end smallexample
13981
13982 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13983 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13984 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13985 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13986 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13987
13988 @itemize @bullet
13989 @item
13990 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13991 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13992 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13993 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13994 @item
13995 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13996 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13997 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13998 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13999 breakpoints properly.
14000 @end itemize
14001
14002
14003 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14004 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14005 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14006
14007 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14008 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14009 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14010 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14011 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14012 current state of the overlays.
14013
14014 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14015 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14016
14017 @table @asis
14018
14019 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14020 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 struct
14024 @{
14025 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14026 unsigned long vma;
14027
14028 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14029 unsigned long size;
14030
14031 /* The overlay's load address. */
14032 unsigned long lma;
14033
14034 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14035 zero otherwise. */
14036 unsigned long mapped;
14037 @}
14038 @end smallexample
14039
14040 @item @code{_novlys}:
14041 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14042 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14043
14044 @end table
14045
14046 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14047 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14048 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14049 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14050 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14051 currently mapped.
14052
14053 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14054 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14055 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14056 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14057 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14058 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14059 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14060 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14061 are not being executed.
14062
14063 @node Overlay Sample Program
14064 @section Overlay Sample Program
14065 @cindex overlay example program
14066
14067 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14068 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14069 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14070 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14071 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14072 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14073 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14074
14075 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14076 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14077 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14078 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14079
14080 @table @file
14081 @item overlays.c
14082 The main program file.
14083 @item ovlymgr.c
14084 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14085 @item foo.c
14086 @itemx bar.c
14087 @itemx baz.c
14088 @itemx grbx.c
14089 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14090 @item d10v.ld
14091 @itemx m32r.ld
14092 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14093 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14094 @end table
14095
14096 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14097 cross-compiler like this:
14098
14099 @smallexample
14100 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14101 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14102 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14103 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14104 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14105 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14106 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14107 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14108 @end smallexample
14109
14110 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14111 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14112 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14113
14114
14115 @node Languages
14116 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14117 @cindex languages
14118
14119 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14120 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14121 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14122 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14123 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14124 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14125
14126 @cindex working language
14127 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14128 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14129 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14130 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14131 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14132 language}.
14133
14134 @menu
14135 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14136 * Show:: Displaying the language
14137 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14138 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14139 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14140 @end menu
14141
14142 @node Setting
14143 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14144
14145 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14146 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14147 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14148 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14149 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14150 are printed, etc.
14151
14152 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14153 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14154 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14155 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14156 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14157 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14158 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14159 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14160 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14161 Displaying the Language}.
14162
14163 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14164 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14165 another language. In that case, make the
14166 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14167 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14168 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14169
14170 @menu
14171 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14172 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14173 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14174 @end menu
14175
14176 @node Filenames
14177 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14178
14179 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14180 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14181
14182 @table @file
14183 @item .ada
14184 @itemx .ads
14185 @itemx .adb
14186 @itemx .a
14187 Ada source file.
14188
14189 @item .c
14190 C source file
14191
14192 @item .C
14193 @itemx .cc
14194 @itemx .cp
14195 @itemx .cpp
14196 @itemx .cxx
14197 @itemx .c++
14198 C@t{++} source file
14199
14200 @item .d
14201 D source file
14202
14203 @item .m
14204 Objective-C source file
14205
14206 @item .f
14207 @itemx .F
14208 Fortran source file
14209
14210 @item .mod
14211 Modula-2 source file
14212
14213 @item .s
14214 @itemx .S
14215 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14216 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14217 @end table
14218
14219 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14220 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14221
14222 @node Manually
14223 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14224
14225 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14226 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14227 your program.
14228
14229 @kindex set language
14230 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14231 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14232 a language, such as
14233 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14234 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14235
14236 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14237 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14238 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14239 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14240 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14241 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14242 command such as:
14243
14244 @smallexample
14245 print a = b + c
14246 @end smallexample
14247
14248 @noindent
14249 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14250 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14251 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14252 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14253
14254 @node Automatically
14255 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14256
14257 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14258 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14259 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14260 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14261 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14262 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14263 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14264 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14265 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14266
14267 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14268 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14269 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14270 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14271 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14272
14273 @node Show
14274 @section Displaying the Language
14275
14276 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14277 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14278
14279 @table @code
14280 @item show language
14281 @anchor{show language}
14282 @kindex show language
14283 Display the current working language. This is the
14284 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14285 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14286
14287 @item info frame
14288 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14289 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14290 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14291 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14292 information listed here.
14293
14294 @item info source
14295 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14296 Display the source language of this source file.
14297 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14298 information listed here.
14299 @end table
14300
14301 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14302 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14303 with a language explicitly:
14304
14305 @table @code
14306 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14307 @kindex set extension-language
14308 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14309 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14310
14311 @item info extensions
14312 @kindex info extensions
14313 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14314 @end table
14315
14316 @node Checks
14317 @section Type and Range Checking
14318
14319 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14320 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14321 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14322 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14323 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14324 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14325 errors when your program is running.
14326
14327 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14328 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14329 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14330 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14331
14332 @menu
14333 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14334 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14335 @end menu
14336
14337 @cindex type checking
14338 @cindex checks, type
14339 @node Type Checking
14340 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14341
14342 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14343 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14344 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14345 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14346
14347 @smallexample
14348 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14349
14350 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14351 $1 = 2
14352 @exdent but
14353 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14354 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14355 @end smallexample
14356
14357 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14358 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14359
14360 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14361 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14362 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14363 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14364 expressions like the second example above.
14365
14366 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14367 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14368 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14369 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14370 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14371 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14372
14373 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14374
14375 @kindex set check type
14376 @kindex show check type
14377 @table @code
14378 @item set check type on
14379 @itemx set check type off
14380 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14381 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14382 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14383
14384 @item show check type
14385 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14386 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14387 @end table
14388
14389 @cindex range checking
14390 @cindex checks, range
14391 @node Range Checking
14392 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14393
14394 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14395 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14396 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14397 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14398 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14399
14400 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14401 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14402 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14403 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14404
14405 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14406 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14407 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14408 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14409 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14410 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14411
14412 @smallexample
14413 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14414 @end smallexample
14415
14416 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14417 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14418 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14419
14420 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14421
14422 @kindex set check range
14423 @kindex show check range
14424 @table @code
14425 @item set check range auto
14426 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14427 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14428 each language.
14429
14430 @item set check range on
14431 @itemx set check range off
14432 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14433 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14434 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14435 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14436
14437 @item set check range warn
14438 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14439 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14440 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14441 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14442 systems).
14443
14444 @item show range
14445 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14446 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14447 @end table
14448
14449 @node Supported Languages
14450 @section Supported Languages
14451
14452 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14453 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14454 @c This is false ...
14455 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14456 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14457 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14458 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14459 language.
14460
14461 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14462 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14463 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14464 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14465 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14466 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14467 language reference or tutorial.
14468
14469 @menu
14470 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14471 * D:: D
14472 * Go:: Go
14473 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14474 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14475 * Fortran:: Fortran
14476 * Pascal:: Pascal
14477 * Rust:: Rust
14478 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14479 * Ada:: Ada
14480 @end menu
14481
14482 @node C
14483 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14484
14485 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14486 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14487
14488 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14489 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14490 together.
14491
14492 @cindex C@t{++}
14493 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14494 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14495 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14496 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14497 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14498 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14499 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14500
14501 @menu
14502 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14503 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14504 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14505 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14506 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14507 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14508 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14509 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14510 @end menu
14511
14512 @node C Operators
14513 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14514
14515 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14516
14517 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14518 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14519 often defined on groups of types.
14520
14521 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14522
14523 @itemize @bullet
14524
14525 @item
14526 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14527 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14528
14529 @item
14530 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14531 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14532
14533 @item
14534 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14535
14536 @item
14537 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14538
14539 @end itemize
14540
14541 @noindent
14542 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14543 in order of increasing precedence:
14544
14545 @table @code
14546 @item ,
14547 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14548 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14549 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14550
14551 @item =
14552 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14553 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14554
14555 @item @var{op}=
14556 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14557 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14558 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14559 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14560 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14561
14562 @item ?:
14563 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14564 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14565 should be of an integral type.
14566
14567 @item ||
14568 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14569
14570 @item &&
14571 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14572
14573 @item |
14574 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14575
14576 @item ^
14577 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14578
14579 @item &
14580 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14581
14582 @item ==@r{, }!=
14583 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14584 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14585
14586 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14587 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14588 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14589 and non-zero for true.
14590
14591 @item <<@r{, }>>
14592 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14593
14594 @item @@
14595 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14596
14597 @item +@r{, }-
14598 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14599 pointer types.
14600
14601 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14602 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14603 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14604 integral types.
14605
14606 @item ++@r{, }--
14607 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14608 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14609 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14610 operation takes place.
14611
14612 @item *
14613 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14614 @code{++}.
14615
14616 @item &
14617 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14618
14619 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14620 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14621 to examine the address
14622 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14623 stored.
14624
14625 @item -
14626 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14627 precedence as @code{++}.
14628
14629 @item !
14630 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14631 @code{++}.
14632
14633 @item ~
14634 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14635 @code{++}.
14636
14637
14638 @item .@r{, }->
14639 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14640 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14641 pointer based on the stored type information.
14642 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14643
14644 @item .*@r{, }->*
14645 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14646
14647 @item []
14648 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14649 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14650
14651 @item ()
14652 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14653
14654 @item ::
14655 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14656 and @code{class} types.
14657
14658 @item ::
14659 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14660 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14661 above.
14662 @end table
14663
14664 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14665 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14666 predefined meaning.
14667
14668 @node C Constants
14669 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14670
14671 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14672
14673 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14674 following ways:
14675
14676 @itemize @bullet
14677 @item
14678 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14679 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14680 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14681 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14682 @code{long} value.
14683
14684 @item
14685 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14686 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14687 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14688 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14689 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14690 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14691 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14692 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14693 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14694 constant.
14695
14696 @item
14697 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14698 integral equivalents.
14699
14700 @item
14701 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14702 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14703 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14704 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14705 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14706 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14707 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14708 @samp{\n} for newline.
14709
14710 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14711 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14712 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14713 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14714
14715 @item
14716 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14717 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14718 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14719 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14720 characters.
14721
14722 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14723 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14724 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14725
14726 @item
14727 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14728 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14729
14730 @item
14731 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14732 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14733 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14734 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14735 @end itemize
14736
14737 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14738 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14739
14740 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14741 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14742
14743 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14744 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14745 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14746 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14747 @quotation
14748 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14749 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14750 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14751 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14752 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14753 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14754 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14755 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14756 @end quotation
14757
14758 @enumerate
14759
14760 @cindex member functions
14761 @item
14762 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14763
14764 @smallexample
14765 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14766 @end smallexample
14767
14768 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14769 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14770 @item
14771 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14772 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14773 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14774 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14775 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14776
14777 @cindex call overloaded functions
14778 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14779 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14780 @item
14781 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14782 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14783 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14784 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14785 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14786 default arguments.
14787
14788 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14789 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14790 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14791 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14792 number of function arguments.
14793
14794 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14795 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14796 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14797
14798 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14799 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14800 @smallexample
14801 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14802 @end smallexample
14803
14804 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14805 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14806
14807 @cindex reference declarations
14808 @item
14809 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14810 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14811 dereferenced.
14812
14813 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14814 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14815 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14816 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14817 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14818
14819 @item
14820 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14821 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14822 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14823 necessary, for example in an expression like
14824 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14825 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14826 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14827
14828 @item
14829 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14830 specification.
14831 @end enumerate
14832
14833 @node C Defaults
14834 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14835
14836 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14837
14838 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14839 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14840 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14841 selects the working language.
14842
14843 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14844 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14845 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14846 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14847 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14848 for further details.
14849
14850 @node C Checks
14851 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14852
14853 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14854
14855 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14856 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14857 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14858 constants to pointers.
14859
14860 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14861 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14862 that is not itself an array.
14863
14864 @node Debugging C
14865 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14866
14867 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14868 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14869 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14870 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14871
14872 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14873 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14874 ,Expressions}.
14875
14876 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14877 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14878
14879 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14880
14881 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14882 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14883
14884 @table @code
14885 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14886 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14887 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14888 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14889 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14890 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14891
14892 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14893 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14894 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14895 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14896 classes.
14897 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14898
14899 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14900 @item catch throw
14901 @itemx catch rethrow
14902 @itemx catch catch
14903 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14904 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14905
14906 @cindex inheritance
14907 @item ptype @var{typename}
14908 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14909 @var{typename}.
14910 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14911
14912 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14913 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14914 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14915 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14916 multiple inheritance is in use.
14917
14918 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14919 @item demangle @var{name}
14920 Demangle @var{name}.
14921 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14922
14923 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14924 @item set print demangle
14925 @itemx show print demangle
14926 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14927 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14928 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14929 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14930 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14931
14932 @item set print object
14933 @itemx show print object
14934 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14935 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14936
14937 @item set print vtbl
14938 @itemx show print vtbl
14939 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14940 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14941 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14942 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14943
14944 @kindex set overload-resolution
14945 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14946 @item set overload-resolution on
14947 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14948 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14949 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14950 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14951 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14952 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14953
14954 @item set overload-resolution off
14955 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14956 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14957 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14958 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14959 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14960 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14961 argument types.
14962
14963 @kindex show overload-resolution
14964 @item show overload-resolution
14965 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14966
14967 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14968 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14969 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14970 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14971 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14972 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14973 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14974 @end table
14975
14976 @node Decimal Floating Point
14977 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14978 @cindex decimal floating point format
14979
14980 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14981 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14982 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14983 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14984
14985 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14986 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14987 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14988 configured target.
14989
14990 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14991 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14992 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14993
14994 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14995 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14996 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14997
14998 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14999 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15000 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15001
15002 @node D
15003 @subsection D
15004
15005 @cindex D
15006 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15007 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15008 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15009
15010 @node Go
15011 @subsection Go
15012
15013 @cindex Go (programming language)
15014 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15015 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15016
15017 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15018
15019 @table @code
15020 @cindex current Go package
15021 @item The current Go package
15022 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15023 specifying global variables and functions.
15024
15025 For example, given the program:
15026
15027 @example
15028 package main
15029 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15030 func main () @{
15031 // ...
15032 @}
15033 @end example
15034
15035 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15036
15037 @example
15038 (gdb) p myglob
15039 (gdb) p main.myglob
15040 @end example
15041
15042 @cindex builtin Go types
15043 @item Builtin Go types
15044 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15045 as a string.
15046
15047 @cindex builtin Go functions
15048 @item Builtin Go functions
15049 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15050 function and handles it internally.
15051
15052 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15053 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15054 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15055 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15056 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15057 @end table
15058
15059 @node Objective-C
15060 @subsection Objective-C
15061
15062 @cindex Objective-C
15063 This section provides information about some commands and command
15064 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15065 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15066 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15067
15068 @menu
15069 * Method Names in Commands::
15070 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15071 @end menu
15072
15073 @node Method Names in Commands
15074 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15075
15076 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15077 names as line specifications:
15078
15079 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15080 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15081 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15082 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15083 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15084 @itemize
15085 @item @code{clear}
15086 @item @code{break}
15087 @item @code{info line}
15088 @item @code{jump}
15089 @item @code{list}
15090 @end itemize
15091
15092 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15093
15094 @smallexample
15095 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15096 @end smallexample
15097
15098 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15099 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15100 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15101 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15102 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15103 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15104 debugged, enter:
15105
15106 @smallexample
15107 break -[Fruit create]
15108 @end smallexample
15109
15110 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15111 enter:
15112
15113 @smallexample
15114 list +[NSText initialize]
15115 @end smallexample
15116
15117 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15118 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15119 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15120 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15121
15122 @smallexample
15123 break create
15124 @end smallexample
15125
15126 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15127 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15128 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15129 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15130 none apply.
15131
15132 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15133 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15134
15135 @smallexample
15136 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15140 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15141 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15142 @kindex print-object
15143 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15144
15145 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15146
15147 @smallexample
15148 print -[@var{object} hash]
15149 @end smallexample
15150
15151 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15152 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15153 @noindent
15154 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15155 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15156 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15157 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15158 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15159 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15160
15161 @node OpenCL C
15162 @subsection OpenCL C
15163
15164 @cindex OpenCL C
15165 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15166
15167 @menu
15168 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15169 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15170 * OpenCL C Operators::
15171 @end menu
15172
15173 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15174 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15175
15176 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15177 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15178 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15179 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15180 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15181
15182 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15183 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15184
15185 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15186 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15187 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15188 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15189
15190 @node OpenCL C Operators
15191 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15192
15193 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15194 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15195 vector data types.
15196
15197 @node Fortran
15198 @subsection Fortran
15199 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15200
15201 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15202 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15203
15204 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15205 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15206 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15207 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15208 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15209 underscore.
15210
15211 @menu
15212 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15213 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15214 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15215 @end menu
15216
15217 @node Fortran Operators
15218 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15219
15220 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15221
15222 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15223 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15224 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15225
15226 @table @code
15227 @item **
15228 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15229 of the second one.
15230
15231 @item :
15232 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15233 represent a section of array.
15234
15235 @item %
15236 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15237 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15238 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15239 union type.
15240 @end table
15241
15242 @node Fortran Defaults
15243 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15244
15245 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15246
15247 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15248 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15249 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15250 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15251
15252 @node Special Fortran Commands
15253 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15254
15255 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15256
15257 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15258 such as displaying common blocks.
15259
15260 @table @code
15261 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15262 @kindex info common
15263 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15264 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15265 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15266 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15267 printed.
15268 @end table
15269
15270 @node Pascal
15271 @subsection Pascal
15272
15273 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15274 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15275 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15276 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15277 syntax.
15278
15279 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15280 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15281 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15282
15283 @node Rust
15284 @subsection Rust
15285
15286 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15287 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15288 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15289 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15290
15291 @itemize @bullet
15292 @item
15293 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15294 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15295 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15296
15297 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15298 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15299 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15300 @samp{B}.
15301
15302 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15303 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15304
15305 @item
15306 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15307 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15308 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15309 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15310 @samp{K::x::y}.
15311
15312 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15313 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15314 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15315 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15316 scope.
15317
15318 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15319 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15320
15321 @item
15322 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15323 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15324
15325 @item
15326 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15327
15328 @item
15329 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15330 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15331 never be destroyed.
15332
15333 @item
15334 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15335 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15336 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15337
15338 @item
15339 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15340 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15341 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15342 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15343 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15344 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15345 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15346 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15347
15348 @item
15349 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15350 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15351 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15352 @itemize @bullet
15353
15354 @item
15355 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15356
15357 @item
15358 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15359
15360 @item
15361 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15362
15363 @item
15364 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15365 type names.
15366
15367 @item
15368 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15369
15370 @item
15371 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15372 available in the crate.
15373 @end itemize
15374 @end itemize
15375
15376 @node Modula-2
15377 @subsection Modula-2
15378
15379 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15380
15381 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15382 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15383 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15384 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15385 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15386 table.
15387
15388 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15389 @menu
15390 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15391 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15392 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15393 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15394 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15395 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15396 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15397 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15398 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15399 @end menu
15400
15401 @node M2 Operators
15402 @subsubsection Operators
15403 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15404
15405 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15406 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15407 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15408 following definitions hold:
15409
15410 @itemize @bullet
15411
15412 @item
15413 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15414 their subranges.
15415
15416 @item
15417 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15418
15419 @item
15420 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15421
15422 @item
15423 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15424 @var{type}}.
15425
15426 @item
15427 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15428
15429 @item
15430 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15431
15432 @item
15433 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15434 @end itemize
15435
15436 @noindent
15437 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15438 increasing precedence:
15439
15440 @table @code
15441 @item ,
15442 Function argument or array index separator.
15443
15444 @item :=
15445 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15446 @var{value}.
15447
15448 @item <@r{, }>
15449 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15450 types.
15451
15452 @item <=@r{, }>=
15453 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15454 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15455 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15456
15457 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15458 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15459 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15460 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15461 comment character.
15462
15463 @item IN
15464 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15465 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15466
15467 @item OR
15468 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15469
15470 @item AND@r{, }&
15471 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15472
15473 @item @@
15474 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15475
15476 @item +@r{, }-
15477 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15478 and difference on set types.
15479
15480 @item *
15481 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15482 on set types.
15483
15484 @item /
15485 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15486 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15487
15488 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15489 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15490 precedence as @code{*}.
15491
15492 @item -
15493 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15494
15495 @item ^
15496 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15497
15498 @item NOT
15499 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15500 @code{^}.
15501
15502 @item .
15503 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15504 precedence as @code{^}.
15505
15506 @item []
15507 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15508
15509 @item ()
15510 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15511 as @code{^}.
15512
15513 @item ::@r{, }.
15514 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15515 @end table
15516
15517 @quotation
15518 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15519 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15520 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15521 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15522 @end quotation
15523
15524
15525 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15526 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15527 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15528
15529 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15530 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15531
15532 @table @var
15533
15534 @item a
15535 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15536
15537 @item c
15538 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15539
15540 @item i
15541 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15542
15543 @item m
15544 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15545 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15546 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15547
15548 @item n
15549 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15550
15551 @item r
15552 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15553
15554 @item t
15555 represents a type.
15556
15557 @item v
15558 represents a variable.
15559
15560 @item x
15561 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15562 explanation of the function for details.
15563 @end table
15564
15565 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15566
15567 @table @code
15568 @item ABS(@var{n})
15569 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15570
15571 @item CAP(@var{c})
15572 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15573 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15574
15575 @item CHR(@var{i})
15576 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15577
15578 @item DEC(@var{v})
15579 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15580
15581 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15582 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15583 new value.
15584
15585 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15586 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15587 set.
15588
15589 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15590 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15591
15592 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15593 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15594
15595 @item INC(@var{v})
15596 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15597
15598 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15599 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15600 new value.
15601
15602 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15603 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15604 there. Returns the new set.
15605
15606 @item MAX(@var{t})
15607 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15608
15609 @item MIN(@var{t})
15610 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15611
15612 @item ODD(@var{i})
15613 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15614
15615 @item ORD(@var{x})
15616 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15617 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15618 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15619 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15620
15621 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15622 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15623 variable or a type.
15624
15625 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15626 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15627
15628 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15629 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15630 variable or a type.
15631
15632 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15633 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15634 @end table
15635
15636 @quotation
15637 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15638 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15639 an error.
15640 @end quotation
15641
15642 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15643 @node M2 Constants
15644 @subsubsection Constants
15645
15646 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15647 ways:
15648
15649 @itemize @bullet
15650
15651 @item
15652 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15653 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15654 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15655 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15656
15657 @item
15658 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15659 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15660 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15661 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15662 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15663 digits.
15664
15665 @item
15666 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15667 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15668 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15669 followed by a @samp{C}.
15670
15671 @item
15672 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15673 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15674 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15675 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15676 sequences.
15677
15678 @item
15679 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15680
15681 @item
15682 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15683 @code{FALSE}.
15684
15685 @item
15686 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15687
15688 @item
15689 Set constants are not yet supported.
15690 @end itemize
15691
15692 @node M2 Types
15693 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15694 @cindex Modula-2 types
15695
15696 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15697 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15698 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15699 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15700 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15701 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15702
15703 The first example contains the following section of code:
15704
15705 @smallexample
15706 VAR
15707 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15708 r: [20..40] ;
15709 @end smallexample
15710
15711 @noindent
15712 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15713 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15714
15715 @smallexample
15716 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15717 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15718 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15719 SET OF CHAR
15720 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15721 21
15722 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15723 [20..40]
15724 @end smallexample
15725
15726 @noindent
15727 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15728
15729 @smallexample
15730 VAR
15731 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15732 @end smallexample
15733
15734 @noindent
15735 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15736
15737 @smallexample
15738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15739 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15740 @end smallexample
15741
15742 @noindent
15743 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15744 expressions using the debugger.
15745
15746 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15747 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15748
15749 @smallexample
15750 VAR
15751 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15752 @end smallexample
15753
15754 @smallexample
15755 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15756 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15757 @end smallexample
15758
15759 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15760 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15761 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15762 above.
15763
15764 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15765
15766 @smallexample
15767 TYPE
15768 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15769 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15770 VAR
15771 s: t ;
15772 BEGIN
15773 s := blue ;
15774 @end smallexample
15775
15776 @noindent
15777 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15778 and value of a variable.
15779
15780 @smallexample
15781 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15782 $1 = blue
15783 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15784 type = [blue..yellow]
15785 @end smallexample
15786
15787 @noindent
15788 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15789 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15790 their @code{C} counterparts.
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793 VAR
15794 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15795 BEGIN
15796 s[1] := 1 ;
15797 @end smallexample
15798
15799 @smallexample
15800 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15801 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15802 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15803 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15804 @end smallexample
15805
15806 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15807 pointer types as shown in this example:
15808
15809 @smallexample
15810 VAR
15811 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15812 BEGIN
15813 NEW(s) ;
15814 s^[1] := 1 ;
15815 @end smallexample
15816
15817 @noindent
15818 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15819
15820 @smallexample
15821 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15822 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15823 @end smallexample
15824
15825 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15826 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15827 types:
15828
15829 @smallexample
15830 TYPE
15831 foo = RECORD
15832 f1: CARDINAL ;
15833 f2: CHAR ;
15834 f3: myarray ;
15835 END ;
15836
15837 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15838 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15839 VAR
15840 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15841 @end smallexample
15842
15843 @noindent
15844 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15845 below.
15846
15847 @smallexample
15848 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15849 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15850 f1 : CARDINAL;
15851 f2 : CHAR;
15852 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15853 END
15854 @end smallexample
15855
15856 @node M2 Defaults
15857 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15858 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15859
15860 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15861 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15862 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15863 selected the working language.
15864
15865 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15866 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15867 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15868 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15869
15870 @node Deviations
15871 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15872 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15873
15874 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15875 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15876
15877 @itemize @bullet
15878 @item
15879 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15880 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15881 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15882 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15883 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15884 returned a pointer.)
15885
15886 @item
15887 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15888 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15889 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15890 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15891
15892 @item
15893 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15894 argument.
15895
15896 @item
15897 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15898 @end itemize
15899
15900 @node M2 Checks
15901 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15902 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15903
15904 @quotation
15905 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15906 range checking.
15907 @end quotation
15908 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15909
15910 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15911
15912 @itemize @bullet
15913 @item
15914 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15915 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15916
15917 @item
15918 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15919 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15920 @end itemize
15921
15922 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15923 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15924
15925 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15926 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15927
15928 @node M2 Scope
15929 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15930 @cindex scope
15931 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15932 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15933 @ifinfo
15934 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15935 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15936 @end ifinfo
15937 @ifnotinfo
15938 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15939 @end ifnotinfo
15940
15941 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15942 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15943 similar syntax:
15944
15945 @smallexample
15946
15947 @var{module} . @var{id}
15948 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15949 @end smallexample
15950
15951 @noindent
15952 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15953 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15954 identifier within your program, except another module.
15955
15956 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15957 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15958 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15959 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15960
15961 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15962 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15963 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15964 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15965 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15966 @var{module}.
15967
15968 @node GDB/M2
15969 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15970
15971 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15972 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15973 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15974 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15975 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15976 analogue in Modula-2.
15977
15978 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15979 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15980 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15981 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15982 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15983 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15984
15985 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15986 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15987 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15988
15989 @node Ada
15990 @subsection Ada
15991 @cindex Ada
15992
15993 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15994 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15995 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15996 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15997 to be difficult.
15998
15999
16000 @cindex expressions in Ada
16001 @menu
16002 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16003 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16004 in @value{GDBN}.
16005 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16006 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16007 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16008 subprograms.
16009 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16010 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16011 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16012 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16013 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16014 Profile
16015 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16016 @end menu
16017
16018 @node Ada Mode Intro
16019 @subsubsection Introduction
16020 @cindex Ada mode, general
16021
16022 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16023 syntax, with some extensions.
16024 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16025
16026 @itemize @bullet
16027 @item
16028 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16029 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16030 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16031 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16032
16033 @item
16034 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16035 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16036
16037 @item
16038 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16039 @end itemize
16040
16041 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16042 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16043 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16044 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16045 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16046
16047 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16048 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16049 was translated from an Ada source file.
16050
16051 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16052 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16053 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16054 middle (to allow based literals).
16055
16056 @node Omissions from Ada
16057 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16058 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16059
16060 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16061
16062 @itemize @bullet
16063 @item
16064 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16065
16066 @itemize @minus
16067 @item
16068 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16069 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16070
16071 @item
16072 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16073
16074 @item
16075 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16076
16077 @item
16078 @t{'Tag}.
16079
16080 @item
16081 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16082 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16083
16084 @item
16085 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16086 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16087
16088 @item
16089 @t{'Address}.
16090 @end itemize
16091
16092 @item
16093 The names in
16094 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16095 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16096 not currently available.
16097
16098 @item
16099 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16100 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16101 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16102 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16103 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16104 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16105 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16106 indeterminate values.
16107
16108 @item
16109 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16110 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16111 are not implemented.
16112
16113 @item
16114 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16115 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16116 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16117 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16118 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16119
16120 @smallexample
16121 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16122 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16123 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16124 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16125 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16126 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16127 @end smallexample
16128
16129 Changing a
16130 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16131 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16132 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16133 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16134 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16135 declared to have a type such as:
16136
16137 @smallexample
16138 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16139 Id : Integer;
16140 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16141 end record;
16142 @end smallexample
16143
16144 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16145 assignments:
16146
16147 @smallexample
16148 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16149 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16150 @end smallexample
16151
16152 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16153 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16154 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16155 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16156 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16157 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16158 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16159 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16160
16161 @item
16162 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16163
16164 @item
16165 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16166 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16167 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16168 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16169 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16170 the proper resolution.
16171
16172 @item
16173 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16174
16175 @item
16176 Entry calls are not implemented.
16177
16178 @item
16179 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16180 formats are not supported.
16181
16182 @item
16183 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16184
16185 @item
16186 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16187 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16188 context.
16189 Should your program
16190 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16191 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16192 @end itemize
16193
16194 @node Additions to Ada
16195 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16196 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16197
16198 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16199 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16200
16201 @itemize @bullet
16202 @item
16203 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16204 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16205 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16206 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16207 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16208 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16209 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16210 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16211
16212 @item
16213 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16214 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16215 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16216
16217 @item
16218 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16219 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16220
16221 @item
16222 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16223 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16224 @end itemize
16225
16226 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16227 additions specific to Ada:
16228
16229 @itemize @bullet
16230 @item
16231 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16232 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16236 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16237 @end smallexample
16238
16239 @item
16240 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16241 the value of its right-hand operand.
16242 This allows, for example,
16243 complex conditional breaks:
16244
16245 @smallexample
16246 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16247 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16248 @end smallexample
16249
16250 @item
16251 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16252 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16253 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16254 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16255 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16256 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16257 in strings. For example,
16258 @smallexample
16259 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16260 @end smallexample
16261 @noindent
16262 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16263 after each period.
16264
16265 @item
16266 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16267 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16268 to write
16269
16270 @smallexample
16271 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16272 @end smallexample
16273
16274 @item
16275 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16276 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16277 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16278 of 3 might print as
16279
16280 @smallexample
16281 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16282 @end smallexample
16283
16284 @noindent
16285 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16286 clause.
16287
16288 @item
16289 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16290 multi-character subsequence of
16291 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16292 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16293 in place of @t{a'length}.
16294
16295 @item
16296 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16297 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16298 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16299 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16300 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16301 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16302 For example,
16303 @smallexample
16304 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16305 @end smallexample
16306
16307 @item
16308 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16309 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16310 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16311 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16312 object.
16313
16314 @end itemize
16315
16316 @node Overloading support for Ada
16317 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16318 @cindex overloading, Ada
16319
16320 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16321 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16322 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16323 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16324 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16325 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16326
16327 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16328 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16329 use, for instance:
16330
16331 @smallexample
16332 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16333 Multiple matches for f
16334 [0] cancel
16335 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16336 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16337 >
16338 @end smallexample
16339
16340 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16341 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16342 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16343
16344 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16345 case:
16346
16347 @table @code
16348
16349 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16350 @item set ada print-signatures
16351 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16352 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16353 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16354
16355 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16356 @item show ada print-signatures
16357 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16358 overloads selection menu.
16359 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16360
16361 @end table
16362
16363 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16364 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16365
16366 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16367 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16368 before reaching the main procedure.
16369 As defined in the Ada Reference
16370 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16371 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16372 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16373 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16374
16375 @node Ada Exceptions
16376 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16377
16378 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16379
16380 @table @code
16381 @kindex info exceptions
16382 @item info exceptions
16383 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16384 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16385 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16386 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16387 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16388 @end table
16389
16390 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16391 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16392 argument.
16393
16394 @smallexample
16395 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16396 All defined Ada exceptions:
16397 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16398 program_error: 0x613d20
16399 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16400 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16401 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16402 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16403 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16404 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16405 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16406 @end smallexample
16407
16408 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16409 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16410
16411 @node Ada Tasks
16412 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16413 @cindex Ada, tasking
16414
16415 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16416 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16417
16418 @table @code
16419 @kindex info tasks
16420 @item info tasks
16421 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16422
16423
16424 @smallexample
16425 @iftex
16426 @leftskip=0.5cm
16427 @end iftex
16428 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16429 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16430 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16431 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16432 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16433 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16434
16435 @end smallexample
16436
16437 @noindent
16438 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16439 task currently being inspected.
16440
16441 @table @asis
16442 @item ID
16443 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16444
16445 @item TID
16446 The Ada task ID.
16447
16448 @item P-ID
16449 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16450
16451 @item Pri
16452 The base priority of the task.
16453
16454 @item State
16455 Current state of the task.
16456
16457 @table @code
16458 @item Unactivated
16459 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16460 executing.
16461
16462 @item Runnable
16463 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16464 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16465
16466 @item Terminated
16467 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16468 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16469 terminated themselves.
16470
16471 @item Child Activation Wait
16472 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16473
16474 @item Accept Statement
16475 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16476
16477 @item Waiting on entry call
16478 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16479
16480 @item Async Select Wait
16481 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16482 select statement.
16483
16484 @item Delay Sleep
16485 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16486 alternative open.
16487
16488 @item Child Termination Wait
16489 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16490 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16491 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16492
16493 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16494 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16495 finish terminating.
16496
16497 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16498 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16499 @end table
16500
16501 @item Name
16502 Name of the task in the program.
16503
16504 @end table
16505
16506 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16507 @item info task @var{taskno}
16508 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16509 the following example:
16510 @smallexample
16511 @iftex
16512 @leftskip=0.5cm
16513 @end iftex
16514 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16515 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16516 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16517 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16518 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16519 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16520 Name: task_1
16521 Thread: 0x807f378
16522 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16523 Base Priority: 15
16524 State: Runnable
16525 @end smallexample
16526
16527 @item task
16528 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16529 @cindex current Ada task ID
16530 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16531
16532 @smallexample
16533 @iftex
16534 @leftskip=0.5cm
16535 @end iftex
16536 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16537 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16538 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16539 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16540 (@value{GDBP}) task
16541 [Current task is 2]
16542 @end smallexample
16543
16544 @item task @var{taskno}
16545 @cindex Ada task switching
16546 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16547 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16548 from the current task to the given task.
16549
16550 @smallexample
16551 @iftex
16552 @leftskip=0.5cm
16553 @end iftex
16554 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16555 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16556 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16557 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16558 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16559 [Switching to task 1]
16560 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16561 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16562 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16563 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16564 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16565 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16566 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16567 @end smallexample
16568
16569 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16570 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16571 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16572 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16573 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16574 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16575 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16576 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16577 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16578
16579 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16580 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16581 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16582 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16583 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16584
16585 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16586 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16587 program.
16588
16589 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16590 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16591 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16592
16593 For example,
16594
16595 @smallexample
16596 @iftex
16597 @leftskip=0.5cm
16598 @end iftex
16599 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16600 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16601 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16602 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16603 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16604 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16605 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16606 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16607 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16608 Continuing.
16609 task # 1 running
16610 task # 2 running
16611
16612 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16613 15 flush;
16614 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16615 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16616 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16617 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16618 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16619 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16620 @end smallexample
16621 @end table
16622
16623 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16624 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16625 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16626
16627 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16628 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16629 the platform being used.
16630 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16631 switching is not supported.
16632
16633 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16634 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16635 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16636 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16637 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16638 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16639
16640 @node Ravenscar Profile
16641 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16642 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16643
16644 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16645 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16646 requirements.
16647
16648 @table @code
16649 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16650 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16651 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16652 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16653 Profile. This is the default.
16654
16655 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16656 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16657 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16658 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16659 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16660 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16661 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16662
16663 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16664 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16665 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16666 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16667
16668 @end table
16669
16670 @node Ada Glitches
16671 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16672 @cindex Ada, problems
16673
16674 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16675 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16676 @value{GDBN},
16677 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16678 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16679
16680 @itemize @bullet
16681 @item
16682 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16683 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16684
16685 @item
16686 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16687 argument lists are treated as positional).
16688
16689 @item
16690 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16691
16692 @item
16693 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16694 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16695 the host machine.
16696
16697 @item
16698 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16699 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16700 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16701 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16702 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16703 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16704 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16705 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16706 you can usually resolve the confusion
16707 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16708 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16709 @end itemize
16710
16711 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16712 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16713 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16714 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16715 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16716 enabled.
16717
16718 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16719 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16720 @table @code
16721
16722 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16723 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16724 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16725 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16726 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16727 This is the default.
16728
16729 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16730 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16731 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16732 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16733 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16734 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16735 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16736
16737 @end table
16738
16739 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16740 @cindex GNAT encoding
16741 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16742 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16743 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16744 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16745 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16746 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16747
16748 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16749 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16750 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16751 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16752 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16753 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16754 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16755 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16756
16757 @table @code
16758
16759 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16760 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16761 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16762 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16763
16764 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16765 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16766 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16767
16768 @end table
16769
16770 @node Unsupported Languages
16771 @section Unsupported Languages
16772
16773 @cindex unsupported languages
16774 @cindex minimal language
16775 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16776 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16777 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16778 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16779 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16780 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16781
16782 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16783 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16784 language.
16785
16786 @node Symbols
16787 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16788
16789 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16790 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16791 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16792 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16793 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16794 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16795 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16796
16797 @cindex symbol names
16798 @cindex names of symbols
16799 @cindex quoting names
16800 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16801 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16802 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16803 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16804 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16805 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16806 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16807 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16808
16809 @smallexample
16810 p 'foo.c'::x
16811 @end smallexample
16812
16813 @noindent
16814 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16815
16816 @table @code
16817 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16818 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16819 @kindex set case-sensitive
16820 @item set case-sensitive on
16821 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16822 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16823 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16824 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16825 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16826 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16827 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16828 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16829 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16830 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16831 case-insensitive matches.
16832
16833 @kindex show case-sensitive
16834 @item show case-sensitive
16835 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16836 lookups.
16837
16838 @kindex set print type methods
16839 @item set print type methods
16840 @itemx set print type methods on
16841 @itemx set print type methods off
16842 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16843 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16844 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16845 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16846 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16847 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16848
16849 @kindex show print type methods
16850 @item show print type methods
16851 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16852 classes.
16853
16854 @kindex set print type typedefs
16855 @item set print type typedefs
16856 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16857 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16858
16859 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16860 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16861 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16862 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16863 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16864 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16865 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16866 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16867 types.
16868
16869 @kindex show print type typedefs
16870 @item show print type typedefs
16871 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16872 printing classes.
16873
16874 @kindex info address
16875 @cindex address of a symbol
16876 @item info address @var{symbol}
16877 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16878 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16879 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16880 is always stored.
16881
16882 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16883 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16884 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16885
16886 @kindex info symbol
16887 @cindex symbol from address
16888 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16889 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16890 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16891 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16892 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16893
16894 @smallexample
16895 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16896 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16897 @end smallexample
16898
16899 @noindent
16900 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16901 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16902
16903 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16904 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16905
16906 @smallexample
16907 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16908 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16909 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16910 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16911 @end smallexample
16912
16913 @kindex demangle
16914 @cindex demangle
16915 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16916 Demangle @var{name}.
16917 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16918 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16919
16920 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16921 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16922
16923 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16924 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16925
16926 @kindex whatis
16927 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16928 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16929 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16930 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16931
16932 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16933 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16934 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16935
16936 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16937 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16938 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16939 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16940 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16941 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16942 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16943 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16944 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16945
16946 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16947 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16948 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16949 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16950 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16951 unroll it.
16952
16953 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16954 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16955 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16956
16957 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16958 Available flags are:
16959
16960 @table @code
16961 @item r
16962 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16963 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16964 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16965
16966 @item m
16967 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16968
16969 @item M
16970 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16971 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16972
16973 @item t
16974 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16975 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16976 names are substituted when printing other types.
16977
16978 @item T
16979 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16980 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16981 @end table
16982
16983 @kindex ptype
16984 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16985 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16986 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16987 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16988
16989 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16990 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16991 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16992 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16993 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16994 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16995 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16996 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16997
16998 For example, for this variable declaration:
16999
17000 @smallexample
17001 typedef double real_t;
17002 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17003 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17004 complex_t var;
17005 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17006 @end smallexample
17007
17008 @noindent
17009 the two commands give this output:
17010
17011 @smallexample
17012 @group
17013 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17014 type = complex_t
17015 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17016 type = struct complex @{
17017 real_t real;
17018 double imag;
17019 @}
17020 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17021 type = struct complex
17022 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17023 type = struct complex
17024 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17025 type = struct complex @{
17026 real_t real;
17027 double imag;
17028 @}
17029 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17030 type = real_t *
17031 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17032 type = double *
17033 @end group
17034 @end smallexample
17035
17036 @noindent
17037 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17038 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17039
17040 @cindex incomplete type
17041 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17042 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17043 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17044 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17045 given these declarations:
17046
17047 @smallexample
17048 struct foo;
17049 struct foo *fooptr;
17050 @end smallexample
17051
17052 @noindent
17053 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17054
17055 @smallexample
17056 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17057 $1 = <incomplete type>
17058 @end smallexample
17059
17060 @noindent
17061 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17062 completely specified.
17063
17064 @kindex info types
17065 @item info types @var{regexp}
17066 @itemx info types
17067 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17068 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17069 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17070 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17071 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17072 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17073 name is @code{value}.
17074
17075 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17076 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17077 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17078
17079 @kindex info type-printers
17080 @item info type-printers
17081 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17082 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17083 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17084 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17085 type printers.
17086
17087 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17088
17089 @kindex enable type-printer
17090 @kindex disable type-printer
17091 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17092 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17093 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17094
17095 @kindex info scope
17096 @cindex local variables
17097 @item info scope @var{location}
17098 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17099 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17100 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17101 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17102 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17103
17104 @smallexample
17105 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17106 Scope for command_line_handler:
17107 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17108 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17109 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17110 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17111 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17112 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17113 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17114 @end smallexample
17115
17116 @noindent
17117 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17118 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17119 collect}.
17120
17121 @kindex info source
17122 @item info source
17123 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17124 the function containing the current point of execution:
17125 @itemize @bullet
17126 @item
17127 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17128 @item
17129 the directory it was compiled in,
17130 @item
17131 its length, in lines,
17132 @item
17133 which programming language it is written in,
17134 @item
17135 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17136 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17137 @item
17138 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17139 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17140 @item
17141 whether the debugging information includes information about
17142 preprocessor macros.
17143 @end itemize
17144
17145
17146 @kindex info sources
17147 @item info sources
17148 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17149 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17150 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17151
17152 @kindex info functions
17153 @item info functions
17154 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17155
17156 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17157 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17158 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17159 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17160 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17161 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17162 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17163 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17164
17165 @kindex info variables
17166 @item info variables
17167 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17168 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17169
17170 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17171 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17172 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17173 @var{regexp}.
17174
17175 @kindex info classes
17176 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17177 @item info classes
17178 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17179 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17180 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17181 expression.
17182
17183 @kindex info selectors
17184 @item info selectors
17185 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17186 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17187 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17188 expression.
17189
17190 @ignore
17191 This was never implemented.
17192 @kindex info methods
17193 @item info methods
17194 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17195 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17196 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17197 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17198 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17199 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17200 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17201 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17202 @end ignore
17203
17204 @cindex opaque data types
17205 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17206 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17207 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17208 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17209 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17210 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17211 another source file. The default is on.
17212
17213 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17214 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17215
17216 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17217 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17218 is printed as follows:
17219 @smallexample
17220 @{<no data fields>@}
17221 @end smallexample
17222
17223 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17224 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17225 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17226
17227 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17228 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17229 @item set print symbol-loading
17230 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17231 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17232 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17233 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17234 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17235 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17236 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17237 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17238 can be annoying.
17239 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17240 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17241 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17242 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17243
17244 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17245 @item show print symbol-loading
17246 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17247 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17248
17249 @kindex maint print symbols
17250 @cindex symbol dump
17251 @kindex maint print psymbols
17252 @cindex partial symbol dump
17253 @kindex maint print msymbols
17254 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17255 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17256 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17257 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17258 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17259 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17260 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17261 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17262 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17263 that objfile.
17264 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17265 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17266 @code{main}.
17267 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17268 source file.
17269
17270 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17271 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17272 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17273 tables.
17274 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17275 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17276 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17277 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17278 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17279 ``ELF symbols''.
17280
17281 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17282 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17283
17284 @kindex maint info symtabs
17285 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17286 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17287 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17288 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17289 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17290 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17291 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17292
17293 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17294 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17295 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17296 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17297 structure in more detail. For example:
17298
17299 @smallexample
17300 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17301 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17302 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17303 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17304 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17305 readin no
17306 fullname (null)
17307 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17308 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17309 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17310 dependencies (none)
17311 @}
17312 @}
17313 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17314 (@value{GDBP})
17315 @end smallexample
17316 @noindent
17317 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17318 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17319 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17320 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17321 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17322
17323 @smallexample
17324 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17325 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17326 line 1574.
17327 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17328 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17329 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17330 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17331 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17332 dirname (null)
17333 fullname (null)
17334 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17335 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17336 debugformat DWARF 2
17337 @}
17338 @}
17339 (@value{GDBP})
17340 @end smallexample
17341
17342 @kindex maint info line-table
17343 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17344 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17345 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17346
17347 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17348 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17349 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17350
17351 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17352 @cindex symbol cache size
17353 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17354 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17355 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17356 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17357 with different sizes.
17358
17359 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17360 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17361 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17362
17363 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17364 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17365 @item maint print symbol-cache
17366 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17367 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17368
17369 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17370 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17371 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17372 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17373 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17374
17375 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17376 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17377 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17378 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17379 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17380 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17381
17382 @end table
17383
17384 @node Altering
17385 @chapter Altering Execution
17386
17387 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17388 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17389 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17390 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17391 program.
17392
17393 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17394 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17395 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17396
17397 @menu
17398 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17399 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17400 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17401 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17402 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17403 * Patching:: Patching your program
17404 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17405 @end menu
17406
17407 @node Assignment
17408 @section Assignment to Variables
17409
17410 @cindex assignment
17411 @cindex setting variables
17412 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17413 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17414
17415 @smallexample
17416 print x=4
17417 @end smallexample
17418
17419 @noindent
17420 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17421 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17422 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17423 information on operators in supported languages.
17424
17425 @kindex set variable
17426 @cindex variables, setting
17427 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17428 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17429 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17430 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17431 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17432
17433 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17434 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17435 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17436 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17437 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17438 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17439 command @code{set width}:
17440
17441 @smallexample
17442 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17443 type = double
17444 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17445 $4 = 13
17446 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17447 Invalid syntax in expression.
17448 @end smallexample
17449
17450 @noindent
17451 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17452 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17453
17454 @smallexample
17455 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17456 @end smallexample
17457
17458 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17459 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17460 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17461 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17462 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17463 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17464
17465 @smallexample
17466 @group
17467 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17468 type = double
17469 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17470 $1 = 1
17471 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17472 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17473 $2 = 1
17474 (@value{GDBP}) r
17475 The program being debugged has been started already.
17476 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17477 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17478 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17479 Invalid bfd target.
17480 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17481 The current BFD target is "=4".
17482 @end group
17483 @end smallexample
17484
17485 @noindent
17486 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17487 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17488 @code{g}, use
17489
17490 @smallexample
17491 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17492 @end smallexample
17493
17494 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17495 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17496 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17497 same length or shorter.
17498 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17499 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17500
17501 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17502 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17503 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17504 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17505 and representation in memory), and
17506
17507 @smallexample
17508 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17509 @end smallexample
17510
17511 @noindent
17512 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17513
17514 @node Jumping
17515 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17516
17517 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17518 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17519 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17520
17521 @table @code
17522 @kindex jump
17523 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17524 @item jump @var{location}
17525 @itemx j @var{location}
17526 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17527 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17528 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17529 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17530 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17531
17532 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17533 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17534 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17535 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17536 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17537 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17538 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17539 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17540 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17541 @end table
17542
17543 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17544 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17545 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17546 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17547 example,
17548
17549 @smallexample
17550 set $pc = 0x485
17551 @end smallexample
17552
17553 @noindent
17554 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17555 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17556 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17557
17558 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17559 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17560 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17561 detail.
17562
17563 @c @group
17564 @node Signaling
17565 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17566 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17567
17568 @table @code
17569 @kindex signal
17570 @item signal @var{signal}
17571 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17572 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17573 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17574 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17575
17576 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17577 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17578 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17579 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17580 signal.
17581
17582 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17583 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17584 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17585 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17586 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17587 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17588 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17589 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17590
17591 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17592 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17593 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17594 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17595 passes the signal directly to your program.
17596
17597 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17598 after executing the command.
17599
17600 @kindex queue-signal
17601 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17602 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17603 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17604 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17605 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17606 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17607 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17608 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17609 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17610
17611 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17612 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17613 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17614 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17615 @code{continue} command.
17616
17617 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17618 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17619 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17620 (@pxref{Signals}).
17621 @end table
17622 @c @end group
17623
17624 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17625 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17626
17627 @node Returning
17628 @section Returning from a Function
17629
17630 @table @code
17631 @cindex returning from a function
17632 @kindex return
17633 @item return
17634 @itemx return @var{expression}
17635 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17636 command. If you give an
17637 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17638 value.
17639 @end table
17640
17641 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17642 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17643 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17644 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17645
17646 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17647 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17648 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17649 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17650 of functions.
17651
17652 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17653 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17654 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17655 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17656 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17657
17658 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17659 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17660 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17661 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17662 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17663 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17664 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17665 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17666 assignment into the right register(s).
17667
17668 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17669 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17670 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17671 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17672 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17673 into a @code{long long int}:
17674
17675 @smallexample
17676 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17677 29 return 31;
17678 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17679 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17680 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17681 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17682 (@value{GDBP})
17683 @end smallexample
17684
17685 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17686 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17687 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17688 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17689 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17690 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17691 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17692 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17693
17694 @smallexample
17695 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17696 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17697 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17698 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17699 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17700 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17701 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17702 (@value{GDBP})
17703 @end smallexample
17704
17705 @node Calling
17706 @section Calling Program Functions
17707
17708 @table @code
17709 @cindex calling functions
17710 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17711 @item print @var{expr}
17712 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17713 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17714 debugged.
17715
17716 @kindex call
17717 @item call @var{expr}
17718 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17719 returned values.
17720
17721 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17722 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17723 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17724 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17725 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17726 value history.
17727 @end table
17728
17729 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17730 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17731 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17732 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17733
17734 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17735 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17736 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17737 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17738 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17739 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17740 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17741 in that case is controlled by the
17742 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17743
17744 @table @code
17745 @item set unwindonsignal
17746 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17747 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17748 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17749 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17750 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17751 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17752 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17753 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17754 received.
17755
17756 @item show unwindonsignal
17757 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17758 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17759 @value{GDBN}.
17760
17761 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17762 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17763 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17764 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17765 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17766 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17767 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17768 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17769 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17770 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17771
17772 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17773 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17774 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17775 @value{GDBN}.
17776
17777 @end table
17778
17779 @cindex weak alias functions
17780 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17781 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17782 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17783 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17784 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17785 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17786 function instead.
17787
17788 @node Patching
17789 @section Patching Programs
17790
17791 @cindex patching binaries
17792 @cindex writing into executables
17793 @cindex writing into corefiles
17794
17795 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17796 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17797 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17798 patching your program's binary.
17799
17800 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17801 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17802 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17803 repairs.
17804
17805 @table @code
17806 @kindex set write
17807 @item set write on
17808 @itemx set write off
17809 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17810 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17811 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17812
17813 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17814 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17815 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17816
17817 @item show write
17818 @kindex show write
17819 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17820 as well as reading.
17821 @end table
17822
17823 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17824 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17825 @cindex injecting code
17826 @cindex writing into executables
17827 @cindex compiling code
17828
17829 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17830 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17831 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17832 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17833
17834 @table @code
17835 @kindex compile code
17836 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17837 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17838 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17839 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17840 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17841 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17842 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17843 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17844 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17845 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17846 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17847 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17848
17849 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17850 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17851 E.g.:
17852
17853 @smallexample
17854 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17855 @end smallexample
17856
17857 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17858 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17859 from actual source code. E.g.:
17860
17861 @smallexample
17862 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17863 @end smallexample
17864
17865 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17866 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17867 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17868 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17869 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17870 editor.
17871
17872 @smallexample
17873 compile code
17874 >printf ("hello\n");
17875 >printf ("world\n");
17876 >end
17877 @end smallexample
17878
17879 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17880 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17881 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17882 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17883 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17884 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17885 inferior symbols otherwise.
17886
17887 @kindex compile file
17888 @item compile file @var{filename}
17889 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17890 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17891
17892 @smallexample
17893 compile file /home/user/example.c
17894 @end smallexample
17895 @end table
17896
17897 @table @code
17898 @item compile print @var{expr}
17899 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17900 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17901 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17902 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17903 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17904 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17905 Formats}.
17906
17907 @item compile print
17908 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17909 @cindex reprint the last value
17910 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17911 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17912 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17913 multiple-line editor.
17914 @end table
17915
17916 @noindent
17917 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17918
17919 @table @code
17920 @anchor{set debug compile}
17921 @item set debug compile
17922 @cindex compile command debugging info
17923 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17924 injecting the code. The default is off.
17925
17926 @item show debug compile
17927 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17928 compiling and injecting the code.
17929 @end table
17930
17931 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17932
17933 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17934 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17935 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17936 injecting process.
17937
17938 @noindent
17939 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17940
17941 @table @asis
17942 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17943 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17944 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17945 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17946
17947 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17948 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17949 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17950 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17951 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17952 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17953 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17954 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17955
17956 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17957 @end table
17958
17959 @noindent
17960 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17961
17962 @table @code
17963 @item set compile-args
17964 @cindex compile command options override
17965 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17966 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17967 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17968 compilation.
17969
17970 @item show compile-args
17971 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17972 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17973 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17974 @end table
17975
17976 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17977
17978 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17979 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17980 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17981
17982 @table @asis
17983 @item C code examples and caveats
17984 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17985 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17986 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17987 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17988 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17989
17990 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17991 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17992 much like any other normal debugging session.
17993
17994 @smallexample
17995 void function1 (void)
17996 @{
17997 int i = 42;
17998 printf ("function 1\n");
17999 @}
18000
18001 void function2 (void)
18002 @{
18003 int j = 12;
18004 function1 ();
18005 @}
18006
18007 int main(void)
18008 @{
18009 int k = 6;
18010 int *p;
18011 function2 ();
18012 return 0;
18013 @}
18014 @end smallexample
18015
18016 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18017 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18018 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18019
18020 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18021 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18022 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18023 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18024 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18025
18026 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18027 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18028 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18029 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18030 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18031 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18032 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18033 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18034 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18035 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18036
18037 @smallexample
18038 compile code k = 3;
18039 @end smallexample
18040
18041 @noindent
18042 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18043 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18044 @code{compile} command changes it.
18045
18046 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18047 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18048 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18049 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18050 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18051
18052 @smallexample
18053 compile code j = 3;
18054 @end smallexample
18055
18056 @noindent
18057 will result in a compilation error message.
18058
18059 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18060 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18061 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18062
18063 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18064 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18065 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18066 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18067
18068 @smallexample
18069 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18070 @end smallexample
18071
18072 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18073 command has completed:
18074
18075 @smallexample
18076 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18077 @end smallexample
18078
18079 @noindent
18080 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18081 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18082 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18083 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18084 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18085
18086 @smallexample
18087 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18088 @end smallexample
18089
18090 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18091 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18092 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18093 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18094 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18095 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18096 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18097 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18098
18099 @smallexample
18100 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18101 @end smallexample
18102
18103 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18104 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18105 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18106 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18107 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18108 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18109 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18110
18111 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18112 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18113 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18114 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18115 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18116 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18117
18118 @smallexample
18119 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18120 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18121 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18122 Compilation failed.
18123 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18124 42
18125 @end smallexample
18126
18127 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18128 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18129 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18130 will print to the console.
18131 @end table
18132
18133 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18134
18135 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18136 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18137 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18138 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18139 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18140 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18141 target architecture and operating system.
18142
18143 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18144 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18145 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18146 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18147 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18148 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18149 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18150
18151 @node GDB Files
18152 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18153
18154 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18155 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18156 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18157 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18158
18159 @menu
18160 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18161 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18162 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18163 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18164 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18165 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18166 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18167 @end menu
18168
18169 @node Files
18170 @section Commands to Specify Files
18171
18172 @cindex symbol table
18173 @cindex core dump file
18174
18175 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18176 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18177 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18178 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18179
18180 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18181 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18182 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18183 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18184 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18185 new files are useful.
18186
18187 @table @code
18188 @cindex executable file
18189 @kindex file
18190 @item file @var{filename}
18191 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18192 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18193 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18194 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18195 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18196 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18197 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18198 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18199
18200 @cindex unlinked object files
18201 @cindex patching object files
18202 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18203 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18204 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18205 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18206 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18207 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18208 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18209 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18210
18211 @item file
18212 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18213 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18214
18215 @kindex exec-file
18216 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18217 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18218 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18219 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18220 discard information on the executable file.
18221
18222 @kindex symbol-file
18223 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18224 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18225 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18226 table and program to run from the same file.
18227
18228 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18229 program's symbol table.
18230
18231 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18232 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18233 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18234 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18235 @value{GDBN}.
18236
18237 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18238 executing it once.
18239
18240 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18241 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18242 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18243 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18244 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18245 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18246 optimized code.
18247
18248 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18249 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18250 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18251 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18252 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18253
18254 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18255 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18256 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18257 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18258 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18259 Warnings and Messages}.)
18260
18261 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18262 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18263 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18264 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18265 in stabs format.
18266
18267 @kindex readnow
18268 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18269 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18270 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18271 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18272 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18273 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18274 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18275 entire symbol table available.
18276
18277 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18278 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18279 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18280 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18281 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18282 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18283 @c files.
18284
18285 @kindex core-file
18286 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18287 @itemx core
18288 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18289 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18290 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18291 executable file itself for other parts.
18292
18293 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18294 to be used.
18295
18296 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18297 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18298 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18299 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18300 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18301
18302 @kindex add-symbol-file
18303 @cindex dynamic linking
18304 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18305 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18306 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18307 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18308 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18309 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18310 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18311 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18312 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18313 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18314 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18315 @var{address} as an expression.
18316
18317 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18318 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18319 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18320 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18321
18322 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18323
18324 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18325 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18326 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18327 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18328 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18329 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18330 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18331 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18332 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18333
18334 @itemize @bullet
18335 @item
18336 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18337 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18338 @item
18339 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18340 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18341 @item
18342 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18343 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18344 @end itemize
18345
18346 @noindent
18347 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18348 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18349 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18350 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18351 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18352 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18353 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18354 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18355 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18356 way.
18357
18358 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18359
18360 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18361 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18362 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18363 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18364 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18365 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18366
18367 @smallexample
18368 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18369 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18370 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18371 (y or n) y
18372 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18373 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18374 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18375 (gdb)
18376 @end smallexample
18377
18378
18379 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18380
18381 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18382 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18383 @cindex load symbols from memory
18384 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18385 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18386 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18387 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18388 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18389 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18390 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18391 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18392 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18393
18394 @kindex section
18395 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18396 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18397 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18398 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18399 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18400 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18401 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18402 their addresses.
18403
18404 @kindex info files
18405 @kindex info target
18406 @item info files
18407 @itemx info target
18408 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18409 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18410 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18411 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18412 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18413 current ones.
18414
18415 @kindex maint info sections
18416 @item maint info sections
18417 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18418 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18419 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18420 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18421 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18422 may be arbitrarily combined):
18423
18424 @table @code
18425 @item ALLOBJ
18426 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18427 @item @var{sections}
18428 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18429 @item @var{section-flags}
18430 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18431 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18432 @table @code
18433 @item ALLOC
18434 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18435 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18436 @item LOAD
18437 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18438 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18439 @item RELOC
18440 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18441 @item READONLY
18442 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18443 @item CODE
18444 Section contains executable code only.
18445 @item DATA
18446 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18447 @item ROM
18448 Section will reside in ROM.
18449 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18450 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18451 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18452 Section is not empty.
18453 @item NEVER_LOAD
18454 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18455 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18456 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18457 COFF shared library information.
18458 @item IS_COMMON
18459 Section contains common symbols.
18460 @end table
18461 @end table
18462 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18463 @cindex read-only sections
18464 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18465 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18466 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18467 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18468 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18469 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18470 enhancement to debugging performance.
18471
18472 The default is off.
18473
18474 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18475 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18476 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18477 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18478
18479 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18480 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18481 @end table
18482
18483 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18484 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18485 name and remembers it that way.
18486
18487 @cindex shared libraries
18488 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18489 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18490 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18491 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18492
18493 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18494 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18495
18496 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18497 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18498 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18499 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18500 debugging a core file).
18501
18502 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18503 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18504 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18505
18506 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18507 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18508 particularly large or there are many of them.
18509
18510 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18511 commands:
18512
18513 @table @code
18514 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18515 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18516 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18517 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18518 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18519 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18520 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18521 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18522
18523 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18524 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18525 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18526 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18527 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18528 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18529 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18530 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18531 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18532
18533 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18534 @item show auto-solib-add
18535 Display the current autoloading mode.
18536 @end table
18537
18538 @cindex load shared library
18539 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18540 command:
18541
18542 @table @code
18543 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18544 @kindex info share
18545 @item info share @var{regex}
18546 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18547 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18548 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18549 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18550
18551 @kindex info dll
18552 @item info dll @var{regex}
18553 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18554
18555 @kindex sharedlibrary
18556 @kindex share
18557 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18558 @itemx share @var{regex}
18559 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18560 Unix regular expression.
18561 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18562 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18563 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18564 loaded.
18565
18566 @item nosharedlibrary
18567 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18568 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18569 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18570 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18571 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18572 discarded.
18573 @end table
18574
18575 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18576 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18577 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18578 Catchpoints}).
18579
18580 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18581 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18582 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18583 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18584
18585 @table @code
18586 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18587 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18588 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18589 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18590 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18591 shared library.
18592
18593 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18594 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18595 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18596 library events happen.
18597 @end table
18598
18599 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18600 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18601 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18602 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18603 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18604 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18605 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18606 not.
18607
18608 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18609 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18610 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18611 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18612 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18613
18614 @table @code
18615 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18616 @cindex system root, alternate
18617 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18618 @kindex set sysroot
18619 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18620 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18621 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18622 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18623 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18624 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18625 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18626 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18627 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18628 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18629 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18630 @var{path}.
18631
18632 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18633 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18634 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18635 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18636 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18637 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18638 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18639 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18640 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18641 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18642 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18643 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18644 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18645 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18646
18647 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18648 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18649 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18650 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18651 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18652
18653 @smallexample
18654 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18655 @end smallexample
18656
18657 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18658 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18659 system:
18660
18661 @smallexample
18662 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18663 @end smallexample
18664
18665 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18666 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18667 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18668 colons:
18669
18670 @smallexample
18671 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18672 @end smallexample
18673
18674 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18675 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18676 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18677 @samp{z}):
18678
18679 @smallexample
18680 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18681 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18682 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 @noindent
18686 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18687 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18688 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18689
18690 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18691 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18692
18693 @smallexample
18694 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18695 @end smallexample
18696
18697 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18698 if you don't want or need to.
18699
18700 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18701 sysroot}.
18702
18703 @cindex default system root
18704 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18705 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18706 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18707 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18708 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18709 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18710 location.
18711
18712 @kindex show sysroot
18713 @item show sysroot
18714 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18715
18716 @kindex set solib-search-path
18717 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18718 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18719 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18720 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18721 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18722 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18723 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18724 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18725 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18726 of shared library symbols.
18727
18728 @kindex show solib-search-path
18729 @item show solib-search-path
18730 Display the current shared library search path.
18731
18732 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18733 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18734 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18735 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18736 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18737
18738 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18739 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18740 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18741 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18742 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18743 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18744 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18745 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18746 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18747 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18748 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18749 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18750 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18751 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18752 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18753 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18754 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18755 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18756 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18757 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18758 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18759 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18760
18761 @table @code
18762 @item unix
18763 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18764 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18765 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18766 the forward slash.
18767
18768 @item dos-based
18769 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18770 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18771 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18772 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18773 considered directory separators.
18774
18775 @item auto
18776 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18777 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18778 This is the default.
18779 @end table
18780 @end table
18781
18782 @cindex file name canonicalization
18783 @cindex base name differences
18784 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18785 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18786 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18787 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18788 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18789 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18790 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18791 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18792 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18793 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18794 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18795 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18796 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18797 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18798 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18799
18800 @table @code
18801 @item set basenames-may-differ
18802 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18803 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18804
18805 @item show basenames-may-differ
18806 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18807 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18808 @end table
18809
18810 @node File Caching
18811 @section File Caching
18812 @cindex caching of opened files
18813 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18814
18815 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18816 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18817 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18818 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18819
18820 @table @code
18821 @kindex maint info bfds
18822 @item maint info bfds
18823 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18824 @value{GDBN}.
18825
18826 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18827 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18828 @kindex bfd caching
18829 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18830 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18831 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18832 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18833 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18834 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18835 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18836 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18837 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18838
18839 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18840 @kindex bfd caching
18841 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18842 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18843
18844 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18845 @kindex bfd caching
18846 @item show debug bfd-cache
18847 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18848 @end table
18849
18850 @node Separate Debug Files
18851 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18852 @cindex separate debugging information files
18853 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18854 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18855 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18856 @cindex global debugging information directories
18857 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18858 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18859
18860 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18861 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18862 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18863 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18864 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18865 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18866 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18867
18868 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18869 file:
18870
18871 @itemize @bullet
18872 @item
18873 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18874 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18875 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18876 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18877 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18878 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18879 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18880 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18881
18882 @item
18883 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18884 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18885 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18886 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18887 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18888 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18889 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18890 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18891 below.
18892 @end itemize
18893
18894 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18895 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18896
18897 @itemize @bullet
18898 @item
18899 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18900 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18901 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18902 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18903 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18904
18905 @item
18906 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18907 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18908 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18909 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18910 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18911 hex characters, not 10.)
18912 @end itemize
18913
18914 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18915 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18916 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18917 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18918 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18919 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18920
18921 @itemize @minus
18922 @item
18923 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18924 @item
18925 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18926 @item
18927 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18928 @item
18929 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18930 @end itemize
18931
18932 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18933 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18934 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18935 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18936 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18937
18938 @table @code
18939
18940 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18941 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18942 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18943 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18944 concatenating them by a path separator.
18945
18946 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18947 @item show debug-file-directory
18948 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18949 information files.
18950
18951 @end table
18952
18953 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18954 @cindex debug link sections
18955 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18956 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18957
18958 @itemize
18959 @item
18960 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18961 a zero byte,
18962 @item
18963 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18964 boundary within the section, and
18965 @item
18966 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18967 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18968 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18969 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18970 @end itemize
18971
18972 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18973 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18974 described above.
18975
18976 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18977 @cindex build ID sections
18978 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18979 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18980 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18981 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18982 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18983 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18984 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18985 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18986 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18987
18988 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18989 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18990 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18991 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18992 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18993 in an ordinary executable.
18994
18995 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18996 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18997 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18998 following commands:
18999
19000 @smallexample
19001 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19002 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19003 @end smallexample
19004
19005 @noindent
19006 These commands remove the debugging
19007 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19008 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19009 two files:
19010
19011 @itemize @bullet
19012 @item
19013 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19014 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19015
19016 @smallexample
19017 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19018 @end smallexample
19019
19020 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19021 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19022 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19023 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19024
19025 @item
19026 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19027 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19028 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19029 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19030 @end itemize
19031
19032 @noindent
19033
19034 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19035 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19036 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19037
19038 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19039 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19040 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19041 @c different ways!
19042 @ifhtml
19043 @display
19044 @html
19045 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19046 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19047 @end html
19048 @end display
19049 @end ifhtml
19050 @ifnothtml
19051 @display
19052 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19053 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19054 @end display
19055 @end ifnothtml
19056
19057 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19058 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19059 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19060 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19061 CRC.
19062
19063 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19064 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19065 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19066 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19067 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19068
19069 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19070 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19071 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19072 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19073 @code{0xffffffff}.
19074
19075 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19076 @smallexample
19077 unsigned long
19078 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19079 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19080 @{
19081 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19082 @{
19083 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19084 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19085 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19086 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19087 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19088 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19089 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19090 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19091 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19092 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19093 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19094 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19095 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19096 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19097 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19098 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19099 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19100 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19101 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19102 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19103 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19104 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19105 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19106 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19107 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19108 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19109 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19110 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19111 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19112 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19113 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19114 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19115 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19116 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19117 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19118 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19119 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19120 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19121 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19122 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19123 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19124 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19125 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19126 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19127 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19128 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19129 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19130 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19131 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19132 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19133 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19134 0x2d02ef8d
19135 @};
19136 unsigned char *end;
19137
19138 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19139 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19140 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19141 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19142 @}
19143 @end smallexample
19144
19145 @noindent
19146 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19147
19148 @node MiniDebugInfo
19149 @section Debugging information in a special section
19150 @cindex separate debug sections
19151 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19152
19153 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19154 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19155 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19156 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19157
19158 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19159 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19160 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19161 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19162 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19163 debugging information might be included in the section.
19164
19165 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19166 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19167 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19168
19169 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19170 standard utilities:
19171
19172 @smallexample
19173 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19174 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19175 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19176 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19177
19178 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19179 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19180 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19181 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19182 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19183 | sort > funcsyms
19184
19185 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19186 # table.
19187 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19188
19189 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19190 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19191
19192 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19193 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19194 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19195 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19196
19197 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19198 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19199
19200 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19201 # original binary.
19202 xz mini_debuginfo
19203 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19204 @end smallexample
19205
19206 @node Index Files
19207 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19208 @cindex index files
19209 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19210
19211 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19212 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19213 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19214 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19215 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19216 startup.
19217
19218 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19219 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19220 using @command{objcopy}.
19221
19222 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19223
19224 @table @code
19225 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19226 @kindex save gdb-index
19227 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19228 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19229 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19230 @var{directory}.
19231 @end table
19232
19233 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19234 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19235
19236 @smallexample
19237 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19238 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19239 @end smallexample
19240
19241 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19242 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19243 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19244 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19245 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19246 The default is @code{off}.
19247 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19248 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19249
19250 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19251 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19252
19253 @smallexample
19254 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19255 @end smallexample
19256
19257 Instead you must do, for example,
19258
19259 @smallexample
19260 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19264 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19265 currently work for programs using Ada.
19266
19267 @node Symbol Errors
19268 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19269
19270 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19271 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19272 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19273 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19274 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19275 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19276 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19277 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19278 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19279 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19280 Messages}).
19281
19282 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19283
19284 @table @code
19285 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19286
19287 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19288 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19289 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19290 in its outer scope blocks.
19291
19292 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19293 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19294 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19295 function.
19296
19297 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19298
19299 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19300 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19301 do so.
19302
19303 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19304 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19305 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19306 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19307 Messages}.)
19308
19309 @item bad block start address patched
19310
19311 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19312 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19313 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19314
19315 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19316 starting on the previous source line.
19317
19318 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19319
19320 @cindex foo
19321 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19322 larger than the size of the string table.
19323
19324 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19325 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19326 with this name.
19327
19328 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19329
19330 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19331 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19332 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19333
19334 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19335 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19336 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19337 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19338 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19339 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19340
19341 @item stub type has NULL name
19342
19343 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19344
19345 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19346 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19347 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19348 it.
19349
19350 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19351
19352 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19353
19354 @end table
19355
19356 @node Data Files
19357 @section GDB Data Files
19358
19359 @cindex prefix for data files
19360 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19361 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19362
19363 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19364 is currently using.
19365
19366 @table @code
19367 @kindex set data-directory
19368 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19369 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19370 to @var{directory}.
19371
19372 @kindex show data-directory
19373 @item show data-directory
19374 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19375 @end table
19376
19377 @cindex default data directory
19378 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19379 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19380 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19381 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19382 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19383 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19384 location.
19385
19386 The data directory may also be specified with the
19387 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19388 @xref{Mode Options}.
19389
19390 @node Targets
19391 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19392
19393 @cindex debugging target
19394 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19395
19396 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19397 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19398 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19399 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19400 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19401 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19402 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19403 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19404
19405 @cindex target architecture
19406 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19407 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19408 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19409 command.
19410
19411 @table @code
19412 @kindex set architecture
19413 @kindex show architecture
19414 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19415 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19416 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19417 supported architectures.
19418
19419 @item show architecture
19420 Show the current target architecture.
19421
19422 @item set processor
19423 @itemx processor
19424 @kindex set processor
19425 @kindex show processor
19426 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19427 and @code{show architecture}.
19428 @end table
19429
19430 @menu
19431 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19432 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19433 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19434 @end menu
19435
19436 @node Active Targets
19437 @section Active Targets
19438
19439 @cindex stacking targets
19440 @cindex active targets
19441 @cindex multiple targets
19442
19443 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19444 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19445 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19446 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19447 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19448 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19449 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19450 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19451 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19452
19453 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19454 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19455 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19456 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19457
19458 @node Target Commands
19459 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19460
19461 @table @code
19462 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19463 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19464 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19465 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19466 protocol of the target machine.
19467
19468 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19469 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19470 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19471
19472 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19473 after executing the command.
19474
19475 @kindex help target
19476 @item help target
19477 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19478 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19479 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19480
19481 @item help target @var{name}
19482 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19483 select it.
19484
19485 @kindex set gnutarget
19486 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19487 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19488 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19489 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19490 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19491 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19492
19493 @quotation
19494 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19495 you must know the actual BFD name.
19496 @end quotation
19497
19498 @noindent
19499 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19500
19501 @kindex show gnutarget
19502 @item show gnutarget
19503 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19504 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19505 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19506 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19507 @end table
19508
19509 @cindex common targets
19510 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19511 configuration):
19512
19513 @table @code
19514 @kindex target
19515 @item target exec @var{program}
19516 @cindex executable file target
19517 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19518 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19519
19520 @item target core @var{filename}
19521 @cindex core dump file target
19522 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19523 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19524
19525 @item target remote @var{medium}
19526 @cindex remote target
19527 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19528 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19529 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19530
19531 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19532 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19533
19534 @smallexample
19535 target remote /dev/ttya
19536 @end smallexample
19537
19538 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19539 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19540 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19541 clobbered by the download.
19542
19543 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19544 @cindex built-in simulator target
19545 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19546 In general,
19547 @smallexample
19548 target sim
19549 load
19550 run
19551 @end smallexample
19552 @noindent
19553 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19554 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19555 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19556 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19557 Processors}.
19558
19559 @item target native
19560 @cindex native target
19561 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19562 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19563 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19564 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19565
19566 @end table
19567
19568 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19569 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19570
19571 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19572 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19573 various aspects of this process.
19574
19575 @table @code
19576
19577 @item set hash
19578 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19579 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19580 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19581 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19582 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19583 monitor.
19584
19585 @item show hash
19586 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19587 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19588
19589 @item set debug monitor
19590 @kindex set debug monitor
19591 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19592 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19593 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19594
19595 @item show debug monitor
19596 @kindex show debug monitor
19597 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19598 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19599 @end table
19600
19601 @table @code
19602
19603 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19604 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19605 @anchor{load}
19606 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19607 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19608 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19609 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19610 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19611 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19612
19613 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19614 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19615 target is @dots{}}''
19616
19617 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19618 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19619 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19620 specifies a fixed address.
19621 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19622
19623 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19624 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19625 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19626
19627 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19628 load programs into flash memory.
19629
19630 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19631 @end table
19632
19633 @table @code
19634
19635 @kindex flash-erase
19636 @item flash-erase
19637 @anchor{flash-erase}
19638
19639 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19640
19641 @end table
19642
19643 @node Byte Order
19644 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19645
19646 @cindex choosing target byte order
19647 @cindex target byte order
19648
19649 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19650 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19651 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19652 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19653 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19654 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19655
19656 @table @code
19657 @kindex set endian
19658 @item set endian big
19659 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19660
19661 @item set endian little
19662 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19663
19664 @item set endian auto
19665 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19666 executable.
19667
19668 @item show endian
19669 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19670
19671 @end table
19672
19673 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19674 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19675 target system.
19676
19677
19678 @node Remote Debugging
19679 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19680 @cindex remote debugging
19681
19682 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19683 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19684 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19685 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19686 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19687
19688 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19689 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19690 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19691 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19692 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19693 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19694
19695 Other remote targets may be available in your
19696 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19697
19698 @menu
19699 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19700 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19701 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19702 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19703 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19704 @end menu
19705
19706 @node Connecting
19707 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19708 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19709 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19710 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19711 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19712 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19713 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19714
19715 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19716 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19717 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19718 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19719
19720 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19721
19722 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19723 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19724 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19725 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19726
19727 @table @asis
19728
19729 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19730 @item Result of detach or program exit
19731 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19732 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19733 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19734
19735 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19736 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19737 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19738 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19739
19740 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19741 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19742 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19743 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19744
19745 @item Specifying the program to debug
19746 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19747 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19748 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19749 target.
19750
19751 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19752 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19753 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19754
19755 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19756 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19757 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19758 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19759
19760 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19761 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19762 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19763 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19764 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19765 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19766 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19767 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19768 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19769
19770 @item The @code{run} command
19771 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19772 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19773 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19774 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19775 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19776
19777 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19778 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19779 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19780 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19781 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19782
19783 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19784 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19785 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19786 @code{target remote} mode.
19787
19788 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19789 @item Attaching
19790 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19791 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19792 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19793
19794 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19795 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19796 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19797 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19798 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19799
19800 @end table
19801
19802 @anchor{Host and target files}
19803 @subsection Host and Target Files
19804 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19805 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19806
19807 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19808 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19809 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19810 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19811 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19812
19813 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19814 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19815 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19816 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19817 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19818
19819 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19820 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19821 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19822 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19823 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19824 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19825 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19826 target libraries.
19827
19828 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19829 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19830 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19831 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19832 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19833 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19834 programs.
19835
19836 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19837 @cindex remote connection commands
19838 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19839 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19840 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19841 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19842 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19843 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19844 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19845
19846 @table @code
19847
19848 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19849 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19850 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19851 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19852 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19853
19854 @smallexample
19855 target remote /dev/ttyb
19856 @end smallexample
19857
19858 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19859 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19860 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19861 @code{target} command.
19862
19863 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19864 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19865 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19866 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19867 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19868 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19869 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19870 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19871 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19872 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19873 target.
19874
19875 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19876 @code{manyfarms}:
19877
19878 @smallexample
19879 target remote manyfarms:2828
19880 @end smallexample
19881
19882 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19883 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19884 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19885 port 1234 on your local machine:
19886
19887 @smallexample
19888 target remote :1234
19889 @end smallexample
19890 @noindent
19891
19892 Note that the colon is still required here.
19893
19894 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19895 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19896 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19897 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19898 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19899
19900 @smallexample
19901 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19902 @end smallexample
19903
19904 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19905 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19906 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19907 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19908
19909 @item target remote | @var{command}
19910 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19911 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19912 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19913 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19914 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19915 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19916 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19917 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19918 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19919
19920 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19921 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19922 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19923
19924 @end table
19925
19926 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19927 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19928 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19929 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19930 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19931 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19932 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19933
19934 @smallexample
19935 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19936 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19937 @end smallexample
19938
19939 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19940 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19941 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19942 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19943
19944 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19945 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19946
19947 @table @code
19948 @kindex detach (remote)
19949 @item detach
19950 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19951 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19952 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19953 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19954 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19955 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19956 still connected to the target.
19957
19958 @kindex disconnect
19959 @item disconnect
19960 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19961 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19962 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19963 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19964 another target.
19965
19966 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19967 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19968 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19969 @kindex monitor
19970 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19971 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19972 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19973 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19974 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19975 and implement.
19976 @end table
19977
19978 @node File Transfer
19979 @section Sending files to a remote system
19980 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19981 @cindex file transfer
19982 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19983
19984 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19985 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19986 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19987 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19988 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19989 the only way to upload or download files.
19990
19991 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19992
19993 @table @code
19994 @kindex remote put
19995 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19996 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19997 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19998
19999 @kindex remote get
20000 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20001 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20002 on the host system.
20003
20004 @kindex remote delete
20005 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20006 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20007
20008 @end table
20009
20010 @node Server
20011 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20012
20013 @kindex gdbserver
20014 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20015 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20016 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20017 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20018 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20019
20020 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20021 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20022 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20023 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20024 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20025 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20026 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20027 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20028 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20029 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20030 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20031 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20032 choice for debugging.
20033
20034 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20035 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20036 protocol.
20037
20038 @quotation
20039 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20040 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20041 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20042 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20043 @code{gdbserver}.
20044 @end quotation
20045
20046 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20047 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20048 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20049 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20050
20051 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20052 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20053 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20054 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20055 system does all the symbol handling.
20056
20057 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20058 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20059 syntax is:
20060
20061 @smallexample
20062 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20063 @end smallexample
20064
20065 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20066 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20067 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20068 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20069 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20070 @file{/dev/com1}:
20071
20072 @smallexample
20073 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20074 @end smallexample
20075
20076 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20077 with it.
20078
20079 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20080
20081 @smallexample
20082 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20083 @end smallexample
20084
20085 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20086 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20087 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20088 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20089 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20090 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20091 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20092 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20093 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20094 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20095 @code{target remote} command.
20096
20097 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20098 with ssh:
20099
20100 @smallexample
20101 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20102 @end smallexample
20103
20104 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20105 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20106 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20107 You could elide it if you want to.
20108
20109 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20110 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20111 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20112 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20113
20114 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20115 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20116 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20117 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20118
20119 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20120 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20127 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20128
20129 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20130 @value{GDBN} attach command
20131 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20132
20133 @pindex pidof
20134 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20135 @code{pidof} utility:
20136
20137 @smallexample
20138 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20139 @end smallexample
20140
20141 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20142 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20143 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20144
20145 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20146
20147 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20148 port.
20149
20150 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20151 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20152 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20153 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20154 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20155 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20156 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20157 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20158
20159 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20160 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20161 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20162
20163 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20164 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20165 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20166 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20167 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20168 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20169 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20170 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20171 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20172 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20173 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20174 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20175
20176 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20177 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20178
20179 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20180 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20181 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20182 program. For more information,
20183 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20184
20185 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20186 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20187 status information about the debugging process.
20188 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20189 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20190 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20191 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20192
20193 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20194 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20195 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20196 Possible options are:
20197
20198 @table @code
20199 @item none
20200 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20201 @item all
20202 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20203 @item timestamps
20204 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20205 @end table
20206
20207 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20208 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20209
20210 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20211 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20212 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20213 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20214 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20215
20216 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20217 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20218 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20219 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20220
20221 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20222 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20223 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20224 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20225
20226 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20227 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20228 environment:
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20232 @end smallexample
20233
20234 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20235
20236 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20237 @itemize
20238
20239 @item
20240 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20241
20242 @item
20243 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20244 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20245 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20246 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20247 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20248 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20249
20250 @item
20251 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20252 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20253 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20254 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20255 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20256 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20257 program is already on the target.
20258
20259 @end itemize
20260
20261 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20262 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20263 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20264
20265 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20266 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20267 Here are the available commands.
20268
20269 @table @code
20270 @item monitor help
20271 List the available monitor commands.
20272
20273 @item monitor set debug 0
20274 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20275 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20276
20277 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20278 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20279 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20280 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20281
20282 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20283 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20284 Possible options are:
20285
20286 @table @code
20287 @item none
20288 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20289 @item all
20290 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20291 @item timestamps
20292 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20293 @end table
20294
20295 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20296 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20297
20298 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20299 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20300 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20301 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20302 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20303 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20304
20305 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20306 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20307
20308 @item monitor exit
20309 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20310 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20311 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20312 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20313 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20314
20315 @end table
20316
20317 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20318 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20319
20320 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20321 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20322
20323 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20324 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20325 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20326 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20327 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20328 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20329 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20330 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20331 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20332 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20333 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20334 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20335
20336 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20337
20338 @table @code
20339 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20340
20341 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20342 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20343 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20344
20345 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20346
20347 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20348 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20349 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20350 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20351 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20352 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20353
20354 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20355
20356 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20357 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20358 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20359 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20360 command for that. For example:
20361
20362 @smallexample
20363 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20364 @end smallexample
20365
20366 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20367 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20368 @end table
20369
20370 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20371 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20372 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20373 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20374 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20375 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20376 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20377 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20378 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20379 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20380
20381 @smallexample
20382 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20383 @end smallexample
20384
20385 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20386
20387 @smallexample
20388 $ gdb myprogram
20389 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20390 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20391 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20392 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20393 @end smallexample
20394
20395 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20396 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20397 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20398 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20399 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20400 tracing.
20401
20402 @node Remote Configuration
20403 @section Remote Configuration
20404
20405 @kindex set remote
20406 @kindex show remote
20407 This section documents the configuration options available when
20408 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20409 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20410 system-call-allowed}.
20411
20412 @table @code
20413 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20414 @cindex address size for remote targets
20415 @cindex bits in remote address
20416 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20417 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20418 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20419 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20420
20421 @item show remoteaddresssize
20422 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20423
20424 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20425 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20426 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20427 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20428 remote targets.
20429
20430 @item show serial baud
20431 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20432
20433 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20434 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20435 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20436
20437 @item show serial parity
20438 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20439
20440 @item set remotebreak
20441 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20442 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20443 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20444 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20445 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20446 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20447 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20448 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20449
20450 @item show remotebreak
20451 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20452 interrupt the remote program.
20453
20454 @item set remoteflow on
20455 @itemx set remoteflow off
20456 @kindex set remoteflow
20457 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20458 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20459
20460 @item show remoteflow
20461 @kindex show remoteflow
20462 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20463
20464 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20465 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20466 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20467 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20468 @code{ascii}.
20469
20470 @item show remotelogbase
20471 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20472 protocol.
20473
20474 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20475 @cindex record serial communications on file
20476 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20477 default is not to record at all.
20478
20479 @item show remotelogfile.
20480 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20481 serial communications.
20482
20483 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20484 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20485 @cindex remote timeout
20486 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20487 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20488
20489 @item show remotetimeout
20490 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20491 responses.
20492
20493 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20494 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20495 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20496 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20497 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20498 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20499 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20500 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20501
20502 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20503 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20504 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20505 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20506 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20507 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20508 as unlimited.
20509
20510 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20511 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20512 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20513
20514 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20515 @itemx show remote exec-file
20516 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20517 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20518 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20519 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20520 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20521 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20522
20523 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20524 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20525 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20526 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20527 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20528 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20529 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20530 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20531 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20532 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20533
20534 @item show interrupt-sequence
20535 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20536 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20537 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20538 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20539
20540 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20541 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20542 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20543 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20544 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20545 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20546
20547 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20548 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20549 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20550
20551 @kindex set tcp
20552 @kindex show tcp
20553 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20554 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20555 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20556 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20557 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20558 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20559 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20560 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20561 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20562
20563 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20564 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20565
20566 @item show tcp auto-retry
20567 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20568
20569 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20570 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20571 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20572 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20573 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20574 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20575 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20576 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20577 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20578 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20579 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20580
20581 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20582 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20583 @end table
20584
20585 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20586 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20587 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20588 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20589 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20590 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20591 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20592 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20593 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20594
20595 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20596 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20597 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20598 @value{GDBN} developers.
20599
20600 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20601 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20602 are:
20603
20604 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20605 @item Command Name
20606 @tab Remote Packet
20607 @tab Related Features
20608
20609 @item @code{fetch-register}
20610 @tab @code{p}
20611 @tab @code{info registers}
20612
20613 @item @code{set-register}
20614 @tab @code{P}
20615 @tab @code{set}
20616
20617 @item @code{binary-download}
20618 @tab @code{X}
20619 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20620
20621 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20622 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20623 @tab @code{info auxv}
20624
20625 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20626 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20627 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20628
20629 @item @code{attach}
20630 @tab @code{vAttach}
20631 @tab @code{attach}
20632
20633 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20634 @tab @code{vCont}
20635 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20636
20637 @item @code{run}
20638 @tab @code{vRun}
20639 @tab @code{run}
20640
20641 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20642 @tab @code{Z0}
20643 @tab @code{break}
20644
20645 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20646 @tab @code{Z1}
20647 @tab @code{hbreak}
20648
20649 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20650 @tab @code{Z2}
20651 @tab @code{watch}
20652
20653 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20654 @tab @code{Z3}
20655 @tab @code{rwatch}
20656
20657 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20658 @tab @code{Z4}
20659 @tab @code{awatch}
20660
20661 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20662 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20663 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20664
20665 @item @code{target-features}
20666 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20667 @tab @code{set architecture}
20668
20669 @item @code{library-info}
20670 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20671 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20672
20673 @item @code{memory-map}
20674 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20675 @tab @code{info mem}
20676
20677 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20678 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20679 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20680
20681 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20682 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20683 @tab @code{info spu}
20684
20685 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20686 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20687 @tab @code{info spu}
20688
20689 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20690 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20691 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20692
20693 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20694 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20695 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20696
20697 @item @code{threads}
20698 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20699 @tab @code{info threads}
20700
20701 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20702 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20703 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20704
20705 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20706 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20707 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20708
20709 @item @code{search-memory}
20710 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20711 @tab @code{find}
20712
20713 @item @code{supported-packets}
20714 @tab @code{qSupported}
20715 @tab Remote communications parameters
20716
20717 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20718 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20719 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20720
20721 @item @code{pass-signals}
20722 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20723 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20724
20725 @item @code{program-signals}
20726 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20727 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20728
20729 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20730 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20731 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20732
20733 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20734 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20735 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20736
20737 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20738 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20739 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20740
20741 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20742 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20743 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20744
20745 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20746 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20747 @tab @code{remote delete}
20748
20749 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20750 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20751 @tab Host I/O
20752
20753 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20754 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20755 @tab Host I/O
20756
20757 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20758 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20759 @tab Host I/O
20760
20761 @item @code{noack-packet}
20762 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20763 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20764
20765 @item @code{osdata}
20766 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20767 @tab @code{info os}
20768
20769 @item @code{query-attached}
20770 @tab @code{qAttached}
20771 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20772
20773 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20774 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20775 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20776
20777 @item @code{trace-status}
20778 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20779 @tab @code{tstatus}
20780
20781 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20782 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20783 @tab Traceframe info
20784
20785 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20786 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20787 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20788
20789 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20790 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20791 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20792
20793 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20794 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20795 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20796
20797 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20798 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20799 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20800
20801 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20802 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20803 @tab @code{break}
20804
20805 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20806 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20807 @tab @code{hbreak}
20808
20809 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20810 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20811 @tab @code{fork}
20812
20813 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20814 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20815 @tab @code{vfork}
20816
20817 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20818 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20819 @tab @code{exec}
20820
20821 @item @code{thread-events}
20822 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20823 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20824
20825 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20826 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20827 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20828
20829 @end multitable
20830
20831 @node Remote Stub
20832 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20833
20834 @cindex debugging stub, example
20835 @cindex remote stub, example
20836 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20837 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20838 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20839 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20840 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20841 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20842 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20843 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20844
20845 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20846 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20847 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20848 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20849 program, you need:
20850
20851 @enumerate
20852 @item
20853 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20854 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20855 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20856
20857 @item
20858 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20859 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20860
20861 @item
20862 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20863 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20864 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20865 documentation.
20866 @end enumerate
20867
20868 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20869 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20870 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20871
20872 @table @emph
20873 @item On the host,
20874 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20875 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20876 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20877
20878 @item On the target,
20879 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20880 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20881 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20882
20883 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20884 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20885 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20886 @end table
20887
20888 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20889 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20890 @sc{sparc} boards.
20891
20892 @cindex remote serial stub list
20893 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20894
20895 @table @code
20896
20897 @item i386-stub.c
20898 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20899 @cindex Intel
20900 @cindex i386
20901 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20902
20903 @item m68k-stub.c
20904 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20905 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20906 @cindex m680x0
20907 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20908
20909 @item sh-stub.c
20910 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20911 @cindex Renesas
20912 @cindex SH
20913 For Renesas SH architectures.
20914
20915 @item sparc-stub.c
20916 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20917 @cindex Sparc
20918 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20919
20920 @item sparcl-stub.c
20921 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20922 @cindex Fujitsu
20923 @cindex SparcLite
20924 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20925
20926 @end table
20927
20928 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20929 recently added stubs.
20930
20931 @menu
20932 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20933 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20934 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20935 @end menu
20936
20937 @node Stub Contents
20938 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20939
20940 @cindex remote serial stub
20941 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20942 subroutines:
20943
20944 @table @code
20945 @item set_debug_traps
20946 @findex set_debug_traps
20947 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20948 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20949 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20950 program's startup code.
20951
20952 @item handle_exception
20953 @findex handle_exception
20954 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20955 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20956 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20957 run when a trap is triggered.
20958
20959 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20960 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20961 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20962 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20963 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20964 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20965 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20966 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20967 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20968 machine.
20969
20970 @item breakpoint
20971 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20972 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20973 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20974 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20975 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20976 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20977 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20978 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20979 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20980 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20981 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20982
20983 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20984 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20985 start of your debugging session.
20986 @end table
20987
20988 @node Bootstrapping
20989 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20990
20991 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20992 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20993 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20994 debugging target machine.
20995
20996 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20997 serial port.
20998
20999 @table @code
21000 @item int getDebugChar()
21001 @findex getDebugChar
21002 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21003 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21004 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21005
21006 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21007 @findex putDebugChar
21008 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21009 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21010 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21011 @end table
21012
21013 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21014 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21015 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21016 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21017 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21018 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21019 remote system to stop.
21020
21021 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21022 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21023 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21024 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21025
21026 Other routines you need to supply are:
21027
21028 @table @code
21029 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21030 @findex exceptionHandler
21031 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21032 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21033 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21034 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21035 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21036 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21037 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21038 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21039 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21040 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21041 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21042 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21043 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21044
21045 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21046 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21047 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21048 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21049 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21050
21051 @item void flush_i_cache()
21052 @findex flush_i_cache
21053 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21054 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21055 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21056
21057 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21058 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21059 @end table
21060
21061 @noindent
21062 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21063
21064 @table @code
21065 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21066 @findex memset
21067 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21068 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21069 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21070 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21071 @end table
21072
21073 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21074 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21075 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21076 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21077
21078
21079 @node Debug Session
21080 @subsection Putting it All Together
21081
21082 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21083 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21084 steps.
21085
21086 @enumerate
21087 @item
21088 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21089 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21090 @display
21091 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21092 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21093 @end display
21094
21095 @item
21096 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21097 procedure is called:
21098
21099 @smallexample
21100 set_debug_traps();
21101 breakpoint();
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21105 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21106 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21107 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21108 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21109 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21110 progress.
21111
21112 @item
21113 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21114 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21118 @end smallexample
21119
21120 @noindent
21121 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21122 function in your program, that function is called when
21123 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21124 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21125 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21126
21127 @item
21128 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21129 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21130
21131 @item
21132 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21133 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21134
21135 @item
21136 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21137 @c document that. FIXME.
21138 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21139 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21140
21141 @item
21142 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21143 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21144
21145 @end enumerate
21146
21147 @node Configurations
21148 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21149
21150 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21151 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21152 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21153
21154 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21155 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21156 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21157 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21158 are quite different from each other.
21159
21160 @menu
21161 * Native::
21162 * Embedded OS::
21163 * Embedded Processors::
21164 * Architectures::
21165 @end menu
21166
21167 @node Native
21168 @section Native
21169
21170 This section describes details specific to particular native
21171 configurations.
21172
21173 @menu
21174 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21175 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21176 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21177 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21178 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21179 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21180 @end menu
21181
21182 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21183 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21184
21185 @cindex libkvm
21186 @cindex kernel memory image
21187 @cindex kernel crash dump
21188
21189 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21190 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21191 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21192 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21193 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21194 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21195 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21196 @code{kvm} target:
21197
21198 @smallexample
21199 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21200 @end smallexample
21201
21202 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21203 argument:
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21207 @end smallexample
21208
21209 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21210 available:
21211
21212 @table @code
21213 @kindex kvm
21214 @item kvm pcb
21215 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21216
21217 @item kvm proc
21218 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21219 modern FreeBSD systems.
21220 @end table
21221
21222 @node SVR4 Process Information
21223 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21224 @cindex /proc
21225 @cindex examine process image
21226 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21227
21228 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21229 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21230 process using file-system subroutines.
21231
21232 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21233 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21234 information about the process running your program, or about any
21235 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21236 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21237
21238 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21239 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21240
21241 @table @code
21242 @kindex info proc
21243 @cindex process ID
21244 @item info proc
21245 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21246 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21247 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21248 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21249 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21250 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21251 executable file's absolute file name.
21252
21253 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21254 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21255 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21256 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21257 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21258 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21259
21260 @item info proc cmdline
21261 @cindex info proc cmdline
21262 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21263 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21264
21265 @item info proc cwd
21266 @cindex info proc cwd
21267 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21268 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21269
21270 @item info proc exe
21271 @cindex info proc exe
21272 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21273 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21274
21275 @item info proc mappings
21276 @cindex memory address space mappings
21277 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21278 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21279 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21280 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21281 memory access rights to that range.
21282
21283 @item info proc stat
21284 @itemx info proc status
21285 @cindex process detailed status information
21286 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21287 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21288 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21289 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21290 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21291 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21292 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21293
21294 @item info proc all
21295 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21296 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21297
21298 @ignore
21299 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21300 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21301 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21302 @kindex info proc times
21303 @item info proc times
21304 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21305 its children.
21306
21307 @kindex info proc id
21308 @item info proc id
21309 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21310 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21311 @end ignore
21312
21313 @item set procfs-trace
21314 @kindex set procfs-trace
21315 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21316 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21317
21318 @item show procfs-trace
21319 @kindex show procfs-trace
21320 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21321
21322 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21323 @kindex set procfs-file
21324 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21325 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21326 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21327 standard output.
21328
21329 @item show procfs-file
21330 @kindex show procfs-file
21331 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21332
21333 @item proc-trace-entry
21334 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21335 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21336 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21337 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21338 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21339 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21340 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21341 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21342 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21343
21344 @item info pidlist
21345 @kindex info pidlist
21346 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21347 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21348 processes and all the threads within each process.
21349
21350 @item info meminfo
21351 @kindex info meminfo
21352 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21353 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21354 @end table
21355
21356 @node DJGPP Native
21357 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21358 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21359 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21360 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21361
21362 @cindex DPMI
21363 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21364 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21365 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21366 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21367
21368 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21369 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21370 subsection describes those commands.
21371
21372 @table @code
21373 @kindex info dos
21374 @item info dos
21375 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21376 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21377
21378 @kindex sysinfo
21379 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21380 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21381 @item info dos sysinfo
21382 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21383 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21384 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21385
21386 @cindex GDT
21387 @cindex LDT
21388 @cindex IDT
21389 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21390 @cindex descriptor tables display
21391 @item info dos gdt
21392 @itemx info dos ldt
21393 @itemx info dos idt
21394 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21395 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21396 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21397 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21398 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21399 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21400 rights.
21401
21402 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21403 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21404 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21405 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21406 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21407
21408 @cindex garbled pointers
21409 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21410 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21411 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21412 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21413 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21414 debugged program's data segment:
21415
21416 @smallexample
21417 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21418 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21419 @end smallexample
21420
21421 @noindent
21422 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21423 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21424
21425 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21426 @item info dos pde
21427 @itemx info dos pte
21428 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21429 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21430 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21431 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21432 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21433 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21434 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21435 that is currently in use.
21436
21437 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21438 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21439 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21440 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21441 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21442 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21443 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21444
21445 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21446 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21447 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21448 controller.
21449
21450 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21451
21452 @cindex physical address from linear address
21453 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21454 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21455 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21456 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21457 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21458 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21459 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21460
21461 @smallexample
21462 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21463 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21464 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21465 @end smallexample
21466
21467 @noindent
21468 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21469 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21470 attributes of that page.
21471
21472 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21473 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21474 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21475 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21476 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21477 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21478
21479 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21480 transfer buffer:
21481
21482 @smallexample
21483 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21484 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21485 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 @noindent
21489 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21490 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21491 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21492 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21493 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21494
21495 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21496 @end table
21497
21498 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21499 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21500 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21501 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21502
21503 @table @code
21504 @kindex set com1base
21505 @kindex set com1irq
21506 @kindex set com2base
21507 @kindex set com2irq
21508 @kindex set com3base
21509 @kindex set com3irq
21510 @kindex set com4base
21511 @kindex set com4irq
21512 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21513 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21514 port.
21515
21516 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21517 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21518 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21519
21520 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21521 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21522 other 3 COM ports.
21523
21524 @kindex show com1base
21525 @kindex show com1irq
21526 @kindex show com2base
21527 @kindex show com2irq
21528 @kindex show com3base
21529 @kindex show com3irq
21530 @kindex show com4base
21531 @kindex show com4irq
21532 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21533 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21534 lines used by the COM ports.
21535
21536 @item info serial
21537 @kindex info serial
21538 @cindex DOS serial port status
21539 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21540 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21541 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21542 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21543 @end table
21544
21545
21546 @node Cygwin Native
21547 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21548 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21549 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21550 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21551
21552 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21553 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21554
21555 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21556 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21557 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21558 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21559 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21560 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21561 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21562 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21563
21564 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21565 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21566 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21567
21568 @table @code
21569 @kindex info w32
21570 @item info w32
21571 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21572 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21573
21574 @item info w32 selector
21575 This command displays information returned by
21576 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21577 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21578 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21579 Without argument, this command displays information
21580 about the six segment registers.
21581
21582 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21583 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21584 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21585 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21586
21587 @kindex signal-event
21588 @item signal-event @var{id}
21589 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21590 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21591
21592 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21593 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21594 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21595 (for x86_64 versions):
21596
21597 @itemize @minus
21598 @item
21599 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21600 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21601 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21602
21603 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21604 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21605 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21606 to attach.
21607
21608 @item
21609 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21610 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21611 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21612 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21613 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21614 @end itemize
21615
21616 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21617 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21618 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21619 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21620 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21621 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21622 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21623 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21624 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21625 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21626 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21627
21628 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21629 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21630 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21631 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21632
21633 @kindex set new-console
21634 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21635 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21636 be started in a new console on next start.
21637 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21638 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21639
21640 @kindex show new-console
21641 @item show new-console
21642 Displays whether a new console is used
21643 when the debuggee is started.
21644
21645 @kindex set new-group
21646 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21647 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21648 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21649 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21650 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21651
21652 @kindex show new-group
21653 @item show new-group
21654 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21655
21656 @kindex set debugevents
21657 @item set debugevents
21658 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21659 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21660 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21661 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21662 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21663
21664 @kindex set debugexec
21665 @item set debugexec
21666 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21667 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21668
21669 @kindex set debugexceptions
21670 @item set debugexceptions
21671 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21672 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21673
21674 @kindex set debugmemory
21675 @item set debugmemory
21676 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21677 and writes by the debugger.
21678
21679 @kindex set shell
21680 @item set shell
21681 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21682 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21683
21684 @kindex show shell
21685 @item show shell
21686 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21687
21688 @end table
21689
21690 @menu
21691 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21692 @end menu
21693
21694 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21695 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21696 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21697 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21698
21699 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21700 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21701 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21702 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21703 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21704 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21705 ``minimal symbols''.
21706
21707 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21708 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21709 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21710 program run once to completion.
21711
21712 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21713
21714 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21715 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21716 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21717 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21718 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21719 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21720 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21721 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21722 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21723
21724 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21725 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21726 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21727 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21728 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21729 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21730
21731 @smallexample
21732 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21733 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21734
21735 Non-debugging symbols:
21736 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21737 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21738 @end smallexample
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21742 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21743
21744 Non-debugging symbols:
21745 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21746 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21747 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21748 [etc...]
21749 @end smallexample
21750
21751 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21752
21753 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21754 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21755 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21756 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21757 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21758 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21759 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21760
21761 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21762 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21763 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21764 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21765 problem:
21766
21767 @smallexample
21768 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21769 $1 = 268572168
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 @smallexample
21773 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21774 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21775 @end smallexample
21776
21777 And two possible solutions:
21778
21779 @smallexample
21780 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21781 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 @smallexample
21785 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21786 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21787 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21788 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21789 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21790 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21791 @end smallexample
21792
21793 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21794 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21795 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21796 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21797 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21798
21799 @smallexample
21800 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21801 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21802 @end smallexample
21803
21804 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21805 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21806 safe.
21807
21808 @node Hurd Native
21809 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21810 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21811
21812 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21813 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21814
21815 @table @code
21816 @item set signals
21817 @itemx set sigs
21818 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21819 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21820 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21821 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21822 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21823 @code{signals}.
21824
21825 @item show signals
21826 @itemx show sigs
21827 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21828 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21829 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21830
21831 @item set signal-thread
21832 @itemx set sigthread
21833 @kindex set signal-thread
21834 @kindex set sigthread
21835 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21836 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21837 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21838 signal-thread}.
21839
21840 @item show signal-thread
21841 @itemx show sigthread
21842 @kindex show signal-thread
21843 @kindex show sigthread
21844 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21845 delivered a signal.
21846
21847 @item set stopped
21848 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21849 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21850 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21851 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21852
21853 @item show stopped
21854 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21855 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21856 stopped.
21857
21858 @item set exceptions
21859 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21860 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21861 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21862 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21863 trapping on.
21864
21865 @item show exceptions
21866 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21867 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21868
21869 @item set task pause
21870 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21871 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21872 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21873 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21874 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21875 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21876 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21877 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21878 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21879
21880 @item show task pause
21881 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21882 Show the current state of task suspension.
21883
21884 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21885 @cindex task suspend count
21886 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21887 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21888 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21889
21890 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21891 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21892
21893 @item set task exception-port
21894 @itemx set task excp
21895 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21896 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21897 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21898 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21899
21900 @item set noninvasive
21901 @cindex noninvasive task options
21902 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21903 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21904 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21905 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21906
21907 @item info send-rights
21908 @itemx info receive-rights
21909 @itemx info port-rights
21910 @itemx info port-sets
21911 @itemx info dead-names
21912 @itemx info ports
21913 @itemx info psets
21914 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21915 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21916 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21917 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21918 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21919 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21920 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21921 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21922 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21923
21924 @item set thread pause
21925 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21926 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21927 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21928 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21929 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21930 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21931 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21932 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21933 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21934 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21935 only the current thread.
21936
21937 @item show thread pause
21938 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21939 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21940
21941 @item set thread run
21942 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21943
21944 @item show thread run
21945 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21946
21947 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21948 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21949 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21950 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21951 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21952 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21953 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21954
21955 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21956 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21957 detaching.
21958
21959 @item set thread exception-port
21960 @itemx set thread excp
21961 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21962 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21963 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21964
21965 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21966 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21967 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21968 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21969
21970 @item set thread default
21971 @itemx show thread default
21972 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21973 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21974 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21975 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21976 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21977 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21978 the non-default commands.
21979 @end table
21980
21981 @node Darwin
21982 @subsection Darwin
21983 @cindex Darwin
21984
21985 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21986
21987 @table @code
21988 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21989 @kindex set debug darwin
21990 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21991 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21992
21993 @item show debug darwin
21994 @kindex show debug darwin
21995 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21996
21997 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21998 @kindex set debug mach-o
21999 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22000 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22001 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22002 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22003 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22004 usage.
22005
22006 @item show debug mach-o
22007 @kindex show debug mach-o
22008 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22009
22010 @item set mach-exceptions on
22011 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22012 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22013 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22014 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22015 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22016 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22017
22018 @item show mach-exceptions
22019 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22020 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22021 @end table
22022
22023
22024 @node Embedded OS
22025 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22026
22027 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22028 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22029 architectures.
22030
22031 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22032 various real-time operating systems.
22033
22034 @node Embedded Processors
22035 @section Embedded Processors
22036
22037 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22038 configurations.
22039
22040 @cindex send command to simulator
22041 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22042 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22043
22044 @table @code
22045 @item sim @var{command}
22046 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22047 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22048 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22049 acceptable commands.
22050 @end table
22051
22052
22053 @menu
22054 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22055 * ARM:: ARM
22056 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22057 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22058 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22059 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22060 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22061 * CRIS:: CRIS
22062 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22063 @end menu
22064
22065 @node ARC
22066 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22067 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22068 @cindex ARC specific commands
22069 @cindex ARC600
22070 @cindex ARC700
22071 @cindex ARC EM
22072 @cindex ARC HS
22073
22074 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22075
22076 @table @code
22077 @item set debug arc
22078 @kindex set debug arc
22079 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22080 default) and 1 for debug messages. At present higher values offer no further
22081 messages.
22082
22083 @item show debug arc
22084 @kindex show debug arc
22085 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22086
22087 @end table
22088
22089 @node ARM
22090 @subsection ARM
22091
22092 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22093
22094 @table @code
22095 @item set arm disassembler
22096 @kindex set arm
22097 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22098 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22099
22100 @item show arm disassembler
22101 @kindex show arm
22102 Show the current disassembly style.
22103
22104 @item set arm apcs32
22105 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22106 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22107
22108 @item show arm apcs32
22109 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22110
22111 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22112 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22113 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22114
22115 @table @code
22116 @item auto
22117 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22118 @item softfpa
22119 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22120 processors.
22121 @item fpa
22122 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22123 @item softvfp
22124 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22125 @item vfp
22126 VFP co-processor.
22127 @end table
22128
22129 @item show arm fpu
22130 Show the current type of the FPU.
22131
22132 @item set arm abi
22133 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22134
22135 @item show arm abi
22136 Show the currently used ABI.
22137
22138 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22139 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22140 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22141 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22142 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22143 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22144 register).
22145
22146 @item show arm fallback-mode
22147 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22148
22149 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22150 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22151 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22152 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22153 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22154
22155 @item show arm force-mode
22156 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22157
22158 @item set debug arm
22159 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22160 target support subsystem.
22161
22162 @item show debug arm
22163 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22164 @end table
22165
22166 @table @code
22167 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22168 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22169
22170 @table @code
22171 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22172 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22173 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22174 The default value is @code{all}.
22175
22176 @table @code
22177 @item none
22178 @item demon
22179 @item angel
22180 @item redboot
22181 @item all
22182 @end table
22183 @end table
22184 @end table
22185
22186 @node M68K
22187 @subsection M68k
22188
22189 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22190
22191 @node MicroBlaze
22192 @subsection MicroBlaze
22193 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22194 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22195
22196 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22197 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22198 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22199 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22200 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22201 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22202 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22203 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22204 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22205 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22206 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22207
22208 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22209
22210 @table @code
22211 @item target remote :1234
22212 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22213 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22214
22215 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22216 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22217 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22218
22219 @item load
22220 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22221
22222 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22223 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22224
22225 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22226 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22227 @end table
22228
22229 @node MIPS Embedded
22230 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22231
22232 @noindent
22233 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22234
22235 @table @code
22236 @item set mipsfpu double
22237 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22238 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22239 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22240 @itemx show mipsfpu
22241 @kindex set mipsfpu
22242 @kindex show mipsfpu
22243 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22244 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22245 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22246 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22247 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22248 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22249 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22250 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22251 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22252 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22253 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22254 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22255 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22256
22257 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22258 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22259 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22260
22261 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22262 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22263 @end table
22264
22265 @node PowerPC Embedded
22266 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22267
22268 @cindex DVC register
22269 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22270 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22271
22272 @smallexample
22273 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22274 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22275 @end smallexample
22276
22277 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22278 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22279 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22280 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22281 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22282 or newer.
22283
22284 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22285 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22286 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22287 watching variables of scalar types.
22288
22289 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22290 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22291
22292 @smallexample
22293 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22294 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22295 @end smallexample
22296
22297 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22298 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22299
22300 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22301 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22302 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22303 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22304 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22305 use the @code{break-range} command.
22306
22307 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22308
22309 @table @code
22310 @kindex break-range
22311 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22312 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22313 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22314 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22315 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22316 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22317 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22318 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22319 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22320
22321 @kindex set powerpc
22322 @item set powerpc soft-float
22323 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22324 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22325 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22326 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22327
22328 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22329 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22330 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22331 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22332 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22333 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22334 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22335 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22336
22337 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22338 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22339 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22340 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22341 address of its first byte.
22342
22343 @end table
22344
22345 @node AVR
22346 @subsection Atmel AVR
22347 @cindex AVR
22348
22349 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22350 following AVR-specific commands:
22351
22352 @table @code
22353 @item info io_registers
22354 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22355 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22356 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22357 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22358 @end table
22359
22360 @node CRIS
22361 @subsection CRIS
22362 @cindex CRIS
22363
22364 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22365 following CRIS-specific commands:
22366
22367 @table @code
22368 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22369 @cindex CRIS version
22370 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22371 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22372 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22373
22374 @item show cris-version
22375 Show the current CRIS version.
22376
22377 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22378 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22379 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22380 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22381 @code{R59}.
22382
22383 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22384 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22385
22386 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22387 @cindex CRIS mode
22388 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22389 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22390 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22391
22392 @item show cris-mode
22393 Show the current CRIS mode.
22394 @end table
22395
22396 @node Super-H
22397 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22398 @cindex Super-H
22399
22400 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22401 commands:
22402
22403 @table @code
22404 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22405 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22406 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22407 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22408 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22409 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22410 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22411 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22412 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22413 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22414 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22415 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22416
22417 @item show sh calling-convention
22418 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22419 Show the current calling convention setting.
22420
22421 @end table
22422
22423
22424 @node Architectures
22425 @section Architectures
22426
22427 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22428 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22429
22430 @menu
22431 * AArch64::
22432 * i386::
22433 * Alpha::
22434 * MIPS::
22435 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22436 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22437 * PowerPC::
22438 * Nios II::
22439 @end menu
22440
22441 @node AArch64
22442 @subsection AArch64
22443 @cindex AArch64 support
22444
22445 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22446 following special commands:
22447
22448 @table @code
22449 @item set debug aarch64
22450 @kindex set debug aarch64
22451 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22452 messages are to be displayed.
22453
22454 @item show debug aarch64
22455 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22456
22457 @end table
22458
22459 @node i386
22460 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22461
22462 @table @code
22463 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22464 @kindex set struct-convention
22465 @cindex struct return convention
22466 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22467 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22468 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22469 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22470 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22471 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22472 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22473 be returned in a register.
22474
22475 @item show struct-convention
22476 @kindex show struct-convention
22477 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22478 from functions.
22479 @end table
22480
22481
22482 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22483 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22484
22485 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22486 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22487 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22488 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22489 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22490 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22491 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22492
22493 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22494 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22495 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22496 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22497 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22498 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22499
22500 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22501 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22502 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22503
22504 @smallexample
22505 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22506 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22507 @end smallexample
22508
22509 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22510 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22511 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22512 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22513 the pointer.
22514
22515 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22516 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22517 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22518 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22519 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22520
22521 @table @code
22522 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22523 @kindex show mpx bound
22524 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22525
22526 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22527 @kindex set mpx bound
22528 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22529 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22530 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22531 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22532 @end table
22533
22534 @node Alpha
22535 @subsection Alpha
22536
22537 See the following section.
22538
22539 @node MIPS
22540 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22541
22542 @cindex stack on Alpha
22543 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22544 @cindex Alpha stack
22545 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22546 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22547 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22548 find the beginning of a function.
22549
22550 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22551 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22552 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22553 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22554 commands:
22555
22556 @table @code
22557 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22558 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22559 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22560 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22561 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22562 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22563 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22564 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22565
22566 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22567 Display the current limit.
22568 @end table
22569
22570 @noindent
22571 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22572 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22573
22574 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22575 programs:
22576
22577 @table @code
22578 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22579 @kindex set mips abi
22580 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22581 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22582 values of @var{arg} are:
22583
22584 @table @samp
22585 @item auto
22586 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22587 default).
22588 @item o32
22589 @item o64
22590 @item n32
22591 @item n64
22592 @item eabi32
22593 @item eabi64
22594 @end table
22595
22596 @item show mips abi
22597 @kindex show mips abi
22598 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22599
22600 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22601 @kindex set mips compression
22602 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22603 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22604 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22605 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22606 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22607 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22608 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22609 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22610 provided by the executable.
22611
22612 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22613 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22614 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22615 identified as such.
22616
22617 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22618 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22619 implicitly from an executable.
22620
22621 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22622 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22623 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22624 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22625 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22626
22627 @item show mips compression
22628 @kindex show mips compression
22629 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22630 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22631
22632 @item set mipsfpu
22633 @itemx show mipsfpu
22634 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22635
22636 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22637 @kindex set mips mask-address
22638 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22639 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22640 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22641 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22642 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22643
22644 @item show mips mask-address
22645 @kindex show mips mask-address
22646 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22647 not.
22648
22649 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22650 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22651 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22652 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22653 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22654 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22655
22656 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22657 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22658 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22659
22660 @item set debug mips
22661 @kindex set debug mips
22662 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22663 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22664
22665 @item show debug mips
22666 @kindex show debug mips
22667 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22668 @end table
22669
22670
22671 @node HPPA
22672 @subsection HPPA
22673 @cindex HPPA support
22674
22675 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22676 following special commands:
22677
22678 @table @code
22679 @item set debug hppa
22680 @kindex set debug hppa
22681 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22682 messages are to be displayed.
22683
22684 @item show debug hppa
22685 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22686
22687 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22688 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22689 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22690 given @var{address}.
22691
22692 @end table
22693
22694
22695 @node SPU
22696 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22697 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22698 @cindex SPU
22699
22700 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22701 it provides the following special commands:
22702
22703 @table @code
22704 @item info spu event
22705 @kindex info spu
22706 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22707 and pending event status.
22708
22709 @item info spu signal
22710 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22711 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22712 notification channels.
22713
22714 @item info spu mailbox
22715 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22716 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22717 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22718
22719 @item info spu dma
22720 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22721 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22722 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22723
22724 @item info spu proxydma
22725 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22726 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22727 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22728
22729 @end table
22730
22731 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22732 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22733 special commands:
22734
22735 @table @code
22736 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22737 @kindex set spu
22738 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22739 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22740 function. The default is @code{off}.
22741
22742 @item show spu stop-on-load
22743 @kindex show spu
22744 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22745
22746 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22747 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22748 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22749 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22750 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22751 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22752
22753 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22754 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22755
22756 @end table
22757
22758 @node PowerPC
22759 @subsection PowerPC
22760 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22761
22762 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22763 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22764 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22765 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22766 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22767
22768 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22769 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22770 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22771
22772 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22773 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22774
22775 @node Nios II
22776 @subsection Nios II
22777 @cindex Nios II architecture
22778
22779 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22780 it provides the following special commands:
22781
22782 @table @code
22783
22784 @item set debug nios2
22785 @kindex set debug nios2
22786 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22787 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22788
22789 @item show debug nios2
22790 @kindex show debug nios2
22791 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22792 @end table
22793
22794 @node Controlling GDB
22795 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22796
22797 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22798 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22799 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22800 described here.
22801
22802 @menu
22803 * Prompt:: Prompt
22804 * Editing:: Command editing
22805 * Command History:: Command history
22806 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22807 * Numbers:: Numbers
22808 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22809 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22810 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22811 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22812 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22813 @end menu
22814
22815 @node Prompt
22816 @section Prompt
22817
22818 @cindex prompt
22819
22820 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22821 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22822 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22823 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22824 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22825 which one you are talking to.
22826
22827 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22828 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22829 or a prompt that does not.
22830
22831 @table @code
22832 @kindex set prompt
22833 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22834 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22835
22836 @kindex show prompt
22837 @item show prompt
22838 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22839 @end table
22840
22841 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22842 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22843 are:
22844
22845 @table @code
22846 @kindex set extended-prompt
22847 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22848 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22849 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22850 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22851 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22852 is displayed.
22853
22854 For example:
22855
22856 @smallexample
22857 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22858 @end smallexample
22859
22860 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22861 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22862
22863 @kindex show extended-prompt
22864 @item show extended-prompt
22865 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22866 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22867 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22868 @end table
22869
22870 @node Editing
22871 @section Command Editing
22872 @cindex readline
22873 @cindex command line editing
22874
22875 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22876 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22877 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22878 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22879 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22880 debugging sessions.
22881
22882 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22883 command @code{set}.
22884
22885 @table @code
22886 @kindex set editing
22887 @cindex editing
22888 @item set editing
22889 @itemx set editing on
22890 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22891
22892 @item set editing off
22893 Disable command line editing.
22894
22895 @kindex show editing
22896 @item show editing
22897 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22898 @end table
22899
22900 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22901 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22902 @end ifset
22903 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22904 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22905 @end ifclear
22906 for more details about the Readline
22907 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22908 encouraged to read that chapter.
22909
22910 @node Command History
22911 @section Command History
22912 @cindex command history
22913
22914 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22915 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22916 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22917 history facility.
22918
22919 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22920 package, to provide the history facility.
22921 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22922 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22923 @end ifset
22924 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22925 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22926 @end ifclear
22927 for the detailed description of the History library.
22928
22929 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22930 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22931 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22932 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22933 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22934 pressed on a line by itself.
22935
22936 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22937 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22938 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22939 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22940
22941 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22942 history.
22943
22944 @table @code
22945 @cindex history substitution
22946 @cindex history file
22947 @kindex set history filename
22948 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22949 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22950 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22951 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22952 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22953 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22954 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22955 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22956 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22957 is not set.
22958
22959 @cindex save command history
22960 @kindex set history save
22961 @item set history save
22962 @itemx set history save on
22963 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22964 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22965
22966 @item set history save off
22967 Stop recording command history in a file.
22968
22969 @cindex history size
22970 @kindex set history size
22971 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22972 @item set history size @var{size}
22973 @itemx set history size unlimited
22974 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22975 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22976 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22977 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22978 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22979 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22980
22981 @cindex remove duplicate history
22982 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22983 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22984 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22985 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22986 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22987 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22988 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22989 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22990 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22991
22992 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22993 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22994
22995 @end table
22996
22997 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22998 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22999 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23000 @end ifset
23001 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23002 @xref{Event Designators},
23003 @end ifclear
23004 for more details.
23005
23006 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23007 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23008 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23009 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23010 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23011 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23012 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23013 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23014
23015 The commands to control history expansion are:
23016
23017 @table @code
23018 @item set history expansion on
23019 @itemx set history expansion
23020 @kindex set history expansion
23021 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23022
23023 @item set history expansion off
23024 Disable history expansion.
23025
23026 @c @group
23027 @kindex show history
23028 @item show history
23029 @itemx show history filename
23030 @itemx show history save
23031 @itemx show history size
23032 @itemx show history expansion
23033 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23034 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23035 @c @end group
23036 @end table
23037
23038 @table @code
23039 @kindex show commands
23040 @cindex show last commands
23041 @cindex display command history
23042 @item show commands
23043 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23044
23045 @item show commands @var{n}
23046 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23047
23048 @item show commands +
23049 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23050 @end table
23051
23052 @node Screen Size
23053 @section Screen Size
23054 @cindex size of screen
23055 @cindex screen size
23056 @cindex pagination
23057 @cindex page size
23058 @cindex pauses in output
23059
23060 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23061 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23062 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23063 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23064 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23065 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23066 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23067 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23068
23069 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23070 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23071 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23072 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23073 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23074 width} commands:
23075
23076 @table @code
23077 @kindex set height
23078 @kindex set width
23079 @kindex show width
23080 @kindex show height
23081 @item set height @var{lpp}
23082 @itemx set height unlimited
23083 @itemx show height
23084 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23085 @itemx set width unlimited
23086 @itemx show width
23087 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23088 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23089 commands display the current settings.
23090
23091 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23092 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23093 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23094 buffer.
23095
23096 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23097 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23098
23099 @item set pagination on
23100 @itemx set pagination off
23101 @kindex set pagination
23102 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23103 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23104 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23105 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23106
23107 @item show pagination
23108 @kindex show pagination
23109 Show the current pagination mode.
23110 @end table
23111
23112 @node Numbers
23113 @section Numbers
23114 @cindex number representation
23115 @cindex entering numbers
23116
23117 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23118 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23119 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23120 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23121 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23122 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23123 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23124 both input and output with the commands described below.
23125
23126 @table @code
23127 @kindex set input-radix
23128 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23129 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23130 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23131 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23132 example, any of
23133
23134 @smallexample
23135 set input-radix 012
23136 set input-radix 10.
23137 set input-radix 0xa
23138 @end smallexample
23139
23140 @noindent
23141 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23142 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23143 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23144 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23145 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23146 change the radix.
23147
23148 @kindex set output-radix
23149 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23150 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23151 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23152 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23153
23154 @kindex show input-radix
23155 @item show input-radix
23156 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23157
23158 @kindex show output-radix
23159 @item show output-radix
23160 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23161
23162 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23163 @itemx show radix
23164 @kindex set radix
23165 @kindex show radix
23166 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23167 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23168 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23169 default value of 10.
23170
23171 @end table
23172
23173 @node ABI
23174 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23175
23176 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23177 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23178 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23179 current ABI.
23180
23181 @cindex OS ABI
23182 @kindex set osabi
23183 @kindex show osabi
23184 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23185
23186 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23187 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23188 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23189 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23190 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23191 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23192 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23193 platform provides.
23194
23195 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23196 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23197 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23198 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23199
23200 @table @code
23201 @item show osabi
23202 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23203
23204 @item set osabi
23205 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23206
23207 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23208 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23209 @end table
23210
23211 @cindex float promotion
23212
23213 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23214 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23215 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23216 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23217 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23218 @code{double} and then passed.
23219
23220 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23221 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23222 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23223
23224 @table @code
23225 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23226 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23227 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23228 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23229 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23230
23231 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23232 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23233 functions.
23234
23235 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23236 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23237 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23238 @end table
23239
23240 @kindex set cp-abi
23241 @kindex show cp-abi
23242 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23243 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23244 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23245 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23246 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23247 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23248 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23249 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23250 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23251 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23252 ``auto''.
23253
23254 @table @code
23255 @item show cp-abi
23256 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23257
23258 @item set cp-abi
23259 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23260
23261 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23262 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23263 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23264 @end table
23265
23266 @node Auto-loading
23267 @section Automatically loading associated files
23268 @cindex auto-loading
23269
23270 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23271 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23272 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23273 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23274 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23275 sources).
23276
23277 @menu
23278 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23279 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23280
23281 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23282 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23283 @end menu
23284
23285 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23286 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23287 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23288
23289 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23290 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23291 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23292
23293 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23294 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23295
23296 @table @code
23297 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23298 @kindex set auto-load off
23299 @item set auto-load off
23300 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23301 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23302 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23303 @smallexample
23304 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23305 @end smallexample
23306
23307 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23308 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23309 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23310 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23311 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23312 @code{set auto-load no}.
23313
23314 @anchor{show auto-load}
23315 @kindex show auto-load
23316 @item show auto-load
23317 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23318 or disabled.
23319
23320 @smallexample
23321 (gdb) show auto-load
23322 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23323 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23324 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23325 is on.
23326 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23327 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23328 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23329 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23330 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23331 @end smallexample
23332
23333 @anchor{info auto-load}
23334 @kindex info auto-load
23335 @item info auto-load
23336 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23337 not.
23338
23339 @smallexample
23340 (gdb) info auto-load
23341 gdb-scripts:
23342 Loaded Script
23343 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23344 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23345 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23346 loaded.
23347 python-scripts:
23348 Loaded Script
23349 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23350 @end smallexample
23351 @end table
23352
23353 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23354
23355 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23356 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23357 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23358 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23359 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23360 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23361 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23362 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23363 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23364 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23365 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23366 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23367 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23368 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23369 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23370 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23371 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23372 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23373 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23374 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23375 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23376 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23377 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23378 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23379 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23380 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23381 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23382 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23383 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23384 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23385 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23386 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23387 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23388 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23389 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23390 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23391 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23392 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23393 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23394 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23395 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23396 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23397 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23398 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23399 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23400 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23401 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23402 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23403 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23404 @end multitable
23405
23406 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23407 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23408 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23409
23410 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23411 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23412 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23413
23414 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23415 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23416
23417 @table @code
23418 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23419 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23420 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23421 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23422 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23423
23424 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23425 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23426 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23427 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23428 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23429
23430 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23431 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23432 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23433 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23434 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23435 @end table
23436
23437 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23438 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23439 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23440
23441 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23442
23443 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23444 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23445
23446 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23447 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23448 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23449 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23450 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23451 library.
23452
23453 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23454 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23455
23456 @table @code
23457 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23458 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23459 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23460 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23461
23462 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23463 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23464 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23465 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23466 enabled or disabled.
23467
23468 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23469 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23470 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23471 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23472 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23473 @end table
23474
23475 @node Auto-loading safe path
23476 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23477 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23478
23479 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23480 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23481 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23482 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23483 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23484
23485 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23486 get loaded:
23487
23488 @smallexample
23489 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23490 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23491 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23492 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23493 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23494 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23495 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23496 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23497 @end smallexample
23498
23499 @noindent
23500 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23501 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23502
23503 @smallexample
23504 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23505 @end smallexample
23506
23507 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23508
23509 @table @code
23510 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23511 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23512 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23513 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23514 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23515 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23516 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23517 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23518 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23519 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23520
23521 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23522 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23523 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23524
23525 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23526 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23527 @item show auto-load safe-path
23528 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23529 scripts.
23530
23531 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23532 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23533 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23534 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23535 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23536 by the host platform path separator in use.
23537 @end table
23538
23539 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23540 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23541 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23542 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23543 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23544
23545 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23546 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23547 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23548 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23549 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23550 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23551 init file in the current directory
23552 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23553
23554 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23555 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23556
23557 @table @asis
23558 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23559 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23560 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23561 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23562
23563 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23564 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23565 @value{GDBN} session.
23566
23567 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23568 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23569 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23570 from trusted sources.
23571
23572 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23573 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23574 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23575 trusted sources.
23576 @end table
23577
23578 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23579 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23580
23581 @table @asis
23582 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23583 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23584
23585 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23586 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23587 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23588 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23589 @end table
23590
23591 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23592 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23593 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23594 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23595 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23596 recommended to be entered.
23597
23598 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23599 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23600 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23601
23602 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23603 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23604 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23605 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23606 be printed.
23607
23608 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23609 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23610 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23611
23612 @smallexample
23613 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23614 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23615 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23616 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23617 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23618 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23619 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23620 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23621 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23622 @end smallexample
23623
23624 @table @code
23625 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23626 @kindex set debug auto-load
23627 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23628 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23629
23630 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23631 @kindex show debug auto-load
23632 @item show debug auto-load
23633 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23634 on or off.
23635 @end table
23636
23637 @node Messages/Warnings
23638 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23639
23640 @cindex verbose operation
23641 @cindex optional warnings
23642 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23643 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23644 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23645 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23646
23647 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23648 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23649 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23650
23651 @table @code
23652 @kindex set verbose
23653 @item set verbose on
23654 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23655
23656 @item set verbose off
23657 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23658
23659 @kindex show verbose
23660 @item show verbose
23661 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23662 @end table
23663
23664 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23665 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23666 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23667 Symbol Files}).
23668
23669 @table @code
23670
23671 @kindex set complaints
23672 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23673 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23674 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23675 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23676 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23677
23678 @kindex show complaints
23679 @item show complaints
23680 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23681
23682 @end table
23683
23684 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23685 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23686 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23687 you try to run a program which is already running:
23688
23689 @smallexample
23690 (@value{GDBP}) run
23691 The program being debugged has been started already.
23692 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23693 @end smallexample
23694
23695 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23696 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23697
23698 @table @code
23699
23700 @kindex set confirm
23701 @cindex flinching
23702 @cindex confirmation
23703 @cindex stupid questions
23704 @item set confirm off
23705 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23706 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23707 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23708
23709 @item set confirm on
23710 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23711
23712 @kindex show confirm
23713 @item show confirm
23714 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23715
23716 @end table
23717
23718 @cindex command tracing
23719 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23720 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23721 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23722 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23723
23724 @table @code
23725 @kindex set trace-commands
23726 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23727 @item set trace-commands on
23728 Enable command tracing.
23729 @item set trace-commands off
23730 Disable command tracing.
23731 @item show trace-commands
23732 Display the current state of command tracing.
23733 @end table
23734
23735 @node Debugging Output
23736 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23737 @cindex optional debugging messages
23738
23739 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23740 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23741 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23742 section documents those commands.
23743
23744 @table @code
23745 @kindex set exec-done-display
23746 @item set exec-done-display
23747 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23748 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23749 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23750 @kindex show exec-done-display
23751 @item show exec-done-display
23752 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23753 notification.
23754 @kindex set debug
23755 @cindex ARM AArch64
23756 @item set debug aarch64
23757 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23758 The default is off.
23759 @kindex show debug
23760 @item show debug aarch64
23761 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23762 ARM AArch64.
23763 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23764 @cindex architecture debugging info
23765 @item set debug arch
23766 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23767 @item show debug arch
23768 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23769 @item set debug aix-solib
23770 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23771 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23772 support module. The default is off.
23773 @item show debug aix-thread
23774 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23775 @item set debug aix-thread
23776 @cindex AIX threads
23777 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23778 module.
23779 @item show debug aix-thread
23780 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23781 @item set debug check-physname
23782 @cindex physname
23783 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23784 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23785 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23786 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23787 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23788 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23789 @item show debug check-physname
23790 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23791 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23792 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23793 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23794 exported symbols. The default is off.
23795 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23796 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23797 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23798 @item set debug dwarf-die
23799 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23800 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23801 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23802 A value of zero turns off the display.
23803 @item show debug dwarf-die
23804 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23805 @item set debug dwarf-line
23806 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23807 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23808 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23809 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23810 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23811 @item show debug dwarf-line
23812 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23813 @item set debug dwarf-read
23814 @cindex DWARF Reading
23815 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23816 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23817 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23818 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23819 @item show debug dwarf-read
23820 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23821 @item set debug displaced
23822 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23823 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23824 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23825 @item show debug displaced
23826 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23827 related to displaced stepping.
23828 @item set debug event
23829 @cindex event debugging info
23830 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23831 default is off.
23832 @item show debug event
23833 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23834 info.
23835 @item set debug expression
23836 @cindex expression debugging info
23837 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23838 expression parsing. The default is off.
23839 @item show debug expression
23840 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23841 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23842 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23843 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23844 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23845 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23846 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23847 @item set debug frame
23848 @cindex frame debugging info
23849 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23850 default is off.
23851 @item show debug frame
23852 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23853 info.
23854 @item set debug gnu-nat
23855 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23856 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23857 @item show debug gnu-nat
23858 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23859 @item set debug infrun
23860 @cindex inferior debugging info
23861 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23862 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23863 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23864 @item show debug infrun
23865 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23866 @item set debug jit
23867 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23868 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23869 @item show debug jit
23870 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23871 @item set debug lin-lwp
23872 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23873 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23874 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23875 @item show debug lin-lwp
23876 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23877 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23878 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23879 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23880 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23881 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23882 @item set debug mach-o
23883 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23884 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23885 processing. The default is off.
23886 @item show debug mach-o
23887 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23888 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23889 @item set debug notification
23890 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23891 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23892 The default is off.
23893 @item show debug notification
23894 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23895 @item set debug observer
23896 @cindex observer debugging info
23897 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23898 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23899 @item show debug observer
23900 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23901 @item set debug overload
23902 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23903 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23904 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23905 is off.
23906 @item show debug overload
23907 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23908 debugging info.
23909 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23910 @cindex debug expression parser
23911 @item set debug parser
23912 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23913 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23914 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23915 details. The default is off.
23916 @item show debug parser
23917 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23918 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23919 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23920 @cindex debug remote protocol
23921 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23922 @cindex display remote packets
23923 @item set debug remote
23924 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23925 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23926 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23927 @item show debug remote
23928 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23929 @item set debug serial
23930 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23931 default is off.
23932 @item show debug serial
23933 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23934 info.
23935 @item set debug solib-frv
23936 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23937 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23938 @item show debug solib-frv
23939 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23940 messages.
23941 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23942 @cindex symbol lookup
23943 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23944 The default is 0 (off).
23945 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23946 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23947 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23948 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23949 @item set debug symfile
23950 @cindex symbol file functions
23951 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23952 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23953 @item show debug symfile
23954 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23955 @item set debug symtab-create
23956 @cindex symbol table creation
23957 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23958 The default is 0 (off).
23959 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23960 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23961 @item show debug symtab-create
23962 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23963 @item set debug target
23964 @cindex target debugging info
23965 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23966 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23967 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23968 value of large memory transfers.
23969 @item show debug target
23970 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23971 info.
23972 @item set debug timestamp
23973 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23974 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23975 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23976 message.
23977 @item show debug timestamp
23978 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23979 debugging info.
23980 @item set debug varobj
23981 @cindex variable object debugging info
23982 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23983 info. The default is off.
23984 @item show debug varobj
23985 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23986 debugging info.
23987 @item set debug xml
23988 @cindex XML parser debugging
23989 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23990 @item show debug xml
23991 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23992 @end table
23993
23994 @node Other Misc Settings
23995 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23996 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23997
23998 @table @code
23999 @kindex set interactive-mode
24000 @item set interactive-mode
24001 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24002 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24003 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24004 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24005 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24006 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24007 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24008 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24009
24010 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24011 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24012 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24013 inside a cygwin window.
24014
24015 @kindex show interactive-mode
24016 @item show interactive-mode
24017 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24018 @end table
24019
24020 @node Extending GDB
24021 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24022 @cindex extending GDB
24023
24024 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24025 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24026 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24027 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24028 being debugged.
24029
24030 @menu
24031 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24032 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24033 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24034 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24035 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24036 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24037 @end menu
24038
24039 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24040 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24041 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24042 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24043 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24044 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24045
24046 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24047 setting:
24048
24049 @table @code
24050 @kindex set script-extension
24051 @kindex show script-extension
24052 @item set script-extension off
24053 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24054
24055 @item set script-extension soft
24056 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24057 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24058 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24059 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24060
24061 @item set script-extension strict
24062 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24063 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24064 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24065
24066 @item show script-extension
24067 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24068
24069 @end table
24070
24071 @node Sequences
24072 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24073
24074 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24075 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24076 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24077 files.
24078
24079 @menu
24080 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24081 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24082 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24083 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24084 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24085 @end menu
24086
24087 @node Define
24088 @subsection User-defined Commands
24089
24090 @cindex user-defined command
24091 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24092 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24093 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24094 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24095 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24096 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24097
24098 @smallexample
24099 define adder
24100 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24101 end
24102 @end smallexample
24103
24104 @noindent
24105 To execute the command use:
24106
24107 @smallexample
24108 adder 1 2 3
24109 @end smallexample
24110
24111 @noindent
24112 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24113 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24114 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24115 functions calls.
24116
24117 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24118 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24119 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24120 been passed.
24121
24122 @smallexample
24123 define adder
24124 if $argc == 2
24125 print $arg0 + $arg1
24126 end
24127 if $argc == 3
24128 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24129 end
24130 end
24131 @end smallexample
24132
24133 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24134 to process a variable number of arguments:
24135
24136 @smallexample
24137 define adder
24138 set $i = 0
24139 set $sum = 0
24140 while $i < $argc
24141 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24142 set $i = $i + 1
24143 end
24144 print $sum
24145 end
24146 @end smallexample
24147
24148 @table @code
24149
24150 @kindex define
24151 @item define @var{commandname}
24152 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24153 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24154 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24155 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24156 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24157 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24158
24159 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24160 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24161 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24162
24163 @kindex document
24164 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24165 @item document @var{commandname}
24166 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24167 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24168 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24169 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24170 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24171 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24172
24173 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24174 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24175 does not change the documentation.
24176
24177 @kindex dont-repeat
24178 @cindex don't repeat command
24179 @item dont-repeat
24180 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24181 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24182 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24183
24184 @kindex help user-defined
24185 @item help user-defined
24186 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24187 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24188 included (if any).
24189
24190 @kindex show user
24191 @item show user
24192 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24193 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24194 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24195 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24196 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24197
24198 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24199 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24200 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24201 @item show max-user-call-depth
24202 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24203 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24204 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24205 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24206 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24207 @end table
24208
24209 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24210 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24211
24212 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24213 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24214 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24215
24216 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24217 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24218 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24219 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24220
24221 @node Hooks
24222 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24223 @cindex command hooks
24224 @cindex hooks, for commands
24225 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24226
24227 @kindex hook
24228 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24229 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24230 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24231 before that command.
24232
24233 @cindex hooks, post-command
24234 @kindex hookpost
24235 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24236 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24237 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24238 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24239 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24240
24241 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24242 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24243
24244 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24245 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24246
24247 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24248 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24249 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24250 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24251 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24252
24253 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24254 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24255 you could define:
24256
24257 @smallexample
24258 define hook-stop
24259 handle SIGALRM nopass
24260 end
24261
24262 define hook-run
24263 handle SIGALRM pass
24264 end
24265
24266 define hook-continue
24267 handle SIGALRM pass
24268 end
24269 @end smallexample
24270
24271 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24272 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24273 you could define:
24274
24275 @smallexample
24276 define hook-echo
24277 echo <<<---
24278 end
24279
24280 define hookpost-echo
24281 echo --->>>\n
24282 end
24283
24284 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24285 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24286 (@value{GDBP})
24287
24288 @end smallexample
24289
24290 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24291 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24292 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24293 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24294 @c or not?
24295 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24296 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24297 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24298
24299 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24300 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24301 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24302
24303 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24304 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24305
24306 @node Command Files
24307 @subsection Command Files
24308
24309 @cindex command files
24310 @cindex scripting commands
24311 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24312 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24313 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24314 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24315 terminal.
24316
24317 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24318 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24319 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24320 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24321 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24322
24323 @table @code
24324 @kindex source
24325 @cindex execute commands from a file
24326 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24327 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24328 @end table
24329
24330 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24331 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24332 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24333 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24334 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24335
24336 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24337 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24338 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24339 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24340 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24341 is not relevant to scripts.
24342
24343 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24344 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24345 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24346 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24347 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24348 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24349 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24350 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24351 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24352 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24353 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24354 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24355 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24356 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24357
24358 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24359 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24360 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24361
24362 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24363 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24364 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24365 when called from command files.
24366
24367 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24368 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24369 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24370 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24371 the next command.
24372
24373 @smallexample
24374 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24375 @end smallexample
24376
24377 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24378 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24379 would be directed to @file{log}.
24380
24381 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24382 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24383 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24384 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24385 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24386 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24387 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24388 conditionally, etc.
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @kindex if
24392 @kindex else
24393 @item if
24394 @itemx else
24395 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24396 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24397 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24398 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24399 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24400 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24401 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24402
24403 @kindex while
24404 @item while
24405 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24406 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24407 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24408 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24409 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24410 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24411
24412 @kindex loop_break
24413 @item loop_break
24414 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24415 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24416 line.
24417
24418 @kindex loop_continue
24419 @item loop_continue
24420 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24421 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24422 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24423 the controlling expression.
24424
24425 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24426 @item end
24427 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24428 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24429 @end table
24430
24431
24432 @node Output
24433 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24434
24435 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24436 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24437 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24438 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24439 want.
24440
24441 @table @code
24442 @kindex echo
24443 @item echo @var{text}
24444 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24445 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24446 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24447 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24448 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24449 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24450 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24451 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24452 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24453 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24454 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24455
24456 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24457 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24458
24459 @smallexample
24460 echo This is some text\n\
24461 which is continued\n\
24462 onto several lines.\n
24463 @end smallexample
24464
24465 produces the same output as
24466
24467 @smallexample
24468 echo This is some text\n
24469 echo which is continued\n
24470 echo onto several lines.\n
24471 @end smallexample
24472
24473 @kindex output
24474 @item output @var{expression}
24475 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24476 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24477 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24478 on expressions.
24479
24480 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24481 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24482 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24483 Formats}, for more information.
24484
24485 @kindex printf
24486 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24487 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24488 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24489 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24490 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24491 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24492 executing the code below:
24493
24494 @smallexample
24495 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24496 @end smallexample
24497
24498 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24499 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24500 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24501 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24502 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24503 printed.
24504
24505 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24506
24507 @smallexample
24508 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24509 @end smallexample
24510
24511 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24512 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24513 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24514
24515 @itemize @bullet
24516 @item
24517 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24518
24519 @item
24520 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24521 width.
24522
24523 @item
24524 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24525 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24526
24527 @item
24528 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24529 supported.
24530
24531 @item
24532 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24533
24534 @item
24535 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24536 @end itemize
24537
24538 @noindent
24539 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24540 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24541 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24542 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24543
24544 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24545 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24546 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24547 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24548 supported.
24549
24550 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24551 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24552 together with a floating point specifier.
24553 letters:
24554
24555 @itemize @bullet
24556 @item
24557 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24558
24559 @item
24560 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24561
24562 @item
24563 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24564 @end itemize
24565
24566 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24567 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24568 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24569
24570 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24571 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24572
24573 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24574 @smallexample
24575 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24576 @end smallexample
24577
24578 @anchor{eval}
24579 @kindex eval
24580 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24581 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24582 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24583
24584 @end table
24585
24586 @node Auto-loading sequences
24587 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24588 @cindex native script auto-loading
24589
24590 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24591 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24592 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24593 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24594
24595 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24596 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24597
24598 @table @code
24599 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24600 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24601 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24602 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24603
24604 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24605 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24606 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24607 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24608 disabled.
24609
24610 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24611 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24612 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24613 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24614 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24615 auto-loaded.
24616 @end table
24617
24618 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24619 matching names are printed.
24620
24621 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24622 @include python.texi
24623
24624 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24625 @include guile.texi
24626
24627 @node Auto-loading extensions
24628 @section Auto-loading extensions
24629 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24630
24631 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24632 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24633 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24634 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24635 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24636
24637 @menu
24638 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24639 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24640 * Which flavor to choose?::
24641 @end menu
24642
24643 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24644 debugging commands and features.
24645
24646 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24647 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24648 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24649 for more information.
24650 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24651 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24652
24653 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24654 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24655
24656 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24657 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24658 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24659 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24660 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24661
24662 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24663 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24664 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24665 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24666
24667 @table @code
24668 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24669 GDB's own command language
24670 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24671 Python
24672 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24673 Guile
24674 @end table
24675
24676 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24677 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24678 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24679 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24680 script in the specified extension language.
24681
24682 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24683 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24684
24685 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24686 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24687
24688 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24689 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24690 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24691 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24692 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24693 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24694
24695 @table @code
24696 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24697 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24698 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24699 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24700 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24701 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24702
24703 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24704 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24705
24706 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24707 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24708 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24709 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24710
24711 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24712 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24713 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24714 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24715 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24716 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24717 platform.
24718
24719 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24720 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24721 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24722
24723 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24724 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24725 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24726 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24727
24728 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24729 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24730 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24731 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24732 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24733 @end table
24734
24735 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24736 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24737 @var{objfile} is opened.
24738 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24739 is evaluated more than once.
24740
24741 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24742 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24743 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24744
24745 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24746 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24747 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24748 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24749 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24750 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24751 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24752
24753 The following entries are supported:
24754
24755 @table @code
24756 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24757 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24758 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24759 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24760 @end table
24761
24762 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24763
24764 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24765 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24766 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24767 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24768 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24769
24770 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24771 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24772
24773 @example
24774 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24775 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24776 asm("\
24777 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24778 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24779 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24780 .popsection \n\
24781 ");
24782 @end example
24783
24784 @noindent
24785 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24786 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24787
24788 @example
24789 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24790 @end example
24791
24792 The script name may include directories if desired.
24793
24794 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24795 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24796
24797 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24798 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24799 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24800 will remove duplicates.
24801
24802 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24803
24804 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24805 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24806 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24807 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24808 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24809 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24810 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24811 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24812 on its name.
24813
24814 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24815 testsuite.
24816
24817 @example
24818 #include "symcat.h"
24819 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24820 asm(
24821 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24822 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24823 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24824 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24825 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24826 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24827 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24828 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24829 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24830 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24831 ".byte 0\n"
24832 ".popsection\n"
24833 );
24834 @end example
24835
24836 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24837 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24838 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24839 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24840
24841 @node Which flavor to choose?
24842 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24843
24844 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24845 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24846
24847 @noindent
24848 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24849
24850 @itemize @bullet
24851 @item
24852 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24853
24854 @item
24855 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24856
24857 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24858 in the source search path.
24859 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24860 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24861
24862 @item
24863 Doesn't require source code additions.
24864 @end itemize
24865
24866 @noindent
24867 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24868
24869 @itemize @bullet
24870 @item
24871 Works with static linking.
24872
24873 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24874 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24875 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24876 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24877 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24878
24879 @item
24880 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24881
24882 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24883 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24884
24885 @item
24886 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24887
24888 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24889 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24890 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24891 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24892 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24893 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24894 @end itemize
24895
24896 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24897 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24898
24899 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24900 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24901 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24902
24903 @subsection Python comes first
24904
24905 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24906 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24907 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24908 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24909 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24910 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24911 pretty-printed form of a value).
24912 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24913 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24914 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24915
24916 @node Aliases
24917 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24918 @cindex aliases for commands
24919
24920 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24921 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24922 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24923 that involves less typing.
24924
24925 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24926 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24927 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24928
24929 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24930 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24931 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24932
24933 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24934
24935 @table @code
24936
24937 @kindex alias
24938 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24939
24940 @end table
24941
24942 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24943 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24944 underscores.
24945
24946 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24947 that is being aliased.
24948
24949 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24950 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24951 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24952
24953 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24954 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24955
24956 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24957 of a command so that there is less to type.
24958 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24959 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24960 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24961 The following will accomplish this.
24962
24963 @smallexample
24964 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24965 @end smallexample
24966
24967 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24968 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24969 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24970 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24971
24972 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24973 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24974 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24975 of a command.
24976
24977 @smallexample
24978 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24979 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24980 (gdb) set p elms 20
24981 (gdb) show p elms
24982 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24983 @end smallexample
24984
24985 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24986 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24987 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24988
24989 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24990 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24991
24992 @smallexample
24993 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24994 @end smallexample
24995
24996 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24997 alias for a more complex command.
24998 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24999
25000 @smallexample
25001 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25002 (gdb) spe 20
25003 @end smallexample
25004
25005 @node Interpreters
25006 @chapter Command Interpreters
25007 @cindex command interpreters
25008
25009 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25010 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25011 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25012
25013 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25014 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25015 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25016 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25017
25018 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25019 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25020 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25021 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25022
25023 @table @code
25024 @item console
25025 @cindex console interpreter
25026 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25027 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25028 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25029
25030 @item mi
25031 @cindex mi interpreter
25032 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25033 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25034 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25035 Interface}.
25036
25037 @item mi2
25038 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25039 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25040
25041 @item mi1
25042 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25043 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25044
25045 @end table
25046
25047 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25048
25049 @kindex interpreter-exec
25050 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25051 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25052 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25053
25054 @smallexample
25055 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25056 @end smallexample
25057
25058 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25059 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25060
25061 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25062 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25063 permanently.
25064
25065 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25066
25067 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25068 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25069 device (usually a tty).
25070
25071 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25072 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25073 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25074 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25075 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25076 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25077 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25078 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25079 the separate MI interpreter.
25080
25081 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25082 @code{new-ui} command:
25083
25084 @kindex new-ui
25085 @cindex new user interface
25086 @smallexample
25087 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25088 @end smallexample
25089
25090 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25091 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25092 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25093 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25094 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25095 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25099 @end smallexample
25100
25101 @noindent
25102 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25103
25104 @node TUI
25105 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25106 @cindex TUI
25107 @cindex Text User Interface
25108
25109 @menu
25110 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25111 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25112 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25113 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25114 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25115 @end menu
25116
25117 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25118 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25119 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25120 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25121 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25122 is available.
25123
25124 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25125 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25126 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25127 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25128 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25129 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25130
25131 @node TUI Overview
25132 @section TUI Overview
25133
25134 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25135
25136 @table @emph
25137 @item command
25138 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25139 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25140 managed using readline.
25141
25142 @item source
25143 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25144 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25145
25146 @item assembly
25147 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25148
25149 @item register
25150 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25151 when their values change.
25152 @end table
25153
25154 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25155 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25156 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25157 indicates the breakpoint type:
25158
25159 @table @code
25160 @item B
25161 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25162
25163 @item b
25164 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25165
25166 @item H
25167 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25168
25169 @item h
25170 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25171 @end table
25172
25173 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25174
25175 @table @code
25176 @item +
25177 Breakpoint is enabled.
25178
25179 @item -
25180 Breakpoint is disabled.
25181 @end table
25182
25183 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25184 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25185 changes.
25186
25187 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25188 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25189 layouts:
25190
25191 @itemize @bullet
25192 @item
25193 source only,
25194
25195 @item
25196 assembly only,
25197
25198 @item
25199 source and assembly,
25200
25201 @item
25202 source and registers, or
25203
25204 @item
25205 assembly and registers.
25206 @end itemize
25207
25208 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25209
25210 @table @emph
25211 @item target
25212 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25213 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25214
25215 @item process
25216 Gives the current process or thread number.
25217 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25218
25219 @item function
25220 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25221 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25222 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25223 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25224
25225 @item line
25226 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25227 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25228
25229 @item pc
25230 Indicates the current program counter address.
25231 @end table
25232
25233 @node TUI Keys
25234 @section TUI Key Bindings
25235 @cindex TUI key bindings
25236
25237 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25238 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25239 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25240 @end ifset
25241 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25242 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25243 @end ifclear
25244 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25245 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25246
25247 @table @kbd
25248 @kindex C-x C-a
25249 @item C-x C-a
25250 @kindex C-x a
25251 @itemx C-x a
25252 @kindex C-x A
25253 @itemx C-x A
25254 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25255 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25256 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25257 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25258 The screen is then refreshed.
25259
25260 @kindex C-x 1
25261 @item C-x 1
25262 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25263 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25264 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25265
25266 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25267
25268 @kindex C-x 2
25269 @item C-x 2
25270 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25271 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25272 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25273 previous layout and the new one.
25274
25275 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25276
25277 @kindex C-x o
25278 @item C-x o
25279 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25280 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25281 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25282
25283 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25284
25285 @kindex C-x s
25286 @item C-x s
25287 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25288 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25289 @end table
25290
25291 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25292
25293 @table @asis
25294 @kindex PgUp
25295 @item @key{PgUp}
25296 Scroll the active window one page up.
25297
25298 @kindex PgDn
25299 @item @key{PgDn}
25300 Scroll the active window one page down.
25301
25302 @kindex Up
25303 @item @key{Up}
25304 Scroll the active window one line up.
25305
25306 @kindex Down
25307 @item @key{Down}
25308 Scroll the active window one line down.
25309
25310 @kindex Left
25311 @item @key{Left}
25312 Scroll the active window one column left.
25313
25314 @kindex Right
25315 @item @key{Right}
25316 Scroll the active window one column right.
25317
25318 @kindex C-L
25319 @item @kbd{C-L}
25320 Refresh the screen.
25321 @end table
25322
25323 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25324 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25325 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25326 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25327 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25328
25329 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25330 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25331 @cindex TUI single key mode
25332
25333 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25334 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25335 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25336
25337 @table @kbd
25338 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25339 @item c
25340 continue
25341
25342 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25343 @item d
25344 down
25345
25346 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25347 @item f
25348 finish
25349
25350 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25351 @item n
25352 next
25353
25354 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25355 @item q
25356 exit the SingleKey mode.
25357
25358 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25359 @item r
25360 run
25361
25362 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25363 @item s
25364 step
25365
25366 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25367 @item u
25368 up
25369
25370 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25371 @item v
25372 info locals
25373
25374 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25375 @item w
25376 where
25377 @end table
25378
25379 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25380 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25381 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25382 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25383 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25384 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25385
25386
25387 @node TUI Commands
25388 @section TUI-specific Commands
25389 @cindex TUI commands
25390
25391 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25392 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25393 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25394 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25395
25396 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25397 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25398 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25399 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25400 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25401
25402 @table @code
25403 @item tui enable
25404 @kindex tui enable
25405 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25406 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25407 otherwise a default layout is used.
25408
25409 @item tui disable
25410 @kindex tui disable
25411 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25412
25413 @item info win
25414 @kindex info win
25415 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25416
25417 @item layout @var{name}
25418 @kindex layout
25419 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25420 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25421 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25422
25423 @table @code
25424 @item next
25425 Display the next layout.
25426
25427 @item prev
25428 Display the previous layout.
25429
25430 @item src
25431 Display the source and command windows.
25432
25433 @item asm
25434 Display the assembly and command windows.
25435
25436 @item split
25437 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25438
25439 @item regs
25440 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25441 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25442 register, assembler, and command windows.
25443 @end table
25444
25445 @item focus @var{name}
25446 @kindex focus
25447 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25448 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25449
25450 @table @code
25451 @item next
25452 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25453
25454 @item prev
25455 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25456
25457 @item src
25458 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25459
25460 @item asm
25461 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25462
25463 @item regs
25464 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25465
25466 @item cmd
25467 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25468 @end table
25469
25470 @item refresh
25471 @kindex refresh
25472 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25473
25474 @item tui reg @var{group}
25475 @kindex tui reg
25476 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25477 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25478 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25479 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25480 following groups are available on most targets:
25481 @table @code
25482 @item next
25483 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25484 through all of the available register groups.
25485
25486 @item prev
25487 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25488 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25489 @var{next}.
25490
25491 @item general
25492 Display the general registers.
25493 @item float
25494 Display the floating point registers.
25495 @item system
25496 Display the system registers.
25497 @item vector
25498 Display the vector registers.
25499 @item all
25500 Display all registers.
25501 @end table
25502
25503 @item update
25504 @kindex update
25505 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25506
25507 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25508 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25509 @kindex winheight
25510 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25511 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25512 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25513 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25514 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25515
25516 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25517 @kindex tabset
25518 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25519 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25520 assembly windows.
25521 @end table
25522
25523 @node TUI Configuration
25524 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25525 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25526
25527 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25528
25529 @table @code
25530 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25531 @kindex set tui border-kind
25532 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25533 The possible values are the following:
25534 @table @code
25535 @item space
25536 Use a space character to draw the border.
25537
25538 @item ascii
25539 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25540
25541 @item acs
25542 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25543 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25544 @end table
25545
25546 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25547 @kindex set tui border-mode
25548 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25549 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25550 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25551 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25552 @table @code
25553 @item normal
25554 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25555
25556 @item standout
25557 Use standout mode.
25558
25559 @item reverse
25560 Use reverse video mode.
25561
25562 @item half
25563 Use half bright mode.
25564
25565 @item half-standout
25566 Use half bright and standout mode.
25567
25568 @item bold
25569 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25570
25571 @item bold-standout
25572 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25573 @end table
25574 @end table
25575
25576 @node Emacs
25577 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25578
25579 @cindex Emacs
25580 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25581 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25582 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25583 @value{GDBN}.
25584
25585 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25586 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25587 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25588 created Emacs buffer.
25589 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25590
25591 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25592 things:
25593
25594 @itemize @bullet
25595 @item
25596 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25597 the GUD buffer.
25598
25599 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25600 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25601
25602 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25603 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25604 in this way.
25605
25606 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25607 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25608 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25609 stop.
25610
25611 @item
25612 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25613
25614 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25615 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25616 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25617 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25618 and the source.
25619
25620 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25621 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25622 @end itemize
25623
25624 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25625 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25626 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25627 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25628
25629 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25630 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25631 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25632 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25633 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25634 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25635 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25636 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25637 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25638
25639 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25640 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25641 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25642 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25643
25644 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25645 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25646 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25647 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25648 one you want.
25649
25650 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25651 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25652
25653 @table @kbd
25654 @item C-h m
25655 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25656
25657 @item C-c C-s
25658 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25659 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25660
25661 @item C-c C-n
25662 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25663 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25664 to show the current file and location.
25665
25666 @item C-c C-i
25667 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25668 display window accordingly.
25669
25670 @item C-c C-f
25671 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25672 @code{finish} command.
25673
25674 @item C-c C-r
25675 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25676 command.
25677
25678 @item C-c <
25679 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25680 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25681 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25682
25683 @item C-c >
25684 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25685 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25686 @end table
25687
25688 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25689 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25690
25691 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25692 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25693 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25694 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25695 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25696 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25697 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25698
25699 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25700 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25701 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25702 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25703 frame.
25704
25705 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25706 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25707 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25708 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25709 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25710 to correspond properly with the code.
25711
25712 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25713 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25714 Emacs Manual}).
25715
25716 @node GDB/MI
25717 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25718
25719 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25720
25721 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25722 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25723 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25724 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25725 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25726 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25727
25728 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25729 in the form of a reference manual.
25730
25731 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25732 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25733 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25734
25735 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25736
25737 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25738 This chapter uses the following notation:
25739
25740 @itemize @bullet
25741 @item
25742 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25743
25744 @item
25745 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25746 it may or may not be given.
25747
25748 @item
25749 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25750 may repeat zero or more times.
25751
25752 @item
25753 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25754 may repeat one or more times.
25755
25756 @item
25757 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25758 @end itemize
25759
25760 @ignore
25761 @heading Dependencies
25762 @end ignore
25763
25764 @menu
25765 * GDB/MI General Design::
25766 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25767 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25768 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25769 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25770 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25771 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25772 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25773 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25774 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25775 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25776 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25777 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25778 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25779 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25780 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25781 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25782 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25783 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25784 @ignore
25785 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25786 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25787 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25788 @end ignore
25789 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25790 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25791 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25792 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25793 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25794 @end menu
25795
25796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25797 @node GDB/MI General Design
25798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25799 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25800
25801 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25802 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25803 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25804 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25805 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25806 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25807 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25808 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25809 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25810 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25811
25812 The important examples of notifications are:
25813 @itemize @bullet
25814
25815 @item
25816 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25817 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25818 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25819 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25820 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25821 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25822 command itself was successfully executed.
25823
25824 @item
25825 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25826 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25827 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25828 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25829 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25830 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25831
25832 @item
25833 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25834 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25835 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25836 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25837 orthogonal frontend design.
25838
25839 @end itemize
25840
25841 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25842 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25843 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25844 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25845 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25846 the user interface.
25847
25848
25849 @menu
25850 * Context management::
25851 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25852 * Thread groups::
25853 @end menu
25854
25855 @node Context management
25856 @subsection Context management
25857
25858 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25859
25860 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25861 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25862 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25863 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25864 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25865 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25866 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25867 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25868 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25869
25870 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25871 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25872 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25873 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25874 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25875 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25876 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25877 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25878 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25879 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25880 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25881
25882 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25883 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25884 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25885 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
25886 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25887 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25888 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25889 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
25890 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25891 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25892
25893 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25894 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25895 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25896 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25897 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25898 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25899 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25900 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25901 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25902 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25903 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25904 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25905 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25906 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25907 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25908 @samp{--frame} options.
25909
25910 @subsubsection Language
25911
25912 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25913 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25914 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25915 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25916 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25917 For instance:
25918
25919 @smallexample
25920 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25921 ^done,value="4"
25922 (gdb)
25923 @end smallexample
25924
25925 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25926 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25927 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25928
25929 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25930 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25931
25932 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25933 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25934 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25935 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25936 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25937 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25938 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25939 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25940 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25941
25942 @table @code
25943 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25944 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25945 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25946
25947 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25948 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25949 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25950
25951 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25952 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25953 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25954 MI commands even while the target is running.
25955
25956 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25957 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25958 @end table
25959
25960 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25961 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25962 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25963 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25964 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25965 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25966
25967 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25968 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25969 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25970 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25971 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25972 are running.
25973
25974 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25975 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25976 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25977 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25978 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25979 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25980 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25981 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25982 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25983 @samp{--thread} option).
25984
25985 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25986 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25987 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25988 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25989
25990 @node Thread groups
25991 @subsection Thread groups
25992 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25993 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25994 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25995 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25996 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25997
25998 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25999 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26000 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26001 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26002 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26003 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26004 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26005 into processes.
26006
26007 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26008 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26009 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26010 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26011 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26012 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26013 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26014 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26015 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26016 the members of specific thread group.
26017
26018 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26019 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26020 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26021 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26022 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26023 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26024 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26025 after attaching to that thread group.
26026
26027 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26028 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26029 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26030 such thread groups.
26031
26032 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26033 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26034 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26035
26036 @menu
26037 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26038 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26039 @end menu
26040
26041 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26042 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26043
26044 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26045 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26046 @table @code
26047 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26048 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26049
26050 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26051 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26052 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26053
26054 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26055 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26056 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26057
26058 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26059 "any sequence of digits"
26060
26061 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26062 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26063
26064 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26065 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26066
26067 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26068 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26069
26070 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26071 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26072 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26073
26074 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26075 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26076
26077 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26078 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26079 @end table
26080
26081 @noindent
26082 Notes:
26083
26084 @itemize @bullet
26085 @item
26086 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26087 output is described below.
26088
26089 @item
26090 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26091 finishes.
26092
26093 @item
26094 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26095 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26096 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26097 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26098 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26099 @end itemize
26100
26101 Pragmatics:
26102
26103 @itemize @bullet
26104 @item
26105 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26106
26107 @item
26108 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26109 @end itemize
26110
26111 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26112 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26113
26114 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26115 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26116 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26117 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26118 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26119 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26120
26121 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26122 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26123 @var{token}.
26124
26125 @table @code
26126 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26127 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26128
26129 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26130 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26131
26132 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26133 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26134
26135 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26136 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26137
26138 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26139 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26140
26141 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26142 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26143
26144 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26145 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26146
26147 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26148 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26149
26150 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26151 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26152
26153 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26154 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26155 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26156
26157 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26158 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26159
26160 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26161 @code{ @var{string} }
26162
26163 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26164 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26165
26166 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26167 @code{@var{c-string}}
26168
26169 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26170 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26171
26172 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26173 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26174 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26175
26176 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26177 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26178
26179 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26180 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26181
26182 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26183 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26184
26185 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26186 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26187
26188 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26189 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26190
26191 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26192 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26193 @end table
26194
26195 @noindent
26196 Notes:
26197
26198 @itemize @bullet
26199 @item
26200 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26201
26202 @item
26203 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26204 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26205 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26206 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26207 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26208 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26209 prior command.
26210
26211 @item
26212 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26213 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26214 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26215 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26216
26217 @item
26218 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26219 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26220 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26221 @samp{*}.
26222
26223 @item
26224 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26225 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26226 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26227 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26228
26229 @item
26230 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26231 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26232 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26233 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26234
26235 @item
26236 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26237 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26238 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26239
26240 @item
26241 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26242 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26243 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26244 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26245
26246 @item
26247 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26248 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26249 @var{values}.
26250
26251
26252 @end itemize
26253
26254 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26255 details about the various output records.
26256
26257 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26258 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26259 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26260
26261 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26262 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26263
26264 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26265 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26266 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26267 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26268 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26269 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26270
26271 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26272 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26273 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26274
26275 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26276 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26277 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26278 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26279
26280 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26281 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26282
26283 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26284 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26285 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26286 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26287 might change.
26288
26289 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26290 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26291 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26292 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26293
26294 @itemize @bullet
26295 @item
26296 New MI commands may be added.
26297
26298 @item
26299 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26300
26301 @item
26302 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26303 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26304
26305 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26306 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26307
26308 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26309 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26310 @end itemize
26311
26312 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26313 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26314 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26315 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26316 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26317
26318 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26319 @c version?
26320
26321 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26322 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26323 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26324 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26325 @cindex mailing lists
26326
26327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26328 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26329 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26330
26331 @menu
26332 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26333 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26334 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26335 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26336 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26337 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26338 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26339 @end menu
26340
26341 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26342 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26343
26344 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26345 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26346 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26347 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26348
26349 @table @code
26350 @findex ^done
26351 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26352 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26353 values.
26354
26355 @item "^running"
26356 @findex ^running
26357 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26358 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26359 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26360 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26361 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26362 which threads are resumed.
26363
26364 @item "^connected"
26365 @findex ^connected
26366 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26367
26368 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26369 @findex ^error
26370 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26371 the corresponding error message.
26372
26373 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26374 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26375 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26376
26377 @table @samp
26378 @item "undefined-command"
26379 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26380 @end table
26381
26382 @item "^exit"
26383 @findex ^exit
26384 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26385
26386 @end table
26387
26388 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26389 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26390
26391 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26392 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26393 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26394 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26395 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26396
26397 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26398 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26399 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26400 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26401 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26402
26403 @table @code
26404 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26405 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26406 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26407
26408 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26409 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26410 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26411 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26412
26413 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26414 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26415 internals.
26416 @end table
26417
26418 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26419 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26420
26421 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26422 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26423 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26424 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26425 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26426 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26427
26428 The following is the list of possible async records:
26429
26430 @table @code
26431
26432 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26433 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26434 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26435 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26436 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26437 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26438 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26439 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26440 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26441 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26442 it run freely.
26443
26444 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26445 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26446 following values:
26447
26448 @table @code
26449 @item breakpoint-hit
26450 A breakpoint was reached.
26451 @item watchpoint-trigger
26452 A watchpoint was triggered.
26453 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26454 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26455 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26456 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26457 @item function-finished
26458 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26459 @item location-reached
26460 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26461 @item watchpoint-scope
26462 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26463 @item end-stepping-range
26464 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26465 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26466 @item exited-signalled
26467 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26468 @item exited
26469 The inferior exited.
26470 @item exited-normally
26471 The inferior exited normally.
26472 @item signal-received
26473 A signal was received by the inferior.
26474 @item solib-event
26475 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26476 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26477 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26478 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26479 @item fork
26480 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26481 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26482 @item vfork
26483 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26484 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26485 @item syscall-entry
26486 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26487 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26488 @item syscall-return
26489 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26490 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26491 @item exec
26492 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26493 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26494 @end table
26495
26496 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26497 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26498 Depending on whether all-stop
26499 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26500 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26501 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26502 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26503 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26504 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26505 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26506 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26507 if such information is not available.
26508
26509 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26510 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26511 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26512 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26513 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26514 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26515 cannot be used in any way.
26516
26517 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26518 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26519 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26520 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26521 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26522 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26523
26524 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26525 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26526 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26527 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26528 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26529 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26530
26531 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26532 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26533 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26534 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26535 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26536
26537 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26538 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26539 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26540 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26541 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26542 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26543 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26544 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26545 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26546
26547 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26548 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26549
26550 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26551 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26552 that thread.
26553
26554 @item =library-loaded,...
26555 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26556 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26557 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26558 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26559 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26560 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26561 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26562 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26563 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26564 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26565 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26566 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26567 thread groups.
26568
26569 @item =library-unloaded,...
26570 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26571 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26572 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26573 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26574 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26575 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26576 thread groups.
26577
26578 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26579 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26580 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26581 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26582 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26583
26584 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26585 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26586 initial value @var{initial}.
26587
26588 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26589 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26590 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26591 trace state variables are deleted.
26592
26593 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26594 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26595 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26596 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26597 value of trace state variable is known.
26598
26599 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26600 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26601 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26602 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26603 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26604 user.
26605
26606 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26607 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26608 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26609
26610 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26611 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26612
26613 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26614 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26615 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26616 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26617 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26618
26619 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26620 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26621 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26622 for existing method and format values.
26623
26624 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26625 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26626 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26627 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26628 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26629 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26630
26631 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26632 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26633 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26634 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26635 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26636 executable code.
26637 @end table
26638
26639 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26640 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26641
26642 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26643 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26644 following fields:
26645
26646 @table @code
26647 @item number
26648 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26649 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26650 @samp{1.2}.
26651
26652 @item type
26653 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26654 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26655
26656 @item catch-type
26657 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26658 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26659
26660 @item disp
26661 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26662 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26663 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26664
26665 @item enabled
26666 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26667 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26668 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26669
26670 @item addr
26671 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26672 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26673 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26674 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26675 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26676
26677 @item func
26678 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26679 If not known, this field is not present.
26680
26681 @item filename
26682 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26683 If not known, this field is not present.
26684
26685 @item fullname
26686 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26687 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26688
26689 @item line
26690 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26691 If not known, this field is not present.
26692
26693 @item at
26694 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26695 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26696 by a symbol name.
26697
26698 @item pending
26699 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26700 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26701
26702 @item evaluated-by
26703 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26704 @samp{target}.
26705
26706 @item thread
26707 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26708 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26709
26710 @item task
26711 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26712 field will hold the task identifier.
26713
26714 @item cond
26715 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26716
26717 @item ignore
26718 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26719
26720 @item enable
26721 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26722
26723 @item traceframe-usage
26724 FIXME.
26725
26726 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26727 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26728
26729 @item mask
26730 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26731
26732 @item pass
26733 A tracepoint's pass count.
26734
26735 @item original-location
26736 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26737 This field is optional.
26738
26739 @item times
26740 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26741
26742 @item installed
26743 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26744 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26745 is not.
26746
26747 @item what
26748 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26749
26750 @end table
26751
26752 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26753 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26754
26755 @smallexample
26756 -> -break-insert main
26757 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26758 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26759 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26760 times="0"@}
26761 <- (gdb)
26762 @end smallexample
26763
26764 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26765 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26766
26767 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26768 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26769 fields:
26770
26771 @table @code
26772 @item level
26773 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26774 zero. This field is always present.
26775
26776 @item func
26777 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26778 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26779
26780 @item addr
26781 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26782
26783 @item file
26784 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26785 address. This field may be absent.
26786
26787 @item line
26788 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26789 may be absent.
26790
26791 @item from
26792 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26793 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26794
26795 @end table
26796
26797 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26798 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26799
26800 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26801 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26802
26803 @table @code
26804 @item id
26805 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26806 always present.
26807
26808 @item target-id
26809 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26810
26811 @item details
26812 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26813 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26814 frontend. This field is optional.
26815
26816 @item state
26817 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26818 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26819
26820 @item core
26821 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26822 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26823 @end table
26824
26825 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26826 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26827
26828 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26829 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26830 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26831 the @code{exception-name} field.
26832
26833 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26834 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26835 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26836 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26837
26838 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26839 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26840 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26841 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26842
26843 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26844 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26845
26846 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26847
26848 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26849 information of the breakpoint.
26850
26851 @smallexample
26852 -> -break-insert main
26853 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26854 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26855 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26856 times="0"@}
26857 <- (gdb)
26858 @end smallexample
26859
26860 @subheading Program Execution
26861
26862 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26863 reason that execution stopped.
26864
26865 @smallexample
26866 -> -exec-run
26867 <- ^running
26868 <- (gdb)
26869 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26870 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26871 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26872 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26873 <- (gdb)
26874 -> -exec-continue
26875 <- ^running
26876 <- (gdb)
26877 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26878 <- (gdb)
26879 @end smallexample
26880
26881 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26882
26883 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26884
26885 @smallexample
26886 -> (gdb)
26887 <- -gdb-exit
26888 <- ^exit
26889 @end smallexample
26890
26891 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26892 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26893 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26894 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26895 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26896 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26897
26898 @subheading A Bad Command
26899
26900 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26901
26902 @smallexample
26903 -> -rubbish
26904 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26905 <- (gdb)
26906 @end smallexample
26907
26908
26909 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26910 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26911 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26912
26913 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26914 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26915
26916 @subheading Motivation
26917
26918 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26919
26920 @subheading Introduction
26921
26922 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26923
26924 @subheading Commands
26925
26926 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26927
26928 @subsubheading Synopsis
26929
26930 @smallexample
26931 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26932 @end smallexample
26933
26934 @subsubheading Result
26935
26936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26937
26938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26939
26940 @subsubheading Example
26941
26942 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26943 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26944
26945
26946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26947 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26949
26950 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26951 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26952 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26953 breakpoints.
26954
26955 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26956 @findex -break-after
26957
26958 @subsubheading Synopsis
26959
26960 @smallexample
26961 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26962 @end smallexample
26963
26964 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26965 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26966 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26967 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26968
26969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26970
26971 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26972
26973 @subsubheading Example
26974
26975 @smallexample
26976 (gdb)
26977 -break-insert main
26978 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26979 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26980 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26981 times="0"@}
26982 (gdb)
26983 -break-after 1 3
26984 ~
26985 ^done
26986 (gdb)
26987 -break-list
26988 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26989 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26990 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26991 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26992 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26993 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26994 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26995 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26996 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26997 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26998 (gdb)
26999 @end smallexample
27000
27001 @ignore
27002 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27003 @findex -break-catch
27004 @end ignore
27005
27006 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27007 @findex -break-commands
27008
27009 @subsubheading Synopsis
27010
27011 @smallexample
27012 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27013 @end smallexample
27014
27015 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27016 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27017 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27018 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27019 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27020 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27021
27022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27023
27024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27025
27026 @subsubheading Example
27027
27028 @smallexample
27029 (gdb)
27030 -break-insert main
27031 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27032 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27033 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27034 times="0"@}
27035 (gdb)
27036 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27037 ^done
27038 (gdb)
27039 @end smallexample
27040
27041 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27042 @findex -break-condition
27043
27044 @subsubheading Synopsis
27045
27046 @smallexample
27047 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27048 @end smallexample
27049
27050 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27051 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27052 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27053 command below).
27054
27055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27056
27057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27058
27059 @subsubheading Example
27060
27061 @smallexample
27062 (gdb)
27063 -break-condition 1 1
27064 ^done
27065 (gdb)
27066 -break-list
27067 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27068 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27069 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27070 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27071 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27072 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27073 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27074 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27075 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27076 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27077 (gdb)
27078 @end smallexample
27079
27080 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27081 @findex -break-delete
27082
27083 @subsubheading Synopsis
27084
27085 @smallexample
27086 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27087 @end smallexample
27088
27089 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27090 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27091
27092 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27093
27094 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27095
27096 @subsubheading Example
27097
27098 @smallexample
27099 (gdb)
27100 -break-delete 1
27101 ^done
27102 (gdb)
27103 -break-list
27104 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27105 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27106 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27107 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27108 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27109 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27110 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27111 body=[]@}
27112 (gdb)
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27116 @findex -break-disable
27117
27118 @subsubheading Synopsis
27119
27120 @smallexample
27121 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27122 @end smallexample
27123
27124 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27125 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27126
27127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27128
27129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27130
27131 @subsubheading Example
27132
27133 @smallexample
27134 (gdb)
27135 -break-disable 2
27136 ^done
27137 (gdb)
27138 -break-list
27139 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27140 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27141 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27142 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27143 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27144 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27145 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27146 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27147 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27148 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27149 (gdb)
27150 @end smallexample
27151
27152 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27153 @findex -break-enable
27154
27155 @subsubheading Synopsis
27156
27157 @smallexample
27158 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27159 @end smallexample
27160
27161 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27162
27163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27164
27165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27166
27167 @subsubheading Example
27168
27169 @smallexample
27170 (gdb)
27171 -break-enable 2
27172 ^done
27173 (gdb)
27174 -break-list
27175 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27176 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27177 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27178 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27179 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27180 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27181 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27182 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27183 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27184 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27185 (gdb)
27186 @end smallexample
27187
27188 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27189 @findex -break-info
27190
27191 @subsubheading Synopsis
27192
27193 @smallexample
27194 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27195 @end smallexample
27196
27197 @c REDUNDANT???
27198 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27199
27200 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27201 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27202 table.
27203
27204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27205
27206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27207
27208 @subsubheading Example
27209 N.A.
27210
27211 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27212 @findex -break-insert
27213 @anchor{-break-insert}
27214
27215 @subsubheading Synopsis
27216
27217 @smallexample
27218 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27219 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27220 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27221 @end smallexample
27222
27223 @noindent
27224 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27225
27226 @table @var
27227 @item linespec location
27228 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27229
27230 @item explicit location
27231 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27232 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27233 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27234
27235 @table @samp
27236 @item --source @var{filename}
27237 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27238 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27239
27240 @item --function @var{function}
27241 The name of a function or method.
27242
27243 @item --label @var{label}
27244 The name of a label.
27245
27246 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27247 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27248 @end table
27249
27250 @item address location
27251 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27252 @end table
27253
27254 @noindent
27255 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27256
27257 @table @samp
27258 @item -t
27259 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27260 @item -h
27261 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27262 @item -f
27263 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27264 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27265 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27266 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27267 cannot be parsed.
27268 @item -d
27269 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27270 @item -a
27271 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27272 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27273 @item -c @var{condition}
27274 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27275 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27276 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27277 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27278 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27279 @var{thread-id}.
27280 @end table
27281
27282 @subsubheading Result
27283
27284 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27285 resulting breakpoint.
27286
27287 Note: this format is open to change.
27288 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27289
27290 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27291
27292 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27293 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27294
27295 @subsubheading Example
27296
27297 @smallexample
27298 (gdb)
27299 -break-insert main
27300 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27301 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27302 times="0"@}
27303 (gdb)
27304 -break-insert -t foo
27305 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27306 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27307 times="0"@}
27308 (gdb)
27309 -break-list
27310 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27311 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27312 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27313 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27314 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27315 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27316 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27317 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27318 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27319 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27320 times="0"@},
27321 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27322 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27323 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27324 times="0"@}]@}
27325 (gdb)
27326 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27327 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27328 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27329 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27330 @c times="0"@}
27331 @c (gdb)
27332 @end smallexample
27333
27334 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27335 @findex -dprintf-insert
27336
27337 @subsubheading Synopsis
27338
27339 @smallexample
27340 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27341 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27342 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27343 [ @var{argument} ]
27344 @end smallexample
27345
27346 @noindent
27347 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27348 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27349
27350 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27351
27352 @table @samp
27353 @item -t
27354 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27355 @item -f
27356 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27357 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27358 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27359 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27360 cannot be parsed.
27361 @item -d
27362 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27363 @item -c @var{condition}
27364 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27365 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27366 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27367 to @var{ignore-count}.
27368 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27369 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27370 @var{thread-id}.
27371 @end table
27372
27373 @subsubheading Result
27374
27375 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27376 resulting breakpoint.
27377
27378 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27379
27380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27381
27382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27383
27384 @subsubheading Example
27385
27386 @smallexample
27387 (gdb)
27388 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27389 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27390 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27391 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27392 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27393 original-location="foo"@}
27394 (gdb)
27395 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27396 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27397 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27398 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27399 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27400 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27401 (gdb)
27402 @end smallexample
27403
27404 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27405 @findex -break-list
27406
27407 @subsubheading Synopsis
27408
27409 @smallexample
27410 -break-list
27411 @end smallexample
27412
27413 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27414
27415 @table @samp
27416 @item Number
27417 number of the breakpoint
27418 @item Type
27419 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27420 @item Disposition
27421 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27422 or @samp{nokeep}
27423 @item Enabled
27424 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27425 @item Address
27426 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27427 @item What
27428 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27429 name, line number
27430 @item Thread-groups
27431 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27432 @item Times
27433 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27434 @end table
27435
27436 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27437 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27438
27439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27440
27441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27442
27443 @subsubheading Example
27444
27445 @smallexample
27446 (gdb)
27447 -break-list
27448 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27449 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27450 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27451 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27452 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27453 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27454 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27455 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27456 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27457 times="0"@},
27458 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27459 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27460 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27461 (gdb)
27462 @end smallexample
27463
27464 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27465
27466 @smallexample
27467 (gdb)
27468 -break-list
27469 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27470 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27471 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27472 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27473 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27474 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27475 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27476 body=[]@}
27477 (gdb)
27478 @end smallexample
27479
27480 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27481 @findex -break-passcount
27482
27483 @subsubheading Synopsis
27484
27485 @smallexample
27486 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27487 @end smallexample
27488
27489 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27490 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27491 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27492 command @samp{passcount}.
27493
27494 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27495 @findex -break-watch
27496
27497 @subsubheading Synopsis
27498
27499 @smallexample
27500 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27501 @end smallexample
27502
27503 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27504 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27505 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27506 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27507 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27508 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27509 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27510 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27511
27512 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27513 breakpoints inserted.
27514
27515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27516
27517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27518 @samp{rwatch}.
27519
27520 @subsubheading Example
27521
27522 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27523
27524 @smallexample
27525 (gdb)
27526 -break-watch x
27527 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27528 (gdb)
27529 -exec-continue
27530 ^running
27531 (gdb)
27532 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27533 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27534 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27535 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27536 (gdb)
27537 @end smallexample
27538
27539 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27540 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27541 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27542
27543 @smallexample
27544 (gdb)
27545 -break-watch C
27546 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27547 (gdb)
27548 -exec-continue
27549 ^running
27550 (gdb)
27551 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27552 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27553 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27554 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27555 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27556 (gdb)
27557 -exec-continue
27558 ^running
27559 (gdb)
27560 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27561 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27562 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27563 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27564 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27565 (gdb)
27566 @end smallexample
27567
27568 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27569 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27570 deleted.
27571
27572 @smallexample
27573 (gdb)
27574 -break-watch C
27575 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27576 (gdb)
27577 -break-list
27578 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27579 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27580 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27581 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27582 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27583 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27584 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27585 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27586 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27587 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27588 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27589 times="1"@},
27590 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27591 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27592 (gdb)
27593 -exec-continue
27594 ^running
27595 (gdb)
27596 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27597 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27598 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27599 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27600 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27601 (gdb)
27602 -break-list
27603 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27604 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27605 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27606 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27607 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27608 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27609 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27610 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27611 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27612 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27613 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27614 times="1"@},
27615 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27616 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27617 (gdb)
27618 -exec-continue
27619 ^running
27620 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27621 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27622 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27623 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27624 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27625 (gdb)
27626 -break-list
27627 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27628 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27629 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27630 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27631 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27632 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27633 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27634 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27635 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27636 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27637 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27638 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27639 (gdb)
27640 @end smallexample
27641
27642
27643 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27644 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27645 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27646
27647 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27648 catchpoints.
27649
27650 @menu
27651 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27652 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27653 @end menu
27654
27655 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27656 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27657
27658 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27659 @findex -catch-load
27660
27661 @subsubheading Synopsis
27662
27663 @smallexample
27664 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27665 @end smallexample
27666
27667 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27668 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27669 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27670 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27671 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27672
27673
27674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27675
27676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27677
27678 @subsubheading Example
27679
27680 @smallexample
27681 -catch-load -t foo.so
27682 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27683 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27684 (gdb)
27685 @end smallexample
27686
27687
27688 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27689 @findex -catch-unload
27690
27691 @subsubheading Synopsis
27692
27693 @smallexample
27694 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27695 @end smallexample
27696
27697 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27698 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27699 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27700 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27701 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27702
27703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27704
27705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27706
27707 @subsubheading Example
27708
27709 @smallexample
27710 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27711 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27712 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27713 (gdb)
27714 @end smallexample
27715
27716 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27717 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27718
27719 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27720 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27721
27722 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27723 @findex -catch-assert
27724
27725 @subsubheading Synopsis
27726
27727 @smallexample
27728 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27729 @end smallexample
27730
27731 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27732
27733 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27734
27735 @table @samp
27736 @item -c @var{condition}
27737 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27738 @item -d
27739 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27740 @item -t
27741 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27742 @end table
27743
27744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27745
27746 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27747
27748 @subsubheading Example
27749
27750 @smallexample
27751 -catch-assert
27752 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27753 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27754 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27755 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27756 (gdb)
27757 @end smallexample
27758
27759 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27760 @findex -catch-exception
27761
27762 @subsubheading Synopsis
27763
27764 @smallexample
27765 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27766 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27767 @end smallexample
27768
27769 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27770 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27771 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27772 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27773 catchpoints.
27774
27775 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27776
27777 @table @samp
27778 @item -c @var{condition}
27779 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27780 @item -d
27781 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27782 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27783 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27784 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27785 @item -t
27786 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27787 @item -u
27788 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27789 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27790 @end table
27791
27792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27793
27794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27795 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27796
27797 @subsubheading Example
27798
27799 @smallexample
27800 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27801 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27802 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27803 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27804 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27805 (gdb)
27806 @end smallexample
27807
27808 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27809 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27810 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27811
27812 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27813 @findex -exec-arguments
27814
27815
27816 @subsubheading Synopsis
27817
27818 @smallexample
27819 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27820 @end smallexample
27821
27822 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27823 @samp{-exec-run}.
27824
27825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27826
27827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27828
27829 @subsubheading Example
27830
27831 @smallexample
27832 (gdb)
27833 -exec-arguments -v word
27834 ^done
27835 (gdb)
27836 @end smallexample
27837
27838
27839 @ignore
27840 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27841 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27842
27843 @subsubheading Synopsis
27844
27845 @smallexample
27846 -exec-show-arguments
27847 @end smallexample
27848
27849 Print the arguments of the program.
27850
27851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27852
27853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27854
27855 @subsubheading Example
27856 N.A.
27857 @end ignore
27858
27859
27860 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27861 @findex -environment-cd
27862
27863 @subsubheading Synopsis
27864
27865 @smallexample
27866 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27867 @end smallexample
27868
27869 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27870
27871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27872
27873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27874
27875 @subsubheading Example
27876
27877 @smallexample
27878 (gdb)
27879 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27880 ^done
27881 (gdb)
27882 @end smallexample
27883
27884
27885 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27886 @findex -environment-directory
27887
27888 @subsubheading Synopsis
27889
27890 @smallexample
27891 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27892 @end smallexample
27893
27894 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27895 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27896 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27897 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27898 occurs as normal.
27899 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27900 multiple directories in a single command
27901 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27902 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27903 If blanks are needed as
27904 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27905 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27906 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27907 character must not be used
27908 in any directory name.
27909 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27910
27911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27912
27913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27914
27915 @subsubheading Example
27916
27917 @smallexample
27918 (gdb)
27919 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27920 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27921 (gdb)
27922 -environment-directory ""
27923 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27924 (gdb)
27925 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27926 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27927 (gdb)
27928 -environment-directory -r
27929 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27930 (gdb)
27931 @end smallexample
27932
27933
27934 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27935 @findex -environment-path
27936
27937 @subsubheading Synopsis
27938
27939 @smallexample
27940 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27941 @end smallexample
27942
27943 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27944 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27945 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27946 supplied in addition to the
27947 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27948 occurs as normal.
27949 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27950 multiple directories in a single command
27951 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27952 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27953 If blanks are needed as
27954 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27955 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27956 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27957 character must not be used
27958 in any directory name.
27959 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27960
27961
27962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27963
27964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27965
27966 @subsubheading Example
27967
27968 @smallexample
27969 (gdb)
27970 -environment-path
27971 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27972 (gdb)
27973 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27974 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27975 (gdb)
27976 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27977 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27978 (gdb)
27979 @end smallexample
27980
27981
27982 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27983 @findex -environment-pwd
27984
27985 @subsubheading Synopsis
27986
27987 @smallexample
27988 -environment-pwd
27989 @end smallexample
27990
27991 Show the current working directory.
27992
27993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27994
27995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27996
27997 @subsubheading Example
27998
27999 @smallexample
28000 (gdb)
28001 -environment-pwd
28002 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28003 (gdb)
28004 @end smallexample
28005
28006 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28007 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28008 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28009
28010
28011 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28012 @findex -thread-info
28013
28014 @subsubheading Synopsis
28015
28016 @smallexample
28017 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28018 @end smallexample
28019
28020 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28021 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28022 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28023 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28024 current thread.
28025
28026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28027
28028 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28029 about all threads.
28030
28031 @subsubheading Result
28032
28033 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
28034 defined for a given thread:
28035
28036 @table @samp
28037 @item current
28038 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28039
28040 @item id
28041 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
28042
28043 @item target-id
28044 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
28045
28046 @item details
28047 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
28048 field is optional.
28049
28050 @item name
28051 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28052 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28053 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28054 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28055 field is omitted.
28056
28057 @item frame
28058 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28059
28060 @item state
28061 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
28062 values:
28063
28064 @table @code
28065 @item stopped
28066 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
28067 threads.
28068
28069 @item running
28070 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
28071 threads.
28072
28073 @end table
28074
28075 @item core
28076 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28077 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
28078
28079 @end table
28080
28081 @subsubheading Example
28082
28083 @smallexample
28084 -thread-info
28085 ^done,threads=[
28086 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28087 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28088 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28089 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28090 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28091 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28092 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28093 state="running"@}],
28094 current-thread-id="1"
28095 (gdb)
28096 @end smallexample
28097
28098 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28099 @findex -thread-list-ids
28100
28101 @subsubheading Synopsis
28102
28103 @smallexample
28104 -thread-list-ids
28105 @end smallexample
28106
28107 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28108 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28109 threads.
28110
28111 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28112 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28113
28114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28115
28116 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28117
28118 @subsubheading Example
28119
28120 @smallexample
28121 (gdb)
28122 -thread-list-ids
28123 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28124 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28125 (gdb)
28126 @end smallexample
28127
28128
28129 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28130 @findex -thread-select
28131
28132 @subsubheading Synopsis
28133
28134 @smallexample
28135 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28139 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28140 topmost frame for that thread.
28141
28142 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28143 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28144
28145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28146
28147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28148
28149 @subsubheading Example
28150
28151 @smallexample
28152 (gdb)
28153 -exec-next
28154 ^running
28155 (gdb)
28156 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28157 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28158 (gdb)
28159 -thread-list-ids
28160 ^done,
28161 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28162 number-of-threads="3"
28163 (gdb)
28164 -thread-select 3
28165 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28166 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28167 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28168 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28169 (gdb)
28170 @end smallexample
28171
28172 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28173 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28174 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28175
28176 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28177 @findex -ada-task-info
28178
28179 @subsubheading Synopsis
28180
28181 @smallexample
28182 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28183 @end smallexample
28184
28185 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28186 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28187
28188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28189
28190 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28191 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28192
28193 @subsubheading Result
28194
28195 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28196 defined for each Ada task:
28197
28198 @table @samp
28199 @item current
28200 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28201
28202 @item id
28203 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28204
28205 @item task-id
28206 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28207
28208 @item thread-id
28209 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28210 task.
28211
28212 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28213 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28214 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28215
28216 @item parent-id
28217 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28218 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28219
28220 @item priority
28221 The base priority of the task.
28222
28223 @item state
28224 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28225 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28226
28227 @item name
28228 The name of the task.
28229
28230 @end table
28231
28232 @subsubheading Example
28233
28234 @smallexample
28235 -ada-task-info
28236 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28237 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28238 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28239 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28240 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28241 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28242 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28243 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28244 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28245 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28246 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28247 (gdb)
28248 @end smallexample
28249
28250 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28251 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28252 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28253
28254 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28255 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28256 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28257 other cases.
28258
28259 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28260 @findex -exec-continue
28261
28262 @subsubheading Synopsis
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28266 @end smallexample
28267
28268 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28269 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28270 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28271 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28272 @itemize @bullet
28273 @item
28274 breakpoints or watchpoints
28275 @item
28276 signals or exceptions
28277 @item
28278 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28279 @item
28280 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28281 @end itemize
28282 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28283 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28284 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28285 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28286 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28287 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28288
28289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28290
28291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28292
28293 @subsubheading Example
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 -exec-continue
28297 ^running
28298 (gdb)
28299 @@Hello world
28300 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28301 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28302 line="13"@}
28303 (gdb)
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306
28307 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28308 @findex -exec-finish
28309
28310 @subsubheading Synopsis
28311
28312 @smallexample
28313 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28314 @end smallexample
28315
28316 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28317 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28318 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28319 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28320 function was called.
28321
28322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28323
28324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28325
28326 @subsubheading Example
28327
28328 Function returning @code{void}.
28329
28330 @smallexample
28331 -exec-finish
28332 ^running
28333 (gdb)
28334 @@hello from foo
28335 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28336 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28337 (gdb)
28338 @end smallexample
28339
28340 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28341 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28342 value itself.
28343
28344 @smallexample
28345 -exec-finish
28346 ^running
28347 (gdb)
28348 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28349 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28350 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28351 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28352 (gdb)
28353 @end smallexample
28354
28355
28356 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28357 @findex -exec-interrupt
28358
28359 @subsubheading Synopsis
28360
28361 @smallexample
28362 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28363 @end smallexample
28364
28365 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28366 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28367 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28368 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28369 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28370
28371 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28372 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28373 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28374 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28375
28376 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28377 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28378 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28379 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28380
28381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28382
28383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28384
28385 @subsubheading Example
28386
28387 @smallexample
28388 (gdb)
28389 111-exec-continue
28390 111^running
28391
28392 (gdb)
28393 222-exec-interrupt
28394 222^done
28395 (gdb)
28396 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28397 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28398 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28399 (gdb)
28400
28401 (gdb)
28402 -exec-interrupt
28403 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28404 (gdb)
28405 @end smallexample
28406
28407 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28408 @findex -exec-jump
28409
28410 @subsubheading Synopsis
28411
28412 @smallexample
28413 -exec-jump @var{location}
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28417 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28418 different forms of @var{location}.
28419
28420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28421
28422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28423
28424 @subsubheading Example
28425
28426 @smallexample
28427 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28428 *running,thread-id="all"
28429 ^running
28430 @end smallexample
28431
28432
28433 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28434 @findex -exec-next
28435
28436 @subsubheading Synopsis
28437
28438 @smallexample
28439 -exec-next [--reverse]
28440 @end smallexample
28441
28442 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28443 of the next source line is reached.
28444
28445 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28446 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28447 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28448 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28449 source line where the function was called.
28450
28451
28452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28453
28454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28455
28456 @subsubheading Example
28457
28458 @smallexample
28459 -exec-next
28460 ^running
28461 (gdb)
28462 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28463 (gdb)
28464 @end smallexample
28465
28466
28467 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28468 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28469
28470 @subsubheading Synopsis
28471
28472 @smallexample
28473 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28474 @end smallexample
28475
28476 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28477 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28478 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28479 printed as well.
28480
28481 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28482 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28483 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28484 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28485 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28486
28487 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28488
28489 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28490
28491 @subsubheading Example
28492
28493 @smallexample
28494 (gdb)
28495 -exec-next-instruction
28496 ^running
28497
28498 (gdb)
28499 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28500 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28501 (gdb)
28502 @end smallexample
28503
28504
28505 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28506 @findex -exec-return
28507
28508 @subsubheading Synopsis
28509
28510 @smallexample
28511 -exec-return
28512 @end smallexample
28513
28514 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28515 Displays the new current frame.
28516
28517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28518
28519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28520
28521 @subsubheading Example
28522
28523 @smallexample
28524 (gdb)
28525 200-break-insert callee4
28526 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28527 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28528 (gdb)
28529 000-exec-run
28530 000^running
28531 (gdb)
28532 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28533 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28534 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28535 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28536 (gdb)
28537 205-break-delete
28538 205^done
28539 (gdb)
28540 111-exec-return
28541 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28542 args=[@{name="strarg",
28543 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28544 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28545 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28546 (gdb)
28547 @end smallexample
28548
28549
28550 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28551 @findex -exec-run
28552
28553 @subsubheading Synopsis
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28557 @end smallexample
28558
28559 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28560 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28561 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28562 the program has exited exceptionally.
28563
28564 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28565 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28566 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28567 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28568 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28569
28570 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28571 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28572 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28573 (@pxref{Starting}).
28574
28575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28576
28577 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28578
28579 @subsubheading Examples
28580
28581 @smallexample
28582 (gdb)
28583 -break-insert main
28584 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28585 (gdb)
28586 -exec-run
28587 ^running
28588 (gdb)
28589 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28590 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28591 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28592 (gdb)
28593 @end smallexample
28594
28595 @noindent
28596 Program exited normally:
28597
28598 @smallexample
28599 (gdb)
28600 -exec-run
28601 ^running
28602 (gdb)
28603 x = 55
28604 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28605 (gdb)
28606 @end smallexample
28607
28608 @noindent
28609 Program exited exceptionally:
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 (gdb)
28613 -exec-run
28614 ^running
28615 (gdb)
28616 x = 55
28617 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28618 (gdb)
28619 @end smallexample
28620
28621 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28622 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28623
28624 @smallexample
28625 (gdb)
28626 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28627 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28628 @end smallexample
28629
28630
28631 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28632
28633
28634 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28635 @findex -exec-step
28636
28637 @subsubheading Synopsis
28638
28639 @smallexample
28640 -exec-step [--reverse]
28641 @end smallexample
28642
28643 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28644 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28645 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28646 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28647 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28648 previously executed source line.
28649
28650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28651
28652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28653
28654 @subsubheading Example
28655
28656 Stepping into a function:
28657
28658 @smallexample
28659 -exec-step
28660 ^running
28661 (gdb)
28662 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28663 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28664 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28665 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28666 (gdb)
28667 @end smallexample
28668
28669 Regular stepping:
28670
28671 @smallexample
28672 -exec-step
28673 ^running
28674 (gdb)
28675 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28676 (gdb)
28677 @end smallexample
28678
28679
28680 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28681 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28682
28683 @subsubheading Synopsis
28684
28685 @smallexample
28686 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28687 @end smallexample
28688
28689 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28690 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28691 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28692 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28693 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28694 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28695 as well.
28696
28697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28698
28699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28700
28701 @subsubheading Example
28702
28703 @smallexample
28704 (gdb)
28705 -exec-step-instruction
28706 ^running
28707
28708 (gdb)
28709 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28710 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28711 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28712 (gdb)
28713 -exec-step-instruction
28714 ^running
28715
28716 (gdb)
28717 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28718 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28719 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28720 (gdb)
28721 @end smallexample
28722
28723
28724 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28725 @findex -exec-until
28726
28727 @subsubheading Synopsis
28728
28729 @smallexample
28730 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28731 @end smallexample
28732
28733 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28734 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28735 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28736 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28737
28738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28739
28740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28741
28742 @subsubheading Example
28743
28744 @smallexample
28745 (gdb)
28746 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28747 ^running
28748 (gdb)
28749 x = 55
28750 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28751 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28752 (gdb)
28753 @end smallexample
28754
28755 @ignore
28756 @subheading -file-clear
28757 Is this going away????
28758 @end ignore
28759
28760 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28761 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28762 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28763
28764 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28765 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28766
28767 @smallexample
28768 -enable-frame-filters
28769 @end smallexample
28770
28771 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28772 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28773 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28774 request that this functionality be enabled.
28775
28776 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28777
28778 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28779 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28780
28781 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28782 @findex -stack-info-frame
28783
28784 @subsubheading Synopsis
28785
28786 @smallexample
28787 -stack-info-frame
28788 @end smallexample
28789
28790 Get info on the selected frame.
28791
28792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28793
28794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28795 (without arguments).
28796
28797 @subsubheading Example
28798
28799 @smallexample
28800 (gdb)
28801 -stack-info-frame
28802 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28803 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28804 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28805 (gdb)
28806 @end smallexample
28807
28808 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28809 @findex -stack-info-depth
28810
28811 @subsubheading Synopsis
28812
28813 @smallexample
28814 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28815 @end smallexample
28816
28817 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28818 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28819
28820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28821
28822 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28823
28824 @subsubheading Example
28825
28826 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28827
28828 @smallexample
28829 (gdb)
28830 -stack-info-depth
28831 ^done,depth="12"
28832 (gdb)
28833 -stack-info-depth 4
28834 ^done,depth="4"
28835 (gdb)
28836 -stack-info-depth 12
28837 ^done,depth="12"
28838 (gdb)
28839 -stack-info-depth 11
28840 ^done,depth="11"
28841 (gdb)
28842 -stack-info-depth 13
28843 ^done,depth="12"
28844 (gdb)
28845 @end smallexample
28846
28847 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28848 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28849 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28850
28851 @subsubheading Synopsis
28852
28853 @smallexample
28854 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28855 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28856 @end smallexample
28857
28858 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28859 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28860 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28861 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28862 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28863 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28864 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28865 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28866
28867 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28868 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28869 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28870 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28871 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28872 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28873
28874 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28875 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28876 are still displayed, however.
28877
28878 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28879 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28880
28881 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28882
28883 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28884 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28885 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28886
28887 @subsubheading Example
28888
28889 @smallexample
28890 (gdb)
28891 -stack-list-frames
28892 ^done,
28893 stack=[
28894 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28895 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28896 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28897 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28898 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28899 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28900 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28901 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28902 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28903 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28904 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28905 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28906 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28907 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28908 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28909 (gdb)
28910 -stack-list-arguments 0
28911 ^done,
28912 stack-args=[
28913 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28914 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28915 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28916 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28917 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28918 (gdb)
28919 -stack-list-arguments 1
28920 ^done,
28921 stack-args=[
28922 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28923 frame=@{level="1",
28924 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28925 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28926 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28927 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28928 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28929 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28930 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28931 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28932 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28933 (gdb)
28934 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28935 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28936 (gdb)
28937 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28938 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28939 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28940 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28941 (gdb)
28942 @end smallexample
28943
28944 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28945
28946
28947 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28948 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28949 @findex -stack-list-frames
28950
28951 @subsubheading Synopsis
28952
28953 @smallexample
28954 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28955 @end smallexample
28956
28957 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28958 following info:
28959
28960 @table @samp
28961 @item @var{level}
28962 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28963 @item @var{addr}
28964 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28965 @item @var{func}
28966 Function name.
28967 @item @var{file}
28968 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28969 @item @var{fullname}
28970 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28971 @item @var{line}
28972 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28973 @item @var{from}
28974 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28975 if the frame's function is not known.
28976 @end table
28977
28978 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28979 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28980 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28981 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28982 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28983 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28984 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28985 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28986 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28987
28988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28989
28990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28991
28992 @subsubheading Example
28993
28994 Full stack backtrace:
28995
28996 @smallexample
28997 (gdb)
28998 -stack-list-frames
28999 ^done,stack=
29000 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29001 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29002 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29003 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29004 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29005 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29006 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29007 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29008 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29009 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29010 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29011 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29012 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29013 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29014 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29015 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29016 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29017 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29018 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29019 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29020 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29021 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29022 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29023 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29024 (gdb)
29025 @end smallexample
29026
29027 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29028
29029 @smallexample
29030 (gdb)
29031 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29032 ^done,stack=
29033 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29034 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29035 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29036 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29037 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29038 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29039 (gdb)
29040 @end smallexample
29041
29042 Show a single frame:
29043
29044 @smallexample
29045 (gdb)
29046 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29047 ^done,stack=
29048 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29049 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29050 (gdb)
29051 @end smallexample
29052
29053
29054 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29055 @findex -stack-list-locals
29056 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29057
29058 @subsubheading Synopsis
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29062 @end smallexample
29063
29064 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29065 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29066 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29067 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29068 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29069 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29070 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29071 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29072 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29073 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29074
29075 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29076 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29077 variables are still displayed, however.
29078
29079 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29080 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29081
29082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29083
29084 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29085
29086 @subsubheading Example
29087
29088 @smallexample
29089 (gdb)
29090 -stack-list-locals 0
29091 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29092 (gdb)
29093 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29094 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29095 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29096 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29097 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29098 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29099 (gdb)
29100 @end smallexample
29101
29102 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29103 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29104 @findex -stack-list-variables
29105
29106 @subsubheading Synopsis
29107
29108 @smallexample
29109 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29110 @end smallexample
29111
29112 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29113 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29114 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29115 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29116 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29117 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29118 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29119
29120 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29121 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29122 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29123
29124 @subsubheading Example
29125
29126 @smallexample
29127 (gdb)
29128 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29129 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29130 (gdb)
29131 @end smallexample
29132
29133
29134 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29135 @findex -stack-select-frame
29136
29137 @subsubheading Synopsis
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29141 @end smallexample
29142
29143 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29144 the stack.
29145
29146 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29147 option to every command.
29148
29149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29150
29151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29152 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29153
29154 @subsubheading Example
29155
29156 @smallexample
29157 (gdb)
29158 -stack-select-frame 2
29159 ^done
29160 (gdb)
29161 @end smallexample
29162
29163 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29164 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29165 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29166
29167 @ignore
29168
29169 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29170
29171 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29172 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29173 used by @code{Insight}.
29174
29175 The two main reasons for that are:
29176
29177 @enumerate 1
29178 @item
29179 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29180
29181 @item
29182 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29183 now).
29184 @end enumerate
29185
29186 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29187 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29188 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29189 hints about their use.
29190
29191 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29192 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29193 least, the following operations:
29194
29195 @itemize @bullet
29196 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29197 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29198 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29199 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29200 @end itemize
29201
29202 @end ignore
29203
29204 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29205
29206 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29207
29208 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29209 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29210 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29211 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29212 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29213 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29214 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29215 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29216 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29217 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29218 object, or to change display format.
29219
29220 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29221 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29222 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29223 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29224 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29225 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29226 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29227 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29228 child will be created.
29229
29230 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29231 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29232 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29233 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29234 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29235
29236 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29237 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29238 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29239 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29240 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29241 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29242 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29243 variables that frontend has created.
29244
29245 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29246 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29247 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29248 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29249 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29250 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29251 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29252 implicitly updated.
29253
29254 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29255 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29256 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29257 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29258 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29259 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29260 frame. Consider this example:
29261
29262 @smallexample
29263 void do_work(...)
29264 @{
29265 struct work_state state;
29266
29267 if (...)
29268 do_work(...);
29269 @}
29270 @end smallexample
29271
29272 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29273 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29274 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29275 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29276 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29277
29278 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29279 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29280 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29281 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29282 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29283 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29284
29285 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29286 access this functionality:
29287
29288 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29289 @item @strong{Operation}
29290 @tab @strong{Description}
29291
29292 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29293 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29294 @item @code{-var-create}
29295 @tab create a variable object
29296 @item @code{-var-delete}
29297 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29298 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29299 @tab set the display format of this variable
29300 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29301 @tab show the display format of this variable
29302 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29303 @tab tells how many children this object has
29304 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29305 @tab return a list of the object's children
29306 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29307 @tab show the type of this variable object
29308 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29309 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29310 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29311 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29312 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29313 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29314 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29315 @tab get the value of this variable
29316 @item @code{-var-assign}
29317 @tab set the value of this variable
29318 @item @code{-var-update}
29319 @tab update the variable and its children
29320 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29321 @tab set frozeness attribute
29322 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29323 @tab set range of children to display on update
29324 @end multitable
29325
29326 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29327 how it can be used.
29328
29329 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29330
29331 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29332 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29333
29334 @smallexample
29335 -enable-pretty-printing
29336 @end smallexample
29337
29338 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29339 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29340 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29341 request that this functionality be enabled.
29342
29343 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29344
29345 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29346 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29347
29348 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29349 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29350
29351 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29352 @findex -var-create
29353
29354 @subsubheading Synopsis
29355
29356 @smallexample
29357 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29358 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29359 @end smallexample
29360
29361 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29362 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29363 register.
29364
29365 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29366 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29367 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29368 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29369 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29370
29371 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29372 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29373 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29374 object must be created.
29375
29376 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29377 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29378
29379 @itemize @bullet
29380 @item
29381 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29382
29383 @item
29384 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29385
29386 @item
29387 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29388 @end itemize
29389
29390 @cindex dynamic varobj
29391 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29392 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29393 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29394 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29395 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29396 compatibility for existing clients.
29397
29398 @subsubheading Result
29399
29400 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29401 are:
29402
29403 @table @samp
29404 @item name
29405 The name of the varobj.
29406
29407 @item numchild
29408 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29409 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29410 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29411
29412 @item value
29413 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29414 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29415 will not be interesting.
29416
29417 @item type
29418 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29419 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29420 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29421 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29422 @emph{declared} one.
29423
29424 @item thread-id
29425 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29426 thread's global identifier.
29427
29428 @item has_more
29429 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29430 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29431
29432 @item dynamic
29433 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29434 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29435 then this attribute will not be present.
29436
29437 @item displayhint
29438 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29439 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29440 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29441 @end table
29442
29443 Typical output will look like this:
29444
29445 @smallexample
29446 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29447 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450
29451 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29452 @findex -var-delete
29453
29454 @subsubheading Synopsis
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29458 @end smallexample
29459
29460 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29461 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29462
29463 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29464
29465
29466 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29467 @findex -var-set-format
29468
29469 @subsubheading Synopsis
29470
29471 @smallexample
29472 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29473 @end smallexample
29474
29475 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29476 @var{format-spec}.
29477
29478 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29479 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29480
29481 @smallexample
29482 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29483 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29484 @end smallexample
29485
29486 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29487 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29488 for pointers, etc.).
29489
29490 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29491 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29492 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29493 zero-hexadecimal format.
29494
29495 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29496 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29497
29498 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29499 @findex -var-show-format
29500
29501 @subsubheading Synopsis
29502
29503 @smallexample
29504 -var-show-format @var{name}
29505 @end smallexample
29506
29507 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29508
29509 @smallexample
29510 @var{format} @expansion{}
29511 @var{format-spec}
29512 @end smallexample
29513
29514
29515 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29516 @findex -var-info-num-children
29517
29518 @subsubheading Synopsis
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29522 @end smallexample
29523
29524 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29525
29526 @smallexample
29527 numchild=@var{n}
29528 @end smallexample
29529
29530 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29531 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29532 be available.
29533
29534
29535 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29536 @findex -var-list-children
29537
29538 @subsubheading Synopsis
29539
29540 @smallexample
29541 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29542 @end smallexample
29543 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29544
29545 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29546 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29547 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29548 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29549 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29550 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29551 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29552 and unions.
29553
29554 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29555 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29556 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29557 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29558 reported.
29559
29560 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29561 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29562 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29563 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29564 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29565 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29566 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29567 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29568 the visible items.
29569
29570 For each child the following results are returned:
29571
29572 @table @var
29573
29574 @item name
29575 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29576
29577 @item exp
29578 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29579 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29580
29581 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29582 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29583
29584 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29585 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29586 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29587 type and value are not present.
29588
29589 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29590 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29591 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29592
29593 @item numchild
29594 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29595 0.
29596
29597 @item type
29598 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29599 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29600 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29601 @emph{declared} one.
29602
29603 @item value
29604 If values were requested, this is the value.
29605
29606 @item thread-id
29607 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29608 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29609
29610 @item frozen
29611 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29612
29613 @item displayhint
29614 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29615 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29616 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29617
29618 @item dynamic
29619 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29620 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29621 then this attribute will not be present.
29622
29623 @end table
29624
29625 The result may have its own attributes:
29626
29627 @table @samp
29628 @item displayhint
29629 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29630 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29631 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29632
29633 @item has_more
29634 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29635 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29636 @end table
29637
29638 @subsubheading Example
29639
29640 @smallexample
29641 (gdb)
29642 -var-list-children n
29643 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29644 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29645 (gdb)
29646 -var-list-children --all-values n
29647 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29648 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29649 @end smallexample
29650
29651
29652 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29653 @findex -var-info-type
29654
29655 @subsubheading Synopsis
29656
29657 @smallexample
29658 -var-info-type @var{name}
29659 @end smallexample
29660
29661 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29662 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29663 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29664
29665 @smallexample
29666 type=@var{typename}
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669
29670 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29671 @findex -var-info-expression
29672
29673 @subsubheading Synopsis
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29680 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29681 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29682
29683 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29684 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29685
29686 @smallexample
29687 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29688 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29689 @end smallexample
29690
29691 @noindent
29692 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29693 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29694
29695 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29696 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29697 is of limited use.
29698
29699 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29700 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29701
29702 @subsubheading Synopsis
29703
29704 @smallexample
29705 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29706 @end smallexample
29707
29708 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29709 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29710 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29711 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29712 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29713 watchpoint from a variable object.
29714
29715 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29716 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29717
29718 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29719 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29720 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29721 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29722 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29723 @smallexample
29724 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29725 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29726 @end smallexample
29727
29728 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29729 @findex -var-show-attributes
29730
29731 @subsubheading Synopsis
29732
29733 @smallexample
29734 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29735 @end smallexample
29736
29737 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29738
29739 @smallexample
29740 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29741 @end smallexample
29742
29743 @noindent
29744 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29745
29746 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29747 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29748
29749 @subsubheading Synopsis
29750
29751 @smallexample
29752 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29756 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29757 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29758 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29759 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29760 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29761 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29762
29763 @smallexample
29764 value=@var{value}
29765 @end smallexample
29766
29767 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29768 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29769
29770 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29771 @findex -var-assign
29772
29773 @subsubheading Synopsis
29774
29775 @smallexample
29776 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29777 @end smallexample
29778
29779 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29780 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29781 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29782 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29783
29784 @subsubheading Example
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 (gdb)
29788 -var-assign var1 3
29789 ^done,value="3"
29790 (gdb)
29791 -var-update *
29792 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29793 (gdb)
29794 @end smallexample
29795
29796 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29797 @findex -var-update
29798
29799 @subsubheading Synopsis
29800
29801 @smallexample
29802 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29803 @end smallexample
29804
29805 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29806 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29807 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29808 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29809 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29810 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29811 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29812 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29813 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29814 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29815 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29816 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29817 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29818
29819 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29820 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29821 diagnostic.
29822
29823 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29824 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29825
29826 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29827 @samp{changelist}.
29828
29829 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29830
29831 @table @samp
29832 @item name
29833 The name of the varobj.
29834
29835 @item value
29836 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29837 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29838
29839 @item in_scope
29840 @anchor{-var-update}
29841 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29842
29843 @table @code
29844 @item "true"
29845 The variable object's current value is valid.
29846
29847 @item "false"
29848 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29849 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29850 scope.
29851
29852 @item "invalid"
29853 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29854 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29855 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29856 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29857 objects.
29858 @end table
29859
29860 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29861 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29862
29863 @item type_changed
29864 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29865 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29866 be @samp{false}.
29867
29868 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29869 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29870 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29871 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29872 unset.
29873
29874 @item new_type
29875 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29876 hold the new type.
29877
29878 @item new_num_children
29879 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29880 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29881
29882 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29883 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29884 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29885 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29886 children which may be available.
29887
29888 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29889 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29890 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29891 only happen at the end of the update range).
29892
29893 @item displayhint
29894 The display hint, if any.
29895
29896 @item has_more
29897 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29898 available outside the varobj's update range.
29899
29900 @item dynamic
29901 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29902 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29903 then this attribute will not be present.
29904
29905 @item new_children
29906 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29907 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29908 be listed in this attribute.
29909 @end table
29910
29911 @subsubheading Example
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 (gdb)
29915 -var-assign var1 3
29916 ^done,value="3"
29917 (gdb)
29918 -var-update --all-values var1
29919 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29920 type_changed="false"@}]
29921 (gdb)
29922 @end smallexample
29923
29924 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29925 @findex -var-set-frozen
29926 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29927
29928 @subsubheading Synopsis
29929
29930 @smallexample
29931 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29932 @end smallexample
29933
29934 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29935 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29936 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29937 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29938 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29939 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29940 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29941 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29942 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29943 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29944 @code{-var-update} does.
29945
29946 @subsubheading Example
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 (gdb)
29950 -var-set-frozen V 1
29951 ^done
29952 (gdb)
29953 @end smallexample
29954
29955 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29956 @findex -var-set-update-range
29957 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29958
29959 @subsubheading Synopsis
29960
29961 @smallexample
29962 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29963 @end smallexample
29964
29965 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29966 @code{-var-update}.
29967
29968 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29969 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29970 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29971 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29972
29973 @subsubheading Example
29974
29975 @smallexample
29976 (gdb)
29977 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29978 ^done
29979 @end smallexample
29980
29981 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29982 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29983 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29984
29985 @subsubheading Synopsis
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29992
29993 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29994 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29995
29996 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29997 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29998 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29999 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30000 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30001 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30002 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30003
30004 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30005 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30006 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30007 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30008
30009 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30010 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30011 can be used to check this.
30012
30013 @subsubheading Example
30014
30015 Resetting the visualizer:
30016
30017 @smallexample
30018 (gdb)
30019 -var-set-visualizer V None
30020 ^done
30021 @end smallexample
30022
30023 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 (gdb)
30027 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30028 ^done
30029 @end smallexample
30030
30031 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30032 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30033
30034 @smallexample
30035 (gdb)
30036 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30037 ^done
30038 @end smallexample
30039
30040 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30041 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30042 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30043
30044 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30045 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30046 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30047 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30048
30049 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30050 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30051
30052 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30053 @c @subheading -data-assign
30054 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30055 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30056 @c set variable
30057 @c @subsubheading Example
30058 @c N.A.
30059
30060 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30061 @findex -data-disassemble
30062
30063 @subsubheading Synopsis
30064
30065 @smallexample
30066 -data-disassemble
30067 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30068 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30069 -- @var{mode}
30070 @end smallexample
30071
30072 @noindent
30073 Where:
30074
30075 @table @samp
30076 @item @var{start-addr}
30077 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30078 @item @var{end-addr}
30079 is the end address
30080 @item @var{filename}
30081 is the name of the file to disassemble
30082 @item @var{linenum}
30083 is the line number to disassemble around
30084 @item @var{lines}
30085 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30086 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30087 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30088 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30089 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30090 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30091 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30092 are displayed.
30093 @item @var{mode}
30094 is one of:
30095 @itemize @bullet
30096 @item 0 disassembly only
30097 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30098 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30099 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30100 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30101 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30102 @end itemize
30103
30104 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30105 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30106 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30107 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30108 @end table
30109
30110 @subsubheading Result
30111
30112 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30113 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30114 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30115
30116 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30117 following fields:
30118
30119 @table @code
30120 @item address
30121 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30122
30123 @item func-name
30124 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30125
30126 @item offset
30127 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30128
30129 @item inst
30130 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30131
30132 @item opcodes
30133 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30134 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30135
30136 @end table
30137
30138 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30139 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30140
30141 @table @code
30142 @item line
30143 The line number within @samp{file}.
30144
30145 @item file
30146 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30147 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30148 used.
30149
30150 @item fullname
30151 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30152 using the source file search path
30153 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30154 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30155
30156 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30157 present in the debug information.
30158
30159 @item line_asm_insn
30160 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30161 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30162 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30163 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30164 @samp{opcodes}.
30165
30166 @end table
30167
30168 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30169 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30170 adjust its format.
30171
30172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30173
30174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30175
30176 @subsubheading Example
30177
30178 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30179
30180 @smallexample
30181 (gdb)
30182 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30183 ^done,
30184 asm_insns=[
30185 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30186 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30187 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30188 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30189 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30190 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30191 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30192 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30193 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30194 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30195 (gdb)
30196 @end smallexample
30197
30198 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30199 @code{main}.
30200
30201 @smallexample
30202 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30203 ^done,asm_insns=[
30204 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30205 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30206 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30207 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30208 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30209 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30210 [@dots{}]
30211 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30212 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30213 (gdb)
30214 @end smallexample
30215
30216 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30217
30218 @smallexample
30219 (gdb)
30220 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30221 ^done,asm_insns=[
30222 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30223 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30224 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30225 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30226 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30227 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30228 (gdb)
30229 @end smallexample
30230
30231 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30232
30233 @smallexample
30234 (gdb)
30235 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30236 ^done,asm_insns=[
30237 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30238 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30239 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30240 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30241 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30242 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30243 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30244 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30245 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30246 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30247 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30248 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30249 (gdb)
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252
30253 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30254 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30255
30256 @subsubheading Synopsis
30257
30258 @smallexample
30259 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30260 @end smallexample
30261
30262 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30263 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30264 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30265
30266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30267
30268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30269 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30270 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30271
30272 @subsubheading Example
30273
30274 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30275 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30276 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30277 output.
30278
30279 @smallexample
30280 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30281 211^done,value="1"
30282 (gdb)
30283 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30284 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30285 (gdb)
30286 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30287 411^done,value="4"
30288 (gdb)
30289 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30290 511^done,value="4"
30291 (gdb)
30292 @end smallexample
30293
30294
30295 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30296 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30297
30298 @subsubheading Synopsis
30299
30300 @smallexample
30301 -data-list-changed-registers
30302 @end smallexample
30303
30304 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30305
30306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30307
30308 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30309 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30310
30311 @subsubheading Example
30312
30313 On a PPC MBX board:
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 (gdb)
30317 -exec-continue
30318 ^running
30319
30320 (gdb)
30321 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30322 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30323 line="5"@}
30324 (gdb)
30325 -data-list-changed-registers
30326 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30327 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30328 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30329 (gdb)
30330 @end smallexample
30331
30332
30333 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30334 @findex -data-list-register-names
30335
30336 @subsubheading Synopsis
30337
30338 @smallexample
30339 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30340 @end smallexample
30341
30342 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30343 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30344 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30345 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30346 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30347 include empty register names.
30348
30349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30350
30351 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30352 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30353 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30354
30355 @subsubheading Example
30356
30357 For the PPC MBX board:
30358 @smallexample
30359 (gdb)
30360 -data-list-register-names
30361 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30362 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30363 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30364 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30365 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30366 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30367 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30368 (gdb)
30369 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30370 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30371 (gdb)
30372 @end smallexample
30373
30374 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30375 @findex -data-list-register-values
30376
30377 @subsubheading Synopsis
30378
30379 @smallexample
30380 -data-list-register-values
30381 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30382 @end smallexample
30383
30384 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30385 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30386 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30387 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30388 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30389 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30390
30391 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30392
30393 @table @code
30394 @item x
30395 Hexadecimal
30396 @item o
30397 Octal
30398 @item t
30399 Binary
30400 @item d
30401 Decimal
30402 @item r
30403 Raw
30404 @item N
30405 Natural
30406 @end table
30407
30408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30409
30410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30411 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30412
30413 @subsubheading Example
30414
30415 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30416 don't appear in the actual output):
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 (gdb)
30420 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30421 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30422 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30423 (gdb)
30424 -data-list-register-values x
30425 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30426 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30427 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30428 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30429 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30430 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30431 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30432 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30433 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30434 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30435 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30436 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30437 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30438 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30439 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30440 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30441 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30442 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30443 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30444 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30445 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30446 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30447 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30448 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30449 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30450 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30451 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30452 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30453 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30454 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30455 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30456 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30457 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30458 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30459 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30460 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30461 (gdb)
30462 @end smallexample
30463
30464
30465 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30466 @findex -data-read-memory
30467
30468 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30469
30470 @subsubheading Synopsis
30471
30472 @smallexample
30473 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30474 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30475 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30476 @end smallexample
30477
30478 @noindent
30479 where:
30480
30481 @table @samp
30482 @item @var{address}
30483 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30484 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30485 quoted using the C convention.
30486
30487 @item @var{word-format}
30488 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30489 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30490 ,Output Formats}).
30491
30492 @item @var{word-size}
30493 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30494
30495 @item @var{nr-rows}
30496 The number of rows in the output table.
30497
30498 @item @var{nr-cols}
30499 The number of columns in the output table.
30500
30501 @item @var{aschar}
30502 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30503 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30504 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30505 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30506
30507 @item @var{byte-offset}
30508 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30509 @end table
30510
30511 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30512 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30513 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30514 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30515 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30516 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30517 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30518 @samp{addr}.
30519
30520 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30521 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30522 @samp{prev-page}.
30523
30524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30525
30526 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30527 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30528
30529 @subsubheading Example
30530
30531 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30532 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30533 word. Display each word in hex.
30534
30535 @smallexample
30536 (gdb)
30537 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30538 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30539 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30540 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30541 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30542 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30543 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30544 (gdb)
30545 @end smallexample
30546
30547 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30548 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30549
30550 @smallexample
30551 (gdb)
30552 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30553 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30554 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30555 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30556 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30557 (gdb)
30558 @end smallexample
30559
30560 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30561 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30562 used as the non-printable character.
30563
30564 @smallexample
30565 (gdb)
30566 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30567 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30568 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30569 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30570 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30571 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30572 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30573 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30574 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30575 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30576 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30577 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30578 (gdb)
30579 @end smallexample
30580
30581 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30582 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30583
30584 @subsubheading Synopsis
30585
30586 @smallexample
30587 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30588 @var{address} @var{count}
30589 @end smallexample
30590
30591 @noindent
30592 where:
30593
30594 @table @samp
30595 @item @var{address}
30596 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30597 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30598 quoted using the C convention.
30599
30600 @item @var{count}
30601 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30602 literal.
30603
30604 @item @var{offset}
30605 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30606 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30607 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30608 arithmetics itself.
30609
30610 @end table
30611
30612 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30613 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30614 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30615 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30616 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30617 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30618
30619 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30620 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30621 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30622 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30623 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30624 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30625 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30626 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30627
30628 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30629 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30630 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30631 and has the following fields:
30632
30633 @table @code
30634 @item begin
30635 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30636
30637 @item end
30638 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30639
30640 @item offset
30641 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30642 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30643
30644 @item contents
30645 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30646
30647 @end table
30648
30649
30650
30651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30652
30653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30654
30655 @subsubheading Example
30656
30657 @smallexample
30658 (gdb)
30659 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30660 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30661 end="0xbffff15e",
30662 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30663 (gdb)
30664 @end smallexample
30665
30666
30667 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30668 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30669
30670 @subsubheading Synopsis
30671
30672 @smallexample
30673 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30674 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30675 @end smallexample
30676
30677 @noindent
30678 where:
30679
30680 @table @samp
30681 @item @var{address}
30682 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30683 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30684 be quoted using the C convention.
30685
30686 @item @var{contents}
30687 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30688 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30689
30690 @item @var{count}
30691 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30692 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30693 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30694 @var{count} memory units.
30695
30696 @end table
30697
30698 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30699
30700 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30701
30702 @subsubheading Example
30703
30704 @smallexample
30705 (gdb)
30706 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30707 ^done
30708 (gdb)
30709 @end smallexample
30710
30711 @smallexample
30712 (gdb)
30713 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30714 ^done
30715 (gdb)
30716 @end smallexample
30717
30718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30719 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30721
30722 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30723 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30724
30725 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30726 @findex -trace-find
30727
30728 @subsubheading Synopsis
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30735 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30736 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30737
30738 @table @samp
30739
30740 @item none
30741 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30742
30743 @item frame-number
30744 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30745 that index.
30746
30747 @item tracepoint-number
30748 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30749 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30750
30751 @item pc
30752 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30753 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30754 address.
30755
30756 @item pc-inside-range
30757 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30758 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30759 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30760
30761 @item pc-outside-range
30762 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30763 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30764 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30765
30766 @item line
30767 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30768 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30769 the specified location.
30770
30771 @end table
30772
30773 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30774 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30775
30776 @table @samp
30777 @item found
30778 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30779 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30780
30781 @item traceframe
30782 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30783 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30784
30785 @item tracepoint
30786 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30787 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30788
30789 @item frame
30790 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30791 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30792 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30793
30794 @end table
30795
30796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30797
30798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30799
30800 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30801 @findex -trace-define-variable
30802
30803 @subsubheading Synopsis
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30807 @end smallexample
30808
30809 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30810 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30811 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30812 with the @samp{$} character.
30813
30814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30815
30816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30817
30818 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30819 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30820
30821 @subsubheading Synopsis
30822
30823 @smallexample
30824 -trace-frame-collected
30825 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30826 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30827 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30828 [--memory-contents]
30829 @end smallexample
30830
30831 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30832 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30833 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30834 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30835 See the output description table below for more details.
30836
30837 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30838 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30839 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30840 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30841 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30842
30843 For instance, if the actions were
30844 @smallexample
30845 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30846 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30847 @end smallexample
30848
30849 @noindent
30850 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30851 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30852 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30853 objects would be computed expressions.
30854
30855 An example output would be:
30856
30857 @smallexample
30858 (gdb)
30859 -trace-frame-collected
30860 ^done,
30861 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30862 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30863 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30864 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30865 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30866 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30867 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30868 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30869 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30870 ...
30871 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30872 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30873 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30874 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30875 (gdb)
30876 @end smallexample
30877
30878 Where:
30879
30880 @table @code
30881 @item explicit-variables
30882 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30883 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30884 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30885 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30886 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30887 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30888 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30889 arrays, structures and unions.
30890
30891 @item computed-expressions
30892 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30893 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30894 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30895 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30896
30897 @item registers
30898 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30899 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30900 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30901 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30902 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30903
30904 @item tvars
30905 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30906 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30907 current value are returned.
30908
30909 @item memory
30910 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30911 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30912 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30913
30914 @table @code
30915 @item address
30916 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30917
30918 @item length
30919 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30920
30921 @item contents
30922 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30923 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30924
30925 @end table
30926
30927 @end table
30928
30929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30930
30931 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30932
30933 @subsubheading Example
30934
30935 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30936 @findex -trace-list-variables
30937
30938 @subsubheading Synopsis
30939
30940 @smallexample
30941 -trace-list-variables
30942 @end smallexample
30943
30944 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30945 table has the following fields:
30946
30947 @table @samp
30948 @item name
30949 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30950
30951 @item initial
30952 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30953 field is always present.
30954
30955 @item current
30956 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30957 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30958 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30959 presently running.
30960
30961 @end table
30962
30963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30964
30965 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30966
30967 @subsubheading Example
30968
30969 @smallexample
30970 (gdb)
30971 -trace-list-variables
30972 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30973 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30974 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30975 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30976 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30977 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30978 (gdb)
30979 @end smallexample
30980
30981 @subheading -trace-save
30982 @findex -trace-save
30983
30984 @subsubheading Synopsis
30985
30986 @smallexample
30987 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
30988 @end smallexample
30989
30990 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30991 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30992 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30993 to perform the save.
30994
30995 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
30996 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
30997 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
30998
30999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31000
31001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31002
31003
31004 @subheading -trace-start
31005 @findex -trace-start
31006
31007 @subsubheading Synopsis
31008
31009 @smallexample
31010 -trace-start
31011 @end smallexample
31012
31013 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31014 have any fields.
31015
31016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31017
31018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31019
31020 @subheading -trace-status
31021 @findex -trace-status
31022
31023 @subsubheading Synopsis
31024
31025 @smallexample
31026 -trace-status
31027 @end smallexample
31028
31029 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31030 the following fields:
31031
31032 @table @samp
31033
31034 @item supported
31035 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31036 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31037 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31038 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31039 started. This field is always present.
31040
31041 @item running
31042 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31043 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31044 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31045
31046 @item stop-reason
31047 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31048 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31049 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31050 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31051 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31052 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31053 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31054 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31055 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31056
31057 @item stopping-tracepoint
31058 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31059 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31060 @samp{passcount}.
31061
31062 @item frames
31063 @itemx frames-created
31064 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31065 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31066 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31067 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31068
31069 @item buffer-size
31070 @itemx buffer-free
31071 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31072 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31073
31074 @item circular
31075 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31076 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31077 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31078 and may fill up.
31079
31080 @item disconnected
31081 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31082 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31083 that the trace run will stop.
31084
31085 @item trace-file
31086 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31087 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31088
31089 @end table
31090
31091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31092
31093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31094
31095 @subheading -trace-stop
31096 @findex -trace-stop
31097
31098 @subsubheading Synopsis
31099
31100 @smallexample
31101 -trace-stop
31102 @end smallexample
31103
31104 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31105 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31106 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31107
31108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31109
31110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31111
31112
31113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31114 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31116
31117
31118 @ignore
31119 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31120 @findex -symbol-info-address
31121
31122 @subsubheading Synopsis
31123
31124 @smallexample
31125 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31126 @end smallexample
31127
31128 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31129
31130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31131
31132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31133
31134 @subsubheading Example
31135 N.A.
31136
31137
31138 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31139 @findex -symbol-info-file
31140
31141 @subsubheading Synopsis
31142
31143 @smallexample
31144 -symbol-info-file
31145 @end smallexample
31146
31147 Show the file for the symbol.
31148
31149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31150
31151 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31152 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31153
31154 @subsubheading Example
31155 N.A.
31156
31157
31158 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31159 @findex -symbol-info-function
31160
31161 @subsubheading Synopsis
31162
31163 @smallexample
31164 -symbol-info-function
31165 @end smallexample
31166
31167 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31168
31169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31170
31171 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31172
31173 @subsubheading Example
31174 N.A.
31175
31176
31177 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31178 @findex -symbol-info-line
31179
31180 @subsubheading Synopsis
31181
31182 @smallexample
31183 -symbol-info-line
31184 @end smallexample
31185
31186 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31187
31188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31189
31190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31191 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31192
31193 @subsubheading Example
31194 N.A.
31195
31196
31197 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31198 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31199
31200 @subsubheading Synopsis
31201
31202 @smallexample
31203 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31204 @end smallexample
31205
31206 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31207
31208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31209
31210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31211
31212 @subsubheading Example
31213 N.A.
31214
31215
31216 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31217 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31218
31219 @subsubheading Synopsis
31220
31221 @smallexample
31222 -symbol-list-functions
31223 @end smallexample
31224
31225 List the functions in the executable.
31226
31227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31228
31229 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31230 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31231
31232 @subsubheading Example
31233 N.A.
31234 @end ignore
31235
31236
31237 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31238 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31239
31240 @subsubheading Synopsis
31241
31242 @smallexample
31243 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31244 @end smallexample
31245
31246 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31247 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31248 ascending PC order.
31249
31250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31251
31252 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31253
31254 @subsubheading Example
31255 @smallexample
31256 (gdb)
31257 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31258 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31259 (gdb)
31260 @end smallexample
31261
31262
31263 @ignore
31264 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31265 @findex -symbol-list-types
31266
31267 @subsubheading Synopsis
31268
31269 @smallexample
31270 -symbol-list-types
31271 @end smallexample
31272
31273 List all the type names.
31274
31275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31276
31277 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31278 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31279
31280 @subsubheading Example
31281 N.A.
31282
31283
31284 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31285 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31286
31287 @subsubheading Synopsis
31288
31289 @smallexample
31290 -symbol-list-variables
31291 @end smallexample
31292
31293 List all the global and static variable names.
31294
31295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31296
31297 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31298
31299 @subsubheading Example
31300 N.A.
31301
31302
31303 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31304 @findex -symbol-locate
31305
31306 @subsubheading Synopsis
31307
31308 @smallexample
31309 -symbol-locate
31310 @end smallexample
31311
31312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31313
31314 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31315
31316 @subsubheading Example
31317 N.A.
31318
31319
31320 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31321 @findex -symbol-type
31322
31323 @subsubheading Synopsis
31324
31325 @smallexample
31326 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31327 @end smallexample
31328
31329 Show type of @var{variable}.
31330
31331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31332
31333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31334 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31335
31336 @subsubheading Example
31337 N.A.
31338 @end ignore
31339
31340
31341 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31342 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31343 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31344
31345 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31346 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31347
31348 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31349 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31350
31351 @subsubheading Synopsis
31352
31353 @smallexample
31354 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31358 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31359 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31360 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31361 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31362 notification.
31363
31364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31365
31366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31367
31368 @subsubheading Example
31369
31370 @smallexample
31371 (gdb)
31372 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31373 ^done
31374 (gdb)
31375 @end smallexample
31376
31377
31378 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31379 @findex -file-exec-file
31380
31381 @subsubheading Synopsis
31382
31383 @smallexample
31384 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31385 @end smallexample
31386
31387 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31388 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31389 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31390 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31391 notification.
31392
31393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31394
31395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31396
31397 @subsubheading Example
31398
31399 @smallexample
31400 (gdb)
31401 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31402 ^done
31403 (gdb)
31404 @end smallexample
31405
31406
31407 @ignore
31408 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31409 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31410
31411 @subsubheading Synopsis
31412
31413 @smallexample
31414 -file-list-exec-sections
31415 @end smallexample
31416
31417 List the sections of the current executable file.
31418
31419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31420
31421 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31422 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31423 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31424
31425 @subsubheading Example
31426 N.A.
31427 @end ignore
31428
31429
31430 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31431 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31432
31433 @subsubheading Synopsis
31434
31435 @smallexample
31436 -file-list-exec-source-file
31437 @end smallexample
31438
31439 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31440 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31441 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31442 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31443
31444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31445
31446 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31447
31448 @subsubheading Example
31449
31450 @smallexample
31451 (gdb)
31452 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31453 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31454 (gdb)
31455 @end smallexample
31456
31457
31458 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31459 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31460
31461 @subsubheading Synopsis
31462
31463 @smallexample
31464 -file-list-exec-source-files
31465 @end smallexample
31466
31467 List the source files for the current executable.
31468
31469 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31470 name) of a source file.
31471
31472 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31473
31474 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31475 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31476
31477 @subsubheading Example
31478 @smallexample
31479 (gdb)
31480 -file-list-exec-source-files
31481 ^done,files=[
31482 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31483 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31484 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31485 (gdb)
31486 @end smallexample
31487
31488 @ignore
31489 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31490 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31491
31492 @subsubheading Synopsis
31493
31494 @smallexample
31495 -file-list-shared-libraries
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 List the shared libraries in the program.
31499
31500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31501
31502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31503
31504 @subsubheading Example
31505 N.A.
31506
31507
31508 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31509 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31510
31511 @subsubheading Synopsis
31512
31513 @smallexample
31514 -file-list-symbol-files
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 List symbol files.
31518
31519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31520
31521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31522
31523 @subsubheading Example
31524 N.A.
31525 @end ignore
31526
31527
31528 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31529 @findex -file-symbol-file
31530
31531 @subsubheading Synopsis
31532
31533 @smallexample
31534 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31535 @end smallexample
31536
31537 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31538 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31539 produced, except for a completion notification.
31540
31541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31542
31543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31544
31545 @subsubheading Example
31546
31547 @smallexample
31548 (gdb)
31549 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31550 ^done
31551 (gdb)
31552 @end smallexample
31553
31554 @ignore
31555 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31556 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31557 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31558
31559 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31560
31561 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31562
31563 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31564
31565 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31566
31567 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31568
31569 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31570
31571 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31572
31573 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31574
31575 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31576 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31577 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31578
31579 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31580
31581 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31582
31583 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31584
31585 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31586 @end ignore
31587
31588
31589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31590 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31591 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31592
31593
31594 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31595 @findex -target-attach
31596
31597 @subsubheading Synopsis
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31604 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31605 group, the id previously returned by
31606 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31607
31608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31609
31610 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31611
31612 @subsubheading Example
31613 @smallexample
31614 (gdb)
31615 -target-attach 34
31616 =thread-created,id="1"
31617 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31618 ^done
31619 (gdb)
31620 @end smallexample
31621
31622 @ignore
31623 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31624 @findex -target-compare-sections
31625
31626 @subsubheading Synopsis
31627
31628 @smallexample
31629 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31630 @end smallexample
31631
31632 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31633 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31634
31635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31636
31637 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31638
31639 @subsubheading Example
31640 N.A.
31641 @end ignore
31642
31643
31644 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31645 @findex -target-detach
31646
31647 @subsubheading Synopsis
31648
31649 @smallexample
31650 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31651 @end smallexample
31652
31653 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31654 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31655 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31656
31657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31658
31659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31660
31661 @subsubheading Example
31662
31663 @smallexample
31664 (gdb)
31665 -target-detach
31666 ^done
31667 (gdb)
31668 @end smallexample
31669
31670
31671 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31672 @findex -target-disconnect
31673
31674 @subsubheading Synopsis
31675
31676 @smallexample
31677 -target-disconnect
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31681 generally not resumed.
31682
31683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31684
31685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31686
31687 @subsubheading Example
31688
31689 @smallexample
31690 (gdb)
31691 -target-disconnect
31692 ^done
31693 (gdb)
31694 @end smallexample
31695
31696
31697 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31698 @findex -target-download
31699
31700 @subsubheading Synopsis
31701
31702 @smallexample
31703 -target-download
31704 @end smallexample
31705
31706 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31707 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31708
31709 @table @samp
31710 @item section
31711 The name of the section.
31712 @item section-sent
31713 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31714 @item section-size
31715 The size of the section.
31716 @item total-sent
31717 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31718 @item total-size
31719 The size of the overall executable to download.
31720 @end table
31721
31722 @noindent
31723 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31724 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31725
31726 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31727 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31728
31729 @table @samp
31730 @item section
31731 The name of the section.
31732 @item section-size
31733 The size of the section.
31734 @item total-size
31735 The size of the overall executable to download.
31736 @end table
31737
31738 @noindent
31739 At the end, a summary is printed.
31740
31741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31742
31743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31744
31745 @subsubheading Example
31746
31747 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31748 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31749
31750 @smallexample
31751 (gdb)
31752 -target-download
31753 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31754 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31755 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31756 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31757 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31758 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31759 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31760 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31761 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31762 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31763 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31764 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31765 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31766 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31767 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31768 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31769 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31770 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31771 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31772 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31773 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31774 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31775 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31776 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31777 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31778 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31779 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31780 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31781 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31782 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31783 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31784 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31785 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31786 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31787 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31788 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31789 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31790 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31791 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31792 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31793 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31794 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31795 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31796 write-rate="429"
31797 (gdb)
31798 @end smallexample
31799
31800
31801 @ignore
31802 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31803 @findex -target-exec-status
31804
31805 @subsubheading Synopsis
31806
31807 @smallexample
31808 -target-exec-status
31809 @end smallexample
31810
31811 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31812 not, for instance).
31813
31814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31815
31816 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31817
31818 @subsubheading Example
31819 N.A.
31820
31821
31822 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31823 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31824
31825 @subsubheading Synopsis
31826
31827 @smallexample
31828 -target-list-available-targets
31829 @end smallexample
31830
31831 List the possible targets to connect to.
31832
31833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31834
31835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31836
31837 @subsubheading Example
31838 N.A.
31839
31840
31841 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31842 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31843
31844 @subsubheading Synopsis
31845
31846 @smallexample
31847 -target-list-current-targets
31848 @end smallexample
31849
31850 Describe the current target.
31851
31852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31853
31854 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31855 other things).
31856
31857 @subsubheading Example
31858 N.A.
31859
31860
31861 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31862 @findex -target-list-parameters
31863
31864 @subsubheading Synopsis
31865
31866 @smallexample
31867 -target-list-parameters
31868 @end smallexample
31869
31870 @c ????
31871 @end ignore
31872
31873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31874
31875 No equivalent.
31876
31877 @subsubheading Example
31878 N.A.
31879
31880 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
31881 @findex -target-flash-erase
31882
31883 @subsubheading Synopsis
31884
31885 @smallexample
31886 -target-flash-erase
31887 @end smallexample
31888
31889 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
31890
31891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
31892
31893 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
31894 addresses and memory region sizes.
31895
31896 @smallexample
31897 (gdb)
31898 -target-flash-erase
31899 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
31900 (gdb)
31901 @end smallexample
31902
31903 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31904 @findex -target-select
31905
31906 @subsubheading Synopsis
31907
31908 @smallexample
31909 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31910 @end smallexample
31911
31912 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31913
31914 @table @samp
31915 @item @var{type}
31916 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31917 @item @var{parameters}
31918 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31919 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31920 @end table
31921
31922 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31923 which the target program is, in the following form:
31924
31925 @smallexample
31926 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31927 args=[@var{arg list}]
31928 @end smallexample
31929
31930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31931
31932 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31933
31934 @subsubheading Example
31935
31936 @smallexample
31937 (gdb)
31938 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31939 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31940 (gdb)
31941 @end smallexample
31942
31943 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31944 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31945 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31946
31947
31948 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31949 @findex -target-file-put
31950
31951 @subsubheading Synopsis
31952
31953 @smallexample
31954 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31955 @end smallexample
31956
31957 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31958 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31959
31960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31961
31962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31963
31964 @subsubheading Example
31965
31966 @smallexample
31967 (gdb)
31968 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31969 ^done
31970 (gdb)
31971 @end smallexample
31972
31973
31974 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31975 @findex -target-file-get
31976
31977 @subsubheading Synopsis
31978
31979 @smallexample
31980 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31981 @end smallexample
31982
31983 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31984 on the host system.
31985
31986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31987
31988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31989
31990 @subsubheading Example
31991
31992 @smallexample
31993 (gdb)
31994 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31995 ^done
31996 (gdb)
31997 @end smallexample
31998
31999
32000 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32001 @findex -target-file-delete
32002
32003 @subsubheading Synopsis
32004
32005 @smallexample
32006 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32007 @end smallexample
32008
32009 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32010
32011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32012
32013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32014
32015 @subsubheading Example
32016
32017 @smallexample
32018 (gdb)
32019 -target-file-delete remotefile
32020 ^done
32021 (gdb)
32022 @end smallexample
32023
32024
32025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32026 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32027 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32028
32029 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32030 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32031
32032 @subsubheading Synopsis
32033
32034 @smallexample
32035 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32036 @end smallexample
32037
32038 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32039 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32040 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32041
32042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32043
32044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32045
32046 @subsubheading Result
32047
32048 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32049 defined for each exception:
32050
32051 @table @samp
32052 @item name
32053 The name of the exception.
32054
32055 @item address
32056 The address of the exception.
32057
32058 @end table
32059
32060 @subsubheading Example
32061
32062 @smallexample
32063 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32064 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32065 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32066 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32067 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32068 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32069 @end smallexample
32070
32071 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32072
32073 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32074 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32075 Catchpoint Commands}.
32076
32077
32078 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32079 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32080 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32081
32082 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32083 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32084 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32085 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32086
32087 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32088 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32089 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32090
32091 @subsubheading Synopsis
32092
32093 @smallexample
32094 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32095 @end smallexample
32096
32097 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32098
32099 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32100 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32101 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32102 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32103 dash.
32104
32105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32106
32107 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32108
32109 @subsubheading Result
32110
32111 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32112
32113 @table @samp
32114 @item exists
32115 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32116 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32117
32118 @end table
32119
32120 @subsubheading Example
32121
32122 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32123
32124 @smallexample
32125 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32126 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32127 @end smallexample
32128
32129 @noindent
32130 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32131 to the debugger:
32132
32133 @smallexample
32134 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32135 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32136 @end smallexample
32137
32138 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32139 @findex -list-features
32140 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32141
32142 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32143 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32144 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32145 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32146 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32147 startup.
32148
32149 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32150 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32151 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32152 is given below.
32153
32154 Example output:
32155
32156 @smallexample
32157 (gdb) -list-features
32158 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32159 @end smallexample
32160
32161 The current list of features is:
32162
32163 @ftable @samp
32164 @item frozen-varobjs
32165 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32166 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32167 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32168 @item pending-breakpoints
32169 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32170 command.
32171 @item python
32172 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32173 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32174 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32175 @item thread-info
32176 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32177 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32178 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32179 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32180 @item breakpoint-notifications
32181 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32182 CLI will be announced via async records.
32183 @item ada-task-info
32184 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32185 @item language-option
32186 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32187 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32188 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32189 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32190 @item undefined-command-error-code
32191 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32192 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32193 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32194 @item exec-run-start-option
32195 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32196 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32197 @end ftable
32198
32199 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32200 @findex -list-target-features
32201
32202 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32203 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32204 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32205 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32206 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32207 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32208 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32209 Example output:
32210
32211 @smallexample
32212 (gdb) -list-target-features
32213 ^done,result=["async"]
32214 @end smallexample
32215
32216 The current list of features is:
32217
32218 @table @samp
32219 @item async
32220 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32221 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32222 while the target is running.
32223
32224 @item reverse
32225 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32226 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32227
32228 @end table
32229
32230 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32231 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32232 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32233
32234 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32235
32236 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32237 @findex -gdb-exit
32238
32239 @subsubheading Synopsis
32240
32241 @smallexample
32242 -gdb-exit
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32246
32247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32248
32249 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32250
32251 @subsubheading Example
32252
32253 @smallexample
32254 (gdb)
32255 -gdb-exit
32256 ^exit
32257 @end smallexample
32258
32259
32260 @ignore
32261 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32262 @findex -exec-abort
32263
32264 @subsubheading Synopsis
32265
32266 @smallexample
32267 -exec-abort
32268 @end smallexample
32269
32270 Kill the inferior running program.
32271
32272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32273
32274 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32275
32276 @subsubheading Example
32277 N.A.
32278 @end ignore
32279
32280
32281 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32282 @findex -gdb-set
32283
32284 @subsubheading Synopsis
32285
32286 @smallexample
32287 -gdb-set
32288 @end smallexample
32289
32290 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32291 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32292
32293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32294
32295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32296
32297 @subsubheading Example
32298
32299 @smallexample
32300 (gdb)
32301 -gdb-set $foo=3
32302 ^done
32303 (gdb)
32304 @end smallexample
32305
32306
32307 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32308 @findex -gdb-show
32309
32310 @subsubheading Synopsis
32311
32312 @smallexample
32313 -gdb-show
32314 @end smallexample
32315
32316 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32317
32318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32319
32320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32321
32322 @subsubheading Example
32323
32324 @smallexample
32325 (gdb)
32326 -gdb-show annotate
32327 ^done,value="0"
32328 (gdb)
32329 @end smallexample
32330
32331 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32332
32333
32334 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32335 @findex -gdb-version
32336
32337 @subsubheading Synopsis
32338
32339 @smallexample
32340 -gdb-version
32341 @end smallexample
32342
32343 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32344
32345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32346
32347 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32348 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32349
32350 @subsubheading Example
32351
32352 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32353 @c box in TeX.
32354 @smallexample
32355 (gdb)
32356 -gdb-version
32357 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32358 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32359 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32360 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32361 ~ certain conditions.
32362 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32363 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32364 ~ details.
32365 ~This GDB was configured as
32366 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32367 ^done
32368 (gdb)
32369 @end smallexample
32370
32371 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32372 @findex -list-thread-groups
32373
32374 @subheading Synopsis
32375
32376 @smallexample
32377 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32378 @end smallexample
32379
32380 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32381 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32382 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32383 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32384 top-level thread groups.
32385
32386 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32387 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32388 available on the target.
32389
32390 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32391 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32392 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32393 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32394 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32395 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32396 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32397 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32398
32399 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32400 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32401 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32402 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32403 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32404 @samp{threads} field.
32405
32406 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32407 the following caveats:
32408
32409 @itemize @bullet
32410 @item
32411 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32412 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32413 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32414
32415 @item
32416 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32417 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32418 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32419 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32420 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32421 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32422
32423 @end itemize
32424
32425 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32426 have the following fields:
32427
32428 @table @code
32429 @item id
32430 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32431 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32432 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32433
32434 @item type
32435 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32436 valid type.
32437
32438 @item pid
32439 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32440 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32441
32442 @item exit-code
32443 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32444 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32445 only if the process is not running.
32446
32447 @item num_children
32448 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32449 absent for an available thread group.
32450
32451 @item threads
32452 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32453 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32454 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32455
32456 @item cores
32457 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32458 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32459 such information is not available.
32460
32461 @item executable
32462 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32463 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32464 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32465
32466 @end table
32467
32468 @subheading Example
32469
32470 @smallexample
32471 @value{GDBP}
32472 -list-thread-groups
32473 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32474 -list-thread-groups 17
32475 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32476 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32477 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32478 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32479 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32480 -list-thread-groups --available
32481 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32482 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32483 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32484 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32485 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32486 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32487 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32488 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32489 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32490 @end smallexample
32491
32492 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32493 @findex -info-os
32494
32495 @subsubheading Synopsis
32496
32497 @smallexample
32498 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32499 @end smallexample
32500
32501 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32502 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32503 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32504 of data of that type.
32505
32506 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32507 system.
32508
32509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32510
32511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32512
32513 @subsubheading Example
32514
32515 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32516 like this:
32517
32518 @smallexample
32519 @value{GDBP}
32520 -info-os
32521 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32522 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32523 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32524 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32525 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32526 col2="CPUs"@},
32527 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32528 col2="File descriptors"@},
32529 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32530 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32531 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32532 col2="Message queues"@},
32533 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32534 col2="Processes"@},
32535 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32536 col2="Process groups"@},
32537 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32538 col2="Semaphores"@},
32539 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32540 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32541 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32542 col2="Sockets"@},
32543 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32544 col2="Threads"@}]
32545 @value{GDBP}
32546 -info-os processes
32547 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32548 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32549 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32550 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32551 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32552 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32553 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32554 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32555 ...
32556 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32557 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32558 (gdb)
32559 @end smallexample
32560
32561 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32562 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32563 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32564 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32565 @code{info os} omits it.)
32566
32567 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32568 @findex -add-inferior
32569
32570 @subheading Synopsis
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 -add-inferior
32574 @end smallexample
32575
32576 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32577 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32578 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32579 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32580 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32581 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32582
32583 @subheading Example
32584
32585 @smallexample
32586 @value{GDBP}
32587 -add-inferior
32588 ^done,inferior="i3"
32589 @end smallexample
32590
32591 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32592 @findex -interpreter-exec
32593
32594 @subheading Synopsis
32595
32596 @smallexample
32597 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32598 @end smallexample
32599 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32600
32601 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32602
32603 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32604
32605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32606
32607 @subheading Example
32608
32609 @smallexample
32610 (gdb)
32611 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32612 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32613 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32614 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32615 ^done
32616 (gdb)
32617 @end smallexample
32618
32619 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32620 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32621
32622 @subheading Synopsis
32623
32624 @smallexample
32625 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32626 @end smallexample
32627
32628 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32629
32630 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32631
32632 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32633
32634 @subheading Example
32635
32636 @smallexample
32637 (gdb)
32638 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32639 ^done
32640 (gdb)
32641 @end smallexample
32642
32643 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32644 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32645
32646 @subheading Synopsis
32647
32648 @smallexample
32649 -inferior-tty-show
32650 @end smallexample
32651
32652 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32653
32654 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32655
32656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32657
32658 @subheading Example
32659
32660 @smallexample
32661 (gdb)
32662 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32663 ^done
32664 (gdb)
32665 -inferior-tty-show
32666 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32667 (gdb)
32668 @end smallexample
32669
32670 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32671 @findex -enable-timings
32672
32673 @subheading Synopsis
32674
32675 @smallexample
32676 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32677 @end smallexample
32678
32679 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32680 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32681 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32682 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32683
32684 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32685
32686 No equivalent.
32687
32688 @subheading Example
32689
32690 @smallexample
32691 (gdb)
32692 -enable-timings
32693 ^done
32694 (gdb)
32695 -break-insert main
32696 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32697 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32698 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32699 times="0"@},
32700 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32701 (gdb)
32702 -enable-timings no
32703 ^done
32704 (gdb)
32705 -exec-run
32706 ^running
32707 (gdb)
32708 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32709 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32710 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32711 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32712 (gdb)
32713 @end smallexample
32714
32715 @node Annotations
32716 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32717
32718 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32719 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32720 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32721 relatively high level.
32722
32723 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32724 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32725
32726 @ignore
32727 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32728 @end ignore
32729
32730 @menu
32731 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32732 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32733 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32734 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32735 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32736 * Annotations for Running::
32737 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32738 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32739 @end menu
32740
32741 @node Annotations Overview
32742 @section What is an Annotation?
32743 @cindex annotations
32744
32745 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32746 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32747 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32748 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32749 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32750 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32751 cannot contain newline characters.
32752
32753 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32754 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32755 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32756 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32757 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32758 means those three characters as output.
32759
32760 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32761 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32762 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32763 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32764 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32765 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32766 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32767 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32768 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32769
32770 @table @code
32771 @kindex set annotate
32772 @item set annotate @var{level}
32773 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32774 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32775
32776 @item show annotate
32777 @kindex show annotate
32778 Show the current annotation level.
32779 @end table
32780
32781 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32782
32783 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32784
32785 @smallexample
32786 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32787 GNU gdb 6.0
32788 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32789 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32790 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32791 under certain conditions.
32792 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32793 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32794 for details.
32795 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32796
32797 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32798 (@value{GDBP})
32799 ^Z^Zprompt
32800 @kbd{quit}
32801
32802 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32803 $
32804 @end smallexample
32805
32806 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32807 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32808 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32809 output from @value{GDBN}.
32810
32811 @node Server Prefix
32812 @section The Server Prefix
32813 @cindex server prefix
32814
32815 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32816 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32817 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32818 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32819 a transparent manner.
32820
32821 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32822 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32823 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32824 @code{print} command.
32825
32826 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32827 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32828
32829 @node Prompting
32830 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32831
32832 @cindex annotations for prompts
32833 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32834 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32835 over, etc.
32836
32837 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32838 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32839 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32840 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32841 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32842 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32843 features the following annotations:
32844
32845 @smallexample
32846 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32847 ^Z^Zprompt
32848 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32849 @end smallexample
32850
32851 The input types are
32852
32853 @table @code
32854 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32855 @findex prompt annotation
32856 @findex post-prompt annotation
32857 @item prompt
32858 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32859
32860 @findex pre-commands annotation
32861 @findex commands annotation
32862 @findex post-commands annotation
32863 @item commands
32864 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32865 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32866
32867 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32868 @findex overload-choice annotation
32869 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32870 @item overload-choice
32871 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32872
32873 @findex pre-query annotation
32874 @findex query annotation
32875 @findex post-query annotation
32876 @item query
32877 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32878
32879 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32880 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32881 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32882 @item prompt-for-continue
32883 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32884 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32885 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32886 presence of annotations.
32887 @end table
32888
32889 @node Errors
32890 @section Errors
32891 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32892
32893 @findex quit annotation
32894 @smallexample
32895 ^Z^Zquit
32896 @end smallexample
32897
32898 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32899
32900 @findex error annotation
32901 @smallexample
32902 ^Z^Zerror
32903 @end smallexample
32904
32905 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32906
32907 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32908 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32909 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32910 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32911 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32912 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32913 to the top level.
32914
32915 @findex error-begin annotation
32916 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32917
32918 @smallexample
32919 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32920 @end smallexample
32921
32922 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32923 message.
32924
32925 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32926 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32927 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32928
32929 @node Invalidation
32930 @section Invalidation Notices
32931
32932 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32933 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32934 changed.
32935
32936 @table @code
32937 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32938 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32939
32940 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32941 have changed.
32942
32943 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32944 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32945
32946 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32947 deleted a breakpoint.
32948 @end table
32949
32950 @node Annotations for Running
32951 @section Running the Program
32952 @cindex annotations for running programs
32953
32954 @findex starting annotation
32955 @findex stopping annotation
32956 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32957 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32958
32959 @smallexample
32960 ^Z^Zstarting
32961 @end smallexample
32962
32963 is output. When the program stops,
32964
32965 @smallexample
32966 ^Z^Zstopped
32967 @end smallexample
32968
32969 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32970 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32971
32972 @table @code
32973 @findex exited annotation
32974 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32975 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32976 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32977
32978 @findex signalled annotation
32979 @findex signal-name annotation
32980 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32981 @findex signal-string annotation
32982 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32983 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32984 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32985 annotation continues:
32986
32987 @smallexample
32988 @var{intro-text}
32989 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32990 @var{name}
32991 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32992 @var{middle-text}
32993 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32994 @var{string}
32995 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32996 @var{end-text}
32997 @end smallexample
32998
32999 @noindent
33000 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33001 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33002 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33003 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33004 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33005
33006 @findex signal annotation
33007 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33008 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33009 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33010 terminated with it.
33011
33012 @findex breakpoint annotation
33013 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33014 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33015
33016 @findex watchpoint annotation
33017 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33018 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33019 @end table
33020
33021 @node Source Annotations
33022 @section Displaying Source
33023 @cindex annotations for source display
33024
33025 @findex source annotation
33026 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33027
33028 @smallexample
33029 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33030 @end smallexample
33031
33032 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33033 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33034 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33035 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33036 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33037 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33038 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33039 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33040 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33041 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33042 depend on the language).
33043
33044 @node JIT Interface
33045 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33046 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33047 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33048
33049 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33050 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33051 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33052 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33053
33054 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33055 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33056 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33057 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33058 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33059 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33060
33061 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33062 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33063 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33064 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33065 LLVM JIT.
33066
33067 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33068 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33069 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33070 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33071 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33072 out about additional code.
33073
33074 @menu
33075 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33076 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33077 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33078 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33079 @end menu
33080
33081 @node Declarations
33082 @section JIT Declarations
33083
33084 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33085 implement the interface:
33086
33087 @smallexample
33088 typedef enum
33089 @{
33090 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33091 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33092 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33093 @} jit_actions_t;
33094
33095 struct jit_code_entry
33096 @{
33097 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33098 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33099 const char *symfile_addr;
33100 uint64_t symfile_size;
33101 @};
33102
33103 struct jit_descriptor
33104 @{
33105 uint32_t version;
33106 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33107 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33108 uint32_t action_flag;
33109 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33110 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33111 @};
33112
33113 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33114 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33115
33116 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33117 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33118 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33119 @end smallexample
33120
33121 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33122 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33123 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33124
33125 @node Registering Code
33126 @section Registering Code
33127
33128 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33129
33130 @itemize @bullet
33131 @item
33132 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33133 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33134
33135 @item
33136 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33137 file.
33138
33139 @item
33140 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33141
33142 @item
33143 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33144
33145 @item
33146 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33147 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33148 @end itemize
33149
33150 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33151 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33152 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33153 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33154
33155 @node Unregistering Code
33156 @section Unregistering Code
33157
33158 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33159
33160 @itemize @bullet
33161 @item
33162 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33163
33164 @item
33165 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33166
33167 @item
33168 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33169 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33170 @end itemize
33171
33172 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33173 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33174
33175 @node Custom Debug Info
33176 @section Custom Debug Info
33177 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33178 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33179
33180 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33181 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33182 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33183 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33184 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33185 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33186 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33187 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33188 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33189
33190 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33191 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33192 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33193 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33194 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33195 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33196 compiler.
33197
33198 @menu
33199 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33200 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33201 @end menu
33202
33203 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33204 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33205 @kindex jit-reader-load
33206 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33207
33208 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33209 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33210
33211 @table @code
33212 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33213 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33214 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33215 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33216 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33217 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33218 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33219
33220 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33221 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33222 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33223 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33224 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33225
33226 @item jit-reader-unload
33227 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33228
33229 @end table
33230
33231 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33232 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33233 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33234
33235 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33236 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33237
33238 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33239 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33240 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33241 the system include directory.
33242
33243 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33244 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33245 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33246
33247 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33248 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33249
33250 @findex gdb_init_reader
33251 @smallexample
33252 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33253 @end smallexample
33254
33255 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33256
33257 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33258 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33259 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33260 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33261 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33262 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33263
33264 @smallexample
33265 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33266 @{
33267 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33268 int reader_version;
33269
33270 /* For use by the reader. */
33271 void *priv_data;
33272
33273 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33274 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33275 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33276 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33277 @};
33278 @end smallexample
33279
33280 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33281 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33282
33283 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33284 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33285 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33286 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33287 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33288 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33289 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33290 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33291 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33292 target's address space.
33293
33294 @node In-Process Agent
33295 @chapter In-Process Agent
33296 @cindex debugging agent
33297 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33298 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33299 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33300 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33301 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33302 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33303 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33304 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33305 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33306 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33307 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33308 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33309 behavior without interrupting it.
33310
33311 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33312 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33313 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33314 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33315 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33316 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33317 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33318 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33319 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33320
33321 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33322 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33323 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33324 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33325
33326 @anchor{Control Agent}
33327 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33328 debugging with the following commands:
33329
33330 @table @code
33331 @kindex set agent on
33332 @item set agent on
33333 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33334 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33335 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33336 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33337 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33338 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33339
33340 @kindex set agent off
33341 @item set agent off
33342 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33343 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33344
33345 @kindex show agent
33346 @item show agent
33347 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33348 the in-process agent.
33349 @end table
33350
33351 @menu
33352 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33353 @end menu
33354
33355 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33356 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33357 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33358
33359 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33360 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33361 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33362 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33363 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33364 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33365 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33366 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33367 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33368
33369 @menu
33370 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33371 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33372 @end menu
33373
33374 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33375 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33376 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33377
33378 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33379 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33380
33381 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33382 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33383 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33384 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33385
33386 @enumerate
33387 @item
33388 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33389 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33390 @item
33391 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33392 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33393 the other one.
33394 @end enumerate
33395
33396 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33397
33398 @enumerate
33399 @item
33400 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33401 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33402 @anchor{agent expression object}
33403 @item
33404 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33405 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33406 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33407 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33408 @item
33409 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33410 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33411
33412 @end enumerate
33413
33414 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33415 object:
33416
33417 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33418 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33419 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33420 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33421 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33422 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33423 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33424 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33425 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33426 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33427 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33428 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33429 memory address for collecting.
33430 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33431 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33432 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33433 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33434 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33435 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33436 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33437 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33438 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33439 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33440 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33441 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33442 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33443 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33444 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33445 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33446 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33447 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33448 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33449 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33450 @ref{agent expression object}
33451 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33452 @ref{agent expression object}
33453 @item actions @tab variable
33454 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33455 @end multitable
33456
33457 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33458 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33459 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33460
33461 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33462 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33463
33464 @table @samp
33465
33466 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33467 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33468 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33469 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33470 in IPA finally.
33471
33472 Replies:
33473 @table @samp
33474 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33475 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33476 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33477 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33478 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33479 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33480 @item E @var{NN}
33481 for an error
33482
33483 @end table
33484
33485 @item close
33486 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33487 is about to kill inferiors.
33488
33489 @item qTfSTM
33490 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33491 @item qTsSTM
33492 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33493 @item qTSTMat
33494 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33495 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33496 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33497
33498 Replies:
33499 @table @samp
33500 @item E @var{NN}
33501 for an error
33502 @end table
33503 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33504 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33505 @end table
33506
33507 @node GDB Bugs
33508 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33509 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33510 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33511
33512 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33513
33514 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33515 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33516 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33517 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33518
33519 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33520 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33521
33522 @menu
33523 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33524 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33525 @end menu
33526
33527 @node Bug Criteria
33528 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33529 @cindex bug criteria
33530
33531 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33532
33533 @itemize @bullet
33534 @cindex fatal signal
33535 @cindex debugger crash
33536 @cindex crash of debugger
33537 @item
33538 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33539 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33540
33541 @cindex error on valid input
33542 @item
33543 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33544 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33545 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33546
33547 @cindex invalid input
33548 @item
33549 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33550 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33551 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33552 for traditional practice''.
33553
33554 @item
33555 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33556 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33557 @end itemize
33558
33559 @node Bug Reporting
33560 @section How to Report Bugs
33561 @cindex bug reports
33562 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33563
33564 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33565 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33566 contact that organization first.
33567
33568 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33569 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33570 distribution.
33571 @c should add a web page ref...
33572
33573 @ifset BUGURL
33574 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33575 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33576 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33577 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33578 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33579 be used.
33580
33581 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33582 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33583 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33584 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33585
33586 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33587 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33588 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33589 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33590 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33591 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33592 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33593 bug reports to the mailing list.
33594 @end ifset
33595 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33596 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33597 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33598 @end ifclear
33599 @end ifset
33600
33601 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33602 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33603 fact or leave it out, state it!
33604
33605 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33606 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33607 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33608 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33609 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33610 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33611 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33612 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33613 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33614
33615 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33616 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33617 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33618 self-contained.
33619
33620 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33621 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33622 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33623 bugs properly.
33624
33625 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33626
33627 @itemize @bullet
33628 @item
33629 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33630 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33631 version}.
33632
33633 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33634 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33635
33636 @item
33637 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33638 version number.
33639
33640 @item
33641 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33642 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33643 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33644 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33645
33646 @item
33647 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33648 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33649
33650 @item
33651 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33652 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33653 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33654 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33655 those compilers.
33656
33657 @item
33658 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33659 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33660 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33661 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33662
33663 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33664 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33665
33666 @item
33667 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33668 reproduce the bug.
33669
33670 @item
33671 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33672 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33673
33674 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33675 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33676 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33677 a chance to make a mistake.
33678
33679 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33680 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33681 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33682 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33683 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33684 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33685 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33686 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33687
33688 @pindex script
33689 @cindex recording a session script
33690 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33691 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33692 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33693 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33694
33695 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33696 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33697
33698 @item
33699 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33700 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33701 it by context, not by line number.
33702
33703 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33704 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33705
33706 @end itemize
33707
33708 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33709
33710 @itemize @bullet
33711 @item
33712 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33713
33714 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33715 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33716 changes will not affect it.
33717
33718 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33719 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33720 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33721 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33722
33723 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33724 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33725 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33726 less time, and so on.
33727
33728 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33729 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33730
33731 @item
33732 A patch for the bug.
33733
33734 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33735 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33736 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33737 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33738
33739 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33740 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33741 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33742 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33743
33744 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33745 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33746 help us to understand.
33747
33748 @item
33749 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33750
33751 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33752 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33753 @end itemize
33754
33755 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33756 @c and consists of the two following files:
33757 @c rluser.texi
33758 @c hsuser.texi
33759 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33760 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33761 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33762 @include rluser.texi
33763 @include hsuser.texi
33764 @end ifclear
33765
33766 @node In Memoriam
33767 @appendix In Memoriam
33768
33769 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33770 contributors:
33771
33772 @table @code
33773 @item Fred Fish
33774 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33775 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33776 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33777
33778 @item Michael Snyder
33779 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33780 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33781 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33782 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33783 @end table
33784
33785 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33786 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33787
33788 @node Formatting Documentation
33789 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33790
33791 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33792 @cindex reference card
33793 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33794 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33795 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33796 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33797 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33798 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33799
33800 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33801 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33802
33803 @smallexample
33804 make refcard.dvi
33805 @end smallexample
33806
33807 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33808 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33809 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33810 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33811 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33812
33813 @cindex documentation
33814
33815 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33816 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33817 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33818 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33819 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33820 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33821
33822 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33823 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33824 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33825 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33826 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33827 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33828 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33829 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33830
33831 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33832 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33833 @code{makeinfo}.
33834
33835 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33836 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33837 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33838
33839 @smallexample
33840 cd gdb
33841 make gdb.info
33842 @end smallexample
33843
33844 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33845 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33846 Texinfo definitions file.
33847
33848 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33849 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33850 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33851 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33852 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33853 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33854 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33855
33856 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33857 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33858 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33859 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33860 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33861 directory.
33862
33863 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33864 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33865 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33866 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33867
33868 @smallexample
33869 make gdb.dvi
33870 @end smallexample
33871
33872 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33873
33874 @node Installing GDB
33875 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33876 @cindex installation
33877
33878 @menu
33879 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33880 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33881 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33882 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33883 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33884 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33885 @end menu
33886
33887 @node Requirements
33888 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33889 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33890
33891 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33892 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33893
33894 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33895 @table @asis
33896 @item ISO C90 compiler
33897 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33898 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33899
33900 @end table
33901
33902 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33903 @table @asis
33904 @item Expat
33905 @anchor{Expat}
33906 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33907 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33908 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33909 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33910 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33911 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33912
33913 Expat is used for:
33914
33915 @itemize @bullet
33916 @item
33917 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33918 @item
33919 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33920 @item
33921 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33922 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33923 @item
33924 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33925 @item
33926 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33927 @item
33928 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33929 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33930 @end itemize
33931
33932 @item zlib
33933 @cindex compressed debug sections
33934 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33935 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33936 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33937 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33938 information in such binaries.
33939
33940 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33941 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33942 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33943
33944 @item iconv
33945 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33946 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33947 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33948 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33949
33950 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33951 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33952 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33953 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33954
33955 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33956 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33957 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33958
33959 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33960 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33961 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33962 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33963 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33964 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33965 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33966 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33967 @end table
33968
33969 @node Running Configure
33970 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33971 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33972 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33973 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33974 build the @code{gdb} program.
33975 @iftex
33976 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33977 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33978 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33979 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33980 @end iftex
33981
33982 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33983 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33984 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33985
33986 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33987 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33988
33989 @table @code
33990 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33991 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33992
33993 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33994 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33995
33996 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33997 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33998
33999 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34000 @sc{gnu} include files
34001
34002 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34003 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34004
34005 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34006 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34007
34008 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34009 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34010
34011 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34012 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34013
34014 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34015 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34016 @end table
34017
34018 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34019 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34020 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34021
34022 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34023 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34024 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34025 argument.
34026
34027 For example:
34028
34029 @smallexample
34030 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34031 ./configure @var{host}
34032 make
34033 @end smallexample
34034
34035 @noindent
34036 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34037 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34038 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34039 correct value by examining your system.)
34040
34041 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34042 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34043 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34044 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34045
34046 @need 750
34047 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34048 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34049 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34050
34051 @smallexample
34052 sh configure @var{host}
34053 @end smallexample
34054
34055 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34056 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34057 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34058 @file{configure}
34059 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34060 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34061
34062 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34063 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34064 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34065 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34066 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34067 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34068 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34069 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34070 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34071
34072 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34073 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34074 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34075 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34076 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34077
34078 @node Separate Objdir
34079 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34080
34081 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34082 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34083 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34084 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34085 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34086 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34087 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34088 program specified there.
34089
34090 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34091 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34092 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34093 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34094 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34095 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34096
34097 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34098 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34099
34100 @smallexample
34101 @group
34102 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34103 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34104 cd ../gdb-sun4
34105 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34106 make
34107 @end group
34108 @end smallexample
34109
34110 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34111 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34112 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34113 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34114 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34115 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34116
34117 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34118 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34119 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34120 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34121 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34122
34123 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34124 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34125 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34126 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34127 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34128 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34129
34130 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34131 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34132 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34133
34134 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34135 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34136 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34137 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34138 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34139
34140 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34141 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34142 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34143 with each other.
34144
34145 @node Config Names
34146 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34147
34148 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34149 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34150 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34151 of information in the following pattern:
34152
34153 @smallexample
34154 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34155 @end smallexample
34156
34157 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34158 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34159 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34160
34161 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34162 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34163 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34164 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34165 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34166 abbreviations---for example:
34167
34168 @smallexample
34169 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34170 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34171 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34172 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34173 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34174 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34175 % sh config.sub sun4
34176 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34177 % sh config.sub sun3
34178 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34179 % sh config.sub i986v
34180 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34181 @end smallexample
34182
34183 @noindent
34184 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34185 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34186
34187 @node Configure Options
34188 @section @file{configure} Options
34189
34190 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34191 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34192 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34193 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34194
34195 @smallexample
34196 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34197 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34198 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34199 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34200 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34201 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34202 @var{host}
34203 @end smallexample
34204
34205 @noindent
34206 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34207 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34208 @samp{--}.
34209
34210 @table @code
34211 @item --help
34212 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34213
34214 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34215 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34216 @file{@var{dir}}.
34217
34218 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34219 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34220 @file{@var{dir}}.
34221
34222 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34223 @need 2000
34224 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34225 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34226 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34227 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34228 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34229 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34230 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34231 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34232 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34233 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34234 @var{dirname}.
34235
34236 @item --norecursion
34237 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34238 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34239
34240 @item --target=@var{target}
34241 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34242 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34243 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34244
34245 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34246
34247 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34248 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34249
34250 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34251 @end table
34252
34253 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34254 needed for special purposes only.
34255
34256 @node System-wide configuration
34257 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34258 @cindex system-wide init file
34259
34260 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34261 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34262 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34263
34264 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34265
34266 @table @code
34267 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34268 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34269 @var{file}.
34270 @end table
34271
34272 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34273 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34274
34275 @itemize @bullet
34276 @item
34277 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34278 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34279 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34280 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34281 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34282 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34283
34284 @item
34285 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34286 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34287 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34288 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34289 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34290 @end itemize
34291
34292 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34293 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34294 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34295 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34296 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34297 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34298 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34299 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34300 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34301 reread.
34302
34303 @menu
34304 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34305 @end menu
34306
34307 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34308 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34309 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34310
34311 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34312 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34313 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34314 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34315 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34316 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34317
34318 The following scripts are currently available:
34319 @itemize @bullet
34320
34321 @item @file{elinos.py}
34322 @pindex elinos.py
34323 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34324 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34325 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34326 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34327 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34328 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34329
34330 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34331 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34332 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34333 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34334 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34335 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34336
34337 @end itemize
34338
34339 @node Maintenance Commands
34340 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34341 @cindex maintenance commands
34342 @cindex internal commands
34343
34344 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34345 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34346 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34347 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34348 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34349
34350 @table @code
34351 @kindex maint agent
34352 @kindex maint agent-eval
34353 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34354 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34355 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34356 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34357 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34358 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34359 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34360 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34361 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34362 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34363 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34364 addition and return the sum.
34365 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34366 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34367
34368 @kindex maint agent-printf
34369 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34370 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34371 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34372 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34373 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34374
34375 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34376 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34377 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34378 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34379 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34380 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34381 is shown:
34382
34383 @table @code
34384 @item breakpoint
34385 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34386
34387 @item watchpoint
34388 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34389
34390 @item longjmp
34391 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34392 @code{longjmp} calls.
34393
34394 @item longjmp resume
34395 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34396
34397 @item until
34398 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34399
34400 @item finish
34401 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34402
34403 @item shlib events
34404 Shared library events.
34405
34406 @end table
34407
34408 @kindex maint info btrace
34409 @item maint info btrace
34410 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34411
34412 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34413 @item maint btrace packet-history
34414 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34415 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34416 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34417 recording format.
34418
34419 @table @code
34420 @item bts
34421 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34422 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34423
34424 @table @asis
34425 @item Block number
34426 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34427 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34428 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34429 @end table
34430
34431 @item pt
34432 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34433 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34434 information is printed:
34435
34436 @table @asis
34437 @item Packet number
34438 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34439 @item Trace offset
34440 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34441 @item Packet opcode and payload
34442 @end table
34443 @end table
34444
34445 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34446 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34447 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34448 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34449 needed.
34450
34451 @kindex maint btrace clear
34452 @item maint btrace clear
34453 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34454 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34455
34456 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34457 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34458 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34459 buffer.
34460
34461 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34462 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34463 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34464 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34465 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34466 packet history.
34467
34468 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34469 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34470 @cindex displaced stepping support
34471 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34472 @item set displaced-stepping
34473 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34474 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34475 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34476 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34477 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34478 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34479
34480 @table @code
34481 @item set displaced-stepping on
34482 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34483 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34484
34485 @item set displaced-stepping off
34486 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34487 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34488
34489 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34490 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34491 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34492 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34493 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34494 @end table
34495
34496 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34497 @item maint check-psymtabs
34498 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34499 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34500
34501 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34502 @item maint check-symtabs
34503 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34504
34505 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34506 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34507 Expand symbol tables.
34508 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34509 names matching @var{regexp}.
34510
34511 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34512 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34513 @cindex demangler crashes
34514 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34515 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34516 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34517 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34518 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34519 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34520 option to terminate the current session.
34521
34522 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34523 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34524 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34525
34526 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34527 @item maint cplus namespace
34528 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34529
34530 @kindex maint deprecate
34531 @kindex maint undeprecate
34532 @cindex deprecated commands
34533 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34534 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34535 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34536 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34537 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34538 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34539 the replacement as part of the warning.
34540
34541 @kindex maint dump-me
34542 @item maint dump-me
34543 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34544 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34545 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34546 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34547
34548 @kindex maint internal-error
34549 @kindex maint internal-warning
34550 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34551 @cindex demangler crashes
34552 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34553 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34554 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34555
34556 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34557 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34558 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34559 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34560 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34561 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34562 @value{GDBN} session.
34563
34564 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34565 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34566
34567 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34568
34569 @smallexample
34570 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34571 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34572 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34573 debugging may prove unreliable.
34574 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34575 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34576 (@value{GDBP})
34577 @end smallexample
34578
34579 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34580 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34581 @cindex demangler crashes
34582
34583 @kindex maint set internal-error
34584 @kindex maint show internal-error
34585 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34586 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34587 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34588 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34589 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34590 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34591 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34592 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34593 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34594 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34595 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34596 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34597 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34598 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34599 described in the table below.
34600
34601 @table @samp
34602 @item quit
34603 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34604 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34605
34606 @item corefile
34607 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34608 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34609 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34610 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34611 disabled.
34612 @end table
34613
34614 @kindex maint packet
34615 @item maint packet @var{text}
34616 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34617 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34618 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34619 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34620 checksum.
34621
34622 @kindex maint print architecture
34623 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34624 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34625 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34626
34627 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34628 @item maint print c-tdesc
34629 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34630 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34631 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34632
34633 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34634 @item maint print dummy-frames
34635 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34636
34637 @smallexample
34638 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34639 @dots{}
34640 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34641 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34642 58 return (a + b);
34643 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34644 @dots{}
34645 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34646 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34647 (@value{GDBP})
34648 @end smallexample
34649
34650 Takes an optional file parameter.
34651
34652 @kindex maint print registers
34653 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34654 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34655 @kindex maint print register-groups
34656 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34657 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34658 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34659 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34660 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34661 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34662 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34663
34664 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34665 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34666 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34667 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34668 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34669 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34670 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34671 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34672
34673 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34674 write the information.
34675
34676 @kindex maint print reggroups
34677 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34678 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34679 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34680 information.
34681
34682 The register groups info looks like this:
34683
34684 @smallexample
34685 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34686 Group Type
34687 general user
34688 float user
34689 all user
34690 vector user
34691 system user
34692 save internal
34693 restore internal
34694 @end smallexample
34695
34696 @kindex flushregs
34697 @item flushregs
34698 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34699
34700 @kindex maint print objfiles
34701 @cindex info for known object files
34702 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34703 Print a dump of all known object files.
34704 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34705 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34706 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34707
34708 @kindex maint print user-registers
34709 @cindex user registers
34710 @item maint print user-registers
34711 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34712 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34713 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34714 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34715 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34716 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34717 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34718
34719 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34720 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34721 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34722 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34723 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34724 matching @var{regexp}.
34725 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34726 and the full path if known.
34727 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34728
34729 @kindex maint print statistics
34730 @cindex bcache statistics
34731 @item maint print statistics
34732 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34733 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34734 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34735 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34736 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34737 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34738 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34739 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34740 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34741 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34742 lengths.
34743
34744 @kindex maint print target-stack
34745 @cindex target stack description
34746 @item maint print target-stack
34747 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34748 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34749 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34750 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34751 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34752 address.
34753
34754 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34755 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34756
34757 @kindex maint print type
34758 @cindex type chain of a data type
34759 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34760 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34761 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34762 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34763 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34764 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34765
34766 @kindex maint selftest
34767 @cindex self tests
34768 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34769 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34770
34771 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34772 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34773 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34774 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34775 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34776 information.
34777
34778 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34779 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34780 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34781 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34782 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34783 always see the disassembly form.
34784
34785 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34786
34787 @smallexample
34788 (gdb) info addr argc
34789 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34790 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34791 @end smallexample
34792
34793 For more information on these expressions, see
34794 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34795
34796 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34797 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34798 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34799 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34800 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34801
34802 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34803 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34804 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34805 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34806 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34807 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34808 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34809 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34810 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34811
34812 @kindex maint set profile
34813 @kindex maint show profile
34814 @cindex profiling GDB
34815 @item maint set profile
34816 @itemx maint show profile
34817 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34818
34819 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34820 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34821 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34822 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34823 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34824 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34825 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34826
34827 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34828 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34829
34830 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34831 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34832 @cindex hardware debug registers
34833 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34834 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34835 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34836 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34837 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34838 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34839 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34840
34841 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34842 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34843 @item maint set show-all-tib
34844 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34845 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34846 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34847 command.
34848
34849 @kindex maint set target-async
34850 @kindex maint show target-async
34851 @item maint set target-async
34852 @itemx maint show target-async
34853 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34854 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34855 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34856 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34857
34858 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34859 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34860 @item maint set target-non-stop
34861 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34862
34863 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34864 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34865 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34866 if supported by the target.
34867
34868 @table @code
34869 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34870 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34871 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34872
34873 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34874 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34875 does not indicate support.
34876
34877 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34878 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34879 target supports it.
34880 @end table
34881
34882 @kindex maint set per-command
34883 @kindex maint show per-command
34884 @item maint set per-command
34885 @itemx maint show per-command
34886 @cindex resources used by commands
34887
34888 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34889 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34890
34891 @table @code
34892 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34893 @itemx maint show per-command space
34894 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34895 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34896 took, following the command's own output.
34897 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34898 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34899
34900 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34901 @itemx maint show per-command time
34902 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34903 for each command.
34904 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34905 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34906 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34907 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34908 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34909 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34910 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34911 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34912 spent by the program been debugged.
34913 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34914 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34915
34916 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34917 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34918 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34919 for each command.
34920 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34921
34922 @enumerate a
34923 @item
34924 number of symbol tables
34925 @item
34926 number of primary symbol tables
34927 @item
34928 number of blocks in the blockvector
34929 @end enumerate
34930 @end table
34931
34932 @kindex maint space
34933 @cindex memory used by commands
34934 @item maint space @var{value}
34935 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34936 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34937
34938 @kindex maint time
34939 @cindex time of command execution
34940 @item maint time @var{value}
34941 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34942 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34943
34944 @kindex maint translate-address
34945 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34946 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34947 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34948 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34949 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34950 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34951 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34952
34953 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34954 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34955 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34956
34957 @end table
34958
34959 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34960 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34961
34962 @table @code
34963 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34964 @kindex set watchdog
34965 @cindex watchdog timer
34966 @cindex timeout for commands
34967 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34968 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34969 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34970
34971 @item show watchdog
34972 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34973 @end table
34974
34975 @node Remote Protocol
34976 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34977
34978 @menu
34979 * Overview::
34980 * Packets::
34981 * Stop Reply Packets::
34982 * General Query Packets::
34983 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34984 * Tracepoint Packets::
34985 * Host I/O Packets::
34986 * Interrupts::
34987 * Notification Packets::
34988 * Remote Non-Stop::
34989 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34990 * Examples::
34991 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34992 * Library List Format::
34993 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34994 * Memory Map Format::
34995 * Thread List Format::
34996 * Traceframe Info Format::
34997 * Branch Trace Format::
34998 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34999 @end menu
35000
35001 @node Overview
35002 @section Overview
35003
35004 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35005 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35006 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35007 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35008
35009 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35010 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35011
35012 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35013 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35014 @cindex remote serial protocol
35015 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35016 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35017 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35018 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35019 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35020
35021 @smallexample
35022 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35023 @end smallexample
35024 @noindent
35025
35026 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35027 @noindent
35028 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35029 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35030 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35031
35032 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35033 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35034
35035 @smallexample
35036 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35037 @end smallexample
35038
35039 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35040 @noindent
35041 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35042 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35043 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35044
35045 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35046 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35047 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35048 retransmission):
35049
35050 @smallexample
35051 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35052 <- @code{+}
35053 @end smallexample
35054 @noindent
35055
35056 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35057 once a connection is established.
35058 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35059
35060 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35061 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35062 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35063 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35064 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35065 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35066 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35067
35068 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35069 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35070 exceptions).
35071
35072 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35073 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35074 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35075 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35076
35077 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35078 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35079 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35080
35081 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35082 @anchor{Binary Data}
35083 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35084 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35085 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35086 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35087 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35088 binary data.
35089
35090 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35091 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35092 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35093 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35094 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35095 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35096 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35097 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35098 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35099 (described next).
35100
35101 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35102 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35103 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35104 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35105 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35106 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35107 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35108 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35109 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35110 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35111 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35112 3}} more times.
35113
35114 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35115 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35116 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35117 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35118 @samp{0*"00}.
35119
35120 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35121 error number. That number is not well defined.
35122
35123 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35124 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35125 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35126 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35127 on that response.
35128
35129 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35130 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35131 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35132 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35133 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35134 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35135
35136 @node Packets
35137 @section Packets
35138
35139 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35140 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35141 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35142 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35143
35144 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35145 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35146 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35147 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35148 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35149 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35150 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35151 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35152 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35153 @var{baz}.
35154
35155 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35156 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35157 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35158 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35159 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35160 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35161 pick any thread.
35162
35163 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35164 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35165 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35166 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35167 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35168 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35169 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35170 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35171 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35172 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35173 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35174 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35175 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35176
35177 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35178 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35179 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35180 more information.
35181
35182 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35183 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35184
35185 Here are the packet descriptions.
35186
35187 @table @samp
35188
35189 @item !
35190 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35191 @anchor{extended mode}
35192 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35193 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35194 debugged.
35195
35196 Reply:
35197 @table @samp
35198 @item OK
35199 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35200 @end table
35201
35202 @item ?
35203 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35204 @anchor{? packet}
35205 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35206 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35207 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35208
35209 Reply:
35210 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35211
35212 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35213 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35214 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35215 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35216 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35217
35218 Reply:
35219 @table @samp
35220 @item OK
35221 The arguments were set.
35222 @item E @var{NN}
35223 An error occurred.
35224 @end table
35225
35226 @item b @var{baud}
35227 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35228 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35229 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35230
35231 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35232 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35233 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35234
35235 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35236 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35237 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35238 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35239 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35240
35241 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35242 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35243 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35244 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35245
35246 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35247 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35248
35249 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35250 @anchor{bc}
35251 @item bc
35252 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35253 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35254
35255 Reply:
35256 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35257
35258 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35259 @anchor{bs}
35260 @item bs
35261 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35262 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35263
35264 Reply:
35265 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35266
35267 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35268 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35269 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35270 is omitted, resume at current address.
35271
35272 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35273 packet}.
35274
35275 Reply:
35276 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35277
35278 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35279 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35280 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35281 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35282
35283 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35284 packet}.
35285
35286 Reply:
35287 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35288
35289 @item d
35290 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35291 Toggle debug flag.
35292
35293 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35294 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35295
35296 @item D
35297 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35298 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35299 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35300 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35301 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35302
35303 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35304 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35305 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35306 big-endian hex string.
35307
35308 Reply:
35309 @table @samp
35310 @item OK
35311 for success
35312 @item E @var{NN}
35313 for an error
35314 @end table
35315
35316 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35317 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35318 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35319 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35320 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35321
35322 @item g
35323 @anchor{read registers packet}
35324 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35325 Read general registers.
35326
35327 Reply:
35328 @table @samp
35329 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35330 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35331 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35332 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35333 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35334 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35335
35336 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35337 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35338 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35339 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35340 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35341 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35342 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35343 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35344
35345 @smallexample
35346 -> @code{g}
35347 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35348 @end smallexample
35349
35350 @item E @var{NN}
35351 for an error.
35352 @end table
35353
35354 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35355 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35356 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35357 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35358
35359 Reply:
35360 @table @samp
35361 @item OK
35362 for success
35363 @item E @var{NN}
35364 for an error
35365 @end table
35366
35367 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35368 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35369 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35370 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35371 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35372 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35373 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35374 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35375 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35376
35377 Reply:
35378 @table @samp
35379 @item OK
35380 for success
35381 @item E @var{NN}
35382 for an error
35383 @end table
35384
35385 @c FIXME: JTC:
35386 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35387 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35388 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35389 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35390 @c described. For example:
35391 @c
35392 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35393 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35394 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35395 @c
35396 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35397 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35398 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35399
35400 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35401 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35402 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35403 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35404 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35405 step starting at that address.
35406
35407 @item I
35408 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35409 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35410 step packet}.
35411
35412 @item k
35413 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35414 Kill request.
35415
35416 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35417
35418 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35419 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35420
35421 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35422
35423 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35424 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35425 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35426
35427 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35428 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35429 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35430
35431 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35432 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35433 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35434 (@pxref{? packet}).
35435
35436 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35437 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35438 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35439 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35440 any particular boundary.
35441
35442 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35443 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35444 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35445 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35446 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35447 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35448 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35449 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35450
35451 Reply:
35452 @table @samp
35453 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35454 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35455 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35456 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35457 @item E @var{NN}
35458 @var{NN} is errno
35459 @end table
35460
35461 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35462 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35463 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35464 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35465 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35466
35467 Reply:
35468 @table @samp
35469 @item OK
35470 for success
35471 @item E @var{NN}
35472 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35473 written).
35474 @end table
35475
35476 @item p @var{n}
35477 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35478 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35479 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35480 register value is encoded.
35481
35482 Reply:
35483 @table @samp
35484 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35485 the register's value
35486 @item E @var{NN}
35487 for an error
35488 @item @w{}
35489 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35490 @end table
35491
35492 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35493 @anchor{write register packet}
35494 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35495 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35496 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35497 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35498
35499 Reply:
35500 @table @samp
35501 @item OK
35502 for success
35503 @item E @var{NN}
35504 for an error
35505 @end table
35506
35507 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35508 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35509 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35510 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35511 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35512 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35513
35514 @item r
35515 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35516 Reset the entire system.
35517
35518 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35519
35520 @item R @var{XX}
35521 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35522 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35523 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35524
35525 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35526
35527 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35528 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35529 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35530 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35531
35532 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35533 packet}.
35534
35535 Reply:
35536 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35537
35538 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35539 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35540 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35541 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35542 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35543
35544 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35545 packet}.
35546
35547 Reply:
35548 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35549
35550 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35551 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35552 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35553 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35554 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35555
35556 @item T @var{thread-id}
35557 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35558 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35559
35560 Reply:
35561 @table @samp
35562 @item OK
35563 thread is still alive
35564 @item E @var{NN}
35565 thread is dead
35566 @end table
35567
35568 @item v
35569 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35570 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35571
35572 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35573 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35574 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35575 The process ID is a
35576 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35577 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35578 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35579
35580 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35581 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35582 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35583 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35584 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35585 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35586 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35587 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35588
35589 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35590
35591 Reply:
35592 @table @samp
35593 @item E @var{nn}
35594 for an error
35595 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35596 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35597 @item OK
35598 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35599 @end table
35600
35601 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35602 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35603 @anchor{vCont packet}
35604 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35605
35606 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35607 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35608 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35609 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35610 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35611 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35612 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35613 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35614 error.
35615
35616 Currently supported actions are:
35617
35618 @table @samp
35619 @item c
35620 Continue.
35621 @item C @var{sig}
35622 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35623 @item s
35624 Step.
35625 @item S @var{sig}
35626 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35627 @item t
35628 Stop.
35629 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35630 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35631 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35632 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35633 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35634 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35635
35636 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35637 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35638 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35639 jumps to @var{start}).
35640
35641 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35642 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35643 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35644
35645 @end table
35646
35647 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35648 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35649 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35650
35651 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35652 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35653 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35654 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35655 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35656 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35657 as an implementation detail.
35658
35659 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35660 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35661 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35662 stopped.
35663
35664 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35665 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35666 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35667
35668 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35669 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35670
35671 Reply:
35672 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35673
35674 @item vCont?
35675 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35676 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35677
35678 Reply:
35679 @table @samp
35680 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35681 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35682 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35683 @item @w{}
35684 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35685 @end table
35686
35687 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35688 @item vCtrlC
35689 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35690 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35691 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35692 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35693 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35694 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35695 variant.
35696
35697 Reply:
35698 @table @samp
35699 @item E @var{nn}
35700 for an error
35701 @item OK
35702 for success
35703 @end table
35704
35705 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35706 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35707 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35708 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35709
35710 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35711 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35712 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35713 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35714 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35715 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35716 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35717 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35718 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35719 packet is received.
35720
35721 Reply:
35722 @table @samp
35723 @item OK
35724 for success
35725 @item E @var{NN}
35726 for an error
35727 @end table
35728
35729 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35730 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35731 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35732 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35733 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35734 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35735 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35736 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35737 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35738 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35739 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35740 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35741
35742
35743 Reply:
35744 @table @samp
35745 @item OK
35746 for success
35747 @item E.memtype
35748 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35749 @item E @var{NN}
35750 for an error
35751 @end table
35752
35753 @item vFlashDone
35754 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35755 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35756 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35757 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35758 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35759 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35760 request is completed.
35761
35762 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35763 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35764 @anchor{vKill packet}
35765 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35766 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35767 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35768 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35769
35770 Reply:
35771 @table @samp
35772 @item E @var{nn}
35773 for an error
35774 @item OK
35775 for success
35776 @end table
35777
35778 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35779 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35780 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35781 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35782 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35783 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35784 state.
35785
35786 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35787
35788 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35789
35790 Reply:
35791 @table @samp
35792 @item E @var{nn}
35793 for an error
35794 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35795 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35796 @end table
35797
35798 @item vStopped
35799 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35800 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35801
35802 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35803 @anchor{X packet}
35804 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35805 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35806 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35807 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35808 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35809
35810 Reply:
35811 @table @samp
35812 @item OK
35813 for success
35814 @item E @var{NN}
35815 for an error
35816 @end table
35817
35818 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35819 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35820 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35821 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35822 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35823 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35824 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35825
35826 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35827 separately.
35828
35829 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35830 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35831 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35832 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35833 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35834 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35835
35836 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35837 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35838 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35839 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35840 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
35841 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35842
35843 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35844 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35845 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
35846 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
35847 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35848 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
35849 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
35850 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
35851 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
35852 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
35853 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
35854 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
35855 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35856
35857 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35858 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35859
35860 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35861 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35862
35863 @table @samp
35864
35865 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35866 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35867 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35868
35869 @end table
35870
35871 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35872 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35873 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35874 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35875 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35876 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35877 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35878
35879 @table @samp
35880
35881 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35882 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35883 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35884
35885 @end table
35886
35887 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35888 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35889 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35890 target, is not defined.}
35891
35892 Reply:
35893 @table @samp
35894 @item OK
35895 success
35896 @item @w{}
35897 not supported
35898 @item E @var{NN}
35899 for an error
35900 @end table
35901
35902 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35903 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35904 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35905 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35906 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35907 address @var{addr}.
35908
35909 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35910 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
35911 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
35912 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35913
35914 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35915 movement.}
35916
35917 Reply:
35918 @table @samp
35919 @item OK
35920 success
35921 @item @w{}
35922 not supported
35923 @item E @var{NN}
35924 for an error
35925 @end table
35926
35927 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35928 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35929 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35930 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35931 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35932 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35933
35934 Reply:
35935 @table @samp
35936 @item OK
35937 success
35938 @item @w{}
35939 not supported
35940 @item E @var{NN}
35941 for an error
35942 @end table
35943
35944 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35945 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35946 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35947 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35948 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35949 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35950
35951 Reply:
35952 @table @samp
35953 @item OK
35954 success
35955 @item @w{}
35956 not supported
35957 @item E @var{NN}
35958 for an error
35959 @end table
35960
35961 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35962 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35963 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35964 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35965 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35966 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35967
35968 Reply:
35969 @table @samp
35970 @item OK
35971 success
35972 @item @w{}
35973 not supported
35974 @item E @var{NN}
35975 for an error
35976 @end table
35977
35978 @end table
35979
35980 @node Stop Reply Packets
35981 @section Stop Reply Packets
35982 @cindex stop reply packets
35983
35984 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35985 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35986 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35987 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35988 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35989 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35990 @value{GDBN} source code.
35991
35992 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
35993 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
35994 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35995
35996 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35997 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35998 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35999 components.
36000
36001 @table @samp
36002
36003 @item S @var{AA}
36004 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36005 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36006 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36007
36008 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36009 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36010 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36011 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36012 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36013 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36014 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36015 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36016
36017 @itemize @bullet
36018 @item
36019 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36020 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36021 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36022 two-digit hex number.
36023
36024 @item
36025 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36026 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36027
36028 @item
36029 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36030 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36031
36032 @item
36033 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36034 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36035 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36036 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36037
36038 @item
36039 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36040 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36041 future.
36042 @end itemize
36043
36044 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36045
36046 @table @samp
36047 @item watch
36048 @itemx rwatch
36049 @itemx awatch
36050 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36051 hex.
36052
36053 @item syscall_entry
36054 @itemx syscall_return
36055 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36056 syscall number, in hex.
36057
36058 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36059 @item library
36060 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36061 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36062 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36063
36064 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36065 @item replaylog
36066 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36067 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36068 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36069 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36070 for more information.
36071
36072 @item swbreak
36073 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36074 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36075 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36076 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36077 part must be left empty.
36078
36079 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36080 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36081 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36082 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36083 address.
36084
36085 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36086 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36087 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36088 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36089 indicating support.
36090
36091 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36092
36093 @item hwbreak
36094 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36095 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36096
36097 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36098 apply.
36099
36100 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36101 @item fork
36102 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36103 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36104 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36105 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36106 fork events.
36107
36108 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36109 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36110 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36111 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36112 indicating support.
36113
36114 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36115 @item vfork
36116 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36117 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36118 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36119 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36120 vfork events.
36121
36122 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36123 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36124 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36125 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36126 indicating support.
36127
36128 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36129 @item vforkdone
36130 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36131 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36132 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36133 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36134 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36135
36136 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36137 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36138 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36139 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36140 indicating support.
36141
36142 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36143 @item exec
36144 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36145 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36146 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36147
36148 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36149 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36150 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36151 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36152 indicating support.
36153
36154 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36155 @anchor{thread create event}
36156 @item create
36157 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36158 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36159 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36160 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36161 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36162 @var{r} part is ignored.
36163
36164 @end table
36165
36166 @item W @var{AA}
36167 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36168 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36169 applicable to certain targets.
36170
36171 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36172 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36173 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36174 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36175 hex strings.
36176
36177 @item X @var{AA}
36178 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36179 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36180
36181 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36182 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36183 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36184 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36185 hex strings.
36186
36187 @anchor{thread exit event}
36188 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36189 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36190
36191 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36192 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36193 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36194 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36195
36196 @item N
36197 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36198 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36199 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36200 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36201 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36202 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36203 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36204 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36205 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36206 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36207 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36208 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36209 support.
36210
36211 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36212 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36213 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36214 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36215 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36216
36217 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36218 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36219 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36220 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36221 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36222 system calls.
36223
36224 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36225 this very system call.
36226
36227 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36228 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36229 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36230 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36231 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36232 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36233
36234 @end table
36235
36236 @node General Query Packets
36237 @section General Query Packets
36238 @cindex remote query requests
36239
36240 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36241 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36242 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36243 sending information to and from the stub.
36244
36245 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36246 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36247 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36248 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36249 conventions:
36250
36251 @itemize @bullet
36252 @item
36253 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36254 @item
36255 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36256 letter.
36257 @item
36258 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36259 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36260 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36261 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36262 @end itemize
36263
36264 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36265 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36266 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36267 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36268 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36269 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36270 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36271 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36272 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36273 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36274 packet.}.
36275
36276 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36277 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36278 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36279 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36280 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36281
36282 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36283
36284 @table @samp
36285
36286 @item QAgent:1
36287 @itemx QAgent:0
36288 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36289 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36290
36291 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36292 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36293 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36294 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36295 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36296 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36297 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36298 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36299 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36300 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36301 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36302
36303 @item qC
36304 @cindex current thread, remote request
36305 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36306 Return the current thread ID.
36307
36308 Reply:
36309 @table @samp
36310 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36311 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36312 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36313 @item @r{(anything else)}
36314 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36315 @end table
36316
36317 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36318 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36319 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36320 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36321 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36322 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36323 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36324 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36325
36326 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36327 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36328 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36329 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36330 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36331 detect trailing zeros.
36332
36333 Reply:
36334 @table @samp
36335 @item E @var{NN}
36336 An error (such as memory fault)
36337 @item C @var{crc32}
36338 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36339 @end table
36340
36341 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36342 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36343 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36344 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36345 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36346 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36347 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36348 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36349 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36350 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36351 randomization.
36352
36353 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36354
36355 Reply:
36356 @table @samp
36357 @item OK
36358 The request succeeded.
36359
36360 @item E @var{nn}
36361 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36362
36363 @item @w{}
36364 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36365 by the stub.
36366 @end table
36367
36368 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36369 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36370 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36371 address space randomization.
36372
36373 @item qfThreadInfo
36374 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36375 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36376 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36377 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36378 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36379 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36380 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36381 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36382 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36383 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36384
36385 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36386
36387 Reply:
36388 @table @samp
36389 @item m @var{thread-id}
36390 A single thread ID
36391 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36392 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36393 @item l
36394 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36395 @end table
36396
36397 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36398 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36399 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36400 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36401 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36402 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36403 fields.
36404
36405 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36406 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36407 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36408 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36409 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36410
36411 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36412 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36413 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36414 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36415 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36416
36417 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36418 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36419
36420 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36421 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36422 information associated with the variable.)
36423
36424 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36425 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36426 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36427 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36428 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36429 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36430
36431 Reply:
36432 @table @samp
36433 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36434 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36435 local storage requested.
36436
36437 @item E @var{nn}
36438 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36439
36440 @item @w{}
36441 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36442 @end table
36443
36444 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36445 @cindex get thread information block address
36446 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36447 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36448
36449 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36450
36451 Reply:
36452 @table @samp
36453 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36454 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36455 thread information block.
36456
36457 @item E @var{nn}
36458 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36459 address could not be retrieved.
36460
36461 @item @w{}
36462 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36463 @end table
36464
36465 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36466 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36467 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36468 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36469 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36470 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36471 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36472
36473 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36474
36475 Reply:
36476 @table @samp
36477 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36478 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36479 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36480 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36481 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36482 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36483 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36484 @end table
36485
36486 @item qOffsets
36487 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36488 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36489 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36490 image.
36491
36492 Reply:
36493 @table @samp
36494 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36495 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36496 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36497 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36498 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36499 segments by the supplied offsets.
36500
36501 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36502 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36503 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36504
36505 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36506 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36507 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36508 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36509 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36510 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36511 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36512 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36513 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36514 @end table
36515
36516 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36517 @cindex thread information, remote request
36518 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36519 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36520 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36521 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36522
36523 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36524 (see below).
36525
36526 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36527
36528 @item QNonStop:1
36529 @itemx QNonStop:0
36530 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36531 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36532 @anchor{QNonStop}
36533 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36534 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36535
36536 Reply:
36537 @table @samp
36538 @item OK
36539 The request succeeded.
36540
36541 @item E @var{nn}
36542 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36543
36544 @item @w{}
36545 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36546 the stub.
36547 @end table
36548
36549 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36550 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36551 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36552 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36553
36554 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36555 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36556 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36557 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36558 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36559 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36560 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36561
36562 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36563 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36564 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36565
36566 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36567 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36568 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36569 report the requested syscalls.
36570
36571 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36572 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36573
36574 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36575 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36576 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36577 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36578
36579 Reply:
36580 @table @samp
36581 @item OK
36582 The request succeeded.
36583
36584 @item E @var{nn}
36585 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36586
36587 @item @w{}
36588 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36589 the stub.
36590 @end table
36591
36592 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36593 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36594 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36595 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36596
36597 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36598 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36599 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36600 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36601 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36602 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36603 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36604 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36605 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36606 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36607 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36608 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36609 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36610
36611 Reply:
36612 @table @samp
36613 @item OK
36614 The request succeeded.
36615
36616 @item E @var{nn}
36617 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36618
36619 @item @w{}
36620 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36621 the stub.
36622 @end table
36623
36624 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36625 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36626 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36627 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36628
36629 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36630 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36631 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36632 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36633 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36634 Others should be silently discarded.
36635
36636 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36637 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36638 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36639 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36640 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36641 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36642 signals.
36643
36644 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36645 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36646
36647 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36648 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36649 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36650 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36651 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36652
36653 Reply:
36654 @table @samp
36655 @item OK
36656 The request succeeded.
36657
36658 @item E @var{nn}
36659 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36660
36661 @item @w{}
36662 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36663 by the stub.
36664 @end table
36665
36666 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36667 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36668 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36669 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36670
36671 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36672 @item QThreadEvents:1
36673 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36674 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36675 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36676
36677 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36678 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36679 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36680 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36681 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36682 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36683 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36684 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36685 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36686 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36687
36688 Reply:
36689 @table @samp
36690 @item OK
36691 The request succeeded.
36692
36693 @item E @var{nn}
36694 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36695
36696 @item @w{}
36697 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36698 the stub.
36699 @end table
36700
36701 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36702 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36703
36704 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36705 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36706 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36707 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36708 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36709 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36710 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36711 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36712 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36713
36714 Reply:
36715 @table @samp
36716 @item OK
36717 A command response with no output.
36718 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36719 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36720 @item E @var{NN}
36721 Indicate a badly formed request.
36722 @item @w{}
36723 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36724 @end table
36725
36726 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36727 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36728 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36729 packets.)
36730
36731 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36732 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36733 @ifnotinfo
36734 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36735 @end ifnotinfo
36736 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36737 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36738 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36739 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36740 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36741
36742 Reply:
36743 @table @samp
36744 @item 0
36745 The pattern was not found.
36746 @item 1,address
36747 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36748 @item E @var{NN}
36749 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36750 @item @w{}
36751 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36752 @end table
36753
36754 @item QStartNoAckMode
36755 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36756 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36757 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36758 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36759
36760 Reply:
36761 @table @samp
36762 @item OK
36763 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36764 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36765 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36766 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36767 @item @w{}
36768 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36769 @end table
36770
36771 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36772 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36773 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36774 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36775 @anchor{qSupported}
36776 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36777 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36778 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36779 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36780 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36781 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36782 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36783 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36784 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36785 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36786 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36787 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36788 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36789 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36790
36791 Reply:
36792 @table @samp
36793 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36794 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36795 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36796 possible forms).
36797 @item @w{}
36798 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36799 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36800 @end table
36801
36802 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36803 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36804 are:
36805
36806 @table @samp
36807 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36808 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36809 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36810 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36811 @item @var{name}+
36812 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36813 need an associated value.
36814 @item @var{name}-
36815 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36816 @item @var{name}?
36817 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36818 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36819 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36820 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36821 @end table
36822
36823 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36824 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36825 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36826 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36827 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36828
36829 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36830 are defined:
36831
36832 @table @samp
36833 @item multiprocess
36834 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36835 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36836 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36837 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36838 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36839
36840 @item xmlRegisters
36841 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36842 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36843 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36844 description.
36845
36846 @item qRelocInsn
36847 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36848 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36849 instruction reply packet}).
36850
36851 @item swbreak
36852 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36853 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36854
36855 @item hwbreak
36856 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36857 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36858
36859 @item fork-events
36860 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36861 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36862 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36863 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36864
36865 @item vfork-events
36866 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36867 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36868 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36869 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36870
36871 @item exec-events
36872 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36873 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36874 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36875 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36876
36877 @item vContSupported
36878 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36879 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36880 @end table
36881
36882 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36883 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36884 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36885 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36886 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36887 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36888 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36889 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36890 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36891 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36892 all the features it supports.
36893
36894 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36895 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36896
36897 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36898 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36899 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36900 form response.
36901
36902 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36903 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36904 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36905 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36906
36907 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36908 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36909 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36910 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36911 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36912
36913 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36914
36915 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36916 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36917 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36918 @item Feature Name
36919 @tab Value Required
36920 @tab Default
36921 @tab Probe Allowed
36922
36923 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36924 @tab Yes
36925 @tab @samp{-}
36926 @tab No
36927
36928 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36929 @tab No
36930 @tab @samp{-}
36931 @tab Yes
36932
36933 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36934 @tab No
36935 @tab @samp{-}
36936 @tab Yes
36937
36938 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36939 @tab No
36940 @tab @samp{-}
36941 @tab Yes
36942
36943 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36944 @tab No
36945 @tab @samp{-}
36946 @tab Yes
36947
36948 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36949 @tab No
36950 @tab @samp{-}
36951 @tab Yes
36952
36953 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36954 @tab No
36955 @tab @samp{-}
36956 @tab Yes
36957
36958 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36959 @tab No
36960 @tab @samp{-}
36961 @tab Yes
36962
36963 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36964 @tab No
36965 @tab @samp{-}
36966 @tab No
36967
36968 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36969 @tab No
36970 @tab @samp{-}
36971 @tab Yes
36972
36973 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36974 @tab No
36975 @tab @samp{-}
36976 @tab Yes
36977
36978 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36979 @tab No
36980 @tab @samp{-}
36981 @tab Yes
36982
36983 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36984 @tab No
36985 @tab @samp{-}
36986 @tab Yes
36987
36988 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36989 @tab No
36990 @tab @samp{-}
36991 @tab Yes
36992
36993 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36994 @tab No
36995 @tab @samp{-}
36996 @tab Yes
36997
36998 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36999 @tab No
37000 @tab @samp{-}
37001 @tab Yes
37002
37003 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37004 @tab No
37005 @tab @samp{-}
37006 @tab Yes
37007
37008 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37009 @tab No
37010 @tab @samp{-}
37011 @tab Yes
37012
37013 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37014 @tab No
37015 @tab @samp{-}
37016 @tab Yes
37017
37018 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37019 @tab Yes
37020 @tab @samp{-}
37021 @tab Yes
37022
37023 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37024 @tab Yes
37025 @tab @samp{-}
37026 @tab Yes
37027
37028 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37029 @tab Yes
37030 @tab @samp{-}
37031 @tab Yes
37032
37033 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37034 @tab Yes
37035 @tab @samp{-}
37036 @tab Yes
37037
37038 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37039 @tab Yes
37040 @tab @samp{-}
37041 @tab Yes
37042
37043 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37044 @tab No
37045 @tab @samp{-}
37046 @tab Yes
37047
37048 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37049 @tab No
37050 @tab @samp{-}
37051 @tab Yes
37052
37053 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37054 @tab No
37055 @tab @samp{-}
37056 @tab Yes
37057
37058 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37059 @tab No
37060 @tab @samp{-}
37061 @tab Yes
37062
37063 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37064 @tab No
37065 @tab @samp{-}
37066 @tab No
37067
37068 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37069 @tab No
37070 @tab @samp{-}
37071 @tab No
37072
37073 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37074 @tab No
37075 @tab @samp{-}
37076 @tab No
37077
37078 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37079 @tab No
37080 @tab @samp{-}
37081 @tab No
37082
37083 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37084 @tab No
37085 @tab @samp{-}
37086 @tab No
37087
37088 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37089 @tab No
37090 @tab @samp{-}
37091 @tab No
37092
37093 @item @samp{QAgent}
37094 @tab No
37095 @tab @samp{-}
37096 @tab No
37097
37098 @item @samp{QAllow}
37099 @tab No
37100 @tab @samp{-}
37101 @tab No
37102
37103 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37104 @tab No
37105 @tab @samp{-}
37106 @tab No
37107
37108 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37109 @tab No
37110 @tab @samp{-}
37111 @tab No
37112
37113 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37114 @tab No
37115 @tab @samp{-}
37116 @tab No
37117
37118 @item @samp{tracenz}
37119 @tab No
37120 @tab @samp{-}
37121 @tab No
37122
37123 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37124 @tab No
37125 @tab @samp{-}
37126 @tab No
37127
37128 @item @samp{swbreak}
37129 @tab No
37130 @tab @samp{-}
37131 @tab No
37132
37133 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37134 @tab No
37135 @tab @samp{-}
37136 @tab No
37137
37138 @item @samp{fork-events}
37139 @tab No
37140 @tab @samp{-}
37141 @tab No
37142
37143 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37144 @tab No
37145 @tab @samp{-}
37146 @tab No
37147
37148 @item @samp{exec-events}
37149 @tab No
37150 @tab @samp{-}
37151 @tab No
37152
37153 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37154 @tab No
37155 @tab @samp{-}
37156 @tab No
37157
37158 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37159 @tab No
37160 @tab @samp{-}
37161 @tab No
37162
37163 @end multitable
37164
37165 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37166
37167 @table @samp
37168 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37169 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37170 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37171 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37172 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37173 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37174 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37175 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37176 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37177 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37178
37179 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37180 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37181 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37182
37183 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37184 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37185 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37186
37187 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37188 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37189 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37190
37191 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37192 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37193 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37194
37195 @item qXfer:features:read
37196 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37197 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37198
37199 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37200 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37201 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37202
37203 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37204 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37205 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37206
37207 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37208 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37209 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37210 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37211
37212 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37213 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37214 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37215
37216 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37217 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37218 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37219
37220 @item qXfer:spu:read
37221 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37222 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37223
37224 @item qXfer:spu:write
37225 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37226 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37227
37228 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37229 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37230 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37231
37232 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37233 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37234 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37235
37236 @item qXfer:threads:read
37237 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37238 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37239
37240 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37241 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37242 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37243
37244 @item qXfer:uib:read
37245 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37246 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37247
37248 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37249 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37250 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37251
37252 @item QNonStop
37253 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37254 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37255
37256 @item QCatchSyscalls
37257 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37258 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37259
37260 @item QPassSignals
37261 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37262 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37263
37264 @item QStartNoAckMode
37265 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37266 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37267
37268 @item multiprocess
37269 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37270 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37271 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37272 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37273 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37274 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37275 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37276 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37277 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37278 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37279 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37280
37281 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37282 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37283 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37284
37285 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37286 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37287 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37288 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37289
37290 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37291 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37292 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37293
37294 @item ReverseContinue
37295 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37296 (@pxref{bc}).
37297
37298 @item ReverseStep
37299 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37300 (@pxref{bs}).
37301
37302 @item TracepointSource
37303 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37304 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37305
37306 @item QAgent
37307 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37308
37309 @item QAllow
37310 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37311
37312 @item QDisableRandomization
37313 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37314
37315 @item StaticTracepoint
37316 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37317 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37318
37319 @item InstallInTrace
37320 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37321 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37322
37323 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37324 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37325 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37326 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37327
37328 @item QTBuffer:size
37329 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37330 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37331
37332 @item tracenz
37333 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37334 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37335 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37336
37337 @item BreakpointCommands
37338 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37339 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37340 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37341
37342 @item Qbtrace:off
37343 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37344
37345 @item Qbtrace:bts
37346 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37347
37348 @item Qbtrace:pt
37349 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37350
37351 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37352 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37353
37354 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37355 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37356
37357 @item swbreak
37358 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37359 breakpoints.
37360
37361 @item hwbreak
37362 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37363 breakpoints.
37364
37365 @item fork-events
37366 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37367
37368 @item vfork-events
37369 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37370 and vforkdone events.
37371
37372 @item exec-events
37373 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37374
37375 @item vContSupported
37376 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37377 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37378
37379 @item QThreadEvents
37380 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37381
37382 @item no-resumed
37383 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37384
37385 @end table
37386
37387 @item qSymbol::
37388 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37389 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37390 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37391 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37392
37393 Reply:
37394 @table @samp
37395 @item OK
37396 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37397 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37398 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37399 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37400 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37401 below.
37402 @end table
37403
37404 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37405 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37406
37407 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37408 target has previously requested.
37409
37410 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37411 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37412 will be empty.
37413
37414 Reply:
37415 @table @samp
37416 @item OK
37417 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37418 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37419 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37420 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37421 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37422 @end table
37423
37424 @item qTBuffer
37425 @itemx QTBuffer
37426 @itemx QTDisconnected
37427 @itemx QTDP
37428 @itemx QTDPsrc
37429 @itemx QTDV
37430 @itemx qTfP
37431 @itemx qTfV
37432 @itemx QTFrame
37433 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37434
37435 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37436
37437 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37438 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37439 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37440 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37441 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37442 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37443 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37444 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37445 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37446 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37447 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37448
37449 Reply:
37450 @table @samp
37451 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37452 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37453 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37454 the thread's attributes.
37455 @end table
37456
37457 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37458 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37459 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37460 packets.)
37461
37462 @item QTNotes
37463 @itemx qTP
37464 @itemx QTSave
37465 @itemx qTsP
37466 @itemx qTsV
37467 @itemx QTStart
37468 @itemx QTStop
37469 @itemx QTEnable
37470 @itemx QTDisable
37471 @itemx QTinit
37472 @itemx QTro
37473 @itemx qTStatus
37474 @itemx qTV
37475 @itemx qTfSTM
37476 @itemx qTsSTM
37477 @itemx qTSTMat
37478 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37479
37480 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37481 @cindex read special object, remote request
37482 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37483 @anchor{qXfer read}
37484 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37485 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37486 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37487 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37488 additional details about what data to access.
37489
37490 Reply:
37491 @table @samp
37492 @item m @var{data}
37493 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37494 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37495 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37496 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37497 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37498 request.
37499
37500 @item l @var{data}
37501 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37502 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37503 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37504
37505 @item l
37506 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37507 There is no more data to be read.
37508
37509 @item E00
37510 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37511
37512 @item E @var{nn}
37513 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37514 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37515
37516 @item @w{}
37517 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37518 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37519 @end table
37520
37521 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37522 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37523 formats, listed above.
37524
37525 @table @samp
37526 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37527 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37528 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37529 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37530
37531 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37532 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37533
37534 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37535 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37536
37537 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37538 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37539 packet may have one of the following values:
37540
37541 @table @code
37542 @item all
37543 Returns all available branch trace.
37544
37545 @item new
37546 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37547 the last read request.
37548
37549 @item delta
37550 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37551 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37552 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37553 used to stitch traces together.
37554
37555 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37556 @end table
37557
37558 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37559 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37560
37561 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37562 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37563
37564 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37565 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37566
37567 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37568 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37569
37570 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37571 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37572 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37573 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37574 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37575 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37576 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37577
37578 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37579 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37580
37581 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37582 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37583 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37584 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37585 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37586
37587 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37588 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37589
37590 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37591 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37592 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37593 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37594 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37595
37596 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37597 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37598 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37599
37600 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37601 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37602
37603 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37604 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37605 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37606 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37607 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37608 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37609 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37610 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37611
37612 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37613 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37614
37615 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37616 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37617
37618 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37619 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37620 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37621 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37622
37623 @table @code
37624 @item start=@var{address}
37625 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37626 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37627 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37628 chosen as the starting point.
37629
37630 @item prev=@var{address}
37631 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37632 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37633 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37634 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37635 exists prior to the starting point.
37636
37637 @end table
37638
37639 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37640 ignored.
37641
37642 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37643 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37644 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37645 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37646 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37647
37648 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37649 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37650
37651 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37652 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37653
37654 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37655 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37656 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37657 Action Lists}.
37658
37659 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37660 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37661 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37662
37663 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37664 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37665 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37666 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37667 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37668
37669 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37670 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37671 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37672
37673 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37674 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37675 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37676 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37677 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37678 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37679 in that context to be accessed.
37680
37681 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37682 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37683 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37684
37685 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37686 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37687 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37688 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37689 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37690
37691 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37692 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37693
37694 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37695 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37696
37697 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37698 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37699 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37700
37701 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37702 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37703
37704 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37705 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37706
37707 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37708 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37709
37710 This packet is not probed by default.
37711
37712 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37713 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37714 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37715 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37716 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37717
37718 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37719 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37720
37721 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37722 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37723 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37724 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37725
37726 @end table
37727
37728 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37729 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37730 @anchor{qXfer write}
37731 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37732 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37733 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37734 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37735 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37736 to access.
37737
37738 Reply:
37739 @table @samp
37740 @item @var{nn}
37741 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37742 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37743
37744 @item E00
37745 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37746
37747 @item E @var{nn}
37748 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37749 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37750
37751 @item @w{}
37752 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37753 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37754 @end table
37755
37756 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37757 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37758 formats, listed above.
37759
37760 @table @samp
37761 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37762 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37763 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37764 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37765 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37766
37767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37769 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37770
37771 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37772 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37773 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37774 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37775 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37776 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37777 in that context to be accessed.
37778
37779 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37780 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37781 @end table
37782
37783 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37784 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37785 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37786 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37787 must respond with an empty packet.
37788
37789 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37790 @cindex query attached, remote request
37791 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37792 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37793 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37794 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37795 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37796 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37797 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37798
37799 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37800 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37801 the @code{quit} command.
37802
37803 Reply:
37804 @table @samp
37805 @item 1
37806 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37807 @item 0
37808 The remote server created a new process.
37809 @item E @var{NN}
37810 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37811 @end table
37812
37813 @item Qbtrace:bts
37814 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37815
37816 Reply:
37817 @table @samp
37818 @item OK
37819 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37820 @item E.errtext
37821 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37822 @end table
37823
37824 @item Qbtrace:pt
37825 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37826
37827 Reply:
37828 @table @samp
37829 @item OK
37830 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37831 @item E.errtext
37832 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37833 @end table
37834
37835 @item Qbtrace:off
37836 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37837
37838 Reply:
37839 @table @samp
37840 @item OK
37841 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37842 @item E.errtext
37843 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37844 @end table
37845
37846 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37847 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37848 btrace recording method in bts format.
37849
37850 Reply:
37851 @table @samp
37852 @item OK
37853 The ring buffer size has been set.
37854 @item E.errtext
37855 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37856 @end table
37857
37858 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37859 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37860 btrace recording method in pt format.
37861
37862 Reply:
37863 @table @samp
37864 @item OK
37865 The ring buffer size has been set.
37866 @item E.errtext
37867 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37868 @end table
37869
37870 @end table
37871
37872 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37873 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37874
37875 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37876 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37877 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37878
37879 @menu
37880 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37881 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37882 @end menu
37883
37884 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37885 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37886
37887 @menu
37888 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37889 @end menu
37890
37891 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37892 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37893 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37894
37895 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37896
37897 @table @r
37898
37899 @item 2
37900 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37901
37902 @item 3
37903 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37904
37905 @item 4
37906 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37907
37908 @end table
37909
37910 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37911 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37912
37913 @menu
37914 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37915 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37916 @end menu
37917
37918 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37919 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37920 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37921
37922 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37923 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37924 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37925 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37926 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37927 most-significant -- least-significant.
37928
37929 @table @r
37930
37931 @item MIPS32
37932 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37933 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37934 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37935
37936 @item MIPS64
37937 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37938 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37939 as @code{MIPS32}.
37940
37941 @end table
37942
37943 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37944 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37945 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37946
37947 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37948
37949 @table @r
37950
37951 @item 2
37952 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37953
37954 @item 3
37955 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37956
37957 @item 4
37958 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37959
37960 @item 5
37961 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37962
37963 @end table
37964
37965 @node Tracepoint Packets
37966 @section Tracepoint Packets
37967 @cindex tracepoint packets
37968 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37969
37970 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37971 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37972
37973 @table @samp
37974
37975 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37976 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37977 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37978 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37979 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37980 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37981 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37982 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37983 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37984 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37985 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37986 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37987 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37988 actions.
37989
37990 Replies:
37991 @table @samp
37992 @item OK
37993 The packet was understood and carried out.
37994 @item qRelocInsn
37995 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37996 @item @w{}
37997 The packet was not recognized.
37998 @end table
37999
38000 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38001 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38002 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38003 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38004 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38005 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38006 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38007
38008 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38009 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38010 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38011 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38012 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38013 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38014 tracepoint actions.
38015
38016 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38017 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38018 following forms:
38019
38020 @table @samp
38021
38022 @item R @var{mask}
38023 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38024 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38025 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38026 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38027 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38028
38029 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38030 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38031 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38032 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38033 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38034 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38035 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38036
38037 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38038 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38039 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38040 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38041 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38042 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38043 packet).
38044
38045 @end table
38046
38047 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38048 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38049 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38050 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38051 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38052 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38053 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38054 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38055
38056 Replies:
38057 @table @samp
38058 @item OK
38059 The packet was understood and carried out.
38060 @item qRelocInsn
38061 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38062 @item @w{}
38063 The packet was not recognized.
38064 @end table
38065
38066 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38067 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38068 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38069 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38070 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38071 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38072 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38073 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38074
38075 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38076 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38077 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38078 fit in a single packet.
38079 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38080 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38081
38082 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38083 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38084 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38085 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38086
38087 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38088 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38089 query packets.
38090
38091 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38092 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38093 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38094 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38095 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38096 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38097 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38098 be found.
38099
38100 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38101 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38102 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38103 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38104 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38105 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38106 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38107 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38108 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38109 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38110 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38111 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38112 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38113 variable.
38114
38115 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38116 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38117 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38118 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38119 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38120
38121 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38122 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38123 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38124 one of the following forms:
38125
38126 @table @samp
38127 @item F @var{f}
38128 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38129 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38130 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38131
38132 @item T @var{t}
38133 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38134 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38135
38136 @end table
38137
38138 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38139 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38140 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38141 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38142
38143 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38144 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38145 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38146 is a hexadecimal number.
38147
38148 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38149 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38150 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38151 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38152 numbers.
38153
38154 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38155 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38156 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38157
38158 @item qTMinFTPILen
38159 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38160 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38161 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38162 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38163 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38164 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38165 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38166 arrange for that.
38167
38168 Replies:
38169
38170 @table @samp
38171 @item 0
38172 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38173 @item @var{length}
38174 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38175 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38176 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38177 regardless of size.
38178 @item E
38179 An error has occurred.
38180 @item @w{}
38181 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38182 @end table
38183
38184 @item QTStart
38185 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38186 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38187 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38188 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38189 instruction reply packet}).
38190
38191 @item QTStop
38192 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38193 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38194
38195 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38196 @anchor{QTEnable}
38197 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38198 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38199 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38200 of data from it will resume.
38201
38202 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38203 @anchor{QTDisable}
38204 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38205 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38206 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38207 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38208
38209 @item QTinit
38210 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38211 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38212
38213 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38214 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38215 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38216 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38217 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38218
38219 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38220 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38221 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38222 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38223
38224 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38225 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38226 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38227 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38228 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38229 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38230
38231 @item qTStatus
38232 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38233 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38234
38235 The reply has the form:
38236
38237 @table @samp
38238
38239 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38240 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38241 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38242 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38243
38244 @end table
38245
38246 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38247 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38248
38249 @table @samp
38250
38251 @item tnotrun:0
38252 No trace has been run yet.
38253
38254 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38255 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38256 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38257 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38258 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38259
38260 @item tfull:0
38261 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38262
38263 @item tdisconnected:0
38264 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38265
38266 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38267 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38268
38269 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38270 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38271 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38272 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38273 is hex encoded.
38274
38275 @item tunknown:0
38276 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38277
38278 @end table
38279
38280 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38281 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38282 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38283 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38284 trace.
38285
38286 @table @samp
38287
38288 @item tframes:@var{n}
38289 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38290
38291 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38292 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38293 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38294
38295 @item tsize:@var{n}
38296 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38297
38298 @item tfree:@var{n}
38299 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38300
38301 @item circular:@var{n}
38302 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38303 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38304 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38305 and may fill up.
38306
38307 @item disconn:@var{n}
38308 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38309 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38310 that the trace run will stop.
38311
38312 @end table
38313
38314 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38315 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38316 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38317 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38318 address @var{addr}.
38319
38320 Replies:
38321 @table @samp
38322 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38323 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38324 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38325 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38326 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38327
38328 @end table
38329
38330 @item qTV:@var{var}
38331 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38332 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38333 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38334
38335 Replies:
38336 @table @samp
38337 @item V@var{value}
38338 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38339 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38340 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38341 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38342 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38343 program is running.
38344
38345 @item U
38346 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38347 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38348 was not collected.
38349 @end table
38350
38351 @item qTfP
38352 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38353 @itemx qTsP
38354 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38355 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38356 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38357 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38358 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38359 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38360
38361 @item qTfV
38362 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38363 @itemx qTsV
38364 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38365 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38366 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38367 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38368 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38369 trace state variables.
38370
38371 @item qTfSTM
38372 @itemx qTsSTM
38373 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38374 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38375 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38376 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38377 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38378 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38379 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38380 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38381
38382 Reply:
38383 @table @samp
38384 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38385 A single marker
38386 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38387 a comma-separated list of markers
38388 @item l
38389 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38390 @item E @var{nn}
38391 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38392 @item @w{}
38393 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38394 stub.
38395 @end table
38396
38397 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38398 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38399
38400 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38401 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38402 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38403 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38404 @dfn{last}).
38405
38406 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38407 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38408 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38409 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38410 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38411 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38412 tracepoint markers.
38413
38414 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38415 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38416 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38417 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38418 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38419 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38420
38421 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38422 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38423 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38424 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38425 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38426 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38427 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38428 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38429 available.
38430
38431 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38432 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38433 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38434
38435 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38436 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38437 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38438 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38439 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38440 use whatever size it prefers.
38441
38442 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38443 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38444 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38445 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38446 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38447
38448 @end table
38449
38450 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38451 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38452 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38453 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38454 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38455 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38456 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38457 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38458 it had executed in the original location.
38459
38460 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38461 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38462 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38463 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38464 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38465 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38466 format of the request is:
38467
38468 @table @samp
38469 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38470
38471 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38472 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38473 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38474 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38475 memory starting at @var{to}.
38476 @end table
38477
38478 Replies:
38479 @table @samp
38480 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38481 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38482 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38483 @item E @var{NN}
38484 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38485 relocating the instruction.
38486 @end table
38487
38488 @node Host I/O Packets
38489 @section Host I/O Packets
38490 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38491 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38492
38493 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38494 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38495 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38496 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38497 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38498 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38499 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38500 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38501 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38502 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38503
38504 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38505 its arguments. They have this format:
38506
38507 @table @samp
38508
38509 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38510 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38511 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38512 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38513 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38514 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38515 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38516 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38517 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38518
38519 @end table
38520
38521 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38522
38523 @table @samp
38524
38525 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38526 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38527 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38528 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38529 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38530 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38531 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38532 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38533 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38534 @var{attachment}.
38535
38536 @item @w{}
38537 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38538
38539 @end table
38540
38541 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38542
38543 @table @samp
38544 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38545 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38546 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38547 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38548 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38549 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38550 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38551
38552 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38553 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38554 -1 if an error occurs.
38555
38556 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38557 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38558 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38559 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38560 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38561 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38562 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38563 @var{count} was zero.
38564
38565 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38566 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38567 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38568 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38569 some characters were escaped.
38570
38571 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38572 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38573 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38574 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38575 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38576 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38577 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38578 error occurred.
38579
38580 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38581 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38582 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38583 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38584 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38585 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38586
38587 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38588 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38589 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38590
38591 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38592 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38593 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38594
38595 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38596 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38597 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38598 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38599 some characters were escaped.
38600
38601 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38602 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38603 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38604 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38605 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38606 inferior(s).
38607
38608 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38609 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38610 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38611 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38612 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38613 operation.
38614
38615 @end table
38616
38617 @node Interrupts
38618 @section Interrupts
38619 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38620 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38621
38622 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38623 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38624 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38625 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38626
38627 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38628 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38629 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38630 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38631 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38632
38633 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38634 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38635 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38636 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38637 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38638 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38639 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38640 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38641
38642 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38643 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38644 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38645
38646 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38647 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38648 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38649 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38650 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38651 @code{0x03}.
38652
38653 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38654 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38655 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38656 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38657 currently-executing threads and processes.
38658 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38659 running program, it should send one of the stop
38660 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38661 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38662 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38663 Interrupts received while the
38664 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38665 it is resumed next time.
38666
38667 @node Notification Packets
38668 @section Notification Packets
38669 @cindex notification packets
38670 @cindex packets, notification
38671
38672 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38673 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38674 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38675 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38676 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38677 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38678 is not a problem.
38679
38680 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38681 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38682 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38683 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38684 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38685 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38686 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38687
38688 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38689 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38690
38691 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38692 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38693 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38694 not they understand it.
38695
38696 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38697 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38698 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38699 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38700 recipients.
38701
38702 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38703 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38704 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38705 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38706 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38707
38708 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38709 @table @samp
38710 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38711 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38712 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38713 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38714 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38715 @item @var{ack}
38716 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38717 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38718 @end table
38719
38720 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38721 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38722
38723 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38724 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38725 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38726 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38727 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38728 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38729 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38730 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38731 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38732 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38733
38734 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38735 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38736 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38737 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38738 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38739 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38740
38741 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38742 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38743 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38744 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38745 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38746
38747 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38748 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38749 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38750 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38751 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38752 normally.
38753
38754 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38755 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38756 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38757 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38758 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38759 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38760 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38761 the process shall be repeated.
38762
38763 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38764 following example:
38765 @smallexample
38766 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38767 @code{...}
38768 -> @code{vStopped}
38769 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38770 -> @code{vStopped}
38771 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38772 -> @code{vStopped}
38773 <- @code{OK}
38774 @end smallexample
38775
38776 The following notifications are defined:
38777 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38778
38779 @item Notification
38780 @tab Ack
38781 @tab Event
38782 @tab Description
38783
38784 @item Stop
38785 @tab vStopped
38786 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38787 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38788 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38789 @value{GDBN}.
38790 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38791
38792 @end multitable
38793
38794 @node Remote Non-Stop
38795 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38796
38797 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38798 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38799 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38800 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38801
38802 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38803 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38804 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38805 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38806 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38807 probe the target state after a mode change.
38808
38809 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38810 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38811 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38812 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38813 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38814 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38815 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38816 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38817 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38818 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38819 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38820
38821 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38822 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38823 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38824 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38825 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38826 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38827 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38828 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38829 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38830 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38831 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38832 @samp{OK}.
38833
38834 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38835 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38836 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38837 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38838 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38839 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38840 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38841 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38842 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38843 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38844 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38845 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38846 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38847
38848 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38849 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38850
38851 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38852 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38853 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38854 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38855 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38856 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38857 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38858
38859 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38860 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38861 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38862 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38863 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38864
38865 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38866 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38867 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38868 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38869
38870 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38871 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38872 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38873 @pxref{qSupported}.
38874 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38875 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38876 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38877 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38878 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38879 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38880 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38881
38882 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38883 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38884 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38885 connection.
38886 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38887 new connection is established,
38888 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38889 for the current connection, once disabled.
38890
38891 @node Examples
38892 @section Examples
38893
38894 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38895 does not get any direct output:
38896
38897 @smallexample
38898 -> @code{R00}
38899 <- @code{+}
38900 @emph{target restarts}
38901 -> @code{?}
38902 <- @code{+}
38903 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38904 -> @code{+}
38905 @end smallexample
38906
38907 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38908
38909 @smallexample
38910 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38911 <- @code{+}
38912 -> @code{s}
38913 <- @code{+}
38914 @emph{time passes}
38915 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38916 -> @code{+}
38917 -> @code{g}
38918 <- @code{+}
38919 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38920 -> @code{+}
38921 @end smallexample
38922
38923 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38924 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38925 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38926
38927 @menu
38928 * File-I/O Overview::
38929 * Protocol Basics::
38930 * The F Request Packet::
38931 * The F Reply Packet::
38932 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38933 * Console I/O::
38934 * List of Supported Calls::
38935 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38936 * Constants::
38937 * File-I/O Examples::
38938 @end menu
38939
38940 @node File-I/O Overview
38941 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38942 @cindex file-i/o overview
38943
38944 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38945 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38946 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38947 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38948 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38949 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38950
38951 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38952 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38953 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38954 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38955 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38956
38957 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38958 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38959 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38960 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38961 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38962 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38963 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38964
38965 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38966 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38967 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38968 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38969 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38970
38971 @smallexample
38972 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38973 <- target requests 'system call X'
38974 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38975 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38976 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38977 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38978 @end smallexample
38979
38980 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38981 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38982 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38983 system are not supported by this protocol.
38984
38985 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38986
38987 @node Protocol Basics
38988 @subsection Protocol Basics
38989 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38990
38991 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38992 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38993 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38994 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38995 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38996 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38997 to call the appropriate host system call:
38998
38999 @itemize @bullet
39000 @item
39001 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39002
39003 @item
39004 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39005 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39006 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39007 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39008
39009 @end itemize
39010
39011 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39012
39013 @itemize @bullet
39014 @item
39015 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39016 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39017 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39018 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39019 packet.
39020
39021 @item
39022 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39023 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39024
39025 @item
39026 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39027
39028 @item
39029 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39030
39031 @item
39032 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39033 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39034 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39035 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39036 packet.
39037
39038 @end itemize
39039
39040 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39041 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39042
39043 @itemize @bullet
39044 @item
39045 Return value.
39046
39047 @item
39048 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39049
39050 @item
39051 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39052
39053 @end itemize
39054
39055 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39056 the latest continue or step action.
39057
39058 @node The F Request Packet
39059 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39060 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39061 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39062
39063 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39064
39065 @table @samp
39066 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39067
39068 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39069 This is just the name of the function.
39070
39071 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39072 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39073 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39074 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39075 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39076 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39077 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39078
39079 @end table
39080
39081
39082
39083 @node The F Reply Packet
39084 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39085 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39086 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39087
39088 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39089
39090 @table @samp
39091
39092 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39093
39094 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39095
39096 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39097 representation.
39098 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39099
39100 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39101 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39102 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39103
39104 @smallexample
39105 F0,0,C
39106 @end smallexample
39107
39108 @noindent
39109 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39110
39111 @smallexample
39112 F-1,4,C
39113 @end smallexample
39114
39115 @noindent
39116 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39117
39118 @end table
39119
39120
39121 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39122 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39123 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39124
39125 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39126 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39127 the target should behave as if it had
39128 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39129 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39130 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39131 packet.
39132
39133 It's important for the target to know in which
39134 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39135
39136 @itemize @bullet
39137 @item
39138 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39139
39140 @item
39141 The system call on the host has been finished.
39142
39143 @end itemize
39144
39145 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39146 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39147 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39148 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39149 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39150 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39151
39152 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39153 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39154 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39155 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39156 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39157 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39158 or the full action has been completed.
39159
39160 @node Console I/O
39161 @subsection Console I/O
39162 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39163
39164 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39165 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39166 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39167 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39168 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39169 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39170 conditions is met:
39171
39172 @itemize @bullet
39173 @item
39174 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39175 @code{read}
39176 system call is treated as finished.
39177
39178 @item
39179 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39180 newline.
39181
39182 @item
39183 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39184 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39185
39186 @end itemize
39187
39188 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39189 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39190 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39191 is stopped at the user's request.
39192
39193
39194 @node List of Supported Calls
39195 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39196 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39197
39198 @menu
39199 * open::
39200 * close::
39201 * read::
39202 * write::
39203 * lseek::
39204 * rename::
39205 * unlink::
39206 * stat/fstat::
39207 * gettimeofday::
39208 * isatty::
39209 * system::
39210 @end menu
39211
39212 @node open
39213 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39214 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39215
39216 @table @asis
39217 @item Synopsis:
39218 @smallexample
39219 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39220 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39221 @end smallexample
39222
39223 @item Request:
39224 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39225
39226 @noindent
39227 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39228
39229 @table @code
39230 @item O_CREAT
39231 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39232 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39233 are concerned.
39234
39235 @item O_EXCL
39236 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39237 an error and open() fails.
39238
39239 @item O_TRUNC
39240 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39241 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39242 truncated to zero length.
39243
39244 @item O_APPEND
39245 The file is opened in append mode.
39246
39247 @item O_RDONLY
39248 The file is opened for reading only.
39249
39250 @item O_WRONLY
39251 The file is opened for writing only.
39252
39253 @item O_RDWR
39254 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39255 @end table
39256
39257 @noindent
39258 Other bits are silently ignored.
39259
39260
39261 @noindent
39262 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39263
39264 @table @code
39265 @item S_IRUSR
39266 User has read permission.
39267
39268 @item S_IWUSR
39269 User has write permission.
39270
39271 @item S_IRGRP
39272 Group has read permission.
39273
39274 @item S_IWGRP
39275 Group has write permission.
39276
39277 @item S_IROTH
39278 Others have read permission.
39279
39280 @item S_IWOTH
39281 Others have write permission.
39282 @end table
39283
39284 @noindent
39285 Other bits are silently ignored.
39286
39287
39288 @item Return value:
39289 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39290 occurred.
39291
39292 @item Errors:
39293
39294 @table @code
39295 @item EEXIST
39296 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39297
39298 @item EISDIR
39299 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39300
39301 @item EACCES
39302 The requested access is not allowed.
39303
39304 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39305 @var{pathname} was too long.
39306
39307 @item ENOENT
39308 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39309
39310 @item ENODEV
39311 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39312
39313 @item EROFS
39314 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39315 write access was requested.
39316
39317 @item EFAULT
39318 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39319
39320 @item ENOSPC
39321 No space on device to create the file.
39322
39323 @item EMFILE
39324 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39325
39326 @item ENFILE
39327 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39328 has been reached.
39329
39330 @item EINTR
39331 The call was interrupted by the user.
39332 @end table
39333
39334 @end table
39335
39336 @node close
39337 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39338 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39339
39340 @table @asis
39341 @item Synopsis:
39342 @smallexample
39343 int close(int fd);
39344 @end smallexample
39345
39346 @item Request:
39347 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39348
39349 @item Return value:
39350 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39351
39352 @item Errors:
39353
39354 @table @code
39355 @item EBADF
39356 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39357
39358 @item EINTR
39359 The call was interrupted by the user.
39360 @end table
39361
39362 @end table
39363
39364 @node read
39365 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39366 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39367
39368 @table @asis
39369 @item Synopsis:
39370 @smallexample
39371 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39372 @end smallexample
39373
39374 @item Request:
39375 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39376
39377 @item Return value:
39378 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39379 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39380 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39381
39382 @item Errors:
39383
39384 @table @code
39385 @item EBADF
39386 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39387 reading.
39388
39389 @item EFAULT
39390 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39391
39392 @item EINTR
39393 The call was interrupted by the user.
39394 @end table
39395
39396 @end table
39397
39398 @node write
39399 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39400 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39401
39402 @table @asis
39403 @item Synopsis:
39404 @smallexample
39405 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39406 @end smallexample
39407
39408 @item Request:
39409 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39410
39411 @item Return value:
39412 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39413 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39414 is returned.
39415
39416 @item Errors:
39417
39418 @table @code
39419 @item EBADF
39420 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39421 writing.
39422
39423 @item EFAULT
39424 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39425
39426 @item EFBIG
39427 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39428 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39429
39430 @item ENOSPC
39431 No space on device to write the data.
39432
39433 @item EINTR
39434 The call was interrupted by the user.
39435 @end table
39436
39437 @end table
39438
39439 @node lseek
39440 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39441 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39442
39443 @table @asis
39444 @item Synopsis:
39445 @smallexample
39446 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39447 @end smallexample
39448
39449 @item Request:
39450 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39451
39452 @var{flag} is one of:
39453
39454 @table @code
39455 @item SEEK_SET
39456 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39457
39458 @item SEEK_CUR
39459 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39460 bytes.
39461
39462 @item SEEK_END
39463 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39464 bytes.
39465 @end table
39466
39467 @item Return value:
39468 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39469 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39470 value of -1 is returned.
39471
39472 @item Errors:
39473
39474 @table @code
39475 @item EBADF
39476 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39477
39478 @item ESPIPE
39479 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39480
39481 @item EINVAL
39482 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39483
39484 @item EINTR
39485 The call was interrupted by the user.
39486 @end table
39487
39488 @end table
39489
39490 @node rename
39491 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39492 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39493
39494 @table @asis
39495 @item Synopsis:
39496 @smallexample
39497 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39498 @end smallexample
39499
39500 @item Request:
39501 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39502
39503 @item Return value:
39504 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39505
39506 @item Errors:
39507
39508 @table @code
39509 @item EISDIR
39510 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39511 directory.
39512
39513 @item EEXIST
39514 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39515
39516 @item EBUSY
39517 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39518 process.
39519
39520 @item EINVAL
39521 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39522 of itself.
39523
39524 @item ENOTDIR
39525 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39526 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39527 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39528
39529 @item EFAULT
39530 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39531
39532 @item EACCES
39533 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39534
39535 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39536
39537 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39538
39539 @item ENOENT
39540 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39541
39542 @item EROFS
39543 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39544
39545 @item ENOSPC
39546 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39547 directory entry.
39548
39549 @item EINTR
39550 The call was interrupted by the user.
39551 @end table
39552
39553 @end table
39554
39555 @node unlink
39556 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39557 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39558
39559 @table @asis
39560 @item Synopsis:
39561 @smallexample
39562 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39563 @end smallexample
39564
39565 @item Request:
39566 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39567
39568 @item Return value:
39569 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39570
39571 @item Errors:
39572
39573 @table @code
39574 @item EACCES
39575 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39576
39577 @item EPERM
39578 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39579
39580 @item EBUSY
39581 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39582 being used by another process.
39583
39584 @item EFAULT
39585 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39586
39587 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39588 @var{pathname} was too long.
39589
39590 @item ENOENT
39591 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39592
39593 @item ENOTDIR
39594 A component of the path is not a directory.
39595
39596 @item EROFS
39597 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39598
39599 @item EINTR
39600 The call was interrupted by the user.
39601 @end table
39602
39603 @end table
39604
39605 @node stat/fstat
39606 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39607 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39608 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39609
39610 @table @asis
39611 @item Synopsis:
39612 @smallexample
39613 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39614 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39615 @end smallexample
39616
39617 @item Request:
39618 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39619 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39620
39621 @item Return value:
39622 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39623
39624 @item Errors:
39625
39626 @table @code
39627 @item EBADF
39628 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39629
39630 @item ENOENT
39631 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39632 path is an empty string.
39633
39634 @item ENOTDIR
39635 A component of the path is not a directory.
39636
39637 @item EFAULT
39638 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39639
39640 @item EACCES
39641 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39642
39643 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39644 @var{pathname} was too long.
39645
39646 @item EINTR
39647 The call was interrupted by the user.
39648 @end table
39649
39650 @end table
39651
39652 @node gettimeofday
39653 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39654 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39655
39656 @table @asis
39657 @item Synopsis:
39658 @smallexample
39659 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39660 @end smallexample
39661
39662 @item Request:
39663 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39664
39665 @item Return value:
39666 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39667
39668 @item Errors:
39669
39670 @table @code
39671 @item EINVAL
39672 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39673
39674 @item EFAULT
39675 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39676 @end table
39677
39678 @end table
39679
39680 @node isatty
39681 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39682 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39683
39684 @table @asis
39685 @item Synopsis:
39686 @smallexample
39687 int isatty(int fd);
39688 @end smallexample
39689
39690 @item Request:
39691 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39692
39693 @item Return value:
39694 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39695
39696 @item Errors:
39697
39698 @table @code
39699 @item EINTR
39700 The call was interrupted by the user.
39701 @end table
39702
39703 @end table
39704
39705 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39706 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39707 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39708 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39709 needed.
39710
39711
39712 @node system
39713 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39714 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39715
39716 @table @asis
39717 @item Synopsis:
39718 @smallexample
39719 int system(const char *command);
39720 @end smallexample
39721
39722 @item Request:
39723 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39724
39725 @item Return value:
39726 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39727 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39728 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39729 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39730 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39731 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39732 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39733
39734 @item Errors:
39735
39736 @table @code
39737 @item EINTR
39738 The call was interrupted by the user.
39739 @end table
39740
39741 @end table
39742
39743 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39744 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39745 the host is simplified before it's returned
39746 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39747 is discarded, and the return value consists
39748 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39749
39750 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39751 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39752 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39753
39754 @table @code
39755 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39756 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39757 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39758 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39759
39760 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39761 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39762 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39763 protocol.
39764 @end table
39765
39766 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39767 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39768 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39769
39770 @menu
39771 * Integral Datatypes::
39772 * Pointer Values::
39773 * Memory Transfer::
39774 * struct stat::
39775 * struct timeval::
39776 @end menu
39777
39778 @node Integral Datatypes
39779 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39780 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39781
39782 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39783 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39784 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39785
39786 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39787 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39788
39789 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39790
39791 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39792 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39793
39794 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39795
39796 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39797 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39798 byte order.
39799
39800 @node Pointer Values
39801 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39802 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39803
39804 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39805 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39806 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39807 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39808
39809 @smallexample
39810 @code{1aaf/12}
39811 @end smallexample
39812
39813 @noindent
39814 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39815 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39816 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39817 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39818
39819 @smallexample
39820 @code{123456/d}
39821 @end smallexample
39822
39823 @node Memory Transfer
39824 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39825 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39826
39827 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39828 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39829 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39830 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39831 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39832 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39833 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39834
39835
39836 @node struct stat
39837 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39838 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39839
39840 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39841 is defined as follows:
39842
39843 @smallexample
39844 struct stat @{
39845 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39846 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39847 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39848 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39849 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39850 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39851 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39852 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39853 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39854 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39855 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39856 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39857 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39858 @};
39859 @end smallexample
39860
39861 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39862 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39863 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39864
39865 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39866 range of values.
39867
39868 @table @code
39869
39870 @item st_dev
39871 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39872
39873 @item st_ino
39874 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39875
39876 @item st_mode
39877 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39878 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39879
39880 @item st_uid
39881 @itemx st_gid
39882 @itemx st_rdev
39883 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39884
39885 @item st_atime
39886 @itemx st_mtime
39887 @itemx st_ctime
39888 These values have a host and file system dependent
39889 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39890 support exact timing values.
39891 @end table
39892
39893 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39894 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39895 continuing.
39896
39897 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39898 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39899 get truncated on the target.
39900
39901 @node struct timeval
39902 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39903 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39904
39905 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39906 is defined as follows:
39907
39908 @smallexample
39909 struct timeval @{
39910 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39911 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39912 @};
39913 @end smallexample
39914
39915 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39916 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39917 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39918
39919 @node Constants
39920 @subsection Constants
39921 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39922
39923 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39924 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39925 values before and after the call as needed.
39926
39927 @menu
39928 * Open Flags::
39929 * mode_t Values::
39930 * Errno Values::
39931 * Lseek Flags::
39932 * Limits::
39933 @end menu
39934
39935 @node Open Flags
39936 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39937 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39938
39939 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39940
39941 @smallexample
39942 O_RDONLY 0x0
39943 O_WRONLY 0x1
39944 O_RDWR 0x2
39945 O_APPEND 0x8
39946 O_CREAT 0x200
39947 O_TRUNC 0x400
39948 O_EXCL 0x800
39949 @end smallexample
39950
39951 @node mode_t Values
39952 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39953 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39954
39955 All values are given in octal representation.
39956
39957 @smallexample
39958 S_IFREG 0100000
39959 S_IFDIR 040000
39960 S_IRUSR 0400
39961 S_IWUSR 0200
39962 S_IXUSR 0100
39963 S_IRGRP 040
39964 S_IWGRP 020
39965 S_IXGRP 010
39966 S_IROTH 04
39967 S_IWOTH 02
39968 S_IXOTH 01
39969 @end smallexample
39970
39971 @node Errno Values
39972 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39973 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39974
39975 All values are given in decimal representation.
39976
39977 @smallexample
39978 EPERM 1
39979 ENOENT 2
39980 EINTR 4
39981 EBADF 9
39982 EACCES 13
39983 EFAULT 14
39984 EBUSY 16
39985 EEXIST 17
39986 ENODEV 19
39987 ENOTDIR 20
39988 EISDIR 21
39989 EINVAL 22
39990 ENFILE 23
39991 EMFILE 24
39992 EFBIG 27
39993 ENOSPC 28
39994 ESPIPE 29
39995 EROFS 30
39996 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39997 EUNKNOWN 9999
39998 @end smallexample
39999
40000 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40001 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40002
40003 @node Lseek Flags
40004 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40005 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40006
40007 @smallexample
40008 SEEK_SET 0
40009 SEEK_CUR 1
40010 SEEK_END 2
40011 @end smallexample
40012
40013 @node Limits
40014 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40015 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40016
40017 All values are given in decimal representation.
40018
40019 @smallexample
40020 INT_MIN -2147483648
40021 INT_MAX 2147483647
40022 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40023 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40024 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40025 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40026 @end smallexample
40027
40028 @node File-I/O Examples
40029 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40030 @cindex file-i/o examples
40031
40032 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40033 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40034
40035 @smallexample
40036 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40037 @emph{request memory read from target}
40038 -> @code{m1234,6}
40039 <- XXXXXX
40040 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40041 -> @code{F6}
40042 @end smallexample
40043
40044 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40045 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40046
40047 @smallexample
40048 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40049 @emph{request memory write to target}
40050 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40051 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40052 -> @code{F6}
40053 @end smallexample
40054
40055 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40056 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40057
40058 @smallexample
40059 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40060 -> @code{F-1,9}
40061 @end smallexample
40062
40063 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40064 host is called:
40065
40066 @smallexample
40067 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40068 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40069 <- @code{T02}
40070 @end smallexample
40071
40072 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40073 host is called:
40074
40075 @smallexample
40076 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40077 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40078 <- @code{T02}
40079 @end smallexample
40080
40081 @node Library List Format
40082 @section Library List Format
40083 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40084
40085 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40086 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40087 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40088 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40089 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40090 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40091 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40092 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40093 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40094 are loaded.
40095
40096 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40097 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40098 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40099 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40100
40101 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40102 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40103 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40104 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40105 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40106 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40107
40108 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40109 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40110
40111 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40112 offset, looks like this:
40113
40114 @smallexample
40115 <library-list>
40116 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40117 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40118 </library>
40119 </library-list>
40120 @end smallexample
40121
40122 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40123 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40124
40125 @smallexample
40126 <library-list>
40127 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40128 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40129 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40130 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40131 </library>
40132 </library-list>
40133 @end smallexample
40134
40135 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40136
40137 @smallexample
40138 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40139 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40140 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40141 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40142 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40143 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40144 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40145 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40146 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40147 @end smallexample
40148
40149 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40150 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40151 section for each library.
40152
40153 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40154 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40155 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40156
40157 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40158 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40159 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40160 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40161
40162 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40163 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40164 target, the following parameters are reported:
40165
40166 @itemize @minus
40167 @item
40168 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40169 @code{struct link_map}.
40170 @item
40171 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40172 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40173 @item
40174 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40175 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40176 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40177 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40178 @item
40179 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40180 @end itemize
40181
40182 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40183 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40184 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40185
40186 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40187 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40188
40189 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40190 looks like this:
40191
40192 @smallexample
40193 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40194 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40195 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40196 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40197 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40198 </library-list-svr>
40199 @end smallexample
40200
40201 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40202
40203 @smallexample
40204 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40205 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40206 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40207 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40208 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40209 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40210 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40211 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40212 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40213 @end smallexample
40214
40215 @node Memory Map Format
40216 @section Memory Map Format
40217 @cindex memory map format
40218
40219 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40220 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40221 memory map.
40222
40223 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40224 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40225 lists memory regions.
40226
40227 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40228 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40229
40230 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40231
40232 @smallexample
40233 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40234 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40235 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40236 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40237 <memory-map>
40238 region...
40239 </memory-map>
40240 @end smallexample
40241
40242 Each region can be either:
40243
40244 @itemize
40245
40246 @item
40247 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40248 bytes from there:
40249
40250 @smallexample
40251 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40252 @end smallexample
40253
40254
40255 @item
40256 A region of read-only memory:
40257
40258 @smallexample
40259 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40260 @end smallexample
40261
40262
40263 @item
40264 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40265 bytes in length:
40266
40267 @smallexample
40268 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40269 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40270 </memory>
40271 @end smallexample
40272
40273 @end itemize
40274
40275 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40276 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40277 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40278
40279 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40280
40281 @smallexample
40282 <!-- ................................................... -->
40283 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40284 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40285 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40286 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40287 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40288 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40289 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40290 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40291 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40292 and its type, or device. -->
40293 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40294 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40295 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40296 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40297 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40298 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40299 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40300 @end smallexample
40301
40302 @node Thread List Format
40303 @section Thread List Format
40304 @cindex thread list format
40305
40306 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40307 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40308 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40309 the following structure:
40310
40311 @smallexample
40312 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40313 <threads>
40314 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40315 ... description ...
40316 </thread>
40317 </threads>
40318 @end smallexample
40319
40320 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40321 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40322 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40323 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40324 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40325 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40326 auxiliary information.
40327
40328 @node Traceframe Info Format
40329 @section Traceframe Info Format
40330 @cindex traceframe info format
40331
40332 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40333 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40334 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40335 collected in a traceframe.
40336
40337 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40338 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40339
40340 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40341 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40342
40343 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40344
40345 @smallexample
40346 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40347 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40348 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40349 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40350 <traceframe-info>
40351 block...
40352 </traceframe-info>
40353 @end smallexample
40354
40355 Each traceframe block can be either:
40356
40357 @itemize
40358
40359 @item
40360 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40361 @var{length} bytes from there:
40362
40363 @smallexample
40364 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40365 @end smallexample
40366
40367 @item
40368 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40369 collected:
40370
40371 @smallexample
40372 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40373 @end smallexample
40374
40375 @end itemize
40376
40377 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40378
40379 @smallexample
40380 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40381 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40382
40383 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40384 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40385 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40386 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40387 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40388 @end smallexample
40389
40390 @node Branch Trace Format
40391 @section Branch Trace Format
40392 @cindex branch trace format
40393
40394 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40395 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40396 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40397 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40398
40399 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40400 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40401
40402 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40403 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40404
40405 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40406
40407 @smallexample
40408 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40409 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40410 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40411 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40412 <btrace>
40413 block...
40414 </btrace>
40415 @end smallexample
40416
40417 @itemize
40418
40419 @item
40420 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40421 and ending at @var{end}:
40422
40423 @smallexample
40424 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40425 @end smallexample
40426
40427 @end itemize
40428
40429 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40430
40431 @smallexample
40432 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40433 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40434
40435 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40436 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40437 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40438
40439 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40440
40441 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40442
40443 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40444 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40445 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40446 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40447 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40448
40449 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40450 @end smallexample
40451
40452 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40453 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40454 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40455
40456 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40457 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40458 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40459
40460 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40461 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40462
40463 @table @code
40464 @item bts
40465 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40466 @table @code
40467 @item size
40468 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40469 @end table
40470 @item pt
40471 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40472 PT}) format.
40473 @table @code
40474 @item size
40475 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40476 @end table
40477 @end table
40478
40479 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40480 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40481
40482 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40483
40484 @smallexample
40485 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40486 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40487
40488 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40489 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40490
40491 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40492 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40493 @end smallexample
40494
40495 @include agentexpr.texi
40496
40497 @node Target Descriptions
40498 @appendix Target Descriptions
40499 @cindex target descriptions
40500
40501 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40502 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40503 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40504 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40505 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40506 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40507 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40508
40509 @itemize @bullet
40510 @item
40511 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40512 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40513 @item
40514 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40515 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40516 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40517 @item
40518 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40519 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40520 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40521 @end itemize
40522
40523 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40524 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40525 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40526 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40527 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40528
40529 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40530 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40531
40532 @menu
40533 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40534 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40535 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40536 descriptions.
40537 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40538 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40539 @end menu
40540
40541 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40542 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40543
40544 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40545 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40546 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40547 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40548 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40549 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40550 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40551 Format}.
40552
40553 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40554 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40555 specify a file are:
40556
40557 @table @code
40558 @cindex set tdesc filename
40559 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40560 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40561
40562 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40563 @item unset tdesc filename
40564 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40565 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40566
40567 @cindex show tdesc filename
40568 @item show tdesc filename
40569 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40570 @end table
40571
40572
40573 @node Target Description Format
40574 @section Target Description Format
40575 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40576
40577 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40578 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40579 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40580 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40581 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40582 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40583 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40584
40585 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40586 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40587 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40588 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40589 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40590
40591 Here is a simple target description:
40592
40593 @smallexample
40594 <target version="1.0">
40595 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40596 </target>
40597 @end smallexample
40598
40599 @noindent
40600 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40601 the x86-64 architecture.
40602
40603 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40604 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40605 are explained further below.
40606
40607 @smallexample
40608 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40609 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40610 <target version="1.0">
40611 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40612 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40613 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40614 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40615 </target>
40616 @end smallexample
40617
40618 @noindent
40619 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40620 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40621 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40622 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40623 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40624 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40625 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40626 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40627 the version mismatch.
40628
40629 @subsection Inclusion
40630 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40631 @cindex XInclude
40632 @ifnotinfo
40633 @cindex <xi:include>
40634 @end ifnotinfo
40635
40636 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40637 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40638 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40639 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40640 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40641
40642 @smallexample
40643 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40644 @end smallexample
40645
40646 @noindent
40647 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40648 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40649 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40650 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40651 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40652 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40653 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40654 original description.
40655
40656 @subsection Architecture
40657 @cindex <architecture>
40658
40659 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40660
40661 @smallexample
40662 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40663 @end smallexample
40664
40665 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40666 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40667
40668 @subsection OS ABI
40669 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40670
40671 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40672 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40673
40674 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40675
40676 @smallexample
40677 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40678 @end smallexample
40679
40680 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40681 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40682
40683 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40684 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40685
40686 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40687 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40688
40689 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40690
40691 @smallexample
40692 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40693 @end smallexample
40694
40695 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40696 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40697
40698 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40699 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40700 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40701 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40702 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40703 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40704 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40705
40706 @smallexample
40707 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40708 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40709 @end smallexample
40710
40711 @subsection Features
40712 @cindex <feature>
40713
40714 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40715 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40716 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40717 has this form:
40718
40719 @smallexample
40720 <feature name="@var{name}">
40721 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40722 @var{reg}@dots{}
40723 </feature>
40724 @end smallexample
40725
40726 @noindent
40727 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40728 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40729 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40730 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40731
40732 @subsection Types
40733
40734 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40735 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40736 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40737 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40738 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40739 and enum types.
40740
40741 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40742 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40743 Types must be defined before they are used.
40744
40745 @cindex <vector>
40746 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40747 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40748 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40749 @var{count}:
40750
40751 @smallexample
40752 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40753 @end smallexample
40754
40755 @cindex <union>
40756 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40757 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40758 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40759 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40760
40761 @smallexample
40762 <union id="@var{id}">
40763 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40764 @dots{}
40765 </union>
40766 @end smallexample
40767
40768 @cindex <struct>
40769 @cindex <flags>
40770 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40771 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40772 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40773 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40774 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40775 specified.
40776
40777 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40778
40779 @smallexample
40780 <struct id="@var{id}">
40781 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40782 @dots{}
40783 </struct>
40784 @end smallexample
40785
40786 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40787 No implicit padding is added.
40788
40789 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40790
40791 @smallexample
40792 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40793 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40794 @dots{}
40795 </struct>
40796 @end smallexample
40797
40798 @smallexample
40799 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40800 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40801 @dots{}
40802 </flags>
40803 @end smallexample
40804
40805 The @var{name} value is required.
40806 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40807 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40808 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40809
40810 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40811 is optional.
40812 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40813 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40814
40815 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40816 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40817
40818 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40819
40820 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40821 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40822
40823 @itemize @bullet
40824 @item
40825 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40826 @item
40827 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40828 @end itemize
40829
40830 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40831 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40832
40833 @itemize @bullet
40834 @item
40835 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40836
40837 @smallexample
40838 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40839 $1 = 42
40840 @end smallexample
40841
40842 @end itemize
40843
40844 @subsection Registers
40845 @cindex <reg>
40846
40847 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40848
40849 @smallexample
40850 <reg name="@var{name}"
40851 bitsize="@var{size}"
40852 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40853 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40854 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40855 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40856 @end smallexample
40857
40858 @noindent
40859 The components are as follows:
40860
40861 @table @var
40862
40863 @item name
40864 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40865
40866 @item bitsize
40867 The register's size, in bits.
40868
40869 @item regnum
40870 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40871 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40872 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40873 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40874 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40875 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40876 in order of increasing register number.
40877
40878 @item save-restore
40879 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40880 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40881 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40882 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40883 ABI.
40884
40885 @item type
40886 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40887 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40888 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40889 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40890 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40891 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40892
40893 @item group
40894 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40895 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40896 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40897 in @code{info registers}.
40898
40899 @end table
40900
40901 @node Predefined Target Types
40902 @section Predefined Target Types
40903 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40904
40905 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40906 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40907 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40908 types. The currently supported types are:
40909
40910 @table @code
40911
40912 @item bool
40913 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40914
40915 @item int8
40916 @itemx int16
40917 @itemx int32
40918 @itemx int64
40919 @itemx int128
40920 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40921
40922 @item uint8
40923 @itemx uint16
40924 @itemx uint32
40925 @itemx uint64
40926 @itemx uint128
40927 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40928
40929 @item code_ptr
40930 @itemx data_ptr
40931 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40932 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40933 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40934 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40935 may be marked as data pointers.
40936
40937 @item ieee_single
40938 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40939
40940 @item ieee_double
40941 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40942
40943 @item arm_fpa_ext
40944 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40945
40946 @item i387_ext
40947 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40948
40949 @item i386_eflags
40950 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40951
40952 @item i386_mxcsr
40953 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40954
40955 @end table
40956
40957 @node Enum Target Types
40958 @section Enum Target Types
40959 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40960
40961 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40962 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40963
40964 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40965
40966 @smallexample
40967 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40968 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40969 @dots{}
40970 </enum>
40971 @end smallexample
40972
40973 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40974
40975 @smallexample
40976 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40977 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40978 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40979 </enum>
40980 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40981 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40982 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40983 </flags>
40984 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40985 @end smallexample
40986
40987 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40988 would be printed as:
40989
40990 @smallexample
40991 (gdb) info register flags
40992 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40993 @end smallexample
40994
40995 @node Standard Target Features
40996 @section Standard Target Features
40997 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40998
40999 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41000 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41001 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41002 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41003 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41004 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41005 can recognize them.
41006
41007 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41008 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41009 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41010 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41011 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41012 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41013 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41014 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41015
41016 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41017 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41018 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41019
41020 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41021 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41022 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41023 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41024
41025 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41026 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41027 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41028
41029 @menu
41030 * AArch64 Features::
41031 * ARC Features::
41032 * ARM Features::
41033 * i386 Features::
41034 * MicroBlaze Features::
41035 * MIPS Features::
41036 * M68K Features::
41037 * NDS32 Features::
41038 * Nios II Features::
41039 * PowerPC Features::
41040 * S/390 and System z Features::
41041 * Sparc Features::
41042 * TIC6x Features::
41043 @end menu
41044
41045
41046 @node AArch64 Features
41047 @subsection AArch64 Features
41048 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41049
41050 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41051 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41052 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41053
41054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41055 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41056 and @samp{fpcr}.
41057
41058 @node ARC Features
41059 @subsection ARC Features
41060 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41061
41062 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41063 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41064 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41065 that one of the core registers features is present.
41066 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41067
41068 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41069 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41070 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41071 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41072 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41073 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41074 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41075
41076 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41077 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41078 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41079 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41080 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41081 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41082
41083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41084 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41085 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41086 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41087 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41088 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41089 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41090 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41091 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41092 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41093
41094 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41095 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41096
41097 @node ARM Features
41098 @subsection ARM Features
41099 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41100
41101 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41102 ARM targets.
41103 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41104 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41105
41106 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41107 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41108 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41109 and @samp{xpsr}.
41110
41111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41112 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41113
41114 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41115 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41116 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41117 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41118
41119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41120 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41121 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41122 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41123 halves of the double-precision registers.
41124
41125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41126 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41127 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41128 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41129 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41130 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41131
41132 @node i386 Features
41133 @subsection i386 Features
41134 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41135
41136 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41137 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41138
41139 @itemize @minus
41140 @item
41141 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41142 @item
41143 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41144 @item
41145 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41146 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41147 @item
41148 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41149 @item
41150 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41151 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41152 @end itemize
41153
41154 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41155
41156 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41157 describe registers:
41158
41159 @itemize @minus
41160 @item
41161 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41162 @item
41163 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41164 @item
41165 @samp{mxcsr}
41166 @end itemize
41167
41168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41169 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41170 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41171
41172 @itemize @minus
41173 @item
41174 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41175 @item
41176 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41177 @end itemize
41178
41179 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41180 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41181
41182 @itemize @minus
41183 @item
41184 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41185 @item
41186 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41187 @end itemize
41188
41189 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41190 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41191
41192 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41193 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41194
41195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41196 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41197 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41198
41199 @itemize @minus
41200 @item
41201 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41202 @end itemize
41203
41204 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41205
41206 @itemize @minus
41207 @item
41208 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41209 @end itemize
41210
41211 It should
41212 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41213
41214 @itemize @minus
41215 @item
41216 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41217 @item
41218 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41219 @end itemize
41220
41221 It should
41222 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41223
41224 @itemize @minus
41225 @item
41226 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41227 @end itemize
41228
41229 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41230 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41231 valid for i386 and amd64.
41232
41233 @node MicroBlaze Features
41234 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41235 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41236
41237 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41238 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41239 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41240 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41241 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41242
41243 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41244 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41245
41246 @node MIPS Features
41247 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41248 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41249
41250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41251 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41252 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41253 on the target.
41254
41255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41256 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41257 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41258
41259 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41260 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41261 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41262 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41263
41264 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41265 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41266 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41267 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41268
41269 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41270 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41271 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41272
41273 @node M68K Features
41274 @subsection M68K Features
41275 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41276
41277 @table @code
41278 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41279 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41280 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41281 One of those features must be always present.
41282 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41283 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41284 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41285 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41286
41287 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41288 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41289 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41290 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41291 @end table
41292
41293 @node NDS32 Features
41294 @subsection NDS32 Features
41295 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41296
41297 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41298 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41299 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41300 and @samp{pc}.
41301
41302 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41303 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41304 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41305 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41306
41307 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41308 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41309 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41310 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41311 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41312 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41313 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41314
41315 @node Nios II Features
41316 @subsection Nios II Features
41317 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41318
41319 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41320 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41321 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41322 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41323 @samp{mpuacc}).
41324
41325 @node PowerPC Features
41326 @subsection PowerPC Features
41327 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41328
41329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41330 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41331 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41332 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41333
41334 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41335 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41336
41337 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41338 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41339 and @samp{vrsave}.
41340
41341 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41342 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41343 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41344 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41345 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41346 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41347
41348 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41349 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41350 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41351 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41352 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41353 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41354 user.
41355
41356 @node S/390 and System z Features
41357 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41358 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41359 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41360
41361 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41362 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41363 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41364 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41365 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41366 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41367 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41368 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41369 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41370
41371 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41372 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41373 @samp{fpc}.
41374
41375 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41376 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41377
41378 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41379 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41380 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41381 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41382 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41383 32-bit wide.
41384
41385 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41386 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41387 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41388
41389 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41390 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41391 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41392 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41393 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41394 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41395 @samp{v31}.
41396
41397 @node Sparc Features
41398 @subsection Sparc Features
41399 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41400 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41401 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41402 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41403
41404 @itemize @minus
41405 @item
41406 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41407 @item
41408 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41409 @item
41410 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41411 @item
41412 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41413 @end itemize
41414
41415 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41416
41417 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41418 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41419
41420 @itemize @minus
41421 @item
41422 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41423 @item
41424 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41425 @end itemize
41426
41427 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41428 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41429
41430 @itemize @minus
41431 @item
41432 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41433 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41434 @item
41435 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41436 for sparc64
41437 @end itemize
41438
41439 @node TIC6x Features
41440 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41441 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41442 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41443 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41444 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41445 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41446
41447 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41448 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41449 through @samp{B31}.
41450
41451 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41452 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41453
41454 @node Operating System Information
41455 @appendix Operating System Information
41456 @cindex operating system information
41457
41458 @menu
41459 * Process list::
41460 @end menu
41461
41462 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41463 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41464 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41465 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41466 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41467 on a different aspect of target.
41468
41469 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41470 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41471 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41472 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41473
41474 @node Process list
41475 @appendixsection Process list
41476 @cindex operating system information, process list
41477
41478 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41479 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41480 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41481 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41482
41483 An example document is:
41484
41485 @smallexample
41486 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41487 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41488 <osdata type="processes">
41489 <item>
41490 <column name="pid">1</column>
41491 <column name="user">root</column>
41492 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41493 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41494 </item>
41495 </osdata>
41496 @end smallexample
41497
41498 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41499 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41500 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41501 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41502 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41503 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41504 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41505
41506 @node Trace File Format
41507 @appendix Trace File Format
41508 @cindex trace file format
41509
41510 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41511 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41512
41513 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41514 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41515 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41516 in the future.
41517
41518 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41519 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41520 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41521 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41522 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41523 of this section.
41524
41525 @table @code
41526 @item R @var{size}
41527 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41528 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41529 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41530 a single trace file.
41531
41532 @item status @var{status}
41533 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41534 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41535 file.
41536
41537 @item tp @var{payload}
41538 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41539 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41540 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41541 reply packets.
41542
41543 @item tsv @var{payload}
41544 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41545 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41546 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41547 reply packets.
41548
41549 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41550 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41551 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41552 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41553 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41554 file. Includes are not allowed.
41555
41556 @end table
41557
41558 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41559 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41560 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41561 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41562 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41563 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41564 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41565 endianness.
41566
41567 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41568
41569 @table @code
41570 @item R @var{bytes}
41571 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41572 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41573 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41574
41575 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41576 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41577 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41578 @var{length} bytes.
41579
41580 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41581 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41582 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41583
41584 @end table
41585
41586 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41587 of blocks.
41588
41589 @node Index Section Format
41590 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41591 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41592 @cindex index section format
41593
41594 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41595 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41596 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41597 description.
41598
41599 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41600 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41601 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41602 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41603 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41604 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41605
41606 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41607
41608 @enumerate
41609 @item
41610 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41611 unless otherwise noted:
41612
41613 @enumerate
41614 @item
41615 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41616 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41617 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41618 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41619 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41620 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41621 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41622
41623 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41624 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41625 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41626 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41627
41628 @item
41629 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41630
41631 @item
41632 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41633 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41634 to the next offset.
41635
41636 @item
41637 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41638
41639 @item
41640 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41641
41642 @item
41643 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41644 @end enumerate
41645
41646 @item
41647 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41648 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41649 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41650 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41651 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41652 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41653 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41654 CU indices.
41655
41656 @item
41657 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41658 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41659 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41660 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41661
41662 @item
41663 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41664 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41665
41666 @enumerate
41667 @item
41668 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41669
41670 @item
41671 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41672 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41673
41674 @item
41675 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41676 @end enumerate
41677
41678 @item
41679 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41680 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41681
41682 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41683 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41684 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41685 constant pool.
41686
41687 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41688 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41689 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41690
41691 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41692 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41693 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41694 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41695 index version:
41696
41697 @table @asis
41698 @item Version 4
41699 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41700
41701 @item Versions 5 to 7
41702 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41703 @end table
41704
41705 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41706
41707 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41708 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41709 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41710 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41711 collision.
41712
41713 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41714 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41715 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41716 the code.
41717
41718 @item
41719 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41720 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41721 strings.
41722
41723 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41724 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41725 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41726 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41727 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41728 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41729
41730 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41731 @end enumerate
41732
41733 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41734 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41735 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41736
41737 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41738 (bit 0 = LSB):
41739
41740 @table @asis
41741
41742 @item Bits 0-23
41743 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41744 @item Bits 24-27
41745 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41746 @item Bits 28-30
41747 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41748
41749 @table @asis
41750 @item 0
41751 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41752 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41753 with previous versions of the index.
41754 @item 1
41755 The symbol is a type.
41756 @item 2
41757 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41758 @item 3
41759 The symbol is a function.
41760 @item 4
41761 Any other kind of symbol.
41762 @item 5,6,7
41763 These values are reserved.
41764 @end table
41765
41766 @item Bit 31
41767 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41768
41769 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41770 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41771 @value{GDBN} sources.
41772
41773 @end table
41774
41775 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41776 global/static attributes in the index.
41777
41778 @smallexample
41779 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41780 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41781 switch (die->tag)
41782 @{
41783 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41784 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41785 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41786 kind = TYPE;
41787 is_static = 1;
41788 break;
41789 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41790 kind = VARIABLE;
41791 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41792 break;
41793 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41794 kind = FUNCTION;
41795 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41796 break;
41797 case DW_TAG_constant:
41798 kind = VARIABLE;
41799 is_static = ! is_external;
41800 break;
41801 case DW_TAG_variable:
41802 kind = VARIABLE;
41803 is_static = ! is_external;
41804 break;
41805 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41806 kind = TYPE;
41807 is_static = 0;
41808 break;
41809 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41810 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41811 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41812 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41813 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41814 kind = TYPE;
41815 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41816 break;
41817 default:
41818 assert (0);
41819 @}
41820 @end smallexample
41821
41822 @node Man Pages
41823 @appendix Manual pages
41824 @cindex Man pages
41825
41826 @menu
41827 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41828 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41829 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41830 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41831 @end menu
41832
41833 @node gdb man
41834 @heading gdb man
41835
41836 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41837
41838 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41839 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41840 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41841 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41842 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41843 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41844 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41845 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41846 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41847 @c man end
41848
41849 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41850 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41851 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41852 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41853
41854 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41855 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41856
41857 @itemize @bullet
41858 @item
41859 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41860
41861 @item
41862 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41863
41864 @item
41865 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41866
41867 @item
41868 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41869 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41870 @end itemize
41871
41872 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41873 Modula-2.
41874
41875 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41876 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41877 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41878 by using the command @code{help}.
41879
41880 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41881 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41882 executable program as the argument:
41883
41884 @smallexample
41885 gdb program
41886 @end smallexample
41887
41888 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41889
41890 @smallexample
41891 gdb program core
41892 @end smallexample
41893
41894 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41895 to debug a running process:
41896
41897 @smallexample
41898 gdb program 1234
41899 gdb -p 1234
41900 @end smallexample
41901
41902 @noindent
41903 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41904 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41905 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41906
41907 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41908
41909 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41910 @table @env
41911 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41912 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41913
41914 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41915 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41916
41917 @item bt
41918 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41919
41920 @item print @var{expr}
41921 Display the value of an expression.
41922
41923 @item c
41924 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41925
41926 @item next
41927 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41928 function calls in the line.
41929
41930 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41931 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41932
41933 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41934 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41935
41936 @item step
41937 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41938 function calls in the line.
41939
41940 @item help [@var{name}]
41941 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41942 about using @value{GDBN}.
41943
41944 @item quit
41945 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41946 @end table
41947
41948 @ifset man
41949 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41950 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41951 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41952 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41953 @end ifset
41954 @c man end
41955
41956 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41957 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41958 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41959 encountered with no
41960 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41961 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41962 Many options have
41963 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41964 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41965 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41966 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41967 more usual convention.)
41968
41969 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41970 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41971 option is used.
41972
41973 @table @env
41974 @item -help
41975 @itemx -h
41976 List all options, with brief explanations.
41977
41978 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41979 @itemx -s @var{file}
41980 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41981
41982 @item -write
41983 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41984
41985 @item -exec=@var{file}
41986 @itemx -e @var{file}
41987 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41988 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41989 dump.
41990
41991 @item -se=@var{file}
41992 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41993 file.
41994
41995 @item -core=@var{file}
41996 @itemx -c @var{file}
41997 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41998
41999 @item -command=@var{file}
42000 @itemx -x @var{file}
42001 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42002
42003 @item -ex @var{command}
42004 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42005
42006 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42007 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42008 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42009
42010 @item -nh
42011 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42012
42013 @item -nx
42014 @itemx -n
42015 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42016
42017 @item -quiet
42018 @itemx -q
42019 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42020 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42021
42022 @item -batch
42023 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42024 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42025 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42026 commands in the command files.
42027
42028 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42029 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42030 more useful, the message
42031
42032 @smallexample
42033 Program exited normally.
42034 @end smallexample
42035
42036 @noindent
42037 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42038 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42039
42040 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42041 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42042 instead of the current directory.
42043
42044 @item -fullname
42045 @itemx -f
42046 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42047 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42048 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42049 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42050 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42051 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42052 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42053 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42054
42055 @item -b @var{bps}
42056 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42057 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42058
42059 @item -tty=@var{device}
42060 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42061 @end table
42062 @c man end
42063
42064 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42065 @ifset man
42066 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42067 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42068 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42069
42070 @smallexample
42071 info gdb
42072 @end smallexample
42073
42074 @noindent
42075 should give you access to the complete manual.
42076
42077 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42078 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42079 @end ifset
42080 @c man end
42081
42082 @node gdbserver man
42083 @heading gdbserver man
42084
42085 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42086 @format
42087 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42088 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42089
42090 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42091
42092 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42093 @c man end
42094 @end format
42095
42096 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42097 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42098 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42099
42100 @ifclear man
42101 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42102 @end ifclear
42103 @ifset man
42104 Usage (server (target) side):
42105 @end ifset
42106
42107 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42108 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42109 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42110 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42111
42112 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42113 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42114 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42115
42116 @smallexample
42117 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42118 @end smallexample
42119
42120 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42121
42122 @smallexample
42123 @ifset man
42124 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42125 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42126 @end ifset
42127 @ifclear man
42128 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42129 @end ifclear
42130 @end smallexample
42131
42132 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42133 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42134 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42135
42136 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42137
42138 @smallexample
42139 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42140 @end smallexample
42141
42142 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42143 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42144 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42145 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42146 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42147 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42148 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42149 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42150 print an error message and exit.
42151
42152 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42153 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42154
42155 @smallexample
42156 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42157 @end smallexample
42158
42159 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42160 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42161
42162 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42163 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42164 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42165 the program you want to debug.
42166
42167 @smallexample
42168 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42169 @end smallexample
42170
42171 @ifclear man
42172 @subheading Usage (host side)
42173 @end ifclear
42174 @ifset man
42175 Usage (host side):
42176 @end ifset
42177
42178 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42179 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42180 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42181 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42182 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42183 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42184 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42185 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42186 descriptor. For example:
42187
42188 @smallexample
42189 @ifset man
42190 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42191 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42192 @end ifset
42193 @ifclear man
42194 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42195 @end ifclear
42196 @end smallexample
42197
42198 @noindent
42199 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42200
42201 @smallexample
42202 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42203 @end smallexample
42204
42205 @noindent
42206 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42207 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42208 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42209 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42210 `Connection refused'.
42211
42212 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42213 described in
42214 @ifset man
42215 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42216 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42217 @end ifset
42218 @ifclear man
42219 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42220 @end ifclear
42221 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42222
42223 @smallexample
42224 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42225 @end smallexample
42226
42227 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42228 case.
42229 @c man end
42230
42231 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42232 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42233
42234 @itemize @bullet
42235
42236 @item
42237 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42238
42239 @smallexample
42240 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42241 @end smallexample
42242
42243 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42244 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42245 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42246 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42247 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42248 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42249 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42250
42251 @item
42252 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42253 program:
42254
42255 @smallexample
42256 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42257 @end smallexample
42258
42259 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42260 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42261 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42262 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42263
42264 @item
42265 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42266
42267 @smallexample
42268 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42269 @end smallexample
42270
42271 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42272 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42273 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42274 debug several processes in the same session.
42275 @end itemize
42276
42277 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42278
42279 @table @env
42280
42281 @item --help
42282 List all options, with brief explanations.
42283
42284 @item --version
42285 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42286
42287 @item --attach
42288 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42289
42290 @smallexample
42291 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42292 @end smallexample
42293
42294 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42295 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42296
42297 @item --multi
42298 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42299 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42300 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42301 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42302
42303 @smallexample
42304 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42305 @end smallexample
42306
42307 @item --debug
42308 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42309 process.
42310 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42311 the developers.
42312
42313 @item --remote-debug
42314 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42315 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42316 the developers.
42317
42318 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42319 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42320 of debugging output.
42321 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42322
42323 @item --wrapper
42324 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42325 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42326 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42327 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42328
42329 @item --once
42330 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42331 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42332 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42333 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42334
42335 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42336
42337 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42338 @c QDisableRandomization.
42339
42340 @end table
42341 @c man end
42342
42343 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42344 @ifset man
42345 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42346 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42347 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42348
42349 @smallexample
42350 info gdb
42351 @end smallexample
42352
42353 should give you access to the complete manual.
42354
42355 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42356 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42357 @end ifset
42358 @c man end
42359
42360 @node gcore man
42361 @heading gcore
42362
42363 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42364
42365 @format
42366 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42367 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42368 @c man end
42369 @end format
42370
42371 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42372 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42373 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42374 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42375 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42376 running without any change.
42377 @c man end
42378
42379 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42380 @table @env
42381 @item -o @var{filename}
42382 The optional argument
42383 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42384 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42385 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42386 @end table
42387 @c man end
42388
42389 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42390 @ifset man
42391 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42392 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42393 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42394
42395 @smallexample
42396 info gdb
42397 @end smallexample
42398
42399 @noindent
42400 should give you access to the complete manual.
42401
42402 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42403 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42404 @end ifset
42405 @c man end
42406
42407 @node gdbinit man
42408 @heading gdbinit
42409
42410 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42411
42412 @format
42413 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42414 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42415 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42416 @end ifset
42417
42418 ~/.gdbinit
42419
42420 ./.gdbinit
42421 @c man end
42422 @end format
42423
42424 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42425 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42426 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42427 described in
42428 @ifset man
42429 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42430 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42431 @end ifset
42432 @ifclear man
42433 @ref{Sequences}.
42434 @end ifclear
42435
42436 Please read more in
42437 @ifset man
42438 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42439 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42440 @end ifset
42441 @ifclear man
42442 @ref{Startup}.
42443 @end ifclear
42444
42445 @table @env
42446 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42447 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42448 @end ifset
42449 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42450 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42451 @end ifclear
42452 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42453 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42454 See more in
42455 @ifset man
42456 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42457 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42458 @end ifset
42459 @ifclear man
42460 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42461 @end ifclear
42462
42463 @item ~/.gdbinit
42464 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42465 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42466
42467 @item ./.gdbinit
42468 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42469 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42470 See more in
42471 @ifset man
42472 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42473 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42474 @end ifset
42475 @ifclear man
42476 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42477 @end ifclear
42478 @end table
42479 @c man end
42480
42481 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42482 @ifset man
42483 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42484
42485 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42486 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42487 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42488
42489 @smallexample
42490 info gdb
42491 @end smallexample
42492
42493 should give you access to the complete manual.
42494
42495 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42496 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42497 @end ifset
42498 @c man end
42499
42500 @include gpl.texi
42501
42502 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42503 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42504 @include fdl.texi
42505
42506 @node Concept Index
42507 @unnumbered Concept Index
42508
42509 @printindex cp
42510
42511 @node Command and Variable Index
42512 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42513
42514 @printindex fn
42515
42516 @tex
42517 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42518 % meantime:
42519 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42520 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42521 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42522 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42523 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42524 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42525 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42526 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42527 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42528 \page\colophon
42529 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42530 @end tex
42531
42532 @bye
This page took 1.17382 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.